1 //===- ASTContext.cpp - Context to hold long-lived AST nodes --------------===//
2 //
3 // Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions.
4 // See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information.
5 // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception
6 //
7 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8 //
9 // This file implements the ASTContext interface.
10 //
11 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
12
13 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
14 #include "CXXABI.h"
15 #include "Interp/Context.h"
16 #include "clang/AST/APValue.h"
17 #include "clang/AST/ASTConcept.h"
18 #include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h"
19 #include "clang/AST/ASTTypeTraits.h"
20 #include "clang/AST/Attr.h"
21 #include "clang/AST/AttrIterator.h"
22 #include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h"
23 #include "clang/AST/Comment.h"
24 #include "clang/AST/Decl.h"
25 #include "clang/AST/DeclBase.h"
26 #include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h"
27 #include "clang/AST/DeclContextInternals.h"
28 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
29 #include "clang/AST/DeclOpenMP.h"
30 #include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
31 #include "clang/AST/DeclarationName.h"
32 #include "clang/AST/DependenceFlags.h"
33 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
34 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
35 #include "clang/AST/ExprConcepts.h"
36 #include "clang/AST/ExternalASTSource.h"
37 #include "clang/AST/Mangle.h"
38 #include "clang/AST/MangleNumberingContext.h"
39 #include "clang/AST/NestedNameSpecifier.h"
40 #include "clang/AST/ParentMapContext.h"
41 #include "clang/AST/RawCommentList.h"
42 #include "clang/AST/RecordLayout.h"
43 #include "clang/AST/Stmt.h"
44 #include "clang/AST/StmtOpenACC.h"
45 #include "clang/AST/TemplateBase.h"
46 #include "clang/AST/TemplateName.h"
47 #include "clang/AST/Type.h"
48 #include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
49 #include "clang/AST/UnresolvedSet.h"
50 #include "clang/AST/VTableBuilder.h"
51 #include "clang/Basic/AddressSpaces.h"
52 #include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h"
53 #include "clang/Basic/CommentOptions.h"
54 #include "clang/Basic/ExceptionSpecificationType.h"
55 #include "clang/Basic/IdentifierTable.h"
56 #include "clang/Basic/LLVM.h"
57 #include "clang/Basic/LangOptions.h"
58 #include "clang/Basic/Linkage.h"
59 #include "clang/Basic/Module.h"
60 #include "clang/Basic/NoSanitizeList.h"
61 #include "clang/Basic/ObjCRuntime.h"
62 #include "clang/Basic/ProfileList.h"
63 #include "clang/Basic/SourceLocation.h"
64 #include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
65 #include "clang/Basic/Specifiers.h"
66 #include "clang/Basic/TargetCXXABI.h"
67 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
68 #include "clang/Basic/XRayLists.h"
69 #include "llvm/ADT/APFixedPoint.h"
70 #include "llvm/ADT/APInt.h"
71 #include "llvm/ADT/APSInt.h"
72 #include "llvm/ADT/ArrayRef.h"
73 #include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
74 #include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h"
75 #include "llvm/ADT/FoldingSet.h"
76 #include "llvm/ADT/PointerUnion.h"
77 #include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
78 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
79 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
80 #include "llvm/ADT/StringExtras.h"
81 #include "llvm/ADT/StringRef.h"
82 #include "llvm/Frontend/OpenMP/OMPIRBuilder.h"
83 #include "llvm/Support/Capacity.h"
84 #include "llvm/Support/Casting.h"
85 #include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
86 #include "llvm/Support/ErrorHandling.h"
87 #include "llvm/Support/MD5.h"
88 #include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
89 #include "llvm/Support/SipHash.h"
90 #include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h"
91 #include "llvm/TargetParser/AArch64TargetParser.h"
92 #include "llvm/TargetParser/Triple.h"
93 #include <algorithm>
94 #include <cassert>
95 #include <cstddef>
96 #include <cstdint>
97 #include <cstdlib>
98 #include <map>
99 #include <memory>
100 #include <optional>
101 #include <string>
102 #include <tuple>
103 #include <utility>
104
105 using namespace clang;
106
107 enum FloatingRank {
108 BFloat16Rank,
109 Float16Rank,
110 HalfRank,
111 FloatRank,
112 DoubleRank,
113 LongDoubleRank,
114 Float128Rank,
115 Ibm128Rank
116 };
117
118 /// \returns The locations that are relevant when searching for Doc comments
119 /// related to \p D.
120 static SmallVector<SourceLocation, 2>
getDeclLocsForCommentSearch(const Decl * D,SourceManager & SourceMgr)121 getDeclLocsForCommentSearch(const Decl *D, SourceManager &SourceMgr) {
122 assert(D);
123
124 // User can not attach documentation to implicit declarations.
125 if (D->isImplicit())
126 return {};
127
128 // User can not attach documentation to implicit instantiations.
129 if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
130 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
131 return {};
132 }
133
134 if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
135 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
136 VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
137 return {};
138 }
139
140 if (const auto *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
141 if (CRD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
142 return {};
143 }
144
145 if (const auto *CTSD = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) {
146 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = CTSD->getSpecializationKind();
147 if (TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation ||
148 TSK == TSK_Undeclared)
149 return {};
150 }
151
152 if (const auto *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
153 if (ED->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
154 return {};
155 }
156 if (const auto *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
157 // When tag declaration (but not definition!) is part of the
158 // decl-specifier-seq of some other declaration, it doesn't get comment
159 if (TD->isEmbeddedInDeclarator() && !TD->isCompleteDefinition())
160 return {};
161 }
162 // TODO: handle comments for function parameters properly.
163 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D))
164 return {};
165
166 // TODO: we could look up template parameter documentation in the template
167 // documentation.
168 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(D) ||
169 isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(D) ||
170 isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(D))
171 return {};
172
173 SmallVector<SourceLocation, 2> Locations;
174 // Find declaration location.
175 // For Objective-C declarations we generally don't expect to have multiple
176 // declarators, thus use declaration starting location as the "declaration
177 // location".
178 // For all other declarations multiple declarators are used quite frequently,
179 // so we use the location of the identifier as the "declaration location".
180 SourceLocation BaseLocation;
181 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(D) ||
182 isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D) || isa<RedeclarableTemplateDecl>(D) ||
183 isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D) ||
184 // Allow association with Y across {} in `typedef struct X {} Y`.
185 isa<TypedefDecl>(D))
186 BaseLocation = D->getBeginLoc();
187 else
188 BaseLocation = D->getLocation();
189
190 if (!D->getLocation().isMacroID()) {
191 Locations.emplace_back(BaseLocation);
192 } else {
193 const auto *DeclCtx = D->getDeclContext();
194
195 // When encountering definitions generated from a macro (that are not
196 // contained by another declaration in the macro) we need to try and find
197 // the comment at the location of the expansion but if there is no comment
198 // there we should retry to see if there is a comment inside the macro as
199 // well. To this end we return first BaseLocation to first look at the
200 // expansion site, the second value is the spelling location of the
201 // beginning of the declaration defined inside the macro.
202 if (!(DeclCtx &&
203 Decl::castFromDeclContext(DeclCtx)->getLocation().isMacroID())) {
204 Locations.emplace_back(SourceMgr.getExpansionLoc(BaseLocation));
205 }
206
207 // We use Decl::getBeginLoc() and not just BaseLocation here to ensure that
208 // we don't refer to the macro argument location at the expansion site (this
209 // can happen if the name's spelling is provided via macro argument), and
210 // always to the declaration itself.
211 Locations.emplace_back(SourceMgr.getSpellingLoc(D->getBeginLoc()));
212 }
213
214 return Locations;
215 }
216
getRawCommentForDeclNoCacheImpl(const Decl * D,const SourceLocation RepresentativeLocForDecl,const std::map<unsigned,RawComment * > & CommentsInTheFile) const217 RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForDeclNoCacheImpl(
218 const Decl *D, const SourceLocation RepresentativeLocForDecl,
219 const std::map<unsigned, RawComment *> &CommentsInTheFile) const {
220 // If the declaration doesn't map directly to a location in a file, we
221 // can't find the comment.
222 if (RepresentativeLocForDecl.isInvalid() ||
223 !RepresentativeLocForDecl.isFileID())
224 return nullptr;
225
226 // If there are no comments anywhere, we won't find anything.
227 if (CommentsInTheFile.empty())
228 return nullptr;
229
230 // Decompose the location for the declaration and find the beginning of the
231 // file buffer.
232 const std::pair<FileID, unsigned> DeclLocDecomp =
233 SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc(RepresentativeLocForDecl);
234
235 // Slow path.
236 auto OffsetCommentBehindDecl =
237 CommentsInTheFile.lower_bound(DeclLocDecomp.second);
238
239 // First check whether we have a trailing comment.
240 if (OffsetCommentBehindDecl != CommentsInTheFile.end()) {
241 RawComment *CommentBehindDecl = OffsetCommentBehindDecl->second;
242 if ((CommentBehindDecl->isDocumentation() ||
243 LangOpts.CommentOpts.ParseAllComments) &&
244 CommentBehindDecl->isTrailingComment() &&
245 (isa<FieldDecl>(D) || isa<EnumConstantDecl>(D) || isa<VarDecl>(D) ||
246 isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D))) {
247
248 // Check that Doxygen trailing comment comes after the declaration, starts
249 // on the same line and in the same file as the declaration.
250 if (SourceMgr.getLineNumber(DeclLocDecomp.first, DeclLocDecomp.second) ==
251 Comments.getCommentBeginLine(CommentBehindDecl, DeclLocDecomp.first,
252 OffsetCommentBehindDecl->first)) {
253 return CommentBehindDecl;
254 }
255 }
256 }
257
258 // The comment just after the declaration was not a trailing comment.
259 // Let's look at the previous comment.
260 if (OffsetCommentBehindDecl == CommentsInTheFile.begin())
261 return nullptr;
262
263 auto OffsetCommentBeforeDecl = --OffsetCommentBehindDecl;
264 RawComment *CommentBeforeDecl = OffsetCommentBeforeDecl->second;
265
266 // Check that we actually have a non-member Doxygen comment.
267 if (!(CommentBeforeDecl->isDocumentation() ||
268 LangOpts.CommentOpts.ParseAllComments) ||
269 CommentBeforeDecl->isTrailingComment())
270 return nullptr;
271
272 // Decompose the end of the comment.
273 const unsigned CommentEndOffset =
274 Comments.getCommentEndOffset(CommentBeforeDecl);
275
276 // Get the corresponding buffer.
277 bool Invalid = false;
278 const char *Buffer = SourceMgr.getBufferData(DeclLocDecomp.first,
279 &Invalid).data();
280 if (Invalid)
281 return nullptr;
282
283 // Extract text between the comment and declaration.
284 StringRef Text(Buffer + CommentEndOffset,
285 DeclLocDecomp.second - CommentEndOffset);
286
287 // There should be no other declarations or preprocessor directives between
288 // comment and declaration.
289 if (Text.find_last_of(";{}#@") != StringRef::npos)
290 return nullptr;
291
292 return CommentBeforeDecl;
293 }
294
getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(const Decl * D) const295 RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(const Decl *D) const {
296 const auto DeclLocs = getDeclLocsForCommentSearch(D, SourceMgr);
297
298 for (const auto DeclLoc : DeclLocs) {
299 // If the declaration doesn't map directly to a location in a file, we
300 // can't find the comment.
301 if (DeclLoc.isInvalid() || !DeclLoc.isFileID())
302 continue;
303
304 if (ExternalSource && !CommentsLoaded) {
305 ExternalSource->ReadComments();
306 CommentsLoaded = true;
307 }
308
309 if (Comments.empty())
310 continue;
311
312 const FileID File = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc(DeclLoc).first;
313 if (!File.isValid())
314 continue;
315
316 const auto CommentsInThisFile = Comments.getCommentsInFile(File);
317 if (!CommentsInThisFile || CommentsInThisFile->empty())
318 continue;
319
320 if (RawComment *Comment =
321 getRawCommentForDeclNoCacheImpl(D, DeclLoc, *CommentsInThisFile))
322 return Comment;
323 }
324
325 return nullptr;
326 }
327
addComment(const RawComment & RC)328 void ASTContext::addComment(const RawComment &RC) {
329 assert(LangOpts.RetainCommentsFromSystemHeaders ||
330 !SourceMgr.isInSystemHeader(RC.getSourceRange().getBegin()));
331 Comments.addComment(RC, LangOpts.CommentOpts, BumpAlloc);
332 }
333
334 /// If we have a 'templated' declaration for a template, adjust 'D' to
335 /// refer to the actual template.
336 /// If we have an implicit instantiation, adjust 'D' to refer to template.
adjustDeclToTemplate(const Decl & D)337 static const Decl &adjustDeclToTemplate(const Decl &D) {
338 if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(&D)) {
339 // Is this function declaration part of a function template?
340 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())
341 return *FTD;
342
343 // Nothing to do if function is not an implicit instantiation.
344 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
345 return D;
346
347 // Function is an implicit instantiation of a function template?
348 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getPrimaryTemplate())
349 return *FTD;
350
351 // Function is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
352 if (const FunctionDecl *MemberDecl =
353 FD->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction())
354 return *MemberDecl;
355
356 return D;
357 }
358 if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(&D)) {
359 // Static data member is instantiated from a member definition of a class
360 // template?
361 if (VD->isStaticDataMember())
362 if (const VarDecl *MemberDecl = VD->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember())
363 return *MemberDecl;
364
365 return D;
366 }
367 if (const auto *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(&D)) {
368 // Is this class declaration part of a class template?
369 if (const ClassTemplateDecl *CTD = CRD->getDescribedClassTemplate())
370 return *CTD;
371
372 // Class is an implicit instantiation of a class template or partial
373 // specialization?
374 if (const auto *CTSD = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(CRD)) {
375 if (CTSD->getSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
376 return D;
377 llvm::PointerUnion<ClassTemplateDecl *,
378 ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>
379 PU = CTSD->getSpecializedTemplateOrPartial();
380 return PU.is<ClassTemplateDecl *>()
381 ? *static_cast<const Decl *>(PU.get<ClassTemplateDecl *>())
382 : *static_cast<const Decl *>(
383 PU.get<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>());
384 }
385
386 // Class is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
387 if (const MemberSpecializationInfo *Info =
388 CRD->getMemberSpecializationInfo())
389 return *Info->getInstantiatedFrom();
390
391 return D;
392 }
393 if (const auto *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(&D)) {
394 // Enum is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
395 if (const EnumDecl *MemberDecl = ED->getInstantiatedFromMemberEnum())
396 return *MemberDecl;
397
398 return D;
399 }
400 // FIXME: Adjust alias templates?
401 return D;
402 }
403
getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(const Decl * D,const Decl ** OriginalDecl) const404 const RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(
405 const Decl *D,
406 const Decl **OriginalDecl) const {
407 if (!D) {
408 if (OriginalDecl)
409 OriginalDecl = nullptr;
410 return nullptr;
411 }
412
413 D = &adjustDeclToTemplate(*D);
414
415 // Any comment directly attached to D?
416 {
417 auto DeclComment = DeclRawComments.find(D);
418 if (DeclComment != DeclRawComments.end()) {
419 if (OriginalDecl)
420 *OriginalDecl = D;
421 return DeclComment->second;
422 }
423 }
424
425 // Any comment attached to any redeclaration of D?
426 const Decl *CanonicalD = D->getCanonicalDecl();
427 if (!CanonicalD)
428 return nullptr;
429
430 {
431 auto RedeclComment = RedeclChainComments.find(CanonicalD);
432 if (RedeclComment != RedeclChainComments.end()) {
433 if (OriginalDecl)
434 *OriginalDecl = RedeclComment->second;
435 auto CommentAtRedecl = DeclRawComments.find(RedeclComment->second);
436 assert(CommentAtRedecl != DeclRawComments.end() &&
437 "This decl is supposed to have comment attached.");
438 return CommentAtRedecl->second;
439 }
440 }
441
442 // Any redeclarations of D that we haven't checked for comments yet?
443 // We can't use DenseMap::iterator directly since it'd get invalid.
444 auto LastCheckedRedecl = [this, CanonicalD]() -> const Decl * {
445 return CommentlessRedeclChains.lookup(CanonicalD);
446 }();
447
448 for (const auto Redecl : D->redecls()) {
449 assert(Redecl);
450 // Skip all redeclarations that have been checked previously.
451 if (LastCheckedRedecl) {
452 if (LastCheckedRedecl == Redecl) {
453 LastCheckedRedecl = nullptr;
454 }
455 continue;
456 }
457 const RawComment *RedeclComment = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(Redecl);
458 if (RedeclComment) {
459 cacheRawCommentForDecl(*Redecl, *RedeclComment);
460 if (OriginalDecl)
461 *OriginalDecl = Redecl;
462 return RedeclComment;
463 }
464 CommentlessRedeclChains[CanonicalD] = Redecl;
465 }
466
467 if (OriginalDecl)
468 *OriginalDecl = nullptr;
469 return nullptr;
470 }
471
cacheRawCommentForDecl(const Decl & OriginalD,const RawComment & Comment) const472 void ASTContext::cacheRawCommentForDecl(const Decl &OriginalD,
473 const RawComment &Comment) const {
474 assert(Comment.isDocumentation() || LangOpts.CommentOpts.ParseAllComments);
475 DeclRawComments.try_emplace(&OriginalD, &Comment);
476 const Decl *const CanonicalDecl = OriginalD.getCanonicalDecl();
477 RedeclChainComments.try_emplace(CanonicalDecl, &OriginalD);
478 CommentlessRedeclChains.erase(CanonicalDecl);
479 }
480
addRedeclaredMethods(const ObjCMethodDecl * ObjCMethod,SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl * > & Redeclared)481 static void addRedeclaredMethods(const ObjCMethodDecl *ObjCMethod,
482 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Redeclared) {
483 const DeclContext *DC = ObjCMethod->getDeclContext();
484 if (const auto *IMD = dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(DC)) {
485 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = IMD->getClassInterface();
486 if (!ID)
487 return;
488 // Add redeclared method here.
489 for (const auto *Ext : ID->known_extensions()) {
490 if (ObjCMethodDecl *RedeclaredMethod =
491 Ext->getMethod(ObjCMethod->getSelector(),
492 ObjCMethod->isInstanceMethod()))
493 Redeclared.push_back(RedeclaredMethod);
494 }
495 }
496 }
497
attachCommentsToJustParsedDecls(ArrayRef<Decl * > Decls,const Preprocessor * PP)498 void ASTContext::attachCommentsToJustParsedDecls(ArrayRef<Decl *> Decls,
499 const Preprocessor *PP) {
500 if (Comments.empty() || Decls.empty())
501 return;
502
503 FileID File;
504 for (const Decl *D : Decls) {
505 if (D->isInvalidDecl())
506 continue;
507
508 D = &adjustDeclToTemplate(*D);
509 SourceLocation Loc = D->getLocation();
510 if (Loc.isValid()) {
511 // See if there are any new comments that are not attached to a decl.
512 // The location doesn't have to be precise - we care only about the file.
513 File = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc(Loc).first;
514 break;
515 }
516 }
517
518 if (File.isInvalid())
519 return;
520
521 auto CommentsInThisFile = Comments.getCommentsInFile(File);
522 if (!CommentsInThisFile || CommentsInThisFile->empty() ||
523 CommentsInThisFile->rbegin()->second->isAttached())
524 return;
525
526 // There is at least one comment not attached to a decl.
527 // Maybe it should be attached to one of Decls?
528 //
529 // Note that this way we pick up not only comments that precede the
530 // declaration, but also comments that *follow* the declaration -- thanks to
531 // the lookahead in the lexer: we've consumed the semicolon and looked
532 // ahead through comments.
533 for (const Decl *D : Decls) {
534 assert(D);
535 if (D->isInvalidDecl())
536 continue;
537
538 D = &adjustDeclToTemplate(*D);
539
540 if (DeclRawComments.count(D) > 0)
541 continue;
542
543 const auto DeclLocs = getDeclLocsForCommentSearch(D, SourceMgr);
544
545 for (const auto DeclLoc : DeclLocs) {
546 if (DeclLoc.isInvalid() || !DeclLoc.isFileID())
547 continue;
548
549 if (RawComment *const DocComment = getRawCommentForDeclNoCacheImpl(
550 D, DeclLoc, *CommentsInThisFile)) {
551 cacheRawCommentForDecl(*D, *DocComment);
552 comments::FullComment *FC = DocComment->parse(*this, PP, D);
553 ParsedComments[D->getCanonicalDecl()] = FC;
554 break;
555 }
556 }
557 }
558 }
559
cloneFullComment(comments::FullComment * FC,const Decl * D) const560 comments::FullComment *ASTContext::cloneFullComment(comments::FullComment *FC,
561 const Decl *D) const {
562 auto *ThisDeclInfo = new (*this) comments::DeclInfo;
563 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = D;
564 ThisDeclInfo->IsFilled = false;
565 ThisDeclInfo->fill();
566 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = FC->getDecl();
567 if (!ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters)
568 ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters = FC->getDeclInfo()->TemplateParameters;
569 comments::FullComment *CFC =
570 new (*this) comments::FullComment(FC->getBlocks(),
571 ThisDeclInfo);
572 return CFC;
573 }
574
getLocalCommentForDeclUncached(const Decl * D) const575 comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getLocalCommentForDeclUncached(const Decl *D) const {
576 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(D);
577 return RC ? RC->parse(*this, nullptr, D) : nullptr;
578 }
579
getCommentForDecl(const Decl * D,const Preprocessor * PP) const580 comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getCommentForDecl(
581 const Decl *D,
582 const Preprocessor *PP) const {
583 if (!D || D->isInvalidDecl())
584 return nullptr;
585 D = &adjustDeclToTemplate(*D);
586
587 const Decl *Canonical = D->getCanonicalDecl();
588 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, comments::FullComment *>::iterator Pos =
589 ParsedComments.find(Canonical);
590
591 if (Pos != ParsedComments.end()) {
592 if (Canonical != D) {
593 comments::FullComment *FC = Pos->second;
594 comments::FullComment *CFC = cloneFullComment(FC, D);
595 return CFC;
596 }
597 return Pos->second;
598 }
599
600 const Decl *OriginalDecl = nullptr;
601
602 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(D, &OriginalDecl);
603 if (!RC) {
604 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
605 SmallVector<const NamedDecl*, 8> Overridden;
606 const auto *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
607 if (OMD && OMD->isPropertyAccessor())
608 if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = OMD->findPropertyDecl())
609 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(PDecl, PP))
610 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
611 if (OMD)
612 addRedeclaredMethods(OMD, Overridden);
613 getOverriddenMethods(dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(D), Overridden);
614 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Overridden.size(); i < e; i++)
615 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(Overridden[i], PP))
616 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
617 }
618 else if (const auto *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) {
619 // Attach any tag type's documentation to its typedef if latter
620 // does not have one of its own.
621 QualType QT = TD->getUnderlyingType();
622 if (const auto *TT = QT->getAs<TagType>())
623 if (const Decl *TD = TT->getDecl())
624 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(TD, PP))
625 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
626 }
627 else if (const auto *IC = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
628 while (IC->getSuperClass()) {
629 IC = IC->getSuperClass();
630 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
631 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
632 }
633 }
634 else if (const auto *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(D)) {
635 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = CD->getClassInterface())
636 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
637 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
638 }
639 else if (const auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
640 if (!(RD = RD->getDefinition()))
641 return nullptr;
642 // Check non-virtual bases.
643 for (const auto &I : RD->bases()) {
644 if (I.isVirtual() || (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public))
645 continue;
646 QualType Ty = I.getType();
647 if (Ty.isNull())
648 continue;
649 if (const CXXRecordDecl *NonVirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
650 if (!(NonVirtualBase= NonVirtualBase->getDefinition()))
651 continue;
652
653 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((NonVirtualBase), PP))
654 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
655 }
656 }
657 // Check virtual bases.
658 for (const auto &I : RD->vbases()) {
659 if (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public)
660 continue;
661 QualType Ty = I.getType();
662 if (Ty.isNull())
663 continue;
664 if (const CXXRecordDecl *VirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
665 if (!(VirtualBase= VirtualBase->getDefinition()))
666 continue;
667 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((VirtualBase), PP))
668 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
669 }
670 }
671 }
672 return nullptr;
673 }
674
675 // If the RawComment was attached to other redeclaration of this Decl, we
676 // should parse the comment in context of that other Decl. This is important
677 // because comments can contain references to parameter names which can be
678 // different across redeclarations.
679 if (D != OriginalDecl && OriginalDecl)
680 return getCommentForDecl(OriginalDecl, PP);
681
682 comments::FullComment *FC = RC->parse(*this, PP, D);
683 ParsedComments[Canonical] = FC;
684 return FC;
685 }
686
687 void
Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID & ID,const ASTContext & C,TemplateTemplateParmDecl * Parm)688 ASTContext::CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID,
689 const ASTContext &C,
690 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Parm) {
691 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getDepth());
692 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getPosition());
693 ID.AddBoolean(Parm->isParameterPack());
694
695 TemplateParameterList *Params = Parm->getTemplateParameters();
696 ID.AddInteger(Params->size());
697 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
698 PEnd = Params->end();
699 P != PEnd; ++P) {
700 if (const auto *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P)) {
701 ID.AddInteger(0);
702 ID.AddBoolean(TTP->isParameterPack());
703 if (TTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
704 ID.AddBoolean(true);
705 ID.AddInteger(TTP->getNumExpansionParameters());
706 } else
707 ID.AddBoolean(false);
708 continue;
709 }
710
711 if (const auto *NTTP = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
712 ID.AddInteger(1);
713 ID.AddBoolean(NTTP->isParameterPack());
714 ID.AddPointer(C.getUnconstrainedType(C.getCanonicalType(NTTP->getType()))
715 .getAsOpaquePtr());
716 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
717 ID.AddBoolean(true);
718 ID.AddInteger(NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes());
719 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
720 QualType T = NTTP->getExpansionType(I);
721 ID.AddPointer(T.getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
722 }
723 } else
724 ID.AddBoolean(false);
725 continue;
726 }
727
728 auto *TTP = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P);
729 ID.AddInteger(2);
730 Profile(ID, C, TTP);
731 }
732 }
733
734 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *
getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(TemplateTemplateParmDecl * TTP) const735 ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
736 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP) const {
737 // Check if we already have a canonical template template parameter.
738 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
739 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(ID, *this, TTP);
740 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
741 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm *Canonical
742 = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
743 if (Canonical)
744 return Canonical->getParam();
745
746 // Build a canonical template parameter list.
747 TemplateParameterList *Params = TTP->getTemplateParameters();
748 SmallVector<NamedDecl *, 4> CanonParams;
749 CanonParams.reserve(Params->size());
750 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
751 PEnd = Params->end();
752 P != PEnd; ++P) {
753 // Note that, per C++20 [temp.over.link]/6, when determining whether
754 // template-parameters are equivalent, constraints are ignored.
755 if (const auto *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P)) {
756 TemplateTypeParmDecl *NewTTP = TemplateTypeParmDecl::Create(
757 *this, getTranslationUnitDecl(), SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
758 TTP->getDepth(), TTP->getIndex(), nullptr, false,
759 TTP->isParameterPack(), /*HasTypeConstraint=*/false,
760 TTP->isExpandedParameterPack()
761 ? std::optional<unsigned>(TTP->getNumExpansionParameters())
762 : std::nullopt);
763 CanonParams.push_back(NewTTP);
764 } else if (const auto *NTTP = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
765 QualType T = getUnconstrainedType(getCanonicalType(NTTP->getType()));
766 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
767 NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *Param;
768 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
769 SmallVector<QualType, 2> ExpandedTypes;
770 SmallVector<TypeSourceInfo *, 2> ExpandedTInfos;
771 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
772 ExpandedTypes.push_back(getCanonicalType(NTTP->getExpansionType(I)));
773 ExpandedTInfos.push_back(
774 getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ExpandedTypes.back()));
775 }
776
777 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
778 SourceLocation(),
779 SourceLocation(),
780 NTTP->getDepth(),
781 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
782 T,
783 TInfo,
784 ExpandedTypes,
785 ExpandedTInfos);
786 } else {
787 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
788 SourceLocation(),
789 SourceLocation(),
790 NTTP->getDepth(),
791 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
792 T,
793 NTTP->isParameterPack(),
794 TInfo);
795 }
796 CanonParams.push_back(Param);
797 } else
798 CanonParams.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
799 cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P)));
800 }
801
802 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *CanonTTP = TemplateTemplateParmDecl::Create(
803 *this, getTranslationUnitDecl(), SourceLocation(), TTP->getDepth(),
804 TTP->getPosition(), TTP->isParameterPack(), nullptr, /*Typename=*/false,
805 TemplateParameterList::Create(*this, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
806 CanonParams, SourceLocation(),
807 /*RequiresClause=*/nullptr));
808
809 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
810 Canonical = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
811 assert(!Canonical && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
812 (void)Canonical;
813
814 // Create the canonical template template parameter entry.
815 Canonical = new (*this) CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm(CanonTTP);
816 CanonTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(Canonical, InsertPos);
817 return CanonTTP;
818 }
819
getCXXABIKind() const820 TargetCXXABI::Kind ASTContext::getCXXABIKind() const {
821 auto Kind = getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().getKind();
822 return getLangOpts().CXXABI.value_or(Kind);
823 }
824
createCXXABI(const TargetInfo & T)825 CXXABI *ASTContext::createCXXABI(const TargetInfo &T) {
826 if (!LangOpts.CPlusPlus) return nullptr;
827
828 switch (getCXXABIKind()) {
829 case TargetCXXABI::AppleARM64:
830 case TargetCXXABI::Fuchsia:
831 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM: // Same as Itanium at this level
832 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
833 case TargetCXXABI::WatchOS:
834 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
835 case TargetCXXABI::GenericMIPS:
836 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
837 case TargetCXXABI::WebAssembly:
838 case TargetCXXABI::XL:
839 return CreateItaniumCXXABI(*this);
840 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
841 return CreateMicrosoftCXXABI(*this);
842 }
843 llvm_unreachable("Invalid CXXABI type!");
844 }
845
getInterpContext()846 interp::Context &ASTContext::getInterpContext() {
847 if (!InterpContext) {
848 InterpContext.reset(new interp::Context(*this));
849 }
850 return *InterpContext.get();
851 }
852
getParentMapContext()853 ParentMapContext &ASTContext::getParentMapContext() {
854 if (!ParentMapCtx)
855 ParentMapCtx.reset(new ParentMapContext(*this));
856 return *ParentMapCtx.get();
857 }
858
isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(const TargetInfo & TI,const LangOptions & LangOpts)859 static bool isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(const TargetInfo &TI,
860 const LangOptions &LangOpts) {
861 switch (LangOpts.getAddressSpaceMapMangling()) {
862 case LangOptions::ASMM_Target:
863 return TI.useAddressSpaceMapMangling();
864 case LangOptions::ASMM_On:
865 return true;
866 case LangOptions::ASMM_Off:
867 return false;
868 }
869 llvm_unreachable("getAddressSpaceMapMangling() doesn't cover anything.");
870 }
871
ASTContext(LangOptions & LOpts,SourceManager & SM,IdentifierTable & idents,SelectorTable & sels,Builtin::Context & builtins,TranslationUnitKind TUKind)872 ASTContext::ASTContext(LangOptions &LOpts, SourceManager &SM,
873 IdentifierTable &idents, SelectorTable &sels,
874 Builtin::Context &builtins, TranslationUnitKind TUKind)
875 : ConstantArrayTypes(this_(), ConstantArrayTypesLog2InitSize),
876 DependentSizedArrayTypes(this_()), DependentSizedExtVectorTypes(this_()),
877 DependentAddressSpaceTypes(this_()), DependentVectorTypes(this_()),
878 DependentSizedMatrixTypes(this_()),
879 FunctionProtoTypes(this_(), FunctionProtoTypesLog2InitSize),
880 DependentTypeOfExprTypes(this_()), DependentDecltypeTypes(this_()),
881 TemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
882 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()), AutoTypes(this_()),
883 DependentBitIntTypes(this_()), SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks(this_()),
884 ArrayParameterTypes(this_()), CanonTemplateTemplateParms(this_()),
885 SourceMgr(SM), LangOpts(LOpts),
886 NoSanitizeL(new NoSanitizeList(LangOpts.NoSanitizeFiles, SM)),
887 XRayFilter(new XRayFunctionFilter(LangOpts.XRayAlwaysInstrumentFiles,
888 LangOpts.XRayNeverInstrumentFiles,
889 LangOpts.XRayAttrListFiles, SM)),
890 ProfList(new ProfileList(LangOpts.ProfileListFiles, SM)),
891 PrintingPolicy(LOpts), Idents(idents), Selectors(sels),
892 BuiltinInfo(builtins), TUKind(TUKind), DeclarationNames(*this),
893 Comments(SM), CommentCommandTraits(BumpAlloc, LOpts.CommentOpts),
894 CompCategories(this_()), LastSDM(nullptr, 0) {
895 addTranslationUnitDecl();
896 }
897
cleanup()898 void ASTContext::cleanup() {
899 // Release the DenseMaps associated with DeclContext objects.
900 // FIXME: Is this the ideal solution?
901 ReleaseDeclContextMaps();
902
903 // Call all of the deallocation functions on all of their targets.
904 for (auto &Pair : Deallocations)
905 (Pair.first)(Pair.second);
906 Deallocations.clear();
907
908 // ASTRecordLayout objects in ASTRecordLayouts must always be destroyed
909 // because they can contain DenseMaps.
910 for (llvm::DenseMap<const ObjCContainerDecl*,
911 const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
912 I = ObjCLayouts.begin(), E = ObjCLayouts.end(); I != E; )
913 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
914 if (auto *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout *>((I++)->second))
915 R->Destroy(*this);
916 ObjCLayouts.clear();
917
918 for (llvm::DenseMap<const RecordDecl*, const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
919 I = ASTRecordLayouts.begin(), E = ASTRecordLayouts.end(); I != E; ) {
920 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
921 if (auto *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout *>((I++)->second))
922 R->Destroy(*this);
923 }
924 ASTRecordLayouts.clear();
925
926 for (llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator A = DeclAttrs.begin(),
927 AEnd = DeclAttrs.end();
928 A != AEnd; ++A)
929 A->second->~AttrVec();
930 DeclAttrs.clear();
931
932 for (const auto &Value : ModuleInitializers)
933 Value.second->~PerModuleInitializers();
934 ModuleInitializers.clear();
935 }
936
~ASTContext()937 ASTContext::~ASTContext() { cleanup(); }
938
setTraversalScope(const std::vector<Decl * > & TopLevelDecls)939 void ASTContext::setTraversalScope(const std::vector<Decl *> &TopLevelDecls) {
940 TraversalScope = TopLevelDecls;
941 getParentMapContext().clear();
942 }
943
AddDeallocation(void (* Callback)(void *),void * Data) const944 void ASTContext::AddDeallocation(void (*Callback)(void *), void *Data) const {
945 Deallocations.push_back({Callback, Data});
946 }
947
948 void
setExternalSource(IntrusiveRefCntPtr<ExternalASTSource> Source)949 ASTContext::setExternalSource(IntrusiveRefCntPtr<ExternalASTSource> Source) {
950 ExternalSource = std::move(Source);
951 }
952
PrintStats() const953 void ASTContext::PrintStats() const {
954 llvm::errs() << "\n*** AST Context Stats:\n";
955 llvm::errs() << " " << Types.size() << " types total.\n";
956
957 unsigned counts[] = {
958 #define TYPE(Name, Parent) 0,
959 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
960 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.inc"
961 0 // Extra
962 };
963
964 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Types.size(); i != e; ++i) {
965 Type *T = Types[i];
966 counts[(unsigned)T->getTypeClass()]++;
967 }
968
969 unsigned Idx = 0;
970 unsigned TotalBytes = 0;
971 #define TYPE(Name, Parent) \
972 if (counts[Idx]) \
973 llvm::errs() << " " << counts[Idx] << " " << #Name \
974 << " types, " << sizeof(Name##Type) << " each " \
975 << "(" << counts[Idx] * sizeof(Name##Type) \
976 << " bytes)\n"; \
977 TotalBytes += counts[Idx] * sizeof(Name##Type); \
978 ++Idx;
979 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
980 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.inc"
981
982 llvm::errs() << "Total bytes = " << TotalBytes << "\n";
983
984 // Implicit special member functions.
985 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared << "/"
986 << NumImplicitDefaultConstructors
987 << " implicit default constructors created\n";
988 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared << "/"
989 << NumImplicitCopyConstructors
990 << " implicit copy constructors created\n";
991 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
992 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared << "/"
993 << NumImplicitMoveConstructors
994 << " implicit move constructors created\n";
995 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
996 << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators
997 << " implicit copy assignment operators created\n";
998 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
999 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
1000 << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators
1001 << " implicit move assignment operators created\n";
1002 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared << "/"
1003 << NumImplicitDestructors
1004 << " implicit destructors created\n";
1005
1006 if (ExternalSource) {
1007 llvm::errs() << "\n";
1008 ExternalSource->PrintStats();
1009 }
1010
1011 BumpAlloc.PrintStats();
1012 }
1013
mergeDefinitionIntoModule(NamedDecl * ND,Module * M,bool NotifyListeners)1014 void ASTContext::mergeDefinitionIntoModule(NamedDecl *ND, Module *M,
1015 bool NotifyListeners) {
1016 if (NotifyListeners)
1017 if (auto *Listener = getASTMutationListener())
1018 Listener->RedefinedHiddenDefinition(ND, M);
1019
1020 MergedDefModules[cast<NamedDecl>(ND->getCanonicalDecl())].push_back(M);
1021 }
1022
deduplicateMergedDefinitonsFor(NamedDecl * ND)1023 void ASTContext::deduplicateMergedDefinitonsFor(NamedDecl *ND) {
1024 auto It = MergedDefModules.find(cast<NamedDecl>(ND->getCanonicalDecl()));
1025 if (It == MergedDefModules.end())
1026 return;
1027
1028 auto &Merged = It->second;
1029 llvm::DenseSet<Module*> Found;
1030 for (Module *&M : Merged)
1031 if (!Found.insert(M).second)
1032 M = nullptr;
1033 llvm::erase(Merged, nullptr);
1034 }
1035
1036 ArrayRef<Module *>
getModulesWithMergedDefinition(const NamedDecl * Def)1037 ASTContext::getModulesWithMergedDefinition(const NamedDecl *Def) {
1038 auto MergedIt =
1039 MergedDefModules.find(cast<NamedDecl>(Def->getCanonicalDecl()));
1040 if (MergedIt == MergedDefModules.end())
1041 return std::nullopt;
1042 return MergedIt->second;
1043 }
1044
resolve(ASTContext & Ctx)1045 void ASTContext::PerModuleInitializers::resolve(ASTContext &Ctx) {
1046 if (LazyInitializers.empty())
1047 return;
1048
1049 auto *Source = Ctx.getExternalSource();
1050 assert(Source && "lazy initializers but no external source");
1051
1052 auto LazyInits = std::move(LazyInitializers);
1053 LazyInitializers.clear();
1054
1055 for (auto ID : LazyInits)
1056 Initializers.push_back(Source->GetExternalDecl(ID));
1057
1058 assert(LazyInitializers.empty() &&
1059 "GetExternalDecl for lazy module initializer added more inits");
1060 }
1061
addModuleInitializer(Module * M,Decl * D)1062 void ASTContext::addModuleInitializer(Module *M, Decl *D) {
1063 // One special case: if we add a module initializer that imports another
1064 // module, and that module's only initializer is an ImportDecl, simplify.
1065 if (const auto *ID = dyn_cast<ImportDecl>(D)) {
1066 auto It = ModuleInitializers.find(ID->getImportedModule());
1067
1068 // Maybe the ImportDecl does nothing at all. (Common case.)
1069 if (It == ModuleInitializers.end())
1070 return;
1071
1072 // Maybe the ImportDecl only imports another ImportDecl.
1073 auto &Imported = *It->second;
1074 if (Imported.Initializers.size() + Imported.LazyInitializers.size() == 1) {
1075 Imported.resolve(*this);
1076 auto *OnlyDecl = Imported.Initializers.front();
1077 if (isa<ImportDecl>(OnlyDecl))
1078 D = OnlyDecl;
1079 }
1080 }
1081
1082 auto *&Inits = ModuleInitializers[M];
1083 if (!Inits)
1084 Inits = new (*this) PerModuleInitializers;
1085 Inits->Initializers.push_back(D);
1086 }
1087
addLazyModuleInitializers(Module * M,ArrayRef<GlobalDeclID> IDs)1088 void ASTContext::addLazyModuleInitializers(Module *M,
1089 ArrayRef<GlobalDeclID> IDs) {
1090 auto *&Inits = ModuleInitializers[M];
1091 if (!Inits)
1092 Inits = new (*this) PerModuleInitializers;
1093 Inits->LazyInitializers.insert(Inits->LazyInitializers.end(),
1094 IDs.begin(), IDs.end());
1095 }
1096
getModuleInitializers(Module * M)1097 ArrayRef<Decl *> ASTContext::getModuleInitializers(Module *M) {
1098 auto It = ModuleInitializers.find(M);
1099 if (It == ModuleInitializers.end())
1100 return std::nullopt;
1101
1102 auto *Inits = It->second;
1103 Inits->resolve(*this);
1104 return Inits->Initializers;
1105 }
1106
setCurrentNamedModule(Module * M)1107 void ASTContext::setCurrentNamedModule(Module *M) {
1108 assert(M->isNamedModule());
1109 assert(!CurrentCXXNamedModule &&
1110 "We should set named module for ASTContext for only once");
1111 CurrentCXXNamedModule = M;
1112 }
1113
isInSameModule(const Module * M1,const Module * M2)1114 bool ASTContext::isInSameModule(const Module *M1, const Module *M2) {
1115 if (!M1 != !M2)
1116 return false;
1117
1118 /// Get the representative module for M. The representative module is the
1119 /// first module unit for a specific primary module name. So that the module
1120 /// units have the same representative module belongs to the same module.
1121 ///
1122 /// The process is helpful to reduce the expensive string operations.
1123 auto GetRepresentativeModule = [this](const Module *M) {
1124 auto Iter = SameModuleLookupSet.find(M);
1125 if (Iter != SameModuleLookupSet.end())
1126 return Iter->second;
1127
1128 const Module *RepresentativeModule =
1129 PrimaryModuleNameMap.try_emplace(M->getPrimaryModuleInterfaceName(), M)
1130 .first->second;
1131 SameModuleLookupSet[M] = RepresentativeModule;
1132 return RepresentativeModule;
1133 };
1134
1135 assert(M1 && "Shouldn't call `isInSameModule` if both M1 and M2 are none.");
1136 return GetRepresentativeModule(M1) == GetRepresentativeModule(M2);
1137 }
1138
getExternCContextDecl() const1139 ExternCContextDecl *ASTContext::getExternCContextDecl() const {
1140 if (!ExternCContext)
1141 ExternCContext = ExternCContextDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl());
1142
1143 return ExternCContext;
1144 }
1145
1146 BuiltinTemplateDecl *
buildBuiltinTemplateDecl(BuiltinTemplateKind BTK,const IdentifierInfo * II) const1147 ASTContext::buildBuiltinTemplateDecl(BuiltinTemplateKind BTK,
1148 const IdentifierInfo *II) const {
1149 auto *BuiltinTemplate =
1150 BuiltinTemplateDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(), II, BTK);
1151 BuiltinTemplate->setImplicit();
1152 getTranslationUnitDecl()->addDecl(BuiltinTemplate);
1153
1154 return BuiltinTemplate;
1155 }
1156
1157 BuiltinTemplateDecl *
getMakeIntegerSeqDecl() const1158 ASTContext::getMakeIntegerSeqDecl() const {
1159 if (!MakeIntegerSeqDecl)
1160 MakeIntegerSeqDecl = buildBuiltinTemplateDecl(BTK__make_integer_seq,
1161 getMakeIntegerSeqName());
1162 return MakeIntegerSeqDecl;
1163 }
1164
1165 BuiltinTemplateDecl *
getTypePackElementDecl() const1166 ASTContext::getTypePackElementDecl() const {
1167 if (!TypePackElementDecl)
1168 TypePackElementDecl = buildBuiltinTemplateDecl(BTK__type_pack_element,
1169 getTypePackElementName());
1170 return TypePackElementDecl;
1171 }
1172
buildImplicitRecord(StringRef Name,RecordDecl::TagKind TK) const1173 RecordDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitRecord(StringRef Name,
1174 RecordDecl::TagKind TK) const {
1175 SourceLocation Loc;
1176 RecordDecl *NewDecl;
1177 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
1178 NewDecl = CXXRecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc,
1179 Loc, &Idents.get(Name));
1180 else
1181 NewDecl = RecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc, Loc,
1182 &Idents.get(Name));
1183 NewDecl->setImplicit();
1184 NewDecl->addAttr(TypeVisibilityAttr::CreateImplicit(
1185 const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), TypeVisibilityAttr::Default));
1186 return NewDecl;
1187 }
1188
buildImplicitTypedef(QualType T,StringRef Name) const1189 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitTypedef(QualType T,
1190 StringRef Name) const {
1191 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
1192 TypedefDecl *NewDecl = TypedefDecl::Create(
1193 const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), getTranslationUnitDecl(),
1194 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), &Idents.get(Name), TInfo);
1195 NewDecl->setImplicit();
1196 return NewDecl;
1197 }
1198
getInt128Decl() const1199 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getInt128Decl() const {
1200 if (!Int128Decl)
1201 Int128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(Int128Ty, "__int128_t");
1202 return Int128Decl;
1203 }
1204
getUInt128Decl() const1205 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getUInt128Decl() const {
1206 if (!UInt128Decl)
1207 UInt128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(UnsignedInt128Ty, "__uint128_t");
1208 return UInt128Decl;
1209 }
1210
InitBuiltinType(CanQualType & R,BuiltinType::Kind K)1211 void ASTContext::InitBuiltinType(CanQualType &R, BuiltinType::Kind K) {
1212 auto *Ty = new (*this, alignof(BuiltinType)) BuiltinType(K);
1213 R = CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(QualType(Ty, 0));
1214 Types.push_back(Ty);
1215 }
1216
InitBuiltinTypes(const TargetInfo & Target,const TargetInfo * AuxTarget)1217 void ASTContext::InitBuiltinTypes(const TargetInfo &Target,
1218 const TargetInfo *AuxTarget) {
1219 assert((!this->Target || this->Target == &Target) &&
1220 "Incorrect target reinitialization");
1221 assert(VoidTy.isNull() && "Context reinitialized?");
1222
1223 this->Target = &Target;
1224 this->AuxTarget = AuxTarget;
1225
1226 ABI.reset(createCXXABI(Target));
1227 AddrSpaceMapMangling = isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(Target, LangOpts);
1228
1229 // C99 6.2.5p19.
1230 InitBuiltinType(VoidTy, BuiltinType::Void);
1231
1232 // C99 6.2.5p2.
1233 InitBuiltinType(BoolTy, BuiltinType::Bool);
1234 // C99 6.2.5p3.
1235 if (LangOpts.CharIsSigned)
1236 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_S);
1237 else
1238 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_U);
1239 // C99 6.2.5p4.
1240 InitBuiltinType(SignedCharTy, BuiltinType::SChar);
1241 InitBuiltinType(ShortTy, BuiltinType::Short);
1242 InitBuiltinType(IntTy, BuiltinType::Int);
1243 InitBuiltinType(LongTy, BuiltinType::Long);
1244 InitBuiltinType(LongLongTy, BuiltinType::LongLong);
1245
1246 // C99 6.2.5p6.
1247 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedCharTy, BuiltinType::UChar);
1248 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedShortTy, BuiltinType::UShort);
1249 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedIntTy, BuiltinType::UInt);
1250 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongTy, BuiltinType::ULong);
1251 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongLongTy, BuiltinType::ULongLong);
1252
1253 // C99 6.2.5p10.
1254 InitBuiltinType(FloatTy, BuiltinType::Float);
1255 InitBuiltinType(DoubleTy, BuiltinType::Double);
1256 InitBuiltinType(LongDoubleTy, BuiltinType::LongDouble);
1257
1258 // GNU extension, __float128 for IEEE quadruple precision
1259 InitBuiltinType(Float128Ty, BuiltinType::Float128);
1260
1261 // __ibm128 for IBM extended precision
1262 InitBuiltinType(Ibm128Ty, BuiltinType::Ibm128);
1263
1264 // C11 extension ISO/IEC TS 18661-3
1265 InitBuiltinType(Float16Ty, BuiltinType::Float16);
1266
1267 // ISO/IEC JTC1 SC22 WG14 N1169 Extension
1268 InitBuiltinType(ShortAccumTy, BuiltinType::ShortAccum);
1269 InitBuiltinType(AccumTy, BuiltinType::Accum);
1270 InitBuiltinType(LongAccumTy, BuiltinType::LongAccum);
1271 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedShortAccumTy, BuiltinType::UShortAccum);
1272 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedAccumTy, BuiltinType::UAccum);
1273 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongAccumTy, BuiltinType::ULongAccum);
1274 InitBuiltinType(ShortFractTy, BuiltinType::ShortFract);
1275 InitBuiltinType(FractTy, BuiltinType::Fract);
1276 InitBuiltinType(LongFractTy, BuiltinType::LongFract);
1277 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedShortFractTy, BuiltinType::UShortFract);
1278 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedFractTy, BuiltinType::UFract);
1279 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongFractTy, BuiltinType::ULongFract);
1280 InitBuiltinType(SatShortAccumTy, BuiltinType::SatShortAccum);
1281 InitBuiltinType(SatAccumTy, BuiltinType::SatAccum);
1282 InitBuiltinType(SatLongAccumTy, BuiltinType::SatLongAccum);
1283 InitBuiltinType(SatUnsignedShortAccumTy, BuiltinType::SatUShortAccum);
1284 InitBuiltinType(SatUnsignedAccumTy, BuiltinType::SatUAccum);
1285 InitBuiltinType(SatUnsignedLongAccumTy, BuiltinType::SatULongAccum);
1286 InitBuiltinType(SatShortFractTy, BuiltinType::SatShortFract);
1287 InitBuiltinType(SatFractTy, BuiltinType::SatFract);
1288 InitBuiltinType(SatLongFractTy, BuiltinType::SatLongFract);
1289 InitBuiltinType(SatUnsignedShortFractTy, BuiltinType::SatUShortFract);
1290 InitBuiltinType(SatUnsignedFractTy, BuiltinType::SatUFract);
1291 InitBuiltinType(SatUnsignedLongFractTy, BuiltinType::SatULongFract);
1292
1293 // GNU extension, 128-bit integers.
1294 InitBuiltinType(Int128Ty, BuiltinType::Int128);
1295 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedInt128Ty, BuiltinType::UInt128);
1296
1297 // C++ 3.9.1p5
1298 if (TargetInfo::isTypeSigned(Target.getWCharType()))
1299 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_S);
1300 else // -fshort-wchar makes wchar_t be unsigned.
1301 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_U);
1302 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus && LangOpts.WChar)
1303 WideCharTy = WCharTy;
1304 else {
1305 // C99 (or C++ using -fno-wchar).
1306 WideCharTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWCharType());
1307 }
1308
1309 WIntTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWIntType());
1310
1311 // C++20 (proposed)
1312 InitBuiltinType(Char8Ty, BuiltinType::Char8);
1313
1314 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
1315 InitBuiltinType(Char16Ty, BuiltinType::Char16);
1316 else // C99
1317 Char16Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar16Type());
1318
1319 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
1320 InitBuiltinType(Char32Ty, BuiltinType::Char32);
1321 else // C99
1322 Char32Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar32Type());
1323
1324 // Placeholder type for type-dependent expressions whose type is
1325 // completely unknown. No code should ever check a type against
1326 // DependentTy and users should never see it; however, it is here to
1327 // help diagnose failures to properly check for type-dependent
1328 // expressions.
1329 InitBuiltinType(DependentTy, BuiltinType::Dependent);
1330
1331 // Placeholder type for functions.
1332 InitBuiltinType(OverloadTy, BuiltinType::Overload);
1333
1334 // Placeholder type for bound members.
1335 InitBuiltinType(BoundMemberTy, BuiltinType::BoundMember);
1336
1337 // Placeholder type for unresolved templates.
1338 InitBuiltinType(UnresolvedTemplateTy, BuiltinType::UnresolvedTemplate);
1339
1340 // Placeholder type for pseudo-objects.
1341 InitBuiltinType(PseudoObjectTy, BuiltinType::PseudoObject);
1342
1343 // "any" type; useful for debugger-like clients.
1344 InitBuiltinType(UnknownAnyTy, BuiltinType::UnknownAny);
1345
1346 // Placeholder type for unbridged ARC casts.
1347 InitBuiltinType(ARCUnbridgedCastTy, BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast);
1348
1349 // Placeholder type for builtin functions.
1350 InitBuiltinType(BuiltinFnTy, BuiltinType::BuiltinFn);
1351
1352 // Placeholder type for OMP array sections.
1353 if (LangOpts.OpenMP) {
1354 InitBuiltinType(ArraySectionTy, BuiltinType::ArraySection);
1355 InitBuiltinType(OMPArrayShapingTy, BuiltinType::OMPArrayShaping);
1356 InitBuiltinType(OMPIteratorTy, BuiltinType::OMPIterator);
1357 }
1358 // Placeholder type for OpenACC array sections, if we are ALSO in OMP mode,
1359 // don't bother, as we're just using the same type as OMP.
1360 if (LangOpts.OpenACC && !LangOpts.OpenMP) {
1361 InitBuiltinType(ArraySectionTy, BuiltinType::ArraySection);
1362 }
1363 if (LangOpts.MatrixTypes)
1364 InitBuiltinType(IncompleteMatrixIdxTy, BuiltinType::IncompleteMatrixIdx);
1365
1366 // Builtin types for 'id', 'Class', and 'SEL'.
1367 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, BuiltinType::ObjCId);
1368 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, BuiltinType::ObjCClass);
1369 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy, BuiltinType::ObjCSel);
1370
1371 if (LangOpts.OpenCL) {
1372 #define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
1373 InitBuiltinType(SingletonId, BuiltinType::Id);
1374 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
1375
1376 InitBuiltinType(OCLSamplerTy, BuiltinType::OCLSampler);
1377 InitBuiltinType(OCLEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLEvent);
1378 InitBuiltinType(OCLClkEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent);
1379 InitBuiltinType(OCLQueueTy, BuiltinType::OCLQueue);
1380 InitBuiltinType(OCLReserveIDTy, BuiltinType::OCLReserveID);
1381
1382 #define EXT_OPAQUE_TYPE(ExtType, Id, Ext) \
1383 InitBuiltinType(Id##Ty, BuiltinType::Id);
1384 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLExtensionTypes.def"
1385 }
1386
1387 if (Target.hasAArch64SVETypes() ||
1388 (AuxTarget && AuxTarget->hasAArch64SVETypes())) {
1389 #define SVE_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) \
1390 InitBuiltinType(SingletonId, BuiltinType::Id);
1391 #include "clang/Basic/AArch64SVEACLETypes.def"
1392 }
1393
1394 if (Target.getTriple().isPPC64()) {
1395 #define PPC_VECTOR_MMA_TYPE(Name, Id, Size) \
1396 InitBuiltinType(Id##Ty, BuiltinType::Id);
1397 #include "clang/Basic/PPCTypes.def"
1398 #define PPC_VECTOR_VSX_TYPE(Name, Id, Size) \
1399 InitBuiltinType(Id##Ty, BuiltinType::Id);
1400 #include "clang/Basic/PPCTypes.def"
1401 }
1402
1403 if (Target.hasRISCVVTypes()) {
1404 #define RVV_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) \
1405 InitBuiltinType(SingletonId, BuiltinType::Id);
1406 #include "clang/Basic/RISCVVTypes.def"
1407 }
1408
1409 if (Target.getTriple().isWasm() && Target.hasFeature("reference-types")) {
1410 #define WASM_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) \
1411 InitBuiltinType(SingletonId, BuiltinType::Id);
1412 #include "clang/Basic/WebAssemblyReferenceTypes.def"
1413 }
1414
1415 if (Target.getTriple().isAMDGPU() ||
1416 (AuxTarget && AuxTarget->getTriple().isAMDGPU())) {
1417 #define AMDGPU_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) \
1418 InitBuiltinType(SingletonId, BuiltinType::Id);
1419 #include "clang/Basic/AMDGPUTypes.def"
1420 }
1421
1422 // Builtin type for __objc_yes and __objc_no
1423 ObjCBuiltinBoolTy = (Target.useSignedCharForObjCBool() ?
1424 SignedCharTy : BoolTy);
1425
1426 ObjCConstantStringType = QualType();
1427
1428 ObjCSuperType = QualType();
1429
1430 // void * type
1431 if (LangOpts.OpenCLGenericAddressSpace) {
1432 auto Q = VoidTy.getQualifiers();
1433 Q.setAddressSpace(LangAS::opencl_generic);
1434 VoidPtrTy = getPointerType(getCanonicalType(
1435 getQualifiedType(VoidTy.getUnqualifiedType(), Q)));
1436 } else {
1437 VoidPtrTy = getPointerType(VoidTy);
1438 }
1439
1440 // nullptr type (C++0x 2.14.7)
1441 InitBuiltinType(NullPtrTy, BuiltinType::NullPtr);
1442
1443 // half type (OpenCL 6.1.1.1) / ARM NEON __fp16
1444 InitBuiltinType(HalfTy, BuiltinType::Half);
1445
1446 InitBuiltinType(BFloat16Ty, BuiltinType::BFloat16);
1447
1448 // Builtin type used to help define __builtin_va_list.
1449 VaListTagDecl = nullptr;
1450
1451 // MSVC predeclares struct _GUID, and we need it to create MSGuidDecls.
1452 if (LangOpts.MicrosoftExt || LangOpts.Borland) {
1453 MSGuidTagDecl = buildImplicitRecord("_GUID");
1454 getTranslationUnitDecl()->addDecl(MSGuidTagDecl);
1455 }
1456 }
1457
getDiagnostics() const1458 DiagnosticsEngine &ASTContext::getDiagnostics() const {
1459 return SourceMgr.getDiagnostics();
1460 }
1461
getDeclAttrs(const Decl * D)1462 AttrVec& ASTContext::getDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1463 AttrVec *&Result = DeclAttrs[D];
1464 if (!Result) {
1465 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(AttrVec));
1466 Result = new (Mem) AttrVec;
1467 }
1468
1469 return *Result;
1470 }
1471
1472 /// Erase the attributes corresponding to the given declaration.
eraseDeclAttrs(const Decl * D)1473 void ASTContext::eraseDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1474 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator Pos = DeclAttrs.find(D);
1475 if (Pos != DeclAttrs.end()) {
1476 Pos->second->~AttrVec();
1477 DeclAttrs.erase(Pos);
1478 }
1479 }
1480
1481 // FIXME: Remove ?
1482 MemberSpecializationInfo *
getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(const VarDecl * Var)1483 ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(const VarDecl *Var) {
1484 assert(Var->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
1485 return getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Var)
1486 .dyn_cast<MemberSpecializationInfo *>();
1487 }
1488
1489 ASTContext::TemplateOrSpecializationInfo
getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(const VarDecl * Var)1490 ASTContext::getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(const VarDecl *Var) {
1491 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, TemplateOrSpecializationInfo>::iterator Pos =
1492 TemplateOrInstantiation.find(Var);
1493 if (Pos == TemplateOrInstantiation.end())
1494 return {};
1495
1496 return Pos->second;
1497 }
1498
1499 void
setInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(VarDecl * Inst,VarDecl * Tmpl,TemplateSpecializationKind TSK,SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation)1500 ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(VarDecl *Inst, VarDecl *Tmpl,
1501 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK,
1502 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation) {
1503 assert(Inst->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
1504 assert(Tmpl->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
1505 setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Inst, new (*this) MemberSpecializationInfo(
1506 Tmpl, TSK, PointOfInstantiation));
1507 }
1508
1509 void
setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(VarDecl * Inst,TemplateOrSpecializationInfo TSI)1510 ASTContext::setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(VarDecl *Inst,
1511 TemplateOrSpecializationInfo TSI) {
1512 assert(!TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] &&
1513 "Already noted what the variable was instantiated from");
1514 TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] = TSI;
1515 }
1516
1517 NamedDecl *
getInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(NamedDecl * UUD)1518 ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(NamedDecl *UUD) {
1519 return InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.lookup(UUD);
1520 }
1521
1522 void
setInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(NamedDecl * Inst,NamedDecl * Pattern)1523 ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(NamedDecl *Inst, NamedDecl *Pattern) {
1524 assert((isa<UsingDecl>(Pattern) ||
1525 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(Pattern) ||
1526 isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Pattern)) &&
1527 "pattern decl is not a using decl");
1528 assert((isa<UsingDecl>(Inst) ||
1529 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(Inst) ||
1530 isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Inst)) &&
1531 "instantiation did not produce a using decl");
1532 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1533 InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
1534 }
1535
1536 UsingEnumDecl *
getInstantiatedFromUsingEnumDecl(UsingEnumDecl * UUD)1537 ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingEnumDecl(UsingEnumDecl *UUD) {
1538 return InstantiatedFromUsingEnumDecl.lookup(UUD);
1539 }
1540
setInstantiatedFromUsingEnumDecl(UsingEnumDecl * Inst,UsingEnumDecl * Pattern)1541 void ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingEnumDecl(UsingEnumDecl *Inst,
1542 UsingEnumDecl *Pattern) {
1543 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingEnumDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1544 InstantiatedFromUsingEnumDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
1545 }
1546
1547 UsingShadowDecl *
getInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl * Inst)1548 ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst) {
1549 return InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.lookup(Inst);
1550 }
1551
1552 void
setInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl * Inst,UsingShadowDecl * Pattern)1553 ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst,
1554 UsingShadowDecl *Pattern) {
1555 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1556 InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
1557 }
1558
getInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl * Field)1559 FieldDecl *ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Field) {
1560 return InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.lookup(Field);
1561 }
1562
setInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl * Inst,FieldDecl * Tmpl)1563 void ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Inst,
1564 FieldDecl *Tmpl) {
1565 assert(!Inst->getDeclName() && "Instantiated field decl is not unnamed");
1566 assert(!Tmpl->getDeclName() && "Template field decl is not unnamed");
1567 assert(!InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] &&
1568 "Already noted what unnamed field was instantiated from");
1569
1570 InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] = Tmpl;
1571 }
1572
1573 ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
overridden_methods_begin(const CXXMethodDecl * Method) const1574 ASTContext::overridden_methods_begin(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1575 return overridden_methods(Method).begin();
1576 }
1577
1578 ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
overridden_methods_end(const CXXMethodDecl * Method) const1579 ASTContext::overridden_methods_end(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1580 return overridden_methods(Method).end();
1581 }
1582
1583 unsigned
overridden_methods_size(const CXXMethodDecl * Method) const1584 ASTContext::overridden_methods_size(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1585 auto Range = overridden_methods(Method);
1586 return Range.end() - Range.begin();
1587 }
1588
1589 ASTContext::overridden_method_range
overridden_methods(const CXXMethodDecl * Method) const1590 ASTContext::overridden_methods(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1591 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos =
1592 OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
1593 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1594 return overridden_method_range(nullptr, nullptr);
1595 return overridden_method_range(Pos->second.begin(), Pos->second.end());
1596 }
1597
addOverriddenMethod(const CXXMethodDecl * Method,const CXXMethodDecl * Overridden)1598 void ASTContext::addOverriddenMethod(const CXXMethodDecl *Method,
1599 const CXXMethodDecl *Overridden) {
1600 assert(Method->isCanonicalDecl() && Overridden->isCanonicalDecl());
1601 OverriddenMethods[Method].push_back(Overridden);
1602 }
1603
getOverriddenMethods(const NamedDecl * D,SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl * > & Overridden) const1604 void ASTContext::getOverriddenMethods(
1605 const NamedDecl *D,
1606 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Overridden) const {
1607 assert(D);
1608
1609 if (const auto *CXXMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
1610 Overridden.append(overridden_methods_begin(CXXMethod),
1611 overridden_methods_end(CXXMethod));
1612 return;
1613 }
1614
1615 const auto *Method = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
1616 if (!Method)
1617 return;
1618
1619 SmallVector<const ObjCMethodDecl *, 8> OverDecls;
1620 Method->getOverriddenMethods(OverDecls);
1621 Overridden.append(OverDecls.begin(), OverDecls.end());
1622 }
1623
addedLocalImportDecl(ImportDecl * Import)1624 void ASTContext::addedLocalImportDecl(ImportDecl *Import) {
1625 assert(!Import->getNextLocalImport() &&
1626 "Import declaration already in the chain");
1627 assert(!Import->isFromASTFile() && "Non-local import declaration");
1628 if (!FirstLocalImport) {
1629 FirstLocalImport = Import;
1630 LastLocalImport = Import;
1631 return;
1632 }
1633
1634 LastLocalImport->setNextLocalImport(Import);
1635 LastLocalImport = Import;
1636 }
1637
1638 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1639 // Type Sizing and Analysis
1640 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1641
1642 /// getFloatTypeSemantics - Return the APFloat 'semantics' for the specified
1643 /// scalar floating point type.
getFloatTypeSemantics(QualType T) const1644 const llvm::fltSemantics &ASTContext::getFloatTypeSemantics(QualType T) const {
1645 switch (T->castAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
1646 default:
1647 llvm_unreachable("Not a floating point type!");
1648 case BuiltinType::BFloat16:
1649 return Target->getBFloat16Format();
1650 case BuiltinType::Float16:
1651 return Target->getHalfFormat();
1652 case BuiltinType::Half:
1653 return Target->getHalfFormat();
1654 case BuiltinType::Float: return Target->getFloatFormat();
1655 case BuiltinType::Double: return Target->getDoubleFormat();
1656 case BuiltinType::Ibm128:
1657 return Target->getIbm128Format();
1658 case BuiltinType::LongDouble:
1659 if (getLangOpts().OpenMP && getLangOpts().OpenMPIsTargetDevice)
1660 return AuxTarget->getLongDoubleFormat();
1661 return Target->getLongDoubleFormat();
1662 case BuiltinType::Float128:
1663 if (getLangOpts().OpenMP && getLangOpts().OpenMPIsTargetDevice)
1664 return AuxTarget->getFloat128Format();
1665 return Target->getFloat128Format();
1666 }
1667 }
1668
getDeclAlign(const Decl * D,bool ForAlignof) const1669 CharUnits ASTContext::getDeclAlign(const Decl *D, bool ForAlignof) const {
1670 unsigned Align = Target->getCharWidth();
1671
1672 const unsigned AlignFromAttr = D->getMaxAlignment();
1673 if (AlignFromAttr)
1674 Align = AlignFromAttr;
1675
1676 // __attribute__((aligned)) can increase or decrease alignment
1677 // *except* on a struct or struct member, where it only increases
1678 // alignment unless 'packed' is also specified.
1679 //
1680 // It is an error for alignas to decrease alignment, so we can
1681 // ignore that possibility; Sema should diagnose it.
1682 bool UseAlignAttrOnly;
1683 if (const FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(D))
1684 UseAlignAttrOnly =
1685 FD->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() || FD->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
1686 else
1687 UseAlignAttrOnly = AlignFromAttr != 0;
1688 // If we're using the align attribute only, just ignore everything
1689 // else about the declaration and its type.
1690 if (UseAlignAttrOnly) {
1691 // do nothing
1692 } else if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D)) {
1693 QualType T = VD->getType();
1694 if (const auto *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
1695 if (ForAlignof)
1696 T = RT->getPointeeType();
1697 else
1698 T = getPointerType(RT->getPointeeType());
1699 }
1700 QualType BaseT = getBaseElementType(T);
1701 if (T->isFunctionType())
1702 Align = getTypeInfoImpl(T.getTypePtr()).Align;
1703 else if (!BaseT->isIncompleteType()) {
1704 // Adjust alignments of declarations with array type by the
1705 // large-array alignment on the target.
1706 if (const ArrayType *arrayType = getAsArrayType(T)) {
1707 unsigned MinWidth = Target->getLargeArrayMinWidth();
1708 if (!ForAlignof && MinWidth) {
1709 if (isa<VariableArrayType>(arrayType))
1710 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1711 else if (isa<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType) &&
1712 MinWidth <= getTypeSize(cast<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType)))
1713 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1714 }
1715 }
1716 Align = std::max(Align, getPreferredTypeAlign(T.getTypePtr()));
1717 if (BaseT.getQualifiers().hasUnaligned())
1718 Align = Target->getCharWidth();
1719 }
1720
1721 // Ensure miminum alignment for global variables.
1722 if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D))
1723 if (VD->hasGlobalStorage() && !ForAlignof) {
1724 uint64_t TypeSize =
1725 !BaseT->isIncompleteType() ? getTypeSize(T.getTypePtr()) : 0;
1726 Align = std::max(Align, getMinGlobalAlignOfVar(TypeSize, VD));
1727 }
1728
1729 // Fields can be subject to extra alignment constraints, like if
1730 // the field is packed, the struct is packed, or the struct has a
1731 // a max-field-alignment constraint (#pragma pack). So calculate
1732 // the actual alignment of the field within the struct, and then
1733 // (as we're expected to) constrain that by the alignment of the type.
1734 if (const auto *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(VD)) {
1735 const RecordDecl *Parent = Field->getParent();
1736 // We can only produce a sensible answer if the record is valid.
1737 if (!Parent->isInvalidDecl()) {
1738 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(Parent);
1739
1740 // Start with the record's overall alignment.
1741 unsigned FieldAlign = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
1742
1743 // Use the GCD of that and the offset within the record.
1744 uint64_t Offset = Layout.getFieldOffset(Field->getFieldIndex());
1745 if (Offset > 0) {
1746 // Alignment is always a power of 2, so the GCD will be a power of 2,
1747 // which means we get to do this crazy thing instead of Euclid's.
1748 uint64_t LowBitOfOffset = Offset & (~Offset + 1);
1749 if (LowBitOfOffset < FieldAlign)
1750 FieldAlign = static_cast<unsigned>(LowBitOfOffset);
1751 }
1752
1753 Align = std::min(Align, FieldAlign);
1754 }
1755 }
1756 }
1757
1758 // Some targets have hard limitation on the maximum requestable alignment in
1759 // aligned attribute for static variables.
1760 const unsigned MaxAlignedAttr = getTargetInfo().getMaxAlignedAttribute();
1761 const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D);
1762 if (MaxAlignedAttr && VD && VD->getStorageClass() == SC_Static)
1763 Align = std::min(Align, MaxAlignedAttr);
1764
1765 return toCharUnitsFromBits(Align);
1766 }
1767
getExnObjectAlignment() const1768 CharUnits ASTContext::getExnObjectAlignment() const {
1769 return toCharUnitsFromBits(Target->getExnObjectAlignment());
1770 }
1771
1772 // getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars - Return the size of a type, in
1773 // chars. If the type is a record, its data size is returned. This is
1774 // the size of the memcpy that's performed when assigning this type
1775 // using a trivial copy/move assignment operator.
getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars(QualType T) const1776 TypeInfoChars ASTContext::getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
1777 TypeInfoChars Info = getTypeInfoInChars(T);
1778
1779 // In C++, objects can sometimes be allocated into the tail padding
1780 // of a base-class subobject. We decide whether that's possible
1781 // during class layout, so here we can just trust the layout results.
1782 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
1783 if (const auto *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>();
1784 RT && !RT->getDecl()->isInvalidDecl()) {
1785 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RT->getDecl());
1786 Info.Width = layout.getDataSize();
1787 }
1788 }
1789
1790 return Info;
1791 }
1792
1793 /// getConstantArrayInfoInChars - Performing the computation in CharUnits
1794 /// instead of in bits prevents overflowing the uint64_t for some large arrays.
1795 TypeInfoChars
getConstantArrayInfoInChars(const ASTContext & Context,const ConstantArrayType * CAT)1796 static getConstantArrayInfoInChars(const ASTContext &Context,
1797 const ConstantArrayType *CAT) {
1798 TypeInfoChars EltInfo = Context.getTypeInfoInChars(CAT->getElementType());
1799 uint64_t Size = CAT->getZExtSize();
1800 assert((Size == 0 || static_cast<uint64_t>(EltInfo.Width.getQuantity()) <=
1801 (uint64_t)(-1)/Size) &&
1802 "Overflow in array type char size evaluation");
1803 uint64_t Width = EltInfo.Width.getQuantity() * Size;
1804 unsigned Align = EltInfo.Align.getQuantity();
1805 if (!Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1806 Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(LangAS::Default) == 64)
1807 Width = llvm::alignTo(Width, Align);
1808 return TypeInfoChars(CharUnits::fromQuantity(Width),
1809 CharUnits::fromQuantity(Align),
1810 EltInfo.AlignRequirement);
1811 }
1812
getTypeInfoInChars(const Type * T) const1813 TypeInfoChars ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(const Type *T) const {
1814 if (const auto *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(T))
1815 return getConstantArrayInfoInChars(*this, CAT);
1816 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(T);
1817 return TypeInfoChars(toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Width),
1818 toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Align), Info.AlignRequirement);
1819 }
1820
getTypeInfoInChars(QualType T) const1821 TypeInfoChars ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(QualType T) const {
1822 return getTypeInfoInChars(T.getTypePtr());
1823 }
1824
isPromotableIntegerType(QualType T) const1825 bool ASTContext::isPromotableIntegerType(QualType T) const {
1826 // HLSL doesn't promote all small integer types to int, it
1827 // just uses the rank-based promotion rules for all types.
1828 if (getLangOpts().HLSL)
1829 return false;
1830
1831 if (const auto *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>())
1832 switch (BT->getKind()) {
1833 case BuiltinType::Bool:
1834 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
1835 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
1836 case BuiltinType::SChar:
1837 case BuiltinType::UChar:
1838 case BuiltinType::Short:
1839 case BuiltinType::UShort:
1840 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
1841 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
1842 case BuiltinType::Char8:
1843 case BuiltinType::Char16:
1844 case BuiltinType::Char32:
1845 return true;
1846 default:
1847 return false;
1848 }
1849
1850 // Enumerated types are promotable to their compatible integer types
1851 // (C99 6.3.1.1) a.k.a. its underlying type (C++ [conv.prom]p2).
1852 if (const auto *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>()) {
1853 if (T->isDependentType() || ET->getDecl()->getPromotionType().isNull() ||
1854 ET->getDecl()->isScoped())
1855 return false;
1856
1857 return true;
1858 }
1859
1860 return false;
1861 }
1862
isAlignmentRequired(const Type * T) const1863 bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(const Type *T) const {
1864 return getTypeInfo(T).AlignRequirement != AlignRequirementKind::None;
1865 }
1866
isAlignmentRequired(QualType T) const1867 bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(QualType T) const {
1868 return isAlignmentRequired(T.getTypePtr());
1869 }
1870
getTypeAlignIfKnown(QualType T,bool NeedsPreferredAlignment) const1871 unsigned ASTContext::getTypeAlignIfKnown(QualType T,
1872 bool NeedsPreferredAlignment) const {
1873 // An alignment on a typedef overrides anything else.
1874 if (const auto *TT = T->getAs<TypedefType>())
1875 if (unsigned Align = TT->getDecl()->getMaxAlignment())
1876 return Align;
1877
1878 // If we have an (array of) complete type, we're done.
1879 T = getBaseElementType(T);
1880 if (!T->isIncompleteType())
1881 return NeedsPreferredAlignment ? getPreferredTypeAlign(T) : getTypeAlign(T);
1882
1883 // If we had an array type, its element type might be a typedef
1884 // type with an alignment attribute.
1885 if (const auto *TT = T->getAs<TypedefType>())
1886 if (unsigned Align = TT->getDecl()->getMaxAlignment())
1887 return Align;
1888
1889 // Otherwise, see if the declaration of the type had an attribute.
1890 if (const auto *TT = T->getAs<TagType>())
1891 return TT->getDecl()->getMaxAlignment();
1892
1893 return 0;
1894 }
1895
getTypeInfo(const Type * T) const1896 TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfo(const Type *T) const {
1897 TypeInfoMap::iterator I = MemoizedTypeInfo.find(T);
1898 if (I != MemoizedTypeInfo.end())
1899 return I->second;
1900
1901 // This call can invalidate MemoizedTypeInfo[T], so we need a second lookup.
1902 TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfoImpl(T);
1903 MemoizedTypeInfo[T] = TI;
1904 return TI;
1905 }
1906
1907 /// getTypeInfoImpl - Return the size of the specified type, in bits. This
1908 /// method does not work on incomplete types.
1909 ///
1910 /// FIXME: Pointers into different addr spaces could have different sizes and
1911 /// alignment requirements: getPointerInfo should take an AddrSpace, this
1912 /// should take a QualType, &c.
getTypeInfoImpl(const Type * T) const1913 TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfoImpl(const Type *T) const {
1914 uint64_t Width = 0;
1915 unsigned Align = 8;
1916 AlignRequirementKind AlignRequirement = AlignRequirementKind::None;
1917 LangAS AS = LangAS::Default;
1918 switch (T->getTypeClass()) {
1919 #define TYPE(Class, Base)
1920 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
1921 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base)
1922 #define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
1923 #define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) \
1924 case Type::Class: \
1925 assert(!T->isDependentType() && "should not see dependent types here"); \
1926 return getTypeInfo(cast<Class##Type>(T)->desugar().getTypePtr());
1927 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.inc"
1928 llvm_unreachable("Should not see dependent types");
1929
1930 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
1931 case Type::FunctionProto:
1932 // GCC extension: alignof(function) = 32 bits
1933 Width = 0;
1934 Align = 32;
1935 break;
1936
1937 case Type::IncompleteArray:
1938 case Type::VariableArray:
1939 case Type::ConstantArray:
1940 case Type::ArrayParameter: {
1941 // Model non-constant sized arrays as size zero, but track the alignment.
1942 uint64_t Size = 0;
1943 if (const auto *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(T))
1944 Size = CAT->getZExtSize();
1945
1946 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(cast<ArrayType>(T)->getElementType());
1947 assert((Size == 0 || EltInfo.Width <= (uint64_t)(-1) / Size) &&
1948 "Overflow in array type bit size evaluation");
1949 Width = EltInfo.Width * Size;
1950 Align = EltInfo.Align;
1951 AlignRequirement = EltInfo.AlignRequirement;
1952 if (!getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1953 getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(LangAS::Default) == 64)
1954 Width = llvm::alignTo(Width, Align);
1955 break;
1956 }
1957
1958 case Type::ExtVector:
1959 case Type::Vector: {
1960 const auto *VT = cast<VectorType>(T);
1961 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(VT->getElementType());
1962 Width = VT->isExtVectorBoolType() ? VT->getNumElements()
1963 : EltInfo.Width * VT->getNumElements();
1964 // Enforce at least byte size and alignment.
1965 Width = std::max<unsigned>(8, Width);
1966 Align = std::max<unsigned>(8, Width);
1967
1968 // If the alignment is not a power of 2, round up to the next power of 2.
1969 // This happens for non-power-of-2 length vectors.
1970 if (Align & (Align-1)) {
1971 Align = llvm::bit_ceil(Align);
1972 Width = llvm::alignTo(Width, Align);
1973 }
1974 // Adjust the alignment based on the target max.
1975 uint64_t TargetVectorAlign = Target->getMaxVectorAlign();
1976 if (TargetVectorAlign && TargetVectorAlign < Align)
1977 Align = TargetVectorAlign;
1978 if (VT->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::SveFixedLengthData)
1979 // Adjust the alignment for fixed-length SVE vectors. This is important
1980 // for non-power-of-2 vector lengths.
1981 Align = 128;
1982 else if (VT->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::SveFixedLengthPredicate)
1983 // Adjust the alignment for fixed-length SVE predicates.
1984 Align = 16;
1985 else if (VT->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::RVVFixedLengthData ||
1986 VT->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::RVVFixedLengthMask)
1987 // Adjust the alignment for fixed-length RVV vectors.
1988 Align = std::min<unsigned>(64, Width);
1989 break;
1990 }
1991
1992 case Type::ConstantMatrix: {
1993 const auto *MT = cast<ConstantMatrixType>(T);
1994 TypeInfo ElementInfo = getTypeInfo(MT->getElementType());
1995 // The internal layout of a matrix value is implementation defined.
1996 // Initially be ABI compatible with arrays with respect to alignment and
1997 // size.
1998 Width = ElementInfo.Width * MT->getNumRows() * MT->getNumColumns();
1999 Align = ElementInfo.Align;
2000 break;
2001 }
2002
2003 case Type::Builtin:
2004 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
2005 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type!");
2006 case BuiltinType::Void:
2007 // GCC extension: alignof(void) = 8 bits.
2008 Width = 0;
2009 Align = 8;
2010 break;
2011 case BuiltinType::Bool:
2012 Width = Target->getBoolWidth();
2013 Align = Target->getBoolAlign();
2014 break;
2015 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
2016 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
2017 case BuiltinType::UChar:
2018 case BuiltinType::SChar:
2019 case BuiltinType::Char8:
2020 Width = Target->getCharWidth();
2021 Align = Target->getCharAlign();
2022 break;
2023 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
2024 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
2025 Width = Target->getWCharWidth();
2026 Align = Target->getWCharAlign();
2027 break;
2028 case BuiltinType::Char16:
2029 Width = Target->getChar16Width();
2030 Align = Target->getChar16Align();
2031 break;
2032 case BuiltinType::Char32:
2033 Width = Target->getChar32Width();
2034 Align = Target->getChar32Align();
2035 break;
2036 case BuiltinType::UShort:
2037 case BuiltinType::Short:
2038 Width = Target->getShortWidth();
2039 Align = Target->getShortAlign();
2040 break;
2041 case BuiltinType::UInt:
2042 case BuiltinType::Int:
2043 Width = Target->getIntWidth();
2044 Align = Target->getIntAlign();
2045 break;
2046 case BuiltinType::ULong:
2047 case BuiltinType::Long:
2048 Width = Target->getLongWidth();
2049 Align = Target->getLongAlign();
2050 break;
2051 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
2052 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
2053 Width = Target->getLongLongWidth();
2054 Align = Target->getLongLongAlign();
2055 break;
2056 case BuiltinType::Int128:
2057 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
2058 Width = 128;
2059 Align = Target->getInt128Align();
2060 break;
2061 case BuiltinType::ShortAccum:
2062 case BuiltinType::UShortAccum:
2063 case BuiltinType::SatShortAccum:
2064 case BuiltinType::SatUShortAccum:
2065 Width = Target->getShortAccumWidth();
2066 Align = Target->getShortAccumAlign();
2067 break;
2068 case BuiltinType::Accum:
2069 case BuiltinType::UAccum:
2070 case BuiltinType::SatAccum:
2071 case BuiltinType::SatUAccum:
2072 Width = Target->getAccumWidth();
2073 Align = Target->getAccumAlign();
2074 break;
2075 case BuiltinType::LongAccum:
2076 case BuiltinType::ULongAccum:
2077 case BuiltinType::SatLongAccum:
2078 case BuiltinType::SatULongAccum:
2079 Width = Target->getLongAccumWidth();
2080 Align = Target->getLongAccumAlign();
2081 break;
2082 case BuiltinType::ShortFract:
2083 case BuiltinType::UShortFract:
2084 case BuiltinType::SatShortFract:
2085 case BuiltinType::SatUShortFract:
2086 Width = Target->getShortFractWidth();
2087 Align = Target->getShortFractAlign();
2088 break;
2089 case BuiltinType::Fract:
2090 case BuiltinType::UFract:
2091 case BuiltinType::SatFract:
2092 case BuiltinType::SatUFract:
2093 Width = Target->getFractWidth();
2094 Align = Target->getFractAlign();
2095 break;
2096 case BuiltinType::LongFract:
2097 case BuiltinType::ULongFract:
2098 case BuiltinType::SatLongFract:
2099 case BuiltinType::SatULongFract:
2100 Width = Target->getLongFractWidth();
2101 Align = Target->getLongFractAlign();
2102 break;
2103 case BuiltinType::BFloat16:
2104 if (Target->hasBFloat16Type()) {
2105 Width = Target->getBFloat16Width();
2106 Align = Target->getBFloat16Align();
2107 } else if ((getLangOpts().SYCLIsDevice ||
2108 (getLangOpts().OpenMP &&
2109 getLangOpts().OpenMPIsTargetDevice)) &&
2110 AuxTarget->hasBFloat16Type()) {
2111 Width = AuxTarget->getBFloat16Width();
2112 Align = AuxTarget->getBFloat16Align();
2113 }
2114 break;
2115 case BuiltinType::Float16:
2116 case BuiltinType::Half:
2117 if (Target->hasFloat16Type() || !getLangOpts().OpenMP ||
2118 !getLangOpts().OpenMPIsTargetDevice) {
2119 Width = Target->getHalfWidth();
2120 Align = Target->getHalfAlign();
2121 } else {
2122 assert(getLangOpts().OpenMP && getLangOpts().OpenMPIsTargetDevice &&
2123 "Expected OpenMP device compilation.");
2124 Width = AuxTarget->getHalfWidth();
2125 Align = AuxTarget->getHalfAlign();
2126 }
2127 break;
2128 case BuiltinType::Float:
2129 Width = Target->getFloatWidth();
2130 Align = Target->getFloatAlign();
2131 break;
2132 case BuiltinType::Double:
2133 Width = Target->getDoubleWidth();
2134 Align = Target->getDoubleAlign();
2135 break;
2136 case BuiltinType::Ibm128:
2137 Width = Target->getIbm128Width();
2138 Align = Target->getIbm128Align();
2139 break;
2140 case BuiltinType::LongDouble:
2141 if (getLangOpts().OpenMP && getLangOpts().OpenMPIsTargetDevice &&
2142 (Target->getLongDoubleWidth() != AuxTarget->getLongDoubleWidth() ||
2143 Target->getLongDoubleAlign() != AuxTarget->getLongDoubleAlign())) {
2144 Width = AuxTarget->getLongDoubleWidth();
2145 Align = AuxTarget->getLongDoubleAlign();
2146 } else {
2147 Width = Target->getLongDoubleWidth();
2148 Align = Target->getLongDoubleAlign();
2149 }
2150 break;
2151 case BuiltinType::Float128:
2152 if (Target->hasFloat128Type() || !getLangOpts().OpenMP ||
2153 !getLangOpts().OpenMPIsTargetDevice) {
2154 Width = Target->getFloat128Width();
2155 Align = Target->getFloat128Align();
2156 } else {
2157 assert(getLangOpts().OpenMP && getLangOpts().OpenMPIsTargetDevice &&
2158 "Expected OpenMP device compilation.");
2159 Width = AuxTarget->getFloat128Width();
2160 Align = AuxTarget->getFloat128Align();
2161 }
2162 break;
2163 case BuiltinType::NullPtr:
2164 // C++ 3.9.1p11: sizeof(nullptr_t) == sizeof(void*)
2165 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(LangAS::Default);
2166 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(LangAS::Default);
2167 break;
2168 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
2169 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
2170 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
2171 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(LangAS::Default);
2172 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(LangAS::Default);
2173 break;
2174 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
2175 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
2176 case BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent:
2177 case BuiltinType::OCLQueue:
2178 case BuiltinType::OCLReserveID:
2179 #define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
2180 case BuiltinType::Id:
2181 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
2182 #define EXT_OPAQUE_TYPE(ExtType, Id, Ext) \
2183 case BuiltinType::Id:
2184 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLExtensionTypes.def"
2185 AS = Target->getOpenCLTypeAddrSpace(getOpenCLTypeKind(T));
2186 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
2187 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
2188 break;
2189 // The SVE types are effectively target-specific. The length of an
2190 // SVE_VECTOR_TYPE is only known at runtime, but it is always a multiple
2191 // of 128 bits. There is one predicate bit for each vector byte, so the
2192 // length of an SVE_PREDICATE_TYPE is always a multiple of 16 bits.
2193 //
2194 // Because the length is only known at runtime, we use a dummy value
2195 // of 0 for the static length. The alignment values are those defined
2196 // by the Procedure Call Standard for the Arm Architecture.
2197 #define SVE_VECTOR_TYPE(Name, MangledName, Id, SingletonId, NumEls, ElBits, \
2198 IsSigned, IsFP, IsBF) \
2199 case BuiltinType::Id: \
2200 Width = 0; \
2201 Align = 128; \
2202 break;
2203 #define SVE_PREDICATE_TYPE(Name, MangledName, Id, SingletonId, NumEls) \
2204 case BuiltinType::Id: \
2205 Width = 0; \
2206 Align = 16; \
2207 break;
2208 #define SVE_OPAQUE_TYPE(Name, MangledName, Id, SingletonId) \
2209 case BuiltinType::Id: \
2210 Width = 0; \
2211 Align = 16; \
2212 break;
2213 #include "clang/Basic/AArch64SVEACLETypes.def"
2214 #define PPC_VECTOR_TYPE(Name, Id, Size) \
2215 case BuiltinType::Id: \
2216 Width = Size; \
2217 Align = Size; \
2218 break;
2219 #include "clang/Basic/PPCTypes.def"
2220 #define RVV_VECTOR_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId, ElKind, ElBits, NF, IsSigned, \
2221 IsFP, IsBF) \
2222 case BuiltinType::Id: \
2223 Width = 0; \
2224 Align = ElBits; \
2225 break;
2226 #define RVV_PREDICATE_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId, ElKind) \
2227 case BuiltinType::Id: \
2228 Width = 0; \
2229 Align = 8; \
2230 break;
2231 #include "clang/Basic/RISCVVTypes.def"
2232 #define WASM_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) \
2233 case BuiltinType::Id: \
2234 Width = 0; \
2235 Align = 8; \
2236 break;
2237 #include "clang/Basic/WebAssemblyReferenceTypes.def"
2238 #define AMDGPU_OPAQUE_PTR_TYPE(NAME, MANGLEDNAME, AS, WIDTH, ALIGN, ID, \
2239 SINGLETONID) \
2240 case BuiltinType::ID: \
2241 Width = WIDTH; \
2242 Align = ALIGN; \
2243 break;
2244 #include "clang/Basic/AMDGPUTypes.def"
2245 }
2246 break;
2247 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
2248 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(LangAS::Default);
2249 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(LangAS::Default);
2250 break;
2251 case Type::BlockPointer:
2252 AS = cast<BlockPointerType>(T)->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
2253 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
2254 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
2255 break;
2256 case Type::LValueReference:
2257 case Type::RValueReference:
2258 // alignof and sizeof should never enter this code path here, so we go
2259 // the pointer route.
2260 AS = cast<ReferenceType>(T)->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
2261 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
2262 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
2263 break;
2264 case Type::Pointer:
2265 AS = cast<PointerType>(T)->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
2266 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
2267 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
2268 break;
2269 case Type::MemberPointer: {
2270 const auto *MPT = cast<MemberPointerType>(T);
2271 CXXABI::MemberPointerInfo MPI = ABI->getMemberPointerInfo(MPT);
2272 Width = MPI.Width;
2273 Align = MPI.Align;
2274 break;
2275 }
2276 case Type::Complex: {
2277 // Complex types have the same alignment as their elements, but twice the
2278 // size.
2279 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(cast<ComplexType>(T)->getElementType());
2280 Width = EltInfo.Width * 2;
2281 Align = EltInfo.Align;
2282 break;
2283 }
2284 case Type::ObjCObject:
2285 return getTypeInfo(cast<ObjCObjectType>(T)->getBaseType().getTypePtr());
2286 case Type::Adjusted:
2287 case Type::Decayed:
2288 return getTypeInfo(cast<AdjustedType>(T)->getAdjustedType().getTypePtr());
2289 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
2290 const auto *ObjCI = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(T);
2291 if (ObjCI->getDecl()->isInvalidDecl()) {
2292 Width = 8;
2293 Align = 8;
2294 break;
2295 }
2296 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(ObjCI->getDecl());
2297 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
2298 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
2299 break;
2300 }
2301 case Type::BitInt: {
2302 const auto *EIT = cast<BitIntType>(T);
2303 Align = Target->getBitIntAlign(EIT->getNumBits());
2304 Width = Target->getBitIntWidth(EIT->getNumBits());
2305 break;
2306 }
2307 case Type::Record:
2308 case Type::Enum: {
2309 const auto *TT = cast<TagType>(T);
2310
2311 if (TT->getDecl()->isInvalidDecl()) {
2312 Width = 8;
2313 Align = 8;
2314 break;
2315 }
2316
2317 if (const auto *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(TT)) {
2318 const EnumDecl *ED = ET->getDecl();
2319 TypeInfo Info =
2320 getTypeInfo(ED->getIntegerType()->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
2321 if (unsigned AttrAlign = ED->getMaxAlignment()) {
2322 Info.Align = AttrAlign;
2323 Info.AlignRequirement = AlignRequirementKind::RequiredByEnum;
2324 }
2325 return Info;
2326 }
2327
2328 const auto *RT = cast<RecordType>(TT);
2329 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
2330 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(RD);
2331 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
2332 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
2333 AlignRequirement = RD->hasAttr<AlignedAttr>()
2334 ? AlignRequirementKind::RequiredByRecord
2335 : AlignRequirementKind::None;
2336 break;
2337 }
2338
2339 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm:
2340 return getTypeInfo(cast<SubstTemplateTypeParmType>(T)->
2341 getReplacementType().getTypePtr());
2342
2343 case Type::Auto:
2344 case Type::DeducedTemplateSpecialization: {
2345 const auto *A = cast<DeducedType>(T);
2346 assert(!A->getDeducedType().isNull() &&
2347 "cannot request the size of an undeduced or dependent auto type");
2348 return getTypeInfo(A->getDeducedType().getTypePtr());
2349 }
2350
2351 case Type::Paren:
2352 return getTypeInfo(cast<ParenType>(T)->getInnerType().getTypePtr());
2353
2354 case Type::MacroQualified:
2355 return getTypeInfo(
2356 cast<MacroQualifiedType>(T)->getUnderlyingType().getTypePtr());
2357
2358 case Type::ObjCTypeParam:
2359 return getTypeInfo(cast<ObjCTypeParamType>(T)->desugar().getTypePtr());
2360
2361 case Type::Using:
2362 return getTypeInfo(cast<UsingType>(T)->desugar().getTypePtr());
2363
2364 case Type::Typedef: {
2365 const auto *TT = cast<TypedefType>(T);
2366 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(TT->desugar().getTypePtr());
2367 // If the typedef has an aligned attribute on it, it overrides any computed
2368 // alignment we have. This violates the GCC documentation (which says that
2369 // attribute(aligned) can only round up) but matches its implementation.
2370 if (unsigned AttrAlign = TT->getDecl()->getMaxAlignment()) {
2371 Align = AttrAlign;
2372 AlignRequirement = AlignRequirementKind::RequiredByTypedef;
2373 } else {
2374 Align = Info.Align;
2375 AlignRequirement = Info.AlignRequirement;
2376 }
2377 Width = Info.Width;
2378 break;
2379 }
2380
2381 case Type::Elaborated:
2382 return getTypeInfo(cast<ElaboratedType>(T)->getNamedType().getTypePtr());
2383
2384 case Type::Attributed:
2385 return getTypeInfo(
2386 cast<AttributedType>(T)->getEquivalentType().getTypePtr());
2387
2388 case Type::CountAttributed:
2389 return getTypeInfo(cast<CountAttributedType>(T)->desugar().getTypePtr());
2390
2391 case Type::BTFTagAttributed:
2392 return getTypeInfo(
2393 cast<BTFTagAttributedType>(T)->getWrappedType().getTypePtr());
2394
2395 case Type::Atomic: {
2396 // Start with the base type information.
2397 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(cast<AtomicType>(T)->getValueType());
2398 Width = Info.Width;
2399 Align = Info.Align;
2400
2401 if (!Width) {
2402 // An otherwise zero-sized type should still generate an
2403 // atomic operation.
2404 Width = Target->getCharWidth();
2405 assert(Align);
2406 } else if (Width <= Target->getMaxAtomicPromoteWidth()) {
2407 // If the size of the type doesn't exceed the platform's max
2408 // atomic promotion width, make the size and alignment more
2409 // favorable to atomic operations:
2410
2411 // Round the size up to a power of 2.
2412 Width = llvm::bit_ceil(Width);
2413
2414 // Set the alignment equal to the size.
2415 Align = static_cast<unsigned>(Width);
2416 }
2417 }
2418 break;
2419
2420 case Type::Pipe:
2421 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(LangAS::opencl_global);
2422 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(LangAS::opencl_global);
2423 break;
2424 }
2425
2426 assert(llvm::isPowerOf2_32(Align) && "Alignment must be power of 2");
2427 return TypeInfo(Width, Align, AlignRequirement);
2428 }
2429
getTypeUnadjustedAlign(const Type * T) const2430 unsigned ASTContext::getTypeUnadjustedAlign(const Type *T) const {
2431 UnadjustedAlignMap::iterator I = MemoizedUnadjustedAlign.find(T);
2432 if (I != MemoizedUnadjustedAlign.end())
2433 return I->second;
2434
2435 unsigned UnadjustedAlign;
2436 if (const auto *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>()) {
2437 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
2438 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(RD);
2439 UnadjustedAlign = toBits(Layout.getUnadjustedAlignment());
2440 } else if (const auto *ObjCI = T->getAs<ObjCInterfaceType>()) {
2441 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(ObjCI->getDecl());
2442 UnadjustedAlign = toBits(Layout.getUnadjustedAlignment());
2443 } else {
2444 UnadjustedAlign = getTypeAlign(T->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
2445 }
2446
2447 MemoizedUnadjustedAlign[T] = UnadjustedAlign;
2448 return UnadjustedAlign;
2449 }
2450
getOpenMPDefaultSimdAlign(QualType T) const2451 unsigned ASTContext::getOpenMPDefaultSimdAlign(QualType T) const {
2452 unsigned SimdAlign = llvm::OpenMPIRBuilder::getOpenMPDefaultSimdAlign(
2453 getTargetInfo().getTriple(), Target->getTargetOpts().FeatureMap);
2454 return SimdAlign;
2455 }
2456
2457 /// toCharUnitsFromBits - Convert a size in bits to a size in characters.
toCharUnitsFromBits(int64_t BitSize) const2458 CharUnits ASTContext::toCharUnitsFromBits(int64_t BitSize) const {
2459 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(BitSize / getCharWidth());
2460 }
2461
2462 /// toBits - Convert a size in characters to a size in characters.
toBits(CharUnits CharSize) const2463 int64_t ASTContext::toBits(CharUnits CharSize) const {
2464 return CharSize.getQuantity() * getCharWidth();
2465 }
2466
2467 /// getTypeSizeInChars - Return the size of the specified type, in characters.
2468 /// This method does not work on incomplete types.
getTypeSizeInChars(QualType T) const2469 CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
2470 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).Width;
2471 }
getTypeSizeInChars(const Type * T) const2472 CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(const Type *T) const {
2473 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).Width;
2474 }
2475
2476 /// getTypeAlignInChars - Return the ABI-specified alignment of a type, in
2477 /// characters. This method does not work on incomplete types.
getTypeAlignInChars(QualType T) const2478 CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(QualType T) const {
2479 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
2480 }
getTypeAlignInChars(const Type * T) const2481 CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(const Type *T) const {
2482 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
2483 }
2484
2485 /// getTypeUnadjustedAlignInChars - Return the ABI-specified alignment of a
2486 /// type, in characters, before alignment adjustments. This method does
2487 /// not work on incomplete types.
getTypeUnadjustedAlignInChars(QualType T) const2488 CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeUnadjustedAlignInChars(QualType T) const {
2489 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeUnadjustedAlign(T));
2490 }
getTypeUnadjustedAlignInChars(const Type * T) const2491 CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeUnadjustedAlignInChars(const Type *T) const {
2492 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeUnadjustedAlign(T));
2493 }
2494
2495 /// getPreferredTypeAlign - Return the "preferred" alignment of the specified
2496 /// type for the current target in bits. This can be different than the ABI
2497 /// alignment in cases where it is beneficial for performance or backwards
2498 /// compatibility preserving to overalign a data type. (Note: despite the name,
2499 /// the preferred alignment is ABI-impacting, and not an optimization.)
getPreferredTypeAlign(const Type * T) const2500 unsigned ASTContext::getPreferredTypeAlign(const Type *T) const {
2501 TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfo(T);
2502 unsigned ABIAlign = TI.Align;
2503
2504 T = T->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe();
2505
2506 // The preferred alignment of member pointers is that of a pointer.
2507 if (T->isMemberPointerType())
2508 return getPreferredTypeAlign(getPointerDiffType().getTypePtr());
2509
2510 if (!Target->allowsLargerPreferedTypeAlignment())
2511 return ABIAlign;
2512
2513 if (const auto *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>()) {
2514 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
2515
2516 // When used as part of a typedef, or together with a 'packed' attribute,
2517 // the 'aligned' attribute can be used to decrease alignment. Note that the
2518 // 'packed' case is already taken into consideration when computing the
2519 // alignment, we only need to handle the typedef case here.
2520 if (TI.AlignRequirement == AlignRequirementKind::RequiredByTypedef ||
2521 RD->isInvalidDecl())
2522 return ABIAlign;
2523
2524 unsigned PreferredAlign = static_cast<unsigned>(
2525 toBits(getASTRecordLayout(RD).PreferredAlignment));
2526 assert(PreferredAlign >= ABIAlign &&
2527 "PreferredAlign should be at least as large as ABIAlign.");
2528 return PreferredAlign;
2529 }
2530
2531 // Double (and, for targets supporting AIX `power` alignment, long double) and
2532 // long long should be naturally aligned (despite requiring less alignment) if
2533 // possible.
2534 if (const auto *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
2535 T = CT->getElementType().getTypePtr();
2536 if (const auto *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
2537 T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr();
2538 if (T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double) ||
2539 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::LongLong) ||
2540 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ULongLong) ||
2541 (T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::LongDouble) &&
2542 Target->defaultsToAIXPowerAlignment()))
2543 // Don't increase the alignment if an alignment attribute was specified on a
2544 // typedef declaration.
2545 if (!TI.isAlignRequired())
2546 return std::max(ABIAlign, (unsigned)getTypeSize(T));
2547
2548 return ABIAlign;
2549 }
2550
2551 /// getTargetDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned - Return the default alignment
2552 /// for __attribute__((aligned)) on this target, to be used if no alignment
2553 /// value is specified.
getTargetDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned() const2554 unsigned ASTContext::getTargetDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned() const {
2555 return getTargetInfo().getDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned();
2556 }
2557
2558 /// getAlignOfGlobalVar - Return the alignment in bits that should be given
2559 /// to a global variable of the specified type.
getAlignOfGlobalVar(QualType T,const VarDecl * VD) const2560 unsigned ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVar(QualType T, const VarDecl *VD) const {
2561 uint64_t TypeSize = getTypeSize(T.getTypePtr());
2562 return std::max(getPreferredTypeAlign(T),
2563 getMinGlobalAlignOfVar(TypeSize, VD));
2564 }
2565
2566 /// getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars - Return the alignment in characters that
2567 /// should be given to a global variable of the specified type.
getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars(QualType T,const VarDecl * VD) const2568 CharUnits ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars(QualType T,
2569 const VarDecl *VD) const {
2570 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getAlignOfGlobalVar(T, VD));
2571 }
2572
getMinGlobalAlignOfVar(uint64_t Size,const VarDecl * VD) const2573 unsigned ASTContext::getMinGlobalAlignOfVar(uint64_t Size,
2574 const VarDecl *VD) const {
2575 // Make the default handling as that of a non-weak definition in the
2576 // current translation unit.
2577 bool HasNonWeakDef = !VD || (VD->hasDefinition() && !VD->isWeak());
2578 return getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign(Size, HasNonWeakDef);
2579 }
2580
getOffsetOfBaseWithVBPtr(const CXXRecordDecl * RD) const2581 CharUnits ASTContext::getOffsetOfBaseWithVBPtr(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
2582 CharUnits Offset = CharUnits::Zero();
2583 const ASTRecordLayout *Layout = &getASTRecordLayout(RD);
2584 while (const CXXRecordDecl *Base = Layout->getBaseSharingVBPtr()) {
2585 Offset += Layout->getBaseClassOffset(Base);
2586 Layout = &getASTRecordLayout(Base);
2587 }
2588 return Offset;
2589 }
2590
getMemberPointerPathAdjustment(const APValue & MP) const2591 CharUnits ASTContext::getMemberPointerPathAdjustment(const APValue &MP) const {
2592 const ValueDecl *MPD = MP.getMemberPointerDecl();
2593 CharUnits ThisAdjustment = CharUnits::Zero();
2594 ArrayRef<const CXXRecordDecl*> Path = MP.getMemberPointerPath();
2595 bool DerivedMember = MP.isMemberPointerToDerivedMember();
2596 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(MPD->getDeclContext());
2597 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Path.size(); I != N; ++I) {
2598 const CXXRecordDecl *Base = RD;
2599 const CXXRecordDecl *Derived = Path[I];
2600 if (DerivedMember)
2601 std::swap(Base, Derived);
2602 ThisAdjustment += getASTRecordLayout(Derived).getBaseClassOffset(Base);
2603 RD = Path[I];
2604 }
2605 if (DerivedMember)
2606 ThisAdjustment = -ThisAdjustment;
2607 return ThisAdjustment;
2608 }
2609
2610 /// DeepCollectObjCIvars -
2611 /// This routine first collects all declared, but not synthesized, ivars in
2612 /// super class and then collects all ivars, including those synthesized for
2613 /// current class. This routine is used for implementation of current class
2614 /// when all ivars, declared and synthesized are known.
DeepCollectObjCIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl * OI,bool leafClass,SmallVectorImpl<const ObjCIvarDecl * > & Ivars) const2615 void ASTContext::DeepCollectObjCIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI,
2616 bool leafClass,
2617 SmallVectorImpl<const ObjCIvarDecl*> &Ivars) const {
2618 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *SuperClass = OI->getSuperClass())
2619 DeepCollectObjCIvars(SuperClass, false, Ivars);
2620 if (!leafClass) {
2621 llvm::append_range(Ivars, OI->ivars());
2622 } else {
2623 auto *IDecl = const_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl *>(OI);
2624 for (const ObjCIvarDecl *Iv = IDecl->all_declared_ivar_begin(); Iv;
2625 Iv= Iv->getNextIvar())
2626 Ivars.push_back(Iv);
2627 }
2628 }
2629
2630 /// CollectInheritedProtocols - Collect all protocols in current class and
2631 /// those inherited by it.
CollectInheritedProtocols(const Decl * CDecl,llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *,8> & Protocols)2632 void ASTContext::CollectInheritedProtocols(const Decl *CDecl,
2633 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> &Protocols) {
2634 if (const auto *OI = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(CDecl)) {
2635 // We can use protocol_iterator here instead of
2636 // all_referenced_protocol_iterator since we are walking all categories.
2637 for (auto *Proto : OI->all_referenced_protocols()) {
2638 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
2639 }
2640
2641 // Categories of this Interface.
2642 for (const auto *Cat : OI->visible_categories())
2643 CollectInheritedProtocols(Cat, Protocols);
2644
2645 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *SD = OI->getSuperClass())
2646 while (SD) {
2647 CollectInheritedProtocols(SD, Protocols);
2648 SD = SD->getSuperClass();
2649 }
2650 } else if (const auto *OC = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(CDecl)) {
2651 for (auto *Proto : OC->protocols()) {
2652 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
2653 }
2654 } else if (const auto *OP = dyn_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl>(CDecl)) {
2655 // Insert the protocol.
2656 if (!Protocols.insert(
2657 const_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl *>(OP->getCanonicalDecl())).second)
2658 return;
2659
2660 for (auto *Proto : OP->protocols())
2661 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
2662 }
2663 }
2664
unionHasUniqueObjectRepresentations(const ASTContext & Context,const RecordDecl * RD,bool CheckIfTriviallyCopyable)2665 static bool unionHasUniqueObjectRepresentations(const ASTContext &Context,
2666 const RecordDecl *RD,
2667 bool CheckIfTriviallyCopyable) {
2668 assert(RD->isUnion() && "Must be union type");
2669 CharUnits UnionSize = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(RD->getTypeForDecl());
2670
2671 for (const auto *Field : RD->fields()) {
2672 if (!Context.hasUniqueObjectRepresentations(Field->getType(),
2673 CheckIfTriviallyCopyable))
2674 return false;
2675 CharUnits FieldSize = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(Field->getType());
2676 if (FieldSize != UnionSize)
2677 return false;
2678 }
2679 return !RD->field_empty();
2680 }
2681
getSubobjectOffset(const FieldDecl * Field,const ASTContext & Context,const clang::ASTRecordLayout &)2682 static int64_t getSubobjectOffset(const FieldDecl *Field,
2683 const ASTContext &Context,
2684 const clang::ASTRecordLayout & /*Layout*/) {
2685 return Context.getFieldOffset(Field);
2686 }
2687
getSubobjectOffset(const CXXRecordDecl * RD,const ASTContext & Context,const clang::ASTRecordLayout & Layout)2688 static int64_t getSubobjectOffset(const CXXRecordDecl *RD,
2689 const ASTContext &Context,
2690 const clang::ASTRecordLayout &Layout) {
2691 return Context.toBits(Layout.getBaseClassOffset(RD));
2692 }
2693
2694 static std::optional<int64_t>
2695 structHasUniqueObjectRepresentations(const ASTContext &Context,
2696 const RecordDecl *RD,
2697 bool CheckIfTriviallyCopyable);
2698
2699 static std::optional<int64_t>
getSubobjectSizeInBits(const FieldDecl * Field,const ASTContext & Context,bool CheckIfTriviallyCopyable)2700 getSubobjectSizeInBits(const FieldDecl *Field, const ASTContext &Context,
2701 bool CheckIfTriviallyCopyable) {
2702 if (Field->getType()->isRecordType()) {
2703 const RecordDecl *RD = Field->getType()->getAsRecordDecl();
2704 if (!RD->isUnion())
2705 return structHasUniqueObjectRepresentations(Context, RD,
2706 CheckIfTriviallyCopyable);
2707 }
2708
2709 // A _BitInt type may not be unique if it has padding bits
2710 // but if it is a bitfield the padding bits are not used.
2711 bool IsBitIntType = Field->getType()->isBitIntType();
2712 if (!Field->getType()->isReferenceType() && !IsBitIntType &&
2713 !Context.hasUniqueObjectRepresentations(Field->getType(),
2714 CheckIfTriviallyCopyable))
2715 return std::nullopt;
2716
2717 int64_t FieldSizeInBits =
2718 Context.toBits(Context.getTypeSizeInChars(Field->getType()));
2719 if (Field->isBitField()) {
2720 // If we have explicit padding bits, they don't contribute bits
2721 // to the actual object representation, so return 0.
2722 if (Field->isUnnamedBitField())
2723 return 0;
2724
2725 int64_t BitfieldSize = Field->getBitWidthValue(Context);
2726 if (IsBitIntType) {
2727 if ((unsigned)BitfieldSize >
2728 cast<BitIntType>(Field->getType())->getNumBits())
2729 return std::nullopt;
2730 } else if (BitfieldSize > FieldSizeInBits) {
2731 return std::nullopt;
2732 }
2733 FieldSizeInBits = BitfieldSize;
2734 } else if (IsBitIntType && !Context.hasUniqueObjectRepresentations(
2735 Field->getType(), CheckIfTriviallyCopyable)) {
2736 return std::nullopt;
2737 }
2738 return FieldSizeInBits;
2739 }
2740
2741 static std::optional<int64_t>
getSubobjectSizeInBits(const CXXRecordDecl * RD,const ASTContext & Context,bool CheckIfTriviallyCopyable)2742 getSubobjectSizeInBits(const CXXRecordDecl *RD, const ASTContext &Context,
2743 bool CheckIfTriviallyCopyable) {
2744 return structHasUniqueObjectRepresentations(Context, RD,
2745 CheckIfTriviallyCopyable);
2746 }
2747
2748 template <typename RangeT>
structSubobjectsHaveUniqueObjectRepresentations(const RangeT & Subobjects,int64_t CurOffsetInBits,const ASTContext & Context,const clang::ASTRecordLayout & Layout,bool CheckIfTriviallyCopyable)2749 static std::optional<int64_t> structSubobjectsHaveUniqueObjectRepresentations(
2750 const RangeT &Subobjects, int64_t CurOffsetInBits,
2751 const ASTContext &Context, const clang::ASTRecordLayout &Layout,
2752 bool CheckIfTriviallyCopyable) {
2753 for (const auto *Subobject : Subobjects) {
2754 std::optional<int64_t> SizeInBits =
2755 getSubobjectSizeInBits(Subobject, Context, CheckIfTriviallyCopyable);
2756 if (!SizeInBits)
2757 return std::nullopt;
2758 if (*SizeInBits != 0) {
2759 int64_t Offset = getSubobjectOffset(Subobject, Context, Layout);
2760 if (Offset != CurOffsetInBits)
2761 return std::nullopt;
2762 CurOffsetInBits += *SizeInBits;
2763 }
2764 }
2765 return CurOffsetInBits;
2766 }
2767
2768 static std::optional<int64_t>
structHasUniqueObjectRepresentations(const ASTContext & Context,const RecordDecl * RD,bool CheckIfTriviallyCopyable)2769 structHasUniqueObjectRepresentations(const ASTContext &Context,
2770 const RecordDecl *RD,
2771 bool CheckIfTriviallyCopyable) {
2772 assert(!RD->isUnion() && "Must be struct/class type");
2773 const auto &Layout = Context.getASTRecordLayout(RD);
2774
2775 int64_t CurOffsetInBits = 0;
2776 if (const auto *ClassDecl = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
2777 if (ClassDecl->isDynamicClass())
2778 return std::nullopt;
2779
2780 SmallVector<CXXRecordDecl *, 4> Bases;
2781 for (const auto &Base : ClassDecl->bases()) {
2782 // Empty types can be inherited from, and non-empty types can potentially
2783 // have tail padding, so just make sure there isn't an error.
2784 Bases.emplace_back(Base.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl());
2785 }
2786
2787 llvm::sort(Bases, [&](const CXXRecordDecl *L, const CXXRecordDecl *R) {
2788 return Layout.getBaseClassOffset(L) < Layout.getBaseClassOffset(R);
2789 });
2790
2791 std::optional<int64_t> OffsetAfterBases =
2792 structSubobjectsHaveUniqueObjectRepresentations(
2793 Bases, CurOffsetInBits, Context, Layout, CheckIfTriviallyCopyable);
2794 if (!OffsetAfterBases)
2795 return std::nullopt;
2796 CurOffsetInBits = *OffsetAfterBases;
2797 }
2798
2799 std::optional<int64_t> OffsetAfterFields =
2800 structSubobjectsHaveUniqueObjectRepresentations(
2801 RD->fields(), CurOffsetInBits, Context, Layout,
2802 CheckIfTriviallyCopyable);
2803 if (!OffsetAfterFields)
2804 return std::nullopt;
2805 CurOffsetInBits = *OffsetAfterFields;
2806
2807 return CurOffsetInBits;
2808 }
2809
hasUniqueObjectRepresentations(QualType Ty,bool CheckIfTriviallyCopyable) const2810 bool ASTContext::hasUniqueObjectRepresentations(
2811 QualType Ty, bool CheckIfTriviallyCopyable) const {
2812 // C++17 [meta.unary.prop]:
2813 // The predicate condition for a template specialization
2814 // has_unique_object_representations<T> shall be satisfied if and only if:
2815 // (9.1) - T is trivially copyable, and
2816 // (9.2) - any two objects of type T with the same value have the same
2817 // object representation, where:
2818 // - two objects of array or non-union class type are considered to have
2819 // the same value if their respective sequences of direct subobjects
2820 // have the same values, and
2821 // - two objects of union type are considered to have the same value if
2822 // they have the same active member and the corresponding members have
2823 // the same value.
2824 // The set of scalar types for which this condition holds is
2825 // implementation-defined. [ Note: If a type has padding bits, the condition
2826 // does not hold; otherwise, the condition holds true for unsigned integral
2827 // types. -- end note ]
2828 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "Null QualType sent to unique object rep check");
2829
2830 // Arrays are unique only if their element type is unique.
2831 if (Ty->isArrayType())
2832 return hasUniqueObjectRepresentations(getBaseElementType(Ty),
2833 CheckIfTriviallyCopyable);
2834
2835 assert((Ty->isVoidType() || !Ty->isIncompleteType()) &&
2836 "hasUniqueObjectRepresentations should not be called with an "
2837 "incomplete type");
2838
2839 // (9.1) - T is trivially copyable...
2840 if (CheckIfTriviallyCopyable && !Ty.isTriviallyCopyableType(*this))
2841 return false;
2842
2843 // All integrals and enums are unique.
2844 if (Ty->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) {
2845 // Except _BitInt types that have padding bits.
2846 if (const auto *BIT = Ty->getAs<BitIntType>())
2847 return getTypeSize(BIT) == BIT->getNumBits();
2848
2849 return true;
2850 }
2851
2852 // All other pointers are unique.
2853 if (Ty->isPointerType())
2854 return true;
2855
2856 if (const auto *MPT = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
2857 return !ABI->getMemberPointerInfo(MPT).HasPadding;
2858
2859 if (Ty->isRecordType()) {
2860 const RecordDecl *Record = Ty->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
2861
2862 if (Record->isInvalidDecl())
2863 return false;
2864
2865 if (Record->isUnion())
2866 return unionHasUniqueObjectRepresentations(*this, Record,
2867 CheckIfTriviallyCopyable);
2868
2869 std::optional<int64_t> StructSize = structHasUniqueObjectRepresentations(
2870 *this, Record, CheckIfTriviallyCopyable);
2871
2872 return StructSize && *StructSize == static_cast<int64_t>(getTypeSize(Ty));
2873 }
2874
2875 // FIXME: More cases to handle here (list by rsmith):
2876 // vectors (careful about, eg, vector of 3 foo)
2877 // _Complex int and friends
2878 // _Atomic T
2879 // Obj-C block pointers
2880 // Obj-C object pointers
2881 // and perhaps OpenCL's various builtin types (pipe, sampler_t, event_t,
2882 // clk_event_t, queue_t, reserve_id_t)
2883 // There're also Obj-C class types and the Obj-C selector type, but I think it
2884 // makes sense for those to return false here.
2885
2886 return false;
2887 }
2888
CountNonClassIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl * OI) const2889 unsigned ASTContext::CountNonClassIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI) const {
2890 unsigned count = 0;
2891 // Count ivars declared in class extension.
2892 for (const auto *Ext : OI->known_extensions())
2893 count += Ext->ivar_size();
2894
2895 // Count ivar defined in this class's implementation. This
2896 // includes synthesized ivars.
2897 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplDecl = OI->getImplementation())
2898 count += ImplDecl->ivar_size();
2899
2900 return count;
2901 }
2902
isSentinelNullExpr(const Expr * E)2903 bool ASTContext::isSentinelNullExpr(const Expr *E) {
2904 if (!E)
2905 return false;
2906
2907 // nullptr_t is always treated as null.
2908 if (E->getType()->isNullPtrType()) return true;
2909
2910 if (E->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
2911 E->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(*this,
2912 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
2913 return true;
2914
2915 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
2916 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(E)) return true;
2917
2918 return false;
2919 }
2920
2921 /// Get the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl, or nullptr if none
2922 /// exists.
getObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl * D)2923 ObjCImplementationDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) {
2924 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
2925 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
2926 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
2927 return cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(I->second);
2928 return nullptr;
2929 }
2930
2931 /// Get the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl, or nullptr if none
2932 /// exists.
getObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl * D)2933 ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *D) {
2934 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
2935 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
2936 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
2937 return cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(I->second);
2938 return nullptr;
2939 }
2940
2941 /// Set the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl.
setObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl * IFaceD,ObjCImplementationDecl * ImplD)2942 void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFaceD,
2943 ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplD) {
2944 assert(IFaceD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
2945 ObjCImpls[IFaceD] = ImplD;
2946 }
2947
2948 /// Set the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl.
setObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl * CatD,ObjCCategoryImplDecl * ImplD)2949 void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *CatD,
2950 ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ImplD) {
2951 assert(CatD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
2952 ObjCImpls[CatD] = ImplD;
2953 }
2954
2955 const ObjCMethodDecl *
getObjCMethodRedeclaration(const ObjCMethodDecl * MD) const2956 ASTContext::getObjCMethodRedeclaration(const ObjCMethodDecl *MD) const {
2957 return ObjCMethodRedecls.lookup(MD);
2958 }
2959
setObjCMethodRedeclaration(const ObjCMethodDecl * MD,const ObjCMethodDecl * Redecl)2960 void ASTContext::setObjCMethodRedeclaration(const ObjCMethodDecl *MD,
2961 const ObjCMethodDecl *Redecl) {
2962 assert(!getObjCMethodRedeclaration(MD) && "MD already has a redeclaration");
2963 ObjCMethodRedecls[MD] = Redecl;
2964 }
2965
getObjContainingInterface(const NamedDecl * ND) const2966 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjContainingInterface(
2967 const NamedDecl *ND) const {
2968 if (const auto *ID = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
2969 return ID;
2970 if (const auto *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
2971 return CD->getClassInterface();
2972 if (const auto *IMD = dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
2973 return IMD->getClassInterface();
2974
2975 return nullptr;
2976 }
2977
2978 /// Get the copy initialization expression of VarDecl, or nullptr if
2979 /// none exists.
getBlockVarCopyInit(const VarDecl * VD) const2980 BlockVarCopyInit ASTContext::getBlockVarCopyInit(const VarDecl *VD) const {
2981 assert(VD && "Passed null params");
2982 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
2983 "getBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
2984 auto I = BlockVarCopyInits.find(VD);
2985 if (I != BlockVarCopyInits.end())
2986 return I->second;
2987 return {nullptr, false};
2988 }
2989
2990 /// Set the copy initialization expression of a block var decl.
setBlockVarCopyInit(const VarDecl * VD,Expr * CopyExpr,bool CanThrow)2991 void ASTContext::setBlockVarCopyInit(const VarDecl*VD, Expr *CopyExpr,
2992 bool CanThrow) {
2993 assert(VD && CopyExpr && "Passed null params");
2994 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
2995 "setBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
2996 BlockVarCopyInits[VD].setExprAndFlag(CopyExpr, CanThrow);
2997 }
2998
CreateTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,unsigned DataSize) const2999 TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::CreateTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
3000 unsigned DataSize) const {
3001 if (!DataSize)
3002 DataSize = TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T);
3003 else
3004 assert(DataSize == TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T) &&
3005 "incorrect data size provided to CreateTypeSourceInfo!");
3006
3007 auto *TInfo =
3008 (TypeSourceInfo*)BumpAlloc.Allocate(sizeof(TypeSourceInfo) + DataSize, 8);
3009 new (TInfo) TypeSourceInfo(T, DataSize);
3010 return TInfo;
3011 }
3012
getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,SourceLocation L) const3013 TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
3014 SourceLocation L) const {
3015 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(T);
3016 DI->getTypeLoc().initialize(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), L);
3017 return DI;
3018 }
3019
3020 const ASTRecordLayout &
getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(const ObjCInterfaceDecl * D) const3021 ASTContext::getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) const {
3022 return getObjCLayout(D, nullptr);
3023 }
3024
3025 const ASTRecordLayout &
getASTObjCImplementationLayout(const ObjCImplementationDecl * D) const3026 ASTContext::getASTObjCImplementationLayout(
3027 const ObjCImplementationDecl *D) const {
3028 return getObjCLayout(D->getClassInterface(), D);
3029 }
3030
getCanonicalTemplateArguments(const ASTContext & C,ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args,bool & AnyNonCanonArgs)3031 static auto getCanonicalTemplateArguments(const ASTContext &C,
3032 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args,
3033 bool &AnyNonCanonArgs) {
3034 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> CanonArgs(Args);
3035 for (auto &Arg : CanonArgs) {
3036 TemplateArgument OrigArg = Arg;
3037 Arg = C.getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Arg);
3038 AnyNonCanonArgs |= !Arg.structurallyEquals(OrigArg);
3039 }
3040 return CanonArgs;
3041 }
3042
3043 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
3044 // Type creation/memoization methods
3045 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
3046
3047 QualType
getExtQualType(const Type * baseType,Qualifiers quals) const3048 ASTContext::getExtQualType(const Type *baseType, Qualifiers quals) const {
3049 unsigned fastQuals = quals.getFastQualifiers();
3050 quals.removeFastQualifiers();
3051
3052 // Check if we've already instantiated this type.
3053 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3054 ExtQuals::Profile(ID, baseType, quals);
3055 void *insertPos = nullptr;
3056 if (ExtQuals *eq = ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos)) {
3057 assert(eq->getQualifiers() == quals);
3058 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
3059 }
3060
3061 // If the base type is not canonical, make the appropriate canonical type.
3062 QualType canon;
3063 if (!baseType->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
3064 SplitQualType canonSplit = baseType->getCanonicalTypeInternal().split();
3065 canonSplit.Quals.addConsistentQualifiers(quals);
3066 canon = getExtQualType(canonSplit.Ty, canonSplit.Quals);
3067
3068 // Re-find the insert position.
3069 (void) ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
3070 }
3071
3072 auto *eq = new (*this, alignof(ExtQuals)) ExtQuals(baseType, canon, quals);
3073 ExtQualNodes.InsertNode(eq, insertPos);
3074 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
3075 }
3076
getAddrSpaceQualType(QualType T,LangAS AddressSpace) const3077 QualType ASTContext::getAddrSpaceQualType(QualType T,
3078 LangAS AddressSpace) const {
3079 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
3080 if (CanT.getAddressSpace() == AddressSpace)
3081 return T;
3082
3083 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
3084 // into one ExtQuals node.
3085 QualifierCollector Quals;
3086 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
3087
3088 // If this type already has an address space specified, it cannot get
3089 // another one.
3090 assert(!Quals.hasAddressSpace() &&
3091 "Type cannot be in multiple addr spaces!");
3092 Quals.addAddressSpace(AddressSpace);
3093
3094 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
3095 }
3096
removeAddrSpaceQualType(QualType T) const3097 QualType ASTContext::removeAddrSpaceQualType(QualType T) const {
3098 // If the type is not qualified with an address space, just return it
3099 // immediately.
3100 if (!T.hasAddressSpace())
3101 return T;
3102
3103 QualifierCollector Quals;
3104 const Type *TypeNode;
3105 // For arrays, strip the qualifier off the element type, then reconstruct the
3106 // array type
3107 if (T.getTypePtr()->isArrayType()) {
3108 T = getUnqualifiedArrayType(T, Quals);
3109 TypeNode = T.getTypePtr();
3110 } else {
3111 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
3112 // into one ExtQuals node.
3113 while (T.hasAddressSpace()) {
3114 TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
3115
3116 // If the type no longer has an address space after stripping qualifiers,
3117 // jump out.
3118 if (!QualType(TypeNode, 0).hasAddressSpace())
3119 break;
3120
3121 // There might be sugar in the way. Strip it and try again.
3122 T = T.getSingleStepDesugaredType(*this);
3123 }
3124 }
3125
3126 Quals.removeAddressSpace();
3127
3128 // Removal of the address space can mean there are no longer any
3129 // non-fast qualifiers, so creating an ExtQualType isn't possible (asserts)
3130 // or required.
3131 if (Quals.hasNonFastQualifiers())
3132 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
3133 else
3134 return QualType(TypeNode, Quals.getFastQualifiers());
3135 }
3136
3137 uint16_t
getPointerAuthVTablePointerDiscriminator(const CXXRecordDecl * RD)3138 ASTContext::getPointerAuthVTablePointerDiscriminator(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) {
3139 assert(RD->isPolymorphic() &&
3140 "Attempted to get vtable pointer discriminator on a monomorphic type");
3141 std::unique_ptr<MangleContext> MC(createMangleContext());
3142 SmallString<256> Str;
3143 llvm::raw_svector_ostream Out(Str);
3144 MC->mangleCXXVTable(RD, Out);
3145 return llvm::getPointerAuthStableSipHash(Str);
3146 }
3147
3148 /// Encode a function type for use in the discriminator of a function pointer
3149 /// type. We can't use the itanium scheme for this since C has quite permissive
3150 /// rules for type compatibility that we need to be compatible with.
3151 ///
3152 /// Formally, this function associates every function pointer type T with an
3153 /// encoded string E(T). Let the equivalence relation T1 ~ T2 be defined as
3154 /// E(T1) == E(T2). E(T) is part of the ABI of values of type T. C type
3155 /// compatibility requires equivalent treatment under the ABI, so
3156 /// CCompatible(T1, T2) must imply E(T1) == E(T2), that is, CCompatible must be
3157 /// a subset of ~. Crucially, however, it must be a proper subset because
3158 /// CCompatible is not an equivalence relation: for example, int[] is compatible
3159 /// with both int[1] and int[2], but the latter are not compatible with each
3160 /// other. Therefore this encoding function must be careful to only distinguish
3161 /// types if there is no third type with which they are both required to be
3162 /// compatible.
encodeTypeForFunctionPointerAuth(const ASTContext & Ctx,raw_ostream & OS,QualType QT)3163 static void encodeTypeForFunctionPointerAuth(const ASTContext &Ctx,
3164 raw_ostream &OS, QualType QT) {
3165 // FIXME: Consider address space qualifiers.
3166 const Type *T = QT.getCanonicalType().getTypePtr();
3167
3168 // FIXME: Consider using the C++ type mangling when we encounter a construct
3169 // that is incompatible with C.
3170
3171 switch (T->getTypeClass()) {
3172 case Type::Atomic:
3173 return encodeTypeForFunctionPointerAuth(
3174 Ctx, OS, cast<AtomicType>(T)->getValueType());
3175
3176 case Type::LValueReference:
3177 OS << "R";
3178 encodeTypeForFunctionPointerAuth(Ctx, OS,
3179 cast<ReferenceType>(T)->getPointeeType());
3180 return;
3181 case Type::RValueReference:
3182 OS << "O";
3183 encodeTypeForFunctionPointerAuth(Ctx, OS,
3184 cast<ReferenceType>(T)->getPointeeType());
3185 return;
3186
3187 case Type::Pointer:
3188 // C11 6.7.6.1p2:
3189 // For two pointer types to be compatible, both shall be identically
3190 // qualified and both shall be pointers to compatible types.
3191 // FIXME: we should also consider pointee types.
3192 OS << "P";
3193 return;
3194
3195 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
3196 case Type::BlockPointer:
3197 OS << "P";
3198 return;
3199
3200 case Type::Complex:
3201 OS << "C";
3202 return encodeTypeForFunctionPointerAuth(
3203 Ctx, OS, cast<ComplexType>(T)->getElementType());
3204
3205 case Type::VariableArray:
3206 case Type::ConstantArray:
3207 case Type::IncompleteArray:
3208 case Type::ArrayParameter:
3209 // C11 6.7.6.2p6:
3210 // For two array types to be compatible, both shall have compatible
3211 // element types, and if both size specifiers are present, and are integer
3212 // constant expressions, then both size specifiers shall have the same
3213 // constant value [...]
3214 //
3215 // So since ElemType[N] has to be compatible ElemType[], we can't encode the
3216 // width of the array.
3217 OS << "A";
3218 return encodeTypeForFunctionPointerAuth(
3219 Ctx, OS, cast<ArrayType>(T)->getElementType());
3220
3221 case Type::ObjCInterface:
3222 case Type::ObjCObject:
3223 OS << "<objc_object>";
3224 return;
3225
3226 case Type::Enum: {
3227 // C11 6.7.2.2p4:
3228 // Each enumerated type shall be compatible with char, a signed integer
3229 // type, or an unsigned integer type.
3230 //
3231 // So we have to treat enum types as integers.
3232 QualType UnderlyingType = cast<EnumType>(T)->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
3233 return encodeTypeForFunctionPointerAuth(
3234 Ctx, OS, UnderlyingType.isNull() ? Ctx.IntTy : UnderlyingType);
3235 }
3236
3237 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
3238 case Type::FunctionProto: {
3239 // C11 6.7.6.3p15:
3240 // For two function types to be compatible, both shall specify compatible
3241 // return types. Moreover, the parameter type lists, if both are present,
3242 // shall agree in the number of parameters and in the use of the ellipsis
3243 // terminator; corresponding parameters shall have compatible types.
3244 //
3245 // That paragraph goes on to describe how unprototyped functions are to be
3246 // handled, which we ignore here. Unprototyped function pointers are hashed
3247 // as though they were prototyped nullary functions since thats probably
3248 // what the user meant. This behavior is non-conforming.
3249 // FIXME: If we add a "custom discriminator" function type attribute we
3250 // should encode functions as their discriminators.
3251 OS << "F";
3252 const auto *FuncType = cast<FunctionType>(T);
3253 encodeTypeForFunctionPointerAuth(Ctx, OS, FuncType->getReturnType());
3254 if (const auto *FPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncType)) {
3255 for (QualType Param : FPT->param_types()) {
3256 Param = Ctx.getSignatureParameterType(Param);
3257 encodeTypeForFunctionPointerAuth(Ctx, OS, Param);
3258 }
3259 if (FPT->isVariadic())
3260 OS << "z";
3261 }
3262 OS << "E";
3263 return;
3264 }
3265
3266 case Type::MemberPointer: {
3267 OS << "M";
3268 const auto *MPT = T->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3269 encodeTypeForFunctionPointerAuth(Ctx, OS, QualType(MPT->getClass(), 0));
3270 encodeTypeForFunctionPointerAuth(Ctx, OS, MPT->getPointeeType());
3271 return;
3272 }
3273 case Type::ExtVector:
3274 case Type::Vector:
3275 OS << "Dv" << Ctx.getTypeSizeInChars(T).getQuantity();
3276 break;
3277
3278 // Don't bother discriminating based on these types.
3279 case Type::Pipe:
3280 case Type::BitInt:
3281 case Type::ConstantMatrix:
3282 OS << "?";
3283 return;
3284
3285 case Type::Builtin: {
3286 const auto *BTy = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
3287 switch (BTy->getKind()) {
3288 #define SIGNED_TYPE(Id, SingletonId) \
3289 case BuiltinType::Id: \
3290 OS << "i"; \
3291 return;
3292 #define UNSIGNED_TYPE(Id, SingletonId) \
3293 case BuiltinType::Id: \
3294 OS << "i"; \
3295 return;
3296 #define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(Id, SingletonId) case BuiltinType::Id:
3297 #define BUILTIN_TYPE(Id, SingletonId)
3298 #include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
3299 llvm_unreachable("placeholder types should not appear here.");
3300
3301 case BuiltinType::Half:
3302 OS << "Dh";
3303 return;
3304 case BuiltinType::Float:
3305 OS << "f";
3306 return;
3307 case BuiltinType::Double:
3308 OS << "d";
3309 return;
3310 case BuiltinType::LongDouble:
3311 OS << "e";
3312 return;
3313 case BuiltinType::Float16:
3314 OS << "DF16_";
3315 return;
3316 case BuiltinType::Float128:
3317 OS << "g";
3318 return;
3319
3320 case BuiltinType::Void:
3321 OS << "v";
3322 return;
3323
3324 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
3325 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
3326 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
3327 case BuiltinType::NullPtr:
3328 OS << "P";
3329 return;
3330
3331 // Don't bother discriminating based on OpenCL types.
3332 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
3333 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
3334 case BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent:
3335 case BuiltinType::OCLQueue:
3336 case BuiltinType::OCLReserveID:
3337 case BuiltinType::BFloat16:
3338 case BuiltinType::VectorQuad:
3339 case BuiltinType::VectorPair:
3340 OS << "?";
3341 return;
3342
3343 // Don't bother discriminating based on these seldom-used types.
3344 case BuiltinType::Ibm128:
3345 return;
3346 #define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
3347 case BuiltinType::Id: \
3348 return;
3349 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
3350 #define EXT_OPAQUE_TYPE(ExtType, Id, Ext) \
3351 case BuiltinType::Id: \
3352 return;
3353 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLExtensionTypes.def"
3354 #define SVE_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) \
3355 case BuiltinType::Id: \
3356 return;
3357 #include "clang/Basic/AArch64SVEACLETypes.def"
3358 case BuiltinType::Dependent:
3359 llvm_unreachable("should never get here");
3360 case BuiltinType::AMDGPUBufferRsrc:
3361 case BuiltinType::WasmExternRef:
3362 #define RVV_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) case BuiltinType::Id:
3363 #include "clang/Basic/RISCVVTypes.def"
3364 llvm_unreachable("not yet implemented");
3365 }
3366 }
3367 case Type::Record: {
3368 const RecordDecl *RD = T->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
3369 const IdentifierInfo *II = RD->getIdentifier();
3370
3371 // In C++, an immediate typedef of an anonymous struct or union
3372 // is considered to name it for ODR purposes, but C's specification
3373 // of type compatibility does not have a similar rule. Using the typedef
3374 // name in function type discriminators anyway, as we do here,
3375 // therefore technically violates the C standard: two function pointer
3376 // types defined in terms of two typedef'd anonymous structs with
3377 // different names are formally still compatible, but we are assigning
3378 // them different discriminators and therefore incompatible ABIs.
3379 //
3380 // This is a relatively minor violation that significantly improves
3381 // discrimination in some cases and has not caused problems in
3382 // practice. Regardless, it is now part of the ABI in places where
3383 // function type discrimination is used, and it can no longer be
3384 // changed except on new platforms.
3385
3386 if (!II)
3387 if (const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = RD->getTypedefNameForAnonDecl())
3388 II = Typedef->getDeclName().getAsIdentifierInfo();
3389
3390 if (!II) {
3391 OS << "<anonymous_record>";
3392 return;
3393 }
3394 OS << II->getLength() << II->getName();
3395 return;
3396 }
3397 case Type::DeducedTemplateSpecialization:
3398 case Type::Auto:
3399 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
3400 #define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
3401 #define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
3402 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
3403 #define TYPE(Class, Base)
3404 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.inc"
3405 llvm_unreachable("unexpected non-canonical or dependent type!");
3406 return;
3407 }
3408 }
3409
getPointerAuthTypeDiscriminator(QualType T)3410 uint16_t ASTContext::getPointerAuthTypeDiscriminator(QualType T) {
3411 assert(!T->isDependentType() &&
3412 "cannot compute type discriminator of a dependent type");
3413
3414 SmallString<256> Str;
3415 llvm::raw_svector_ostream Out(Str);
3416
3417 if (T->isFunctionPointerType() || T->isFunctionReferenceType())
3418 T = T->getPointeeType();
3419
3420 if (T->isFunctionType()) {
3421 encodeTypeForFunctionPointerAuth(*this, Out, T);
3422 } else {
3423 T = T.getUnqualifiedType();
3424 std::unique_ptr<MangleContext> MC(createMangleContext());
3425 MC->mangleCanonicalTypeName(T, Out);
3426 }
3427
3428 return llvm::getPointerAuthStableSipHash(Str);
3429 }
3430
getObjCGCQualType(QualType T,Qualifiers::GC GCAttr) const3431 QualType ASTContext::getObjCGCQualType(QualType T,
3432 Qualifiers::GC GCAttr) const {
3433 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
3434 if (CanT.getObjCGCAttr() == GCAttr)
3435 return T;
3436
3437 if (const auto *ptr = T->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3438 QualType Pointee = ptr->getPointeeType();
3439 if (Pointee->isAnyPointerType()) {
3440 QualType ResultType = getObjCGCQualType(Pointee, GCAttr);
3441 return getPointerType(ResultType);
3442 }
3443 }
3444
3445 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
3446 // into one ExtQuals node.
3447 QualifierCollector Quals;
3448 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
3449
3450 // If this type already has an ObjCGC specified, it cannot get
3451 // another one.
3452 assert(!Quals.hasObjCGCAttr() &&
3453 "Type cannot have multiple ObjCGCs!");
3454 Quals.addObjCGCAttr(GCAttr);
3455
3456 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
3457 }
3458
removePtrSizeAddrSpace(QualType T) const3459 QualType ASTContext::removePtrSizeAddrSpace(QualType T) const {
3460 if (const PointerType *Ptr = T->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3461 QualType Pointee = Ptr->getPointeeType();
3462 if (isPtrSizeAddressSpace(Pointee.getAddressSpace())) {
3463 return getPointerType(removeAddrSpaceQualType(Pointee));
3464 }
3465 }
3466 return T;
3467 }
3468
getCountAttributedType(QualType WrappedTy,Expr * CountExpr,bool CountInBytes,bool OrNull,ArrayRef<TypeCoupledDeclRefInfo> DependentDecls) const3469 QualType ASTContext::getCountAttributedType(
3470 QualType WrappedTy, Expr *CountExpr, bool CountInBytes, bool OrNull,
3471 ArrayRef<TypeCoupledDeclRefInfo> DependentDecls) const {
3472 assert(WrappedTy->isPointerType() || WrappedTy->isArrayType());
3473
3474 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3475 CountAttributedType::Profile(ID, WrappedTy, CountExpr, CountInBytes, OrNull);
3476
3477 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3478 CountAttributedType *CATy =
3479 CountAttributedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3480 if (CATy)
3481 return QualType(CATy, 0);
3482
3483 QualType CanonTy = getCanonicalType(WrappedTy);
3484 size_t Size = CountAttributedType::totalSizeToAlloc<TypeCoupledDeclRefInfo>(
3485 DependentDecls.size());
3486 CATy = (CountAttributedType *)Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment);
3487 new (CATy) CountAttributedType(WrappedTy, CanonTy, CountExpr, CountInBytes,
3488 OrNull, DependentDecls);
3489 Types.push_back(CATy);
3490 CountAttributedTypes.InsertNode(CATy, InsertPos);
3491
3492 return QualType(CATy, 0);
3493 }
3494
adjustFunctionType(const FunctionType * T,FunctionType::ExtInfo Info)3495 const FunctionType *ASTContext::adjustFunctionType(const FunctionType *T,
3496 FunctionType::ExtInfo Info) {
3497 if (T->getExtInfo() == Info)
3498 return T;
3499
3500 QualType Result;
3501 if (const auto *FNPT = dyn_cast<FunctionNoProtoType>(T)) {
3502 Result = getFunctionNoProtoType(FNPT->getReturnType(), Info);
3503 } else {
3504 const auto *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(T);
3505 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
3506 EPI.ExtInfo = Info;
3507 Result = getFunctionType(FPT->getReturnType(), FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
3508 }
3509
3510 return cast<FunctionType>(Result.getTypePtr());
3511 }
3512
adjustDeducedFunctionResultType(FunctionDecl * FD,QualType ResultType)3513 void ASTContext::adjustDeducedFunctionResultType(FunctionDecl *FD,
3514 QualType ResultType) {
3515 FD = FD->getMostRecentDecl();
3516 while (true) {
3517 const auto *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
3518 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
3519 FD->setType(getFunctionType(ResultType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI));
3520 if (FunctionDecl *Next = FD->getPreviousDecl())
3521 FD = Next;
3522 else
3523 break;
3524 }
3525 if (ASTMutationListener *L = getASTMutationListener())
3526 L->DeducedReturnType(FD, ResultType);
3527 }
3528
3529 /// Get a function type and produce the equivalent function type with the
3530 /// specified exception specification. Type sugar that can be present on a
3531 /// declaration of a function with an exception specification is permitted
3532 /// and preserved. Other type sugar (for instance, typedefs) is not.
getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(QualType Orig,const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo & ESI) const3533 QualType ASTContext::getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(
3534 QualType Orig, const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI) const {
3535 // Might have some parens.
3536 if (const auto *PT = dyn_cast<ParenType>(Orig))
3537 return getParenType(
3538 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(PT->getInnerType(), ESI));
3539
3540 // Might be wrapped in a macro qualified type.
3541 if (const auto *MQT = dyn_cast<MacroQualifiedType>(Orig))
3542 return getMacroQualifiedType(
3543 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(MQT->getUnderlyingType(), ESI),
3544 MQT->getMacroIdentifier());
3545
3546 // Might have a calling-convention attribute.
3547 if (const auto *AT = dyn_cast<AttributedType>(Orig))
3548 return getAttributedType(
3549 AT->getAttrKind(),
3550 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(AT->getModifiedType(), ESI),
3551 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(AT->getEquivalentType(), ESI));
3552
3553 // Anything else must be a function type. Rebuild it with the new exception
3554 // specification.
3555 const auto *Proto = Orig->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
3556 return getFunctionType(
3557 Proto->getReturnType(), Proto->getParamTypes(),
3558 Proto->getExtProtoInfo().withExceptionSpec(ESI));
3559 }
3560
hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringExceptionSpec(QualType T,QualType U) const3561 bool ASTContext::hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringExceptionSpec(QualType T,
3562 QualType U) const {
3563 return hasSameType(T, U) ||
3564 (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 &&
3565 hasSameType(getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(T, EST_None),
3566 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(U, EST_None)));
3567 }
3568
getFunctionTypeWithoutPtrSizes(QualType T)3569 QualType ASTContext::getFunctionTypeWithoutPtrSizes(QualType T) {
3570 if (const auto *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
3571 QualType RetTy = removePtrSizeAddrSpace(Proto->getReturnType());
3572 SmallVector<QualType, 16> Args(Proto->param_types().size());
3573 for (unsigned i = 0, n = Args.size(); i != n; ++i)
3574 Args[i] = removePtrSizeAddrSpace(Proto->param_types()[i]);
3575 return getFunctionType(RetTy, Args, Proto->getExtProtoInfo());
3576 }
3577
3578 if (const FunctionNoProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionNoProtoType>()) {
3579 QualType RetTy = removePtrSizeAddrSpace(Proto->getReturnType());
3580 return getFunctionNoProtoType(RetTy, Proto->getExtInfo());
3581 }
3582
3583 return T;
3584 }
3585
hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringPtrSizes(QualType T,QualType U)3586 bool ASTContext::hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringPtrSizes(QualType T, QualType U) {
3587 return hasSameType(T, U) ||
3588 hasSameType(getFunctionTypeWithoutPtrSizes(T),
3589 getFunctionTypeWithoutPtrSizes(U));
3590 }
3591
adjustExceptionSpec(FunctionDecl * FD,const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo & ESI,bool AsWritten)3592 void ASTContext::adjustExceptionSpec(
3593 FunctionDecl *FD, const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI,
3594 bool AsWritten) {
3595 // Update the type.
3596 QualType Updated =
3597 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(FD->getType(), ESI);
3598 FD->setType(Updated);
3599
3600 if (!AsWritten)
3601 return;
3602
3603 // Update the type in the type source information too.
3604 if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = FD->getTypeSourceInfo()) {
3605 // If the type and the type-as-written differ, we may need to update
3606 // the type-as-written too.
3607 if (TSInfo->getType() != FD->getType())
3608 Updated = getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(TSInfo->getType(), ESI);
3609
3610 // FIXME: When we get proper type location information for exceptions,
3611 // we'll also have to rebuild the TypeSourceInfo. For now, we just patch
3612 // up the TypeSourceInfo;
3613 assert(TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(Updated) ==
3614 TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(TSInfo->getType()) &&
3615 "TypeLoc size mismatch from updating exception specification");
3616 TSInfo->overrideType(Updated);
3617 }
3618 }
3619
3620 /// getComplexType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a complex
3621 /// number with the specified element type.
getComplexType(QualType T) const3622 QualType ASTContext::getComplexType(QualType T) const {
3623 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
3624 // structure.
3625 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3626 ComplexType::Profile(ID, T);
3627
3628 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3629 if (ComplexType *CT = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3630 return QualType(CT, 0);
3631
3632 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
3633 // so fill in the canonical type field.
3634 QualType Canonical;
3635 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
3636 Canonical = getComplexType(getCanonicalType(T));
3637
3638 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3639 ComplexType *NewIP = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3640 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
3641 }
3642 auto *New = new (*this, alignof(ComplexType)) ComplexType(T, Canonical);
3643 Types.push_back(New);
3644 ComplexTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3645 return QualType(New, 0);
3646 }
3647
3648 /// getPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a pointer to
3649 /// the specified type.
getPointerType(QualType T) const3650 QualType ASTContext::getPointerType(QualType T) const {
3651 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
3652 // structure.
3653 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3654 PointerType::Profile(ID, T);
3655
3656 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3657 if (PointerType *PT = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3658 return QualType(PT, 0);
3659
3660 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
3661 // so fill in the canonical type field.
3662 QualType Canonical;
3663 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
3664 Canonical = getPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
3665
3666 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3667 PointerType *NewIP = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3668 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
3669 }
3670 auto *New = new (*this, alignof(PointerType)) PointerType(T, Canonical);
3671 Types.push_back(New);
3672 PointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3673 return QualType(New, 0);
3674 }
3675
getAdjustedType(QualType Orig,QualType New) const3676 QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedType(QualType Orig, QualType New) const {
3677 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3678 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, Orig, New);
3679 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3680 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3681 if (AT)
3682 return QualType(AT, 0);
3683
3684 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(New);
3685
3686 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3687 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3688 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
3689
3690 AT = new (*this, alignof(AdjustedType))
3691 AdjustedType(Type::Adjusted, Orig, New, Canonical);
3692 Types.push_back(AT);
3693 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
3694 return QualType(AT, 0);
3695 }
3696
getDecayedType(QualType Orig,QualType Decayed) const3697 QualType ASTContext::getDecayedType(QualType Orig, QualType Decayed) const {
3698 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3699 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, Orig, Decayed);
3700 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3701 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3702 if (AT)
3703 return QualType(AT, 0);
3704
3705 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decayed);
3706
3707 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3708 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3709 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
3710
3711 AT = new (*this, alignof(DecayedType)) DecayedType(Orig, Decayed, Canonical);
3712 Types.push_back(AT);
3713 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
3714 return QualType(AT, 0);
3715 }
3716
getDecayedType(QualType T) const3717 QualType ASTContext::getDecayedType(QualType T) const {
3718 assert((T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType()) && "T does not decay");
3719
3720 QualType Decayed;
3721
3722 // C99 6.7.5.3p7:
3723 // A declaration of a parameter as "array of type" shall be
3724 // adjusted to "qualified pointer to type", where the type
3725 // qualifiers (if any) are those specified within the [ and ] of
3726 // the array type derivation.
3727 if (T->isArrayType())
3728 Decayed = getArrayDecayedType(T);
3729
3730 // C99 6.7.5.3p8:
3731 // A declaration of a parameter as "function returning type"
3732 // shall be adjusted to "pointer to function returning type", as
3733 // in 6.3.2.1.
3734 if (T->isFunctionType())
3735 Decayed = getPointerType(T);
3736
3737 return getDecayedType(T, Decayed);
3738 }
3739
getArrayParameterType(QualType Ty) const3740 QualType ASTContext::getArrayParameterType(QualType Ty) const {
3741 if (Ty->isArrayParameterType())
3742 return Ty;
3743 assert(Ty->isConstantArrayType() && "Ty must be an array type.");
3744 const auto *ATy = cast<ConstantArrayType>(Ty);
3745 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3746 ATy->Profile(ID, *this, ATy->getElementType(), ATy->getZExtSize(),
3747 ATy->getSizeExpr(), ATy->getSizeModifier(),
3748 ATy->getIndexTypeQualifiers().getAsOpaqueValue());
3749 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3750 ArrayParameterType *AT =
3751 ArrayParameterTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3752 if (AT)
3753 return QualType(AT, 0);
3754
3755 QualType Canonical;
3756 if (!Ty.isCanonical()) {
3757 Canonical = getArrayParameterType(getCanonicalType(Ty));
3758
3759 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3760 AT = ArrayParameterTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3761 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
3762 }
3763
3764 AT = new (*this, alignof(ArrayParameterType))
3765 ArrayParameterType(ATy, Canonical);
3766 Types.push_back(AT);
3767 ArrayParameterTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
3768 return QualType(AT, 0);
3769 }
3770
3771 /// getBlockPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for
3772 /// a pointer to the specified block.
getBlockPointerType(QualType T) const3773 QualType ASTContext::getBlockPointerType(QualType T) const {
3774 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "block of function types only");
3775 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one block of a particular
3776 // structure.
3777 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3778 BlockPointerType::Profile(ID, T);
3779
3780 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3781 if (BlockPointerType *PT =
3782 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3783 return QualType(PT, 0);
3784
3785 // If the block pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
3786 // type either so fill in the canonical type field.
3787 QualType Canonical;
3788 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
3789 Canonical = getBlockPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
3790
3791 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3792 BlockPointerType *NewIP =
3793 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3794 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
3795 }
3796 auto *New =
3797 new (*this, alignof(BlockPointerType)) BlockPointerType(T, Canonical);
3798 Types.push_back(New);
3799 BlockPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3800 return QualType(New, 0);
3801 }
3802
3803 /// getLValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
3804 /// lvalue reference to the specified type.
3805 QualType
getLValueReferenceType(QualType T,bool SpelledAsLValue) const3806 ASTContext::getLValueReferenceType(QualType T, bool SpelledAsLValue) const {
3807 assert((!T->isPlaceholderType() ||
3808 T->isSpecificPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::UnknownAny)) &&
3809 "Unresolved placeholder type");
3810
3811 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
3812 // structure.
3813 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3814 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, SpelledAsLValue);
3815
3816 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3817 if (LValueReferenceType *RT =
3818 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3819 return QualType(RT, 0);
3820
3821 const auto *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
3822
3823 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
3824 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
3825 QualType Canonical;
3826 if (!SpelledAsLValue || InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
3827 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
3828 Canonical = getLValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
3829
3830 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3831 LValueReferenceType *NewIP =
3832 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3833 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
3834 }
3835
3836 auto *New = new (*this, alignof(LValueReferenceType))
3837 LValueReferenceType(T, Canonical, SpelledAsLValue);
3838 Types.push_back(New);
3839 LValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3840
3841 return QualType(New, 0);
3842 }
3843
3844 /// getRValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
3845 /// rvalue reference to the specified type.
getRValueReferenceType(QualType T) const3846 QualType ASTContext::getRValueReferenceType(QualType T) const {
3847 assert((!T->isPlaceholderType() ||
3848 T->isSpecificPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::UnknownAny)) &&
3849 "Unresolved placeholder type");
3850
3851 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
3852 // structure.
3853 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3854 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, false);
3855
3856 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3857 if (RValueReferenceType *RT =
3858 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3859 return QualType(RT, 0);
3860
3861 const auto *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
3862
3863 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
3864 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
3865 QualType Canonical;
3866 if (InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
3867 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
3868 Canonical = getRValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
3869
3870 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3871 RValueReferenceType *NewIP =
3872 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3873 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
3874 }
3875
3876 auto *New = new (*this, alignof(RValueReferenceType))
3877 RValueReferenceType(T, Canonical);
3878 Types.push_back(New);
3879 RValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3880 return QualType(New, 0);
3881 }
3882
3883 /// getMemberPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a
3884 /// member pointer to the specified type, in the specified class.
getMemberPointerType(QualType T,const Type * Cls) const3885 QualType ASTContext::getMemberPointerType(QualType T, const Type *Cls) const {
3886 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
3887 // structure.
3888 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3889 MemberPointerType::Profile(ID, T, Cls);
3890
3891 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3892 if (MemberPointerType *PT =
3893 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3894 return QualType(PT, 0);
3895
3896 // If the pointee or class type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
3897 // type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
3898 QualType Canonical;
3899 if (!T.isCanonical() || !Cls->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
3900 Canonical = getMemberPointerType(getCanonicalType(T),getCanonicalType(Cls));
3901
3902 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3903 MemberPointerType *NewIP =
3904 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3905 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
3906 }
3907 auto *New = new (*this, alignof(MemberPointerType))
3908 MemberPointerType(T, Cls, Canonical);
3909 Types.push_back(New);
3910 MemberPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3911 return QualType(New, 0);
3912 }
3913
3914 /// getConstantArrayType - Return the unique reference to the type for an
3915 /// array of the specified element type.
getConstantArrayType(QualType EltTy,const llvm::APInt & ArySizeIn,const Expr * SizeExpr,ArraySizeModifier ASM,unsigned IndexTypeQuals) const3916 QualType ASTContext::getConstantArrayType(QualType EltTy,
3917 const llvm::APInt &ArySizeIn,
3918 const Expr *SizeExpr,
3919 ArraySizeModifier ASM,
3920 unsigned IndexTypeQuals) const {
3921 assert((EltTy->isDependentType() ||
3922 EltTy->isIncompleteType() || EltTy->isConstantSizeType()) &&
3923 "Constant array of VLAs is illegal!");
3924
3925 // We only need the size as part of the type if it's instantiation-dependent.
3926 if (SizeExpr && !SizeExpr->isInstantiationDependent())
3927 SizeExpr = nullptr;
3928
3929 // Convert the array size into a canonical width matching the pointer size for
3930 // the target.
3931 llvm::APInt ArySize(ArySizeIn);
3932 ArySize = ArySize.zextOrTrunc(Target->getMaxPointerWidth());
3933
3934 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3935 ConstantArrayType::Profile(ID, *this, EltTy, ArySize.getZExtValue(), SizeExpr,
3936 ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
3937
3938 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3939 if (ConstantArrayType *ATP =
3940 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3941 return QualType(ATP, 0);
3942
3943 // If the element type isn't canonical or has qualifiers, or the array bound
3944 // is instantiation-dependent, this won't be a canonical type either, so fill
3945 // in the canonical type field.
3946 QualType Canon;
3947 // FIXME: Check below should look for qualifiers behind sugar.
3948 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers() || SizeExpr) {
3949 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
3950 Canon = getConstantArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), ArySize, nullptr,
3951 ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
3952 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
3953
3954 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3955 ConstantArrayType *NewIP =
3956 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3957 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
3958 }
3959
3960 auto *New = ConstantArrayType::Create(*this, EltTy, Canon, ArySize, SizeExpr,
3961 ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
3962 ConstantArrayTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3963 Types.push_back(New);
3964 return QualType(New, 0);
3965 }
3966
3967 /// getVariableArrayDecayedType - Turns the given type, which may be
3968 /// variably-modified, into the corresponding type with all the known
3969 /// sizes replaced with [*].
getVariableArrayDecayedType(QualType type) const3970 QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayDecayedType(QualType type) const {
3971 // Vastly most common case.
3972 if (!type->isVariablyModifiedType()) return type;
3973
3974 QualType result;
3975
3976 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
3977 const Type *ty = split.Ty;
3978 switch (ty->getTypeClass()) {
3979 #define TYPE(Class, Base)
3980 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
3981 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
3982 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.inc"
3983 llvm_unreachable("didn't desugar past all non-canonical types?");
3984
3985 // These types should never be variably-modified.
3986 case Type::Builtin:
3987 case Type::Complex:
3988 case Type::Vector:
3989 case Type::DependentVector:
3990 case Type::ExtVector:
3991 case Type::DependentSizedExtVector:
3992 case Type::ConstantMatrix:
3993 case Type::DependentSizedMatrix:
3994 case Type::DependentAddressSpace:
3995 case Type::ObjCObject:
3996 case Type::ObjCInterface:
3997 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
3998 case Type::Record:
3999 case Type::Enum:
4000 case Type::UnresolvedUsing:
4001 case Type::TypeOfExpr:
4002 case Type::TypeOf:
4003 case Type::Decltype:
4004 case Type::UnaryTransform:
4005 case Type::DependentName:
4006 case Type::InjectedClassName:
4007 case Type::TemplateSpecialization:
4008 case Type::DependentTemplateSpecialization:
4009 case Type::TemplateTypeParm:
4010 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParmPack:
4011 case Type::Auto:
4012 case Type::DeducedTemplateSpecialization:
4013 case Type::PackExpansion:
4014 case Type::PackIndexing:
4015 case Type::BitInt:
4016 case Type::DependentBitInt:
4017 case Type::ArrayParameter:
4018 llvm_unreachable("type should never be variably-modified");
4019
4020 // These types can be variably-modified but should never need to
4021 // further decay.
4022 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
4023 case Type::FunctionProto:
4024 case Type::BlockPointer:
4025 case Type::MemberPointer:
4026 case Type::Pipe:
4027 return type;
4028
4029 // These types can be variably-modified. All these modifications
4030 // preserve structure except as noted by comments.
4031 // TODO: if we ever care about optimizing VLAs, there are no-op
4032 // optimizations available here.
4033 case Type::Pointer:
4034 result = getPointerType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(
4035 cast<PointerType>(ty)->getPointeeType()));
4036 break;
4037
4038 case Type::LValueReference: {
4039 const auto *lv = cast<LValueReferenceType>(ty);
4040 result = getLValueReferenceType(
4041 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()),
4042 lv->isSpelledAsLValue());
4043 break;
4044 }
4045
4046 case Type::RValueReference: {
4047 const auto *lv = cast<RValueReferenceType>(ty);
4048 result = getRValueReferenceType(
4049 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()));
4050 break;
4051 }
4052
4053 case Type::Atomic: {
4054 const auto *at = cast<AtomicType>(ty);
4055 result = getAtomicType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(at->getValueType()));
4056 break;
4057 }
4058
4059 case Type::ConstantArray: {
4060 const auto *cat = cast<ConstantArrayType>(ty);
4061 result = getConstantArrayType(
4062 getVariableArrayDecayedType(cat->getElementType()),
4063 cat->getSize(),
4064 cat->getSizeExpr(),
4065 cat->getSizeModifier(),
4066 cat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers());
4067 break;
4068 }
4069
4070 case Type::DependentSizedArray: {
4071 const auto *dat = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ty);
4072 result = getDependentSizedArrayType(
4073 getVariableArrayDecayedType(dat->getElementType()),
4074 dat->getSizeExpr(),
4075 dat->getSizeModifier(),
4076 dat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
4077 dat->getBracketsRange());
4078 break;
4079 }
4080
4081 // Turn incomplete types into [*] types.
4082 case Type::IncompleteArray: {
4083 const auto *iat = cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ty);
4084 result =
4085 getVariableArrayType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(iat->getElementType()),
4086 /*size*/ nullptr, ArraySizeModifier::Normal,
4087 iat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(), SourceRange());
4088 break;
4089 }
4090
4091 // Turn VLA types into [*] types.
4092 case Type::VariableArray: {
4093 const auto *vat = cast<VariableArrayType>(ty);
4094 result = getVariableArrayType(
4095 getVariableArrayDecayedType(vat->getElementType()),
4096 /*size*/ nullptr, ArraySizeModifier::Star,
4097 vat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(), vat->getBracketsRange());
4098 break;
4099 }
4100 }
4101
4102 // Apply the top-level qualifiers from the original.
4103 return getQualifiedType(result, split.Quals);
4104 }
4105
4106 /// getVariableArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to the type for a
4107 /// variable array of the specified element type.
getVariableArrayType(QualType EltTy,Expr * NumElts,ArraySizeModifier ASM,unsigned IndexTypeQuals,SourceRange Brackets) const4108 QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayType(QualType EltTy, Expr *NumElts,
4109 ArraySizeModifier ASM,
4110 unsigned IndexTypeQuals,
4111 SourceRange Brackets) const {
4112 // Since we don't unique expressions, it isn't possible to unique VLA's
4113 // that have an expression provided for their size.
4114 QualType Canon;
4115
4116 // Be sure to pull qualifiers off the element type.
4117 // FIXME: Check below should look for qualifiers behind sugar.
4118 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
4119 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
4120 Canon = getVariableArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), NumElts, ASM,
4121 IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
4122 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
4123 }
4124
4125 auto *New = new (*this, alignof(VariableArrayType))
4126 VariableArrayType(EltTy, Canon, NumElts, ASM, IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
4127
4128 VariableArrayTypes.push_back(New);
4129 Types.push_back(New);
4130 return QualType(New, 0);
4131 }
4132
4133 /// getDependentSizedArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to
4134 /// the type for a dependently-sized array of the specified element
4135 /// type.
getDependentSizedArrayType(QualType elementType,Expr * numElements,ArraySizeModifier ASM,unsigned elementTypeQuals,SourceRange brackets) const4136 QualType ASTContext::getDependentSizedArrayType(QualType elementType,
4137 Expr *numElements,
4138 ArraySizeModifier ASM,
4139 unsigned elementTypeQuals,
4140 SourceRange brackets) const {
4141 assert((!numElements || numElements->isTypeDependent() ||
4142 numElements->isValueDependent()) &&
4143 "Size must be type- or value-dependent!");
4144
4145 SplitQualType canonElementType = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
4146
4147 void *insertPos = nullptr;
4148 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4149 DependentSizedArrayType::Profile(
4150 ID, *this, numElements ? QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0) : elementType,
4151 ASM, elementTypeQuals, numElements);
4152
4153 // Look for an existing type with these properties.
4154 DependentSizedArrayType *canonTy =
4155 DependentSizedArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
4156
4157 // Dependently-sized array types that do not have a specified number
4158 // of elements will have their sizes deduced from a dependent
4159 // initializer.
4160 if (!numElements) {
4161 if (canonTy)
4162 return QualType(canonTy, 0);
4163
4164 auto *newType = new (*this, alignof(DependentSizedArrayType))
4165 DependentSizedArrayType(elementType, QualType(), numElements, ASM,
4166 elementTypeQuals, brackets);
4167 DependentSizedArrayTypes.InsertNode(newType, insertPos);
4168 Types.push_back(newType);
4169 return QualType(newType, 0);
4170 }
4171
4172 // If we don't have one, build one.
4173 if (!canonTy) {
4174 canonTy = new (*this, alignof(DependentSizedArrayType))
4175 DependentSizedArrayType(QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0), QualType(),
4176 numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals, brackets);
4177 DependentSizedArrayTypes.InsertNode(canonTy, insertPos);
4178 Types.push_back(canonTy);
4179 }
4180
4181 // Apply qualifiers from the element type to the array.
4182 QualType canon = getQualifiedType(QualType(canonTy,0),
4183 canonElementType.Quals);
4184
4185 // If we didn't need extra canonicalization for the element type or the size
4186 // expression, then just use that as our result.
4187 if (QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0) == elementType &&
4188 canonTy->getSizeExpr() == numElements)
4189 return canon;
4190
4191 // Otherwise, we need to build a type which follows the spelling
4192 // of the element type.
4193 auto *sugaredType = new (*this, alignof(DependentSizedArrayType))
4194 DependentSizedArrayType(elementType, canon, numElements, ASM,
4195 elementTypeQuals, brackets);
4196 Types.push_back(sugaredType);
4197 return QualType(sugaredType, 0);
4198 }
4199
getIncompleteArrayType(QualType elementType,ArraySizeModifier ASM,unsigned elementTypeQuals) const4200 QualType ASTContext::getIncompleteArrayType(QualType elementType,
4201 ArraySizeModifier ASM,
4202 unsigned elementTypeQuals) const {
4203 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4204 IncompleteArrayType::Profile(ID, elementType, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
4205
4206 void *insertPos = nullptr;
4207 if (IncompleteArrayType *iat =
4208 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos))
4209 return QualType(iat, 0);
4210
4211 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
4212 // either, so fill in the canonical type field. We also have to pull
4213 // qualifiers off the element type.
4214 QualType canon;
4215
4216 // FIXME: Check below should look for qualifiers behind sugar.
4217 if (!elementType.isCanonical() || elementType.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
4218 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
4219 canon = getIncompleteArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0),
4220 ASM, elementTypeQuals);
4221 canon = getQualifiedType(canon, canonSplit.Quals);
4222
4223 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
4224 IncompleteArrayType *existing =
4225 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
4226 assert(!existing && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void) existing;
4227 }
4228
4229 auto *newType = new (*this, alignof(IncompleteArrayType))
4230 IncompleteArrayType(elementType, canon, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
4231
4232 IncompleteArrayTypes.InsertNode(newType, insertPos);
4233 Types.push_back(newType);
4234 return QualType(newType, 0);
4235 }
4236
4237 ASTContext::BuiltinVectorTypeInfo
getBuiltinVectorTypeInfo(const BuiltinType * Ty) const4238 ASTContext::getBuiltinVectorTypeInfo(const BuiltinType *Ty) const {
4239 #define SVE_INT_ELTTY(BITS, ELTS, SIGNED, NUMVECTORS) \
4240 {getIntTypeForBitwidth(BITS, SIGNED), llvm::ElementCount::getScalable(ELTS), \
4241 NUMVECTORS};
4242
4243 #define SVE_ELTTY(ELTTY, ELTS, NUMVECTORS) \
4244 {ELTTY, llvm::ElementCount::getScalable(ELTS), NUMVECTORS};
4245
4246 switch (Ty->getKind()) {
4247 default:
4248 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported builtin vector type");
4249 case BuiltinType::SveInt8:
4250 return SVE_INT_ELTTY(8, 16, true, 1);
4251 case BuiltinType::SveUint8:
4252 return SVE_INT_ELTTY(8, 16, false, 1);
4253 case BuiltinType::SveInt8x2:
4254 return SVE_INT_ELTTY(8, 16, true, 2);
4255 case BuiltinType::SveUint8x2:
4256 return SVE_INT_ELTTY(8, 16, false, 2);
4257 case BuiltinType::SveInt8x3:
4258 return SVE_INT_ELTTY(8, 16, true, 3);
4259 case BuiltinType::SveUint8x3:
4260 return SVE_INT_ELTTY(8, 16, false, 3);
4261 case BuiltinType::SveInt8x4:
4262 return SVE_INT_ELTTY(8, 16, true, 4);
4263 case BuiltinType::SveUint8x4:
4264 return SVE_INT_ELTTY(8, 16, false, 4);
4265 case BuiltinType::SveInt16:
4266 return SVE_INT_ELTTY(16, 8, true, 1);
4267 case BuiltinType::SveUint16:
4268 return SVE_INT_ELTTY(16, 8, false, 1);
4269 case BuiltinType::SveInt16x2:
4270 return SVE_INT_ELTTY(16, 8, true, 2);
4271 case BuiltinType::SveUint16x2:
4272 return SVE_INT_ELTTY(16, 8, false, 2);
4273 case BuiltinType::SveInt16x3:
4274 return SVE_INT_ELTTY(16, 8, true, 3);
4275 case BuiltinType::SveUint16x3:
4276 return SVE_INT_ELTTY(16, 8, false, 3);
4277 case BuiltinType::SveInt16x4:
4278 return SVE_INT_ELTTY(16, 8, true, 4);
4279 case BuiltinType::SveUint16x4:
4280 return SVE_INT_ELTTY(16, 8, false, 4);
4281 case BuiltinType::SveInt32:
4282 return SVE_INT_ELTTY(32, 4, true, 1);
4283 case BuiltinType::SveUint32:
4284 return SVE_INT_ELTTY(32, 4, false, 1);
4285 case BuiltinType::SveInt32x2:
4286 return SVE_INT_ELTTY(32, 4, true, 2);
4287 case BuiltinType::SveUint32x2:
4288 return SVE_INT_ELTTY(32, 4, false, 2);
4289 case BuiltinType::SveInt32x3:
4290 return SVE_INT_ELTTY(32, 4, true, 3);
4291 case BuiltinType::SveUint32x3:
4292 return SVE_INT_ELTTY(32, 4, false, 3);
4293 case BuiltinType::SveInt32x4:
4294 return SVE_INT_ELTTY(32, 4, true, 4);
4295 case BuiltinType::SveUint32x4:
4296 return SVE_INT_ELTTY(32, 4, false, 4);
4297 case BuiltinType::SveInt64:
4298 return SVE_INT_ELTTY(64, 2, true, 1);
4299 case BuiltinType::SveUint64:
4300 return SVE_INT_ELTTY(64, 2, false, 1);
4301 case BuiltinType::SveInt64x2:
4302 return SVE_INT_ELTTY(64, 2, true, 2);
4303 case BuiltinType::SveUint64x2:
4304 return SVE_INT_ELTTY(64, 2, false, 2);
4305 case BuiltinType::SveInt64x3:
4306 return SVE_INT_ELTTY(64, 2, true, 3);
4307 case BuiltinType::SveUint64x3:
4308 return SVE_INT_ELTTY(64, 2, false, 3);
4309 case BuiltinType::SveInt64x4:
4310 return SVE_INT_ELTTY(64, 2, true, 4);
4311 case BuiltinType::SveUint64x4:
4312 return SVE_INT_ELTTY(64, 2, false, 4);
4313 case BuiltinType::SveBool:
4314 return SVE_ELTTY(BoolTy, 16, 1);
4315 case BuiltinType::SveBoolx2:
4316 return SVE_ELTTY(BoolTy, 16, 2);
4317 case BuiltinType::SveBoolx4:
4318 return SVE_ELTTY(BoolTy, 16, 4);
4319 case BuiltinType::SveFloat16:
4320 return SVE_ELTTY(HalfTy, 8, 1);
4321 case BuiltinType::SveFloat16x2:
4322 return SVE_ELTTY(HalfTy, 8, 2);
4323 case BuiltinType::SveFloat16x3:
4324 return SVE_ELTTY(HalfTy, 8, 3);
4325 case BuiltinType::SveFloat16x4:
4326 return SVE_ELTTY(HalfTy, 8, 4);
4327 case BuiltinType::SveFloat32:
4328 return SVE_ELTTY(FloatTy, 4, 1);
4329 case BuiltinType::SveFloat32x2:
4330 return SVE_ELTTY(FloatTy, 4, 2);
4331 case BuiltinType::SveFloat32x3:
4332 return SVE_ELTTY(FloatTy, 4, 3);
4333 case BuiltinType::SveFloat32x4:
4334 return SVE_ELTTY(FloatTy, 4, 4);
4335 case BuiltinType::SveFloat64:
4336 return SVE_ELTTY(DoubleTy, 2, 1);
4337 case BuiltinType::SveFloat64x2:
4338 return SVE_ELTTY(DoubleTy, 2, 2);
4339 case BuiltinType::SveFloat64x3:
4340 return SVE_ELTTY(DoubleTy, 2, 3);
4341 case BuiltinType::SveFloat64x4:
4342 return SVE_ELTTY(DoubleTy, 2, 4);
4343 case BuiltinType::SveBFloat16:
4344 return SVE_ELTTY(BFloat16Ty, 8, 1);
4345 case BuiltinType::SveBFloat16x2:
4346 return SVE_ELTTY(BFloat16Ty, 8, 2);
4347 case BuiltinType::SveBFloat16x3:
4348 return SVE_ELTTY(BFloat16Ty, 8, 3);
4349 case BuiltinType::SveBFloat16x4:
4350 return SVE_ELTTY(BFloat16Ty, 8, 4);
4351 #define RVV_VECTOR_TYPE_INT(Name, Id, SingletonId, NumEls, ElBits, NF, \
4352 IsSigned) \
4353 case BuiltinType::Id: \
4354 return {getIntTypeForBitwidth(ElBits, IsSigned), \
4355 llvm::ElementCount::getScalable(NumEls), NF};
4356 #define RVV_VECTOR_TYPE_FLOAT(Name, Id, SingletonId, NumEls, ElBits, NF) \
4357 case BuiltinType::Id: \
4358 return {ElBits == 16 ? Float16Ty : (ElBits == 32 ? FloatTy : DoubleTy), \
4359 llvm::ElementCount::getScalable(NumEls), NF};
4360 #define RVV_VECTOR_TYPE_BFLOAT(Name, Id, SingletonId, NumEls, ElBits, NF) \
4361 case BuiltinType::Id: \
4362 return {BFloat16Ty, llvm::ElementCount::getScalable(NumEls), NF};
4363 #define RVV_PREDICATE_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId, NumEls) \
4364 case BuiltinType::Id: \
4365 return {BoolTy, llvm::ElementCount::getScalable(NumEls), 1};
4366 #include "clang/Basic/RISCVVTypes.def"
4367 }
4368 }
4369
4370 /// getExternrefType - Return a WebAssembly externref type, which represents an
4371 /// opaque reference to a host value.
getWebAssemblyExternrefType() const4372 QualType ASTContext::getWebAssemblyExternrefType() const {
4373 if (Target->getTriple().isWasm() && Target->hasFeature("reference-types")) {
4374 #define WASM_REF_TYPE(Name, MangledName, Id, SingletonId, AS) \
4375 if (BuiltinType::Id == BuiltinType::WasmExternRef) \
4376 return SingletonId;
4377 #include "clang/Basic/WebAssemblyReferenceTypes.def"
4378 }
4379 llvm_unreachable(
4380 "shouldn't try to generate type externref outside WebAssembly target");
4381 }
4382
4383 /// getScalableVectorType - Return the unique reference to a scalable vector
4384 /// type of the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in
4385 /// type.
getScalableVectorType(QualType EltTy,unsigned NumElts,unsigned NumFields) const4386 QualType ASTContext::getScalableVectorType(QualType EltTy, unsigned NumElts,
4387 unsigned NumFields) const {
4388 if (Target->hasAArch64SVETypes()) {
4389 uint64_t EltTySize = getTypeSize(EltTy);
4390 #define SVE_VECTOR_TYPE(Name, MangledName, Id, SingletonId, NumEls, ElBits, \
4391 IsSigned, IsFP, IsBF) \
4392 if (!EltTy->isBooleanType() && \
4393 ((EltTy->hasIntegerRepresentation() && \
4394 EltTy->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation() == IsSigned) || \
4395 (EltTy->hasFloatingRepresentation() && !EltTy->isBFloat16Type() && \
4396 IsFP && !IsBF) || \
4397 (EltTy->hasFloatingRepresentation() && EltTy->isBFloat16Type() && \
4398 IsBF && !IsFP)) && \
4399 EltTySize == ElBits && NumElts == NumEls) { \
4400 return SingletonId; \
4401 }
4402 #define SVE_PREDICATE_TYPE(Name, MangledName, Id, SingletonId, NumEls) \
4403 if (EltTy->isBooleanType() && NumElts == NumEls) \
4404 return SingletonId;
4405 #define SVE_OPAQUE_TYPE(Name, MangledName, Id, SingleTonId)
4406 #include "clang/Basic/AArch64SVEACLETypes.def"
4407 } else if (Target->hasRISCVVTypes()) {
4408 uint64_t EltTySize = getTypeSize(EltTy);
4409 #define RVV_VECTOR_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId, NumEls, ElBits, NF, IsSigned, \
4410 IsFP, IsBF) \
4411 if (!EltTy->isBooleanType() && \
4412 ((EltTy->hasIntegerRepresentation() && \
4413 EltTy->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation() == IsSigned) || \
4414 (EltTy->hasFloatingRepresentation() && !EltTy->isBFloat16Type() && \
4415 IsFP && !IsBF) || \
4416 (EltTy->hasFloatingRepresentation() && EltTy->isBFloat16Type() && \
4417 IsBF && !IsFP)) && \
4418 EltTySize == ElBits && NumElts == NumEls && NumFields == NF) \
4419 return SingletonId;
4420 #define RVV_PREDICATE_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId, NumEls) \
4421 if (EltTy->isBooleanType() && NumElts == NumEls) \
4422 return SingletonId;
4423 #include "clang/Basic/RISCVVTypes.def"
4424 }
4425 return QualType();
4426 }
4427
4428 /// getVectorType - Return the unique reference to a vector type of
4429 /// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
getVectorType(QualType vecType,unsigned NumElts,VectorKind VecKind) const4430 QualType ASTContext::getVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts,
4431 VectorKind VecKind) const {
4432 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType() ||
4433 (vecType->isBitIntType() &&
4434 // Only support _BitInt elements with byte-sized power of 2 NumBits.
4435 llvm::isPowerOf2_32(vecType->castAs<BitIntType>()->getNumBits()) &&
4436 vecType->castAs<BitIntType>()->getNumBits() >= 8));
4437
4438 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
4439 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4440 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::Vector, VecKind);
4441
4442 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4443 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4444 return QualType(VTP, 0);
4445
4446 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
4447 // so fill in the canonical type field.
4448 QualType Canonical;
4449 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
4450 Canonical = getVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts, VecKind);
4451
4452 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
4453 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4454 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
4455 }
4456 auto *New = new (*this, alignof(VectorType))
4457 VectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical, VecKind);
4458 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
4459 Types.push_back(New);
4460 return QualType(New, 0);
4461 }
4462
getDependentVectorType(QualType VecType,Expr * SizeExpr,SourceLocation AttrLoc,VectorKind VecKind) const4463 QualType ASTContext::getDependentVectorType(QualType VecType, Expr *SizeExpr,
4464 SourceLocation AttrLoc,
4465 VectorKind VecKind) const {
4466 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4467 DependentVectorType::Profile(ID, *this, getCanonicalType(VecType), SizeExpr,
4468 VecKind);
4469 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4470 DependentVectorType *Canon =
4471 DependentVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4472 DependentVectorType *New;
4473
4474 if (Canon) {
4475 New = new (*this, alignof(DependentVectorType)) DependentVectorType(
4476 VecType, QualType(Canon, 0), SizeExpr, AttrLoc, VecKind);
4477 } else {
4478 QualType CanonVecTy = getCanonicalType(VecType);
4479 if (CanonVecTy == VecType) {
4480 New = new (*this, alignof(DependentVectorType))
4481 DependentVectorType(VecType, QualType(), SizeExpr, AttrLoc, VecKind);
4482
4483 DependentVectorType *CanonCheck =
4484 DependentVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4485 assert(!CanonCheck &&
4486 "Dependent-sized vector_size canonical type broken");
4487 (void)CanonCheck;
4488 DependentVectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
4489 } else {
4490 QualType CanonTy = getDependentVectorType(CanonVecTy, SizeExpr,
4491 SourceLocation(), VecKind);
4492 New = new (*this, alignof(DependentVectorType))
4493 DependentVectorType(VecType, CanonTy, SizeExpr, AttrLoc, VecKind);
4494 }
4495 }
4496
4497 Types.push_back(New);
4498 return QualType(New, 0);
4499 }
4500
4501 /// getExtVectorType - Return the unique reference to an extended vector type of
4502 /// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
getExtVectorType(QualType vecType,unsigned NumElts) const4503 QualType ASTContext::getExtVectorType(QualType vecType,
4504 unsigned NumElts) const {
4505 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType() || vecType->isDependentType() ||
4506 (vecType->isBitIntType() &&
4507 // Only support _BitInt elements with byte-sized power of 2 NumBits.
4508 llvm::isPowerOf2_32(vecType->castAs<BitIntType>()->getNumBits()) &&
4509 vecType->castAs<BitIntType>()->getNumBits() >= 8));
4510
4511 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
4512 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4513 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::ExtVector,
4514 VectorKind::Generic);
4515 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4516 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4517 return QualType(VTP, 0);
4518
4519 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
4520 // so fill in the canonical type field.
4521 QualType Canonical;
4522 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
4523 Canonical = getExtVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts);
4524
4525 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
4526 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4527 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
4528 }
4529 auto *New = new (*this, alignof(ExtVectorType))
4530 ExtVectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical);
4531 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
4532 Types.push_back(New);
4533 return QualType(New, 0);
4534 }
4535
4536 QualType
getDependentSizedExtVectorType(QualType vecType,Expr * SizeExpr,SourceLocation AttrLoc) const4537 ASTContext::getDependentSizedExtVectorType(QualType vecType,
4538 Expr *SizeExpr,
4539 SourceLocation AttrLoc) const {
4540 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4541 DependentSizedExtVectorType::Profile(ID, *this, getCanonicalType(vecType),
4542 SizeExpr);
4543
4544 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4545 DependentSizedExtVectorType *Canon
4546 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4547 DependentSizedExtVectorType *New;
4548 if (Canon) {
4549 // We already have a canonical version of this array type; use it as
4550 // the canonical type for a newly-built type.
4551 New = new (*this, alignof(DependentSizedExtVectorType))
4552 DependentSizedExtVectorType(vecType, QualType(Canon, 0), SizeExpr,
4553 AttrLoc);
4554 } else {
4555 QualType CanonVecTy = getCanonicalType(vecType);
4556 if (CanonVecTy == vecType) {
4557 New = new (*this, alignof(DependentSizedExtVectorType))
4558 DependentSizedExtVectorType(vecType, QualType(), SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
4559
4560 DependentSizedExtVectorType *CanonCheck
4561 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4562 assert(!CanonCheck && "Dependent-sized ext_vector canonical type broken");
4563 (void)CanonCheck;
4564 DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
4565 } else {
4566 QualType CanonExtTy = getDependentSizedExtVectorType(CanonVecTy, SizeExpr,
4567 SourceLocation());
4568 New = new (*this, alignof(DependentSizedExtVectorType))
4569 DependentSizedExtVectorType(vecType, CanonExtTy, SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
4570 }
4571 }
4572
4573 Types.push_back(New);
4574 return QualType(New, 0);
4575 }
4576
getConstantMatrixType(QualType ElementTy,unsigned NumRows,unsigned NumColumns) const4577 QualType ASTContext::getConstantMatrixType(QualType ElementTy, unsigned NumRows,
4578 unsigned NumColumns) const {
4579 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4580 ConstantMatrixType::Profile(ID, ElementTy, NumRows, NumColumns,
4581 Type::ConstantMatrix);
4582
4583 assert(MatrixType::isValidElementType(ElementTy) &&
4584 "need a valid element type");
4585 assert(ConstantMatrixType::isDimensionValid(NumRows) &&
4586 ConstantMatrixType::isDimensionValid(NumColumns) &&
4587 "need valid matrix dimensions");
4588 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4589 if (ConstantMatrixType *MTP = MatrixTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4590 return QualType(MTP, 0);
4591
4592 QualType Canonical;
4593 if (!ElementTy.isCanonical()) {
4594 Canonical =
4595 getConstantMatrixType(getCanonicalType(ElementTy), NumRows, NumColumns);
4596
4597 ConstantMatrixType *NewIP = MatrixTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4598 assert(!NewIP && "Matrix type shouldn't already exist in the map");
4599 (void)NewIP;
4600 }
4601
4602 auto *New = new (*this, alignof(ConstantMatrixType))
4603 ConstantMatrixType(ElementTy, NumRows, NumColumns, Canonical);
4604 MatrixTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
4605 Types.push_back(New);
4606 return QualType(New, 0);
4607 }
4608
getDependentSizedMatrixType(QualType ElementTy,Expr * RowExpr,Expr * ColumnExpr,SourceLocation AttrLoc) const4609 QualType ASTContext::getDependentSizedMatrixType(QualType ElementTy,
4610 Expr *RowExpr,
4611 Expr *ColumnExpr,
4612 SourceLocation AttrLoc) const {
4613 QualType CanonElementTy = getCanonicalType(ElementTy);
4614 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4615 DependentSizedMatrixType::Profile(ID, *this, CanonElementTy, RowExpr,
4616 ColumnExpr);
4617
4618 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4619 DependentSizedMatrixType *Canon =
4620 DependentSizedMatrixTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4621
4622 if (!Canon) {
4623 Canon = new (*this, alignof(DependentSizedMatrixType))
4624 DependentSizedMatrixType(CanonElementTy, QualType(), RowExpr,
4625 ColumnExpr, AttrLoc);
4626 #ifndef NDEBUG
4627 DependentSizedMatrixType *CanonCheck =
4628 DependentSizedMatrixTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4629 assert(!CanonCheck && "Dependent-sized matrix canonical type broken");
4630 #endif
4631 DependentSizedMatrixTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
4632 Types.push_back(Canon);
4633 }
4634
4635 // Already have a canonical version of the matrix type
4636 //
4637 // If it exactly matches the requested type, use it directly.
4638 if (Canon->getElementType() == ElementTy && Canon->getRowExpr() == RowExpr &&
4639 Canon->getRowExpr() == ColumnExpr)
4640 return QualType(Canon, 0);
4641
4642 // Use Canon as the canonical type for newly-built type.
4643 DependentSizedMatrixType *New = new (*this, alignof(DependentSizedMatrixType))
4644 DependentSizedMatrixType(ElementTy, QualType(Canon, 0), RowExpr,
4645 ColumnExpr, AttrLoc);
4646 Types.push_back(New);
4647 return QualType(New, 0);
4648 }
4649
getDependentAddressSpaceType(QualType PointeeType,Expr * AddrSpaceExpr,SourceLocation AttrLoc) const4650 QualType ASTContext::getDependentAddressSpaceType(QualType PointeeType,
4651 Expr *AddrSpaceExpr,
4652 SourceLocation AttrLoc) const {
4653 assert(AddrSpaceExpr->isInstantiationDependent());
4654
4655 QualType canonPointeeType = getCanonicalType(PointeeType);
4656
4657 void *insertPos = nullptr;
4658 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4659 DependentAddressSpaceType::Profile(ID, *this, canonPointeeType,
4660 AddrSpaceExpr);
4661
4662 DependentAddressSpaceType *canonTy =
4663 DependentAddressSpaceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
4664
4665 if (!canonTy) {
4666 canonTy = new (*this, alignof(DependentAddressSpaceType))
4667 DependentAddressSpaceType(canonPointeeType, QualType(), AddrSpaceExpr,
4668 AttrLoc);
4669 DependentAddressSpaceTypes.InsertNode(canonTy, insertPos);
4670 Types.push_back(canonTy);
4671 }
4672
4673 if (canonPointeeType == PointeeType &&
4674 canonTy->getAddrSpaceExpr() == AddrSpaceExpr)
4675 return QualType(canonTy, 0);
4676
4677 auto *sugaredType = new (*this, alignof(DependentAddressSpaceType))
4678 DependentAddressSpaceType(PointeeType, QualType(canonTy, 0),
4679 AddrSpaceExpr, AttrLoc);
4680 Types.push_back(sugaredType);
4681 return QualType(sugaredType, 0);
4682 }
4683
4684 /// Determine whether \p T is canonical as the result type of a function.
isCanonicalResultType(QualType T)4685 static bool isCanonicalResultType(QualType T) {
4686 return T.isCanonical() &&
4687 (T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None ||
4688 T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone);
4689 }
4690
4691 /// getFunctionNoProtoType - Return a K&R style C function type like 'int()'.
4692 QualType
getFunctionNoProtoType(QualType ResultTy,const FunctionType::ExtInfo & Info) const4693 ASTContext::getFunctionNoProtoType(QualType ResultTy,
4694 const FunctionType::ExtInfo &Info) const {
4695 // FIXME: This assertion cannot be enabled (yet) because the ObjC rewriter
4696 // functionality creates a function without a prototype regardless of
4697 // language mode (so it makes them even in C++). Once the rewriter has been
4698 // fixed, this assertion can be enabled again.
4699 //assert(!LangOpts.requiresStrictPrototypes() &&
4700 // "strict prototypes are disabled");
4701
4702 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
4703 // structure.
4704 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4705 FunctionNoProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, Info);
4706
4707 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4708 if (FunctionNoProtoType *FT =
4709 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4710 return QualType(FT, 0);
4711
4712 QualType Canonical;
4713 if (!isCanonicalResultType(ResultTy)) {
4714 Canonical =
4715 getFunctionNoProtoType(getCanonicalFunctionResultType(ResultTy), Info);
4716
4717 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
4718 FunctionNoProtoType *NewIP =
4719 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4720 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
4721 }
4722
4723 auto *New = new (*this, alignof(FunctionNoProtoType))
4724 FunctionNoProtoType(ResultTy, Canonical, Info);
4725 Types.push_back(New);
4726 FunctionNoProtoTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
4727 return QualType(New, 0);
4728 }
4729
4730 CanQualType
getCanonicalFunctionResultType(QualType ResultType) const4731 ASTContext::getCanonicalFunctionResultType(QualType ResultType) const {
4732 CanQualType CanResultType = getCanonicalType(ResultType);
4733
4734 // Canonical result types do not have ARC lifetime qualifiers.
4735 if (CanResultType.getQualifiers().hasObjCLifetime()) {
4736 Qualifiers Qs = CanResultType.getQualifiers();
4737 Qs.removeObjCLifetime();
4738 return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(
4739 getQualifiedType(CanResultType.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs));
4740 }
4741
4742 return CanResultType;
4743 }
4744
isCanonicalExceptionSpecification(const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo & ESI,bool NoexceptInType)4745 static bool isCanonicalExceptionSpecification(
4746 const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI, bool NoexceptInType) {
4747 if (ESI.Type == EST_None)
4748 return true;
4749 if (!NoexceptInType)
4750 return false;
4751
4752 // C++17 onwards: exception specification is part of the type, as a simple
4753 // boolean "can this function type throw".
4754 if (ESI.Type == EST_BasicNoexcept)
4755 return true;
4756
4757 // A noexcept(expr) specification is (possibly) canonical if expr is
4758 // value-dependent.
4759 if (ESI.Type == EST_DependentNoexcept)
4760 return true;
4761
4762 // A dynamic exception specification is canonical if it only contains pack
4763 // expansions (so we can't tell whether it's non-throwing) and all its
4764 // contained types are canonical.
4765 if (ESI.Type == EST_Dynamic) {
4766 bool AnyPackExpansions = false;
4767 for (QualType ET : ESI.Exceptions) {
4768 if (!ET.isCanonical())
4769 return false;
4770 if (ET->getAs<PackExpansionType>())
4771 AnyPackExpansions = true;
4772 }
4773 return AnyPackExpansions;
4774 }
4775
4776 return false;
4777 }
4778
getFunctionTypeInternal(QualType ResultTy,ArrayRef<QualType> ArgArray,const FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo & EPI,bool OnlyWantCanonical) const4779 QualType ASTContext::getFunctionTypeInternal(
4780 QualType ResultTy, ArrayRef<QualType> ArgArray,
4781 const FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo &EPI, bool OnlyWantCanonical) const {
4782 size_t NumArgs = ArgArray.size();
4783
4784 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
4785 // structure.
4786 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4787 FunctionProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, ArgArray.begin(), NumArgs, EPI,
4788 *this, true);
4789
4790 QualType Canonical;
4791 bool Unique = false;
4792
4793 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4794 if (FunctionProtoType *FPT =
4795 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) {
4796 QualType Existing = QualType(FPT, 0);
4797
4798 // If we find a pre-existing equivalent FunctionProtoType, we can just reuse
4799 // it so long as our exception specification doesn't contain a dependent
4800 // noexcept expression, or we're just looking for a canonical type.
4801 // Otherwise, we're going to need to create a type
4802 // sugar node to hold the concrete expression.
4803 if (OnlyWantCanonical || !isComputedNoexcept(EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type) ||
4804 EPI.ExceptionSpec.NoexceptExpr == FPT->getNoexceptExpr())
4805 return Existing;
4806
4807 // We need a new type sugar node for this one, to hold the new noexcept
4808 // expression. We do no canonicalization here, but that's OK since we don't
4809 // expect to see the same noexcept expression much more than once.
4810 Canonical = getCanonicalType(Existing);
4811 Unique = true;
4812 }
4813
4814 bool NoexceptInType = getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17;
4815 bool IsCanonicalExceptionSpec =
4816 isCanonicalExceptionSpecification(EPI.ExceptionSpec, NoexceptInType);
4817
4818 // Determine whether the type being created is already canonical or not.
4819 bool isCanonical = !Unique && IsCanonicalExceptionSpec &&
4820 isCanonicalResultType(ResultTy) && !EPI.HasTrailingReturn;
4821 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs && isCanonical; ++i)
4822 if (!ArgArray[i].isCanonicalAsParam())
4823 isCanonical = false;
4824
4825 if (OnlyWantCanonical)
4826 assert(isCanonical &&
4827 "given non-canonical parameters constructing canonical type");
4828
4829 // If this type isn't canonical, get the canonical version of it if we don't
4830 // already have it. The exception spec is only partially part of the
4831 // canonical type, and only in C++17 onwards.
4832 if (!isCanonical && Canonical.isNull()) {
4833 SmallVector<QualType, 16> CanonicalArgs;
4834 CanonicalArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
4835 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
4836 CanonicalArgs.push_back(getCanonicalParamType(ArgArray[i]));
4837
4838 llvm::SmallVector<QualType, 8> ExceptionTypeStorage;
4839 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo CanonicalEPI = EPI;
4840 CanonicalEPI.HasTrailingReturn = false;
4841
4842 if (IsCanonicalExceptionSpec) {
4843 // Exception spec is already OK.
4844 } else if (NoexceptInType) {
4845 switch (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type) {
4846 case EST_Unparsed: case EST_Unevaluated: case EST_Uninstantiated:
4847 // We don't know yet. It shouldn't matter what we pick here; no-one
4848 // should ever look at this.
4849 [[fallthrough]];
4850 case EST_None: case EST_MSAny: case EST_NoexceptFalse:
4851 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_None;
4852 break;
4853
4854 // A dynamic exception specification is almost always "not noexcept",
4855 // with the exception that a pack expansion might expand to no types.
4856 case EST_Dynamic: {
4857 bool AnyPacks = false;
4858 for (QualType ET : EPI.ExceptionSpec.Exceptions) {
4859 if (ET->getAs<PackExpansionType>())
4860 AnyPacks = true;
4861 ExceptionTypeStorage.push_back(getCanonicalType(ET));
4862 }
4863 if (!AnyPacks)
4864 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_None;
4865 else {
4866 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_Dynamic;
4867 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Exceptions = ExceptionTypeStorage;
4868 }
4869 break;
4870 }
4871
4872 case EST_DynamicNone:
4873 case EST_BasicNoexcept:
4874 case EST_NoexceptTrue:
4875 case EST_NoThrow:
4876 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_BasicNoexcept;
4877 break;
4878
4879 case EST_DependentNoexcept:
4880 llvm_unreachable("dependent noexcept is already canonical");
4881 }
4882 } else {
4883 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec = FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo();
4884 }
4885
4886 // Adjust the canonical function result type.
4887 CanQualType CanResultTy = getCanonicalFunctionResultType(ResultTy);
4888 Canonical =
4889 getFunctionTypeInternal(CanResultTy, CanonicalArgs, CanonicalEPI, true);
4890
4891 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
4892 FunctionProtoType *NewIP =
4893 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4894 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
4895 }
4896
4897 // Compute the needed size to hold this FunctionProtoType and the
4898 // various trailing objects.
4899 auto ESH = FunctionProtoType::getExceptionSpecSize(
4900 EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type, EPI.ExceptionSpec.Exceptions.size());
4901 size_t Size = FunctionProtoType::totalSizeToAlloc<
4902 QualType, SourceLocation, FunctionType::FunctionTypeExtraBitfields,
4903 FunctionType::FunctionTypeArmAttributes, FunctionType::ExceptionType,
4904 Expr *, FunctionDecl *, FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo, Qualifiers,
4905 FunctionEffect, EffectConditionExpr>(
4906 NumArgs, EPI.Variadic, EPI.requiresFunctionProtoTypeExtraBitfields(),
4907 EPI.requiresFunctionProtoTypeArmAttributes(), ESH.NumExceptionType,
4908 ESH.NumExprPtr, ESH.NumFunctionDeclPtr,
4909 EPI.ExtParameterInfos ? NumArgs : 0,
4910 EPI.TypeQuals.hasNonFastQualifiers() ? 1 : 0, EPI.FunctionEffects.size(),
4911 EPI.FunctionEffects.conditions().size());
4912
4913 auto *FTP = (FunctionProtoType *)Allocate(Size, alignof(FunctionProtoType));
4914 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo newEPI = EPI;
4915 new (FTP) FunctionProtoType(ResultTy, ArgArray, Canonical, newEPI);
4916 Types.push_back(FTP);
4917 if (!Unique)
4918 FunctionProtoTypes.InsertNode(FTP, InsertPos);
4919 if (!EPI.FunctionEffects.empty())
4920 AnyFunctionEffects = true;
4921 return QualType(FTP, 0);
4922 }
4923
getPipeType(QualType T,bool ReadOnly) const4924 QualType ASTContext::getPipeType(QualType T, bool ReadOnly) const {
4925 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4926 PipeType::Profile(ID, T, ReadOnly);
4927
4928 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4929 if (PipeType *PT = PipeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4930 return QualType(PT, 0);
4931
4932 // If the pipe element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
4933 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
4934 QualType Canonical;
4935 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
4936 Canonical = getPipeType(getCanonicalType(T), ReadOnly);
4937
4938 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
4939 PipeType *NewIP = PipeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4940 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
4941 (void)NewIP;
4942 }
4943 auto *New = new (*this, alignof(PipeType)) PipeType(T, Canonical, ReadOnly);
4944 Types.push_back(New);
4945 PipeTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
4946 return QualType(New, 0);
4947 }
4948
adjustStringLiteralBaseType(QualType Ty) const4949 QualType ASTContext::adjustStringLiteralBaseType(QualType Ty) const {
4950 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5.3: a string literal is in the constant address space.
4951 return LangOpts.OpenCL ? getAddrSpaceQualType(Ty, LangAS::opencl_constant)
4952 : Ty;
4953 }
4954
getReadPipeType(QualType T) const4955 QualType ASTContext::getReadPipeType(QualType T) const {
4956 return getPipeType(T, true);
4957 }
4958
getWritePipeType(QualType T) const4959 QualType ASTContext::getWritePipeType(QualType T) const {
4960 return getPipeType(T, false);
4961 }
4962
getBitIntType(bool IsUnsigned,unsigned NumBits) const4963 QualType ASTContext::getBitIntType(bool IsUnsigned, unsigned NumBits) const {
4964 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4965 BitIntType::Profile(ID, IsUnsigned, NumBits);
4966
4967 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4968 if (BitIntType *EIT = BitIntTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4969 return QualType(EIT, 0);
4970
4971 auto *New = new (*this, alignof(BitIntType)) BitIntType(IsUnsigned, NumBits);
4972 BitIntTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
4973 Types.push_back(New);
4974 return QualType(New, 0);
4975 }
4976
getDependentBitIntType(bool IsUnsigned,Expr * NumBitsExpr) const4977 QualType ASTContext::getDependentBitIntType(bool IsUnsigned,
4978 Expr *NumBitsExpr) const {
4979 assert(NumBitsExpr->isInstantiationDependent() && "Only good for dependent");
4980 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4981 DependentBitIntType::Profile(ID, *this, IsUnsigned, NumBitsExpr);
4982
4983 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4984 if (DependentBitIntType *Existing =
4985 DependentBitIntTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4986 return QualType(Existing, 0);
4987
4988 auto *New = new (*this, alignof(DependentBitIntType))
4989 DependentBitIntType(IsUnsigned, NumBitsExpr);
4990 DependentBitIntTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
4991
4992 Types.push_back(New);
4993 return QualType(New, 0);
4994 }
4995
4996 #ifndef NDEBUG
NeedsInjectedClassNameType(const RecordDecl * D)4997 static bool NeedsInjectedClassNameType(const RecordDecl *D) {
4998 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) return false;
4999 const auto *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D);
5000 if (isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(RD))
5001 return true;
5002 if (RD->getDescribedClassTemplate() &&
5003 !isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RD))
5004 return true;
5005 return false;
5006 }
5007 #endif
5008
5009 /// getInjectedClassNameType - Return the unique reference to the
5010 /// injected class name type for the specified templated declaration.
getInjectedClassNameType(CXXRecordDecl * Decl,QualType TST) const5011 QualType ASTContext::getInjectedClassNameType(CXXRecordDecl *Decl,
5012 QualType TST) const {
5013 assert(NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Decl));
5014 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) {
5015 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
5016 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl()) {
5017 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous declaration has no type");
5018 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
5019 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
5020 } else {
5021 Type *newType = new (*this, alignof(InjectedClassNameType))
5022 InjectedClassNameType(Decl, TST);
5023 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
5024 Types.push_back(newType);
5025 }
5026 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
5027 }
5028
5029 /// getTypeDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
5030 /// specified type declaration.
getTypeDeclTypeSlow(const TypeDecl * Decl) const5031 QualType ASTContext::getTypeDeclTypeSlow(const TypeDecl *Decl) const {
5032 assert(Decl && "Passed null for Decl param");
5033 assert(!Decl->TypeForDecl && "TypeForDecl present in slow case");
5034
5035 if (const auto *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Decl))
5036 return getTypedefType(Typedef);
5037
5038 assert(!isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Decl) &&
5039 "Template type parameter types are always available.");
5040
5041 if (const auto *Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Decl)) {
5042 assert(Record->isFirstDecl() && "struct/union has previous declaration");
5043 assert(!NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Record));
5044 return getRecordType(Record);
5045 } else if (const auto *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(Decl)) {
5046 assert(Enum->isFirstDecl() && "enum has previous declaration");
5047 return getEnumType(Enum);
5048 } else if (const auto *Using = dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Decl)) {
5049 return getUnresolvedUsingType(Using);
5050 } else
5051 llvm_unreachable("TypeDecl without a type?");
5052
5053 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
5054 }
5055
5056 /// getTypedefType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
5057 /// specified typedef name decl.
getTypedefType(const TypedefNameDecl * Decl,QualType Underlying) const5058 QualType ASTContext::getTypedefType(const TypedefNameDecl *Decl,
5059 QualType Underlying) const {
5060 if (!Decl->TypeForDecl) {
5061 if (Underlying.isNull())
5062 Underlying = Decl->getUnderlyingType();
5063 auto *NewType = new (*this, alignof(TypedefType)) TypedefType(
5064 Type::Typedef, Decl, QualType(), getCanonicalType(Underlying));
5065 Decl->TypeForDecl = NewType;
5066 Types.push_back(NewType);
5067 return QualType(NewType, 0);
5068 }
5069 if (Underlying.isNull() || Decl->getUnderlyingType() == Underlying)
5070 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
5071 assert(hasSameType(Decl->getUnderlyingType(), Underlying));
5072
5073 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
5074 TypedefType::Profile(ID, Decl, Underlying);
5075
5076 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
5077 if (TypedefType *T = TypedefTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) {
5078 assert(!T->typeMatchesDecl() &&
5079 "non-divergent case should be handled with TypeDecl");
5080 return QualType(T, 0);
5081 }
5082
5083 void *Mem = Allocate(TypedefType::totalSizeToAlloc<QualType>(true),
5084 alignof(TypedefType));
5085 auto *NewType = new (Mem) TypedefType(Type::Typedef, Decl, Underlying,
5086 getCanonicalType(Underlying));
5087 TypedefTypes.InsertNode(NewType, InsertPos);
5088 Types.push_back(NewType);
5089 return QualType(NewType, 0);
5090 }
5091
getUsingType(const UsingShadowDecl * Found,QualType Underlying) const5092 QualType ASTContext::getUsingType(const UsingShadowDecl *Found,
5093 QualType Underlying) const {
5094 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
5095 UsingType::Profile(ID, Found, Underlying);
5096
5097 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
5098 if (UsingType *T = UsingTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
5099 return QualType(T, 0);
5100
5101 const Type *TypeForDecl =
5102 cast<TypeDecl>(Found->getTargetDecl())->getTypeForDecl();
5103
5104 assert(!Underlying.hasLocalQualifiers());
5105 QualType Canon = Underlying->getCanonicalTypeInternal();
5106 assert(TypeForDecl->getCanonicalTypeInternal() == Canon);
5107
5108 if (Underlying.getTypePtr() == TypeForDecl)
5109 Underlying = QualType();
5110 void *Mem =
5111 Allocate(UsingType::totalSizeToAlloc<QualType>(!Underlying.isNull()),
5112 alignof(UsingType));
5113 UsingType *NewType = new (Mem) UsingType(Found, Underlying, Canon);
5114 Types.push_back(NewType);
5115 UsingTypes.InsertNode(NewType, InsertPos);
5116 return QualType(NewType, 0);
5117 }
5118
getRecordType(const RecordDecl * Decl) const5119 QualType ASTContext::getRecordType(const RecordDecl *Decl) const {
5120 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
5121
5122 if (const RecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
5123 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
5124 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
5125
5126 auto *newType = new (*this, alignof(RecordType)) RecordType(Decl);
5127 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
5128 Types.push_back(newType);
5129 return QualType(newType, 0);
5130 }
5131
getEnumType(const EnumDecl * Decl) const5132 QualType ASTContext::getEnumType(const EnumDecl *Decl) const {
5133 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
5134
5135 if (const EnumDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
5136 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
5137 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
5138
5139 auto *newType = new (*this, alignof(EnumType)) EnumType(Decl);
5140 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
5141 Types.push_back(newType);
5142 return QualType(newType, 0);
5143 }
5144
getUnresolvedUsingType(const UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl * Decl) const5145 QualType ASTContext::getUnresolvedUsingType(
5146 const UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *Decl) const {
5147 if (Decl->TypeForDecl)
5148 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
5149
5150 if (const UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *CanonicalDecl =
5151 Decl->getCanonicalDecl())
5152 if (CanonicalDecl->TypeForDecl)
5153 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = CanonicalDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
5154
5155 Type *newType =
5156 new (*this, alignof(UnresolvedUsingType)) UnresolvedUsingType(Decl);
5157 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
5158 Types.push_back(newType);
5159 return QualType(newType, 0);
5160 }
5161
getAttributedType(attr::Kind attrKind,QualType modifiedType,QualType equivalentType) const5162 QualType ASTContext::getAttributedType(attr::Kind attrKind,
5163 QualType modifiedType,
5164 QualType equivalentType) const {
5165 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID id;
5166 AttributedType::Profile(id, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
5167
5168 void *insertPos = nullptr;
5169 AttributedType *type = AttributedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(id, insertPos);
5170 if (type) return QualType(type, 0);
5171
5172 QualType canon = getCanonicalType(equivalentType);
5173 type = new (*this, alignof(AttributedType))
5174 AttributedType(canon, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
5175
5176 Types.push_back(type);
5177 AttributedTypes.InsertNode(type, insertPos);
5178
5179 return QualType(type, 0);
5180 }
5181
getBTFTagAttributedType(const BTFTypeTagAttr * BTFAttr,QualType Wrapped)5182 QualType ASTContext::getBTFTagAttributedType(const BTFTypeTagAttr *BTFAttr,
5183 QualType Wrapped) {
5184 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
5185 BTFTagAttributedType::Profile(ID, Wrapped, BTFAttr);
5186
5187 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
5188 BTFTagAttributedType *Ty =
5189 BTFTagAttributedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
5190 if (Ty)
5191 return QualType(Ty, 0);
5192
5193 QualType Canon = getCanonicalType(Wrapped);
5194 Ty = new (*this, alignof(BTFTagAttributedType))
5195 BTFTagAttributedType(Canon, Wrapped, BTFAttr);
5196
5197 Types.push_back(Ty);
5198 BTFTagAttributedTypes.InsertNode(Ty, InsertPos);
5199
5200 return QualType(Ty, 0);
5201 }
5202
5203 /// Retrieve a substitution-result type.
getSubstTemplateTypeParmType(QualType Replacement,Decl * AssociatedDecl,unsigned Index,std::optional<unsigned> PackIndex) const5204 QualType ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmType(
5205 QualType Replacement, Decl *AssociatedDecl, unsigned Index,
5206 std::optional<unsigned> PackIndex) const {
5207 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
5208 SubstTemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Replacement, AssociatedDecl, Index,
5209 PackIndex);
5210 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
5211 SubstTemplateTypeParmType *SubstParm =
5212 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
5213
5214 if (!SubstParm) {
5215 void *Mem = Allocate(SubstTemplateTypeParmType::totalSizeToAlloc<QualType>(
5216 !Replacement.isCanonical()),
5217 alignof(SubstTemplateTypeParmType));
5218 SubstParm = new (Mem) SubstTemplateTypeParmType(Replacement, AssociatedDecl,
5219 Index, PackIndex);
5220 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
5221 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
5222 }
5223
5224 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
5225 }
5226
5227 /// Retrieve a
5228 QualType
getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(Decl * AssociatedDecl,unsigned Index,bool Final,const TemplateArgument & ArgPack)5229 ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(Decl *AssociatedDecl,
5230 unsigned Index, bool Final,
5231 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) {
5232 #ifndef NDEBUG
5233 for (const auto &P : ArgPack.pack_elements())
5234 assert(P.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Type && "Pack contains a non-type");
5235 #endif
5236
5237 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
5238 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType::Profile(ID, AssociatedDecl, Index, Final,
5239 ArgPack);
5240 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
5241 if (SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm =
5242 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
5243 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
5244
5245 QualType Canon;
5246 {
5247 TemplateArgument CanonArgPack = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(ArgPack);
5248 if (!AssociatedDecl->isCanonicalDecl() ||
5249 !CanonArgPack.structurallyEquals(ArgPack)) {
5250 Canon = getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(
5251 AssociatedDecl->getCanonicalDecl(), Index, Final, CanonArgPack);
5252 [[maybe_unused]] const auto *Nothing =
5253 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
5254 assert(!Nothing);
5255 }
5256 }
5257
5258 auto *SubstParm = new (*this, alignof(SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType))
5259 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(Canon, AssociatedDecl, Index, Final,
5260 ArgPack);
5261 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
5262 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
5263 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
5264 }
5265
5266 /// Retrieve the template type parameter type for a template
5267 /// parameter or parameter pack with the given depth, index, and (optionally)
5268 /// name.
getTemplateTypeParmType(unsigned Depth,unsigned Index,bool ParameterPack,TemplateTypeParmDecl * TTPDecl) const5269 QualType ASTContext::getTemplateTypeParmType(unsigned Depth, unsigned Index,
5270 bool ParameterPack,
5271 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTPDecl) const {
5272 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
5273 TemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Depth, Index, ParameterPack, TTPDecl);
5274 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
5275 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeParm
5276 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
5277
5278 if (TypeParm)
5279 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
5280
5281 if (TTPDecl) {
5282 QualType Canon = getTemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
5283 TypeParm = new (*this, alignof(TemplateTypeParmType))
5284 TemplateTypeParmType(TTPDecl, Canon);
5285
5286 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeCheck
5287 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
5288 assert(!TypeCheck && "Template type parameter canonical type broken");
5289 (void)TypeCheck;
5290 } else
5291 TypeParm = new (*this, alignof(TemplateTypeParmType))
5292 TemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
5293
5294 Types.push_back(TypeParm);
5295 TemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(TypeParm, InsertPos);
5296
5297 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
5298 }
5299
5300 TypeSourceInfo *
getTemplateSpecializationTypeInfo(TemplateName Name,SourceLocation NameLoc,const TemplateArgumentListInfo & Args,QualType Underlying) const5301 ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationTypeInfo(TemplateName Name,
5302 SourceLocation NameLoc,
5303 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
5304 QualType Underlying) const {
5305 assert(!Name.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
5306 "No dependent template names here!");
5307 QualType TST =
5308 getTemplateSpecializationType(Name, Args.arguments(), Underlying);
5309
5310 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(TST);
5311 TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc TL =
5312 DI->getTypeLoc().castAs<TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc>();
5313 TL.setTemplateKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
5314 TL.setTemplateNameLoc(NameLoc);
5315 TL.setLAngleLoc(Args.getLAngleLoc());
5316 TL.setRAngleLoc(Args.getRAngleLoc());
5317 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TL.getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i)
5318 TL.setArgLocInfo(i, Args[i].getLocInfo());
5319 return DI;
5320 }
5321
5322 QualType
getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,ArrayRef<TemplateArgumentLoc> Args,QualType Underlying) const5323 ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
5324 ArrayRef<TemplateArgumentLoc> Args,
5325 QualType Underlying) const {
5326 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
5327 "No dependent template names here!");
5328
5329 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> ArgVec;
5330 ArgVec.reserve(Args.size());
5331 for (const TemplateArgumentLoc &Arg : Args)
5332 ArgVec.push_back(Arg.getArgument());
5333
5334 return getTemplateSpecializationType(Template, ArgVec, Underlying);
5335 }
5336
5337 #ifndef NDEBUG
hasAnyPackExpansions(ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args)5338 static bool hasAnyPackExpansions(ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args) {
5339 for (const TemplateArgument &Arg : Args)
5340 if (Arg.isPackExpansion())
5341 return true;
5342
5343 return true;
5344 }
5345 #endif
5346
5347 QualType
getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args,QualType Underlying) const5348 ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
5349 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args,
5350 QualType Underlying) const {
5351 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
5352 "No dependent template names here!");
5353
5354 const auto *TD = Template.getAsTemplateDecl();
5355 bool IsTypeAlias = TD && TD->isTypeAlias();
5356 QualType CanonType;
5357 if (!Underlying.isNull())
5358 CanonType = getCanonicalType(Underlying);
5359 else {
5360 // We can get here with an alias template when the specialization contains
5361 // a pack expansion that does not match up with a parameter pack.
5362 assert((!IsTypeAlias || hasAnyPackExpansions(Args)) &&
5363 "Caller must compute aliased type");
5364 IsTypeAlias = false;
5365 CanonType = getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args);
5366 }
5367
5368 // Allocate the (non-canonical) template specialization type, but don't
5369 // try to unique it: these types typically have location information that
5370 // we don't unique and don't want to lose.
5371 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
5372 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * Args.size() +
5373 (IsTypeAlias ? sizeof(QualType) : 0),
5374 alignof(TemplateSpecializationType));
5375 auto *Spec
5376 = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args, CanonType,
5377 IsTypeAlias ? Underlying : QualType());
5378
5379 Types.push_back(Spec);
5380 return QualType(Spec, 0);
5381 }
5382
getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args) const5383 QualType ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(
5384 TemplateName Template, ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args) const {
5385 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
5386 "No dependent template names here!");
5387
5388 // Build the canonical template specialization type.
5389 TemplateName CanonTemplate = getCanonicalTemplateName(Template);
5390 bool AnyNonCanonArgs = false;
5391 auto CanonArgs =
5392 ::getCanonicalTemplateArguments(*this, Args, AnyNonCanonArgs);
5393
5394 // Determine whether this canonical template specialization type already
5395 // exists.
5396 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
5397 TemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, CanonTemplate,
5398 CanonArgs, *this);
5399
5400 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
5401 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
5402 = TemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
5403
5404 if (!Spec) {
5405 // Allocate a new canonical template specialization type.
5406 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
5407 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * CanonArgs.size()),
5408 alignof(TemplateSpecializationType));
5409 Spec = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(CanonTemplate,
5410 CanonArgs,
5411 QualType(), QualType());
5412 Types.push_back(Spec);
5413 TemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(Spec, InsertPos);
5414 }
5415
5416 assert(Spec->isDependentType() &&
5417 "Non-dependent template-id type must have a canonical type");
5418 return QualType(Spec, 0);
5419 }
5420
getElaboratedType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,NestedNameSpecifier * NNS,QualType NamedType,TagDecl * OwnedTagDecl) const5421 QualType ASTContext::getElaboratedType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
5422 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
5423 QualType NamedType,
5424 TagDecl *OwnedTagDecl) const {
5425 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
5426 ElaboratedType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, NamedType, OwnedTagDecl);
5427
5428 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
5429 ElaboratedType *T = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
5430 if (T)
5431 return QualType(T, 0);
5432
5433 QualType Canon = NamedType;
5434 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
5435 Canon = getCanonicalType(NamedType);
5436 ElaboratedType *CheckT = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
5437 assert(!CheckT && "Elaborated canonical type broken");
5438 (void)CheckT;
5439 }
5440
5441 void *Mem =
5442 Allocate(ElaboratedType::totalSizeToAlloc<TagDecl *>(!!OwnedTagDecl),
5443 alignof(ElaboratedType));
5444 T = new (Mem) ElaboratedType(Keyword, NNS, NamedType, Canon, OwnedTagDecl);
5445
5446 Types.push_back(T);
5447 ElaboratedTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
5448 return QualType(T, 0);
5449 }
5450
5451 QualType
getParenType(QualType InnerType) const5452 ASTContext::getParenType(QualType InnerType) const {
5453 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
5454 ParenType::Profile(ID, InnerType);
5455
5456 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
5457 ParenType *T = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
5458 if (T)
5459 return QualType(T, 0);
5460
5461 QualType Canon = InnerType;
5462 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
5463 Canon = getCanonicalType(InnerType);
5464 ParenType *CheckT = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
5465 assert(!CheckT && "Paren canonical type broken");
5466 (void)CheckT;
5467 }
5468
5469 T = new (*this, alignof(ParenType)) ParenType(InnerType, Canon);
5470 Types.push_back(T);
5471 ParenTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
5472 return QualType(T, 0);
5473 }
5474
5475 QualType
getMacroQualifiedType(QualType UnderlyingTy,const IdentifierInfo * MacroII) const5476 ASTContext::getMacroQualifiedType(QualType UnderlyingTy,
5477 const IdentifierInfo *MacroII) const {
5478 QualType Canon = UnderlyingTy;
5479 if (!Canon.isCanonical())
5480 Canon = getCanonicalType(UnderlyingTy);
5481
5482 auto *newType = new (*this, alignof(MacroQualifiedType))
5483 MacroQualifiedType(UnderlyingTy, Canon, MacroII);
5484 Types.push_back(newType);
5485 return QualType(newType, 0);
5486 }
5487
getDependentNameType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,NestedNameSpecifier * NNS,const IdentifierInfo * Name,QualType Canon) const5488 QualType ASTContext::getDependentNameType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
5489 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
5490 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
5491 QualType Canon) const {
5492 if (Canon.isNull()) {
5493 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
5494 if (CanonNNS != NNS)
5495 Canon = getDependentNameType(Keyword, CanonNNS, Name);
5496 }
5497
5498 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
5499 DependentNameType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, Name);
5500
5501 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
5502 DependentNameType *T
5503 = DependentNameTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
5504 if (T)
5505 return QualType(T, 0);
5506
5507 T = new (*this, alignof(DependentNameType))
5508 DependentNameType(Keyword, NNS, Name, Canon);
5509 Types.push_back(T);
5510 DependentNameTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
5511 return QualType(T, 0);
5512 }
5513
getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,NestedNameSpecifier * NNS,const IdentifierInfo * Name,ArrayRef<TemplateArgumentLoc> Args) const5514 QualType ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
5515 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword, NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
5516 const IdentifierInfo *Name, ArrayRef<TemplateArgumentLoc> Args) const {
5517 // TODO: avoid this copy
5518 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> ArgCopy;
5519 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Args.size(); I != E; ++I)
5520 ArgCopy.push_back(Args[I].getArgument());
5521 return getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS, Name, ArgCopy);
5522 }
5523
5524 QualType
getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,NestedNameSpecifier * NNS,const IdentifierInfo * Name,ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args) const5525 ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
5526 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
5527 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
5528 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
5529 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args) const {
5530 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
5531 "nested-name-specifier must be dependent");
5532
5533 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
5534 DependentTemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, *this, Keyword, NNS,
5535 Name, Args);
5536
5537 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
5538 DependentTemplateSpecializationType *T
5539 = DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
5540 if (T)
5541 return QualType(T, 0);
5542
5543 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
5544
5545 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
5546 if (Keyword == ElaboratedTypeKeyword::None)
5547 CanonKeyword = ElaboratedTypeKeyword::Typename;
5548
5549 bool AnyNonCanonArgs = false;
5550 auto CanonArgs =
5551 ::getCanonicalTemplateArguments(*this, Args, AnyNonCanonArgs);
5552
5553 QualType Canon;
5554 if (AnyNonCanonArgs || CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword) {
5555 Canon = getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS,
5556 Name,
5557 CanonArgs);
5558
5559 // Find the insert position again.
5560 [[maybe_unused]] auto *Nothing =
5561 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
5562 assert(!Nothing && "canonical type broken");
5563 }
5564
5565 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(DependentTemplateSpecializationType) +
5566 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * Args.size()),
5567 alignof(DependentTemplateSpecializationType));
5568 T = new (Mem) DependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS,
5569 Name, Args, Canon);
5570 Types.push_back(T);
5571 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
5572 return QualType(T, 0);
5573 }
5574
getInjectedTemplateArg(NamedDecl * Param)5575 TemplateArgument ASTContext::getInjectedTemplateArg(NamedDecl *Param) {
5576 TemplateArgument Arg;
5577 if (const auto *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Param)) {
5578 QualType ArgType = getTypeDeclType(TTP);
5579 if (TTP->isParameterPack())
5580 ArgType = getPackExpansionType(ArgType, std::nullopt);
5581
5582 Arg = TemplateArgument(ArgType);
5583 } else if (auto *NTTP = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(Param)) {
5584 QualType T =
5585 NTTP->getType().getNonPackExpansionType().getNonLValueExprType(*this);
5586 // For class NTTPs, ensure we include the 'const' so the type matches that
5587 // of a real template argument.
5588 // FIXME: It would be more faithful to model this as something like an
5589 // lvalue-to-rvalue conversion applied to a const-qualified lvalue.
5590 if (T->isRecordType())
5591 T.addConst();
5592 Expr *E = new (*this) DeclRefExpr(
5593 *this, NTTP, /*RefersToEnclosingVariableOrCapture*/ false, T,
5594 Expr::getValueKindForType(NTTP->getType()), NTTP->getLocation());
5595
5596 if (NTTP->isParameterPack())
5597 E = new (*this)
5598 PackExpansionExpr(DependentTy, E, NTTP->getLocation(), std::nullopt);
5599 Arg = TemplateArgument(E);
5600 } else {
5601 auto *TTP = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Param);
5602 TemplateName Name = getQualifiedTemplateName(
5603 nullptr, /*TemplateKeyword=*/false, TemplateName(TTP));
5604 if (TTP->isParameterPack())
5605 Arg = TemplateArgument(Name, std::optional<unsigned>());
5606 else
5607 Arg = TemplateArgument(Name);
5608 }
5609
5610 if (Param->isTemplateParameterPack())
5611 Arg = TemplateArgument::CreatePackCopy(*this, Arg);
5612
5613 return Arg;
5614 }
5615
5616 void
getInjectedTemplateArgs(const TemplateParameterList * Params,SmallVectorImpl<TemplateArgument> & Args)5617 ASTContext::getInjectedTemplateArgs(const TemplateParameterList *Params,
5618 SmallVectorImpl<TemplateArgument> &Args) {
5619 Args.reserve(Args.size() + Params->size());
5620
5621 for (NamedDecl *Param : *Params)
5622 Args.push_back(getInjectedTemplateArg(Param));
5623 }
5624
getPackExpansionType(QualType Pattern,std::optional<unsigned> NumExpansions,bool ExpectPackInType)5625 QualType ASTContext::getPackExpansionType(QualType Pattern,
5626 std::optional<unsigned> NumExpansions,
5627 bool ExpectPackInType) {
5628 assert((!ExpectPackInType || Pattern->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) &&
5629 "Pack expansions must expand one or more parameter packs");
5630
5631 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
5632 PackExpansionType::Profile(ID, Pattern, NumExpansions);
5633
5634 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
5635 PackExpansionType *T = PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
5636 if (T)
5637 return QualType(T, 0);
5638
5639 QualType Canon;
5640 if (!Pattern.isCanonical()) {
5641 Canon = getPackExpansionType(getCanonicalType(Pattern), NumExpansions,
5642 /*ExpectPackInType=*/false);
5643
5644 // Find the insert position again, in case we inserted an element into
5645 // PackExpansionTypes and invalidated our insert position.
5646 PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
5647 }
5648
5649 T = new (*this, alignof(PackExpansionType))
5650 PackExpansionType(Pattern, Canon, NumExpansions);
5651 Types.push_back(T);
5652 PackExpansionTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
5653 return QualType(T, 0);
5654 }
5655
5656 /// CmpProtocolNames - Comparison predicate for sorting protocols
5657 /// alphabetically.
CmpProtocolNames(ObjCProtocolDecl * const * LHS,ObjCProtocolDecl * const * RHS)5658 static int CmpProtocolNames(ObjCProtocolDecl *const *LHS,
5659 ObjCProtocolDecl *const *RHS) {
5660 return DeclarationName::compare((*LHS)->getDeclName(), (*RHS)->getDeclName());
5661 }
5662
areSortedAndUniqued(ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl * > Protocols)5663 static bool areSortedAndUniqued(ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> Protocols) {
5664 if (Protocols.empty()) return true;
5665
5666 if (Protocols[0]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[0])
5667 return false;
5668
5669 for (unsigned i = 1; i != Protocols.size(); ++i)
5670 if (CmpProtocolNames(&Protocols[i - 1], &Protocols[i]) >= 0 ||
5671 Protocols[i]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[i])
5672 return false;
5673 return true;
5674 }
5675
5676 static void
SortAndUniqueProtocols(SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl * > & Protocols)5677 SortAndUniqueProtocols(SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &Protocols) {
5678 // Sort protocols, keyed by name.
5679 llvm::array_pod_sort(Protocols.begin(), Protocols.end(), CmpProtocolNames);
5680
5681 // Canonicalize.
5682 for (ObjCProtocolDecl *&P : Protocols)
5683 P = P->getCanonicalDecl();
5684
5685 // Remove duplicates.
5686 auto ProtocolsEnd = std::unique(Protocols.begin(), Protocols.end());
5687 Protocols.erase(ProtocolsEnd, Protocols.end());
5688 }
5689
getObjCObjectType(QualType BaseType,ObjCProtocolDecl * const * Protocols,unsigned NumProtocols) const5690 QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(QualType BaseType,
5691 ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
5692 unsigned NumProtocols) const {
5693 return getObjCObjectType(BaseType, {},
5694 llvm::ArrayRef(Protocols, NumProtocols),
5695 /*isKindOf=*/false);
5696 }
5697
getObjCObjectType(QualType baseType,ArrayRef<QualType> typeArgs,ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl * > protocols,bool isKindOf) const5698 QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(
5699 QualType baseType,
5700 ArrayRef<QualType> typeArgs,
5701 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols,
5702 bool isKindOf) const {
5703 // If the base type is an interface and there aren't any protocols or
5704 // type arguments to add, then the interface type will do just fine.
5705 if (typeArgs.empty() && protocols.empty() && !isKindOf &&
5706 isa<ObjCInterfaceType>(baseType))
5707 return baseType;
5708
5709 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
5710 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
5711 ObjCObjectTypeImpl::Profile(ID, baseType, typeArgs, protocols, isKindOf);
5712 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
5713 if (ObjCObjectType *QT = ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
5714 return QualType(QT, 0);
5715
5716 // Determine the type arguments to be used for canonicalization,
5717 // which may be explicitly specified here or written on the base
5718 // type.
5719 ArrayRef<QualType> effectiveTypeArgs = typeArgs;
5720 if (effectiveTypeArgs.empty()) {
5721 if (const auto *baseObject = baseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>())
5722 effectiveTypeArgs = baseObject->getTypeArgs();
5723 }
5724
5725 // Build the canonical type, which has the canonical base type and a
5726 // sorted-and-uniqued list of protocols and the type arguments
5727 // canonicalized.
5728 QualType canonical;
5729 bool typeArgsAreCanonical = llvm::all_of(
5730 effectiveTypeArgs, [&](QualType type) { return type.isCanonical(); });
5731 bool protocolsSorted = areSortedAndUniqued(protocols);
5732 if (!typeArgsAreCanonical || !protocolsSorted || !baseType.isCanonical()) {
5733 // Determine the canonical type arguments.
5734 ArrayRef<QualType> canonTypeArgs;
5735 SmallVector<QualType, 4> canonTypeArgsVec;
5736 if (!typeArgsAreCanonical) {
5737 canonTypeArgsVec.reserve(effectiveTypeArgs.size());
5738 for (auto typeArg : effectiveTypeArgs)
5739 canonTypeArgsVec.push_back(getCanonicalType(typeArg));
5740 canonTypeArgs = canonTypeArgsVec;
5741 } else {
5742 canonTypeArgs = effectiveTypeArgs;
5743 }
5744
5745 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> canonProtocols;
5746 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> canonProtocolsVec;
5747 if (!protocolsSorted) {
5748 canonProtocolsVec.append(protocols.begin(), protocols.end());
5749 SortAndUniqueProtocols(canonProtocolsVec);
5750 canonProtocols = canonProtocolsVec;
5751 } else {
5752 canonProtocols = protocols;
5753 }
5754
5755 canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(baseType), canonTypeArgs,
5756 canonProtocols, isKindOf);
5757
5758 // Regenerate InsertPos.
5759 ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
5760 }
5761
5762 unsigned size = sizeof(ObjCObjectTypeImpl);
5763 size += typeArgs.size() * sizeof(QualType);
5764 size += protocols.size() * sizeof(ObjCProtocolDecl *);
5765 void *mem = Allocate(size, alignof(ObjCObjectTypeImpl));
5766 auto *T =
5767 new (mem) ObjCObjectTypeImpl(canonical, baseType, typeArgs, protocols,
5768 isKindOf);
5769
5770 Types.push_back(T);
5771 ObjCObjectTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
5772 return QualType(T, 0);
5773 }
5774
5775 /// Apply Objective-C protocol qualifiers to the given type.
5776 /// If this is for the canonical type of a type parameter, we can apply
5777 /// protocol qualifiers on the ObjCObjectPointerType.
5778 QualType
applyObjCProtocolQualifiers(QualType type,ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl * > protocols,bool & hasError,bool allowOnPointerType) const5779 ASTContext::applyObjCProtocolQualifiers(QualType type,
5780 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols, bool &hasError,
5781 bool allowOnPointerType) const {
5782 hasError = false;
5783
5784 if (const auto *objT = dyn_cast<ObjCTypeParamType>(type.getTypePtr())) {
5785 return getObjCTypeParamType(objT->getDecl(), protocols);
5786 }
5787
5788 // Apply protocol qualifiers to ObjCObjectPointerType.
5789 if (allowOnPointerType) {
5790 if (const auto *objPtr =
5791 dyn_cast<ObjCObjectPointerType>(type.getTypePtr())) {
5792 const ObjCObjectType *objT = objPtr->getObjectType();
5793 // Merge protocol lists and construct ObjCObjectType.
5794 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> protocolsVec;
5795 protocolsVec.append(objT->qual_begin(),
5796 objT->qual_end());
5797 protocolsVec.append(protocols.begin(), protocols.end());
5798 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols = protocolsVec;
5799 type = getObjCObjectType(
5800 objT->getBaseType(),
5801 objT->getTypeArgsAsWritten(),
5802 protocols,
5803 objT->isKindOfTypeAsWritten());
5804 return getObjCObjectPointerType(type);
5805 }
5806 }
5807
5808 // Apply protocol qualifiers to ObjCObjectType.
5809 if (const auto *objT = dyn_cast<ObjCObjectType>(type.getTypePtr())){
5810 // FIXME: Check for protocols to which the class type is already
5811 // known to conform.
5812
5813 return getObjCObjectType(objT->getBaseType(),
5814 objT->getTypeArgsAsWritten(),
5815 protocols,
5816 objT->isKindOfTypeAsWritten());
5817 }
5818
5819 // If the canonical type is ObjCObjectType, ...
5820 if (type->isObjCObjectType()) {
5821 // Silently overwrite any existing protocol qualifiers.
5822 // TODO: determine whether that's the right thing to do.
5823
5824 // FIXME: Check for protocols to which the class type is already
5825 // known to conform.
5826 return getObjCObjectType(type, {}, protocols, false);
5827 }
5828
5829 // id<protocol-list>
5830 if (type->isObjCIdType()) {
5831 const auto *objPtr = type->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
5832 type = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, {}, protocols,
5833 objPtr->isKindOfType());
5834 return getObjCObjectPointerType(type);
5835 }
5836
5837 // Class<protocol-list>
5838 if (type->isObjCClassType()) {
5839 const auto *objPtr = type->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
5840 type = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, {}, protocols,
5841 objPtr->isKindOfType());
5842 return getObjCObjectPointerType(type);
5843 }
5844
5845 hasError = true;
5846 return type;
5847 }
5848
5849 QualType
getObjCTypeParamType(const ObjCTypeParamDecl * Decl,ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl * > protocols) const5850 ASTContext::getObjCTypeParamType(const ObjCTypeParamDecl *Decl,
5851 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols) const {
5852 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
5853 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
5854 ObjCTypeParamType::Profile(ID, Decl, Decl->getUnderlyingType(), protocols);
5855 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
5856 if (ObjCTypeParamType *TypeParam =
5857 ObjCTypeParamTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
5858 return QualType(TypeParam, 0);
5859
5860 // We canonicalize to the underlying type.
5861 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decl->getUnderlyingType());
5862 if (!protocols.empty()) {
5863 // Apply the protocol qualifers.
5864 bool hasError;
5865 Canonical = getCanonicalType(applyObjCProtocolQualifiers(
5866 Canonical, protocols, hasError, true /*allowOnPointerType*/));
5867 assert(!hasError && "Error when apply protocol qualifier to bound type");
5868 }
5869
5870 unsigned size = sizeof(ObjCTypeParamType);
5871 size += protocols.size() * sizeof(ObjCProtocolDecl *);
5872 void *mem = Allocate(size, alignof(ObjCTypeParamType));
5873 auto *newType = new (mem) ObjCTypeParamType(Decl, Canonical, protocols);
5874
5875 Types.push_back(newType);
5876 ObjCTypeParamTypes.InsertNode(newType, InsertPos);
5877 return QualType(newType, 0);
5878 }
5879
adjustObjCTypeParamBoundType(const ObjCTypeParamDecl * Orig,ObjCTypeParamDecl * New) const5880 void ASTContext::adjustObjCTypeParamBoundType(const ObjCTypeParamDecl *Orig,
5881 ObjCTypeParamDecl *New) const {
5882 New->setTypeSourceInfo(getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(Orig->getUnderlyingType()));
5883 // Update TypeForDecl after updating TypeSourceInfo.
5884 auto NewTypeParamTy = cast<ObjCTypeParamType>(New->getTypeForDecl());
5885 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> protocols;
5886 protocols.append(NewTypeParamTy->qual_begin(), NewTypeParamTy->qual_end());
5887 QualType UpdatedTy = getObjCTypeParamType(New, protocols);
5888 New->setTypeForDecl(UpdatedTy.getTypePtr());
5889 }
5890
5891 /// ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols - Checks that protocols in IC's
5892 /// protocol list adopt all protocols in QT's qualified-id protocol
5893 /// list.
ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols(QualType QT,ObjCInterfaceDecl * IC)5894 bool ASTContext::ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols(QualType QT,
5895 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC) {
5896 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
5897 return false;
5898
5899 if (const auto *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
5900 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
5901 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
5902 if (!IC->ClassImplementsProtocol(Proto, false))
5903 return false;
5904 }
5905 return true;
5906 }
5907 return false;
5908 }
5909
5910 /// QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols - Checks that protocols in
5911 /// QT's qualified-id protocol list adopt all protocols in IDecl's list
5912 /// of protocols.
QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols(QualType QT,ObjCInterfaceDecl * IDecl)5913 bool ASTContext::QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols(QualType QT,
5914 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl) {
5915 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
5916 return false;
5917 const auto *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
5918 if (!OPT)
5919 return false;
5920 if (!IDecl->hasDefinition())
5921 return false;
5922 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> InheritedProtocols;
5923 CollectInheritedProtocols(IDecl, InheritedProtocols);
5924 if (InheritedProtocols.empty())
5925 return false;
5926 // Check that if every protocol in list of id<plist> conforms to a protocol
5927 // of IDecl's, then bridge casting is ok.
5928 bool Conforms = false;
5929 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
5930 Conforms = false;
5931 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
5932 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(Proto, PI)) {
5933 Conforms = true;
5934 break;
5935 }
5936 }
5937 if (!Conforms)
5938 break;
5939 }
5940 if (Conforms)
5941 return true;
5942
5943 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
5944 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
5945 bool Adopts = false;
5946 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
5947 // return 'true' if 'PI' is in the inheritance hierarchy of Proto
5948 if ((Adopts = ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(PI, Proto)))
5949 break;
5950 }
5951 if (!Adopts)
5952 return false;
5953 }
5954 return true;
5955 }
5956
5957 /// getObjCObjectPointerType - Return a ObjCObjectPointerType type for
5958 /// the given object type.
getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType ObjectT) const5959 QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType ObjectT) const {
5960 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
5961 ObjCObjectPointerType::Profile(ID, ObjectT);
5962
5963 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
5964 if (ObjCObjectPointerType *QT =
5965 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
5966 return QualType(QT, 0);
5967
5968 // Find the canonical object type.
5969 QualType Canonical;
5970 if (!ObjectT.isCanonical()) {
5971 Canonical = getObjCObjectPointerType(getCanonicalType(ObjectT));
5972
5973 // Regenerate InsertPos.
5974 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
5975 }
5976
5977 // No match.
5978 void *Mem =
5979 Allocate(sizeof(ObjCObjectPointerType), alignof(ObjCObjectPointerType));
5980 auto *QType =
5981 new (Mem) ObjCObjectPointerType(Canonical, ObjectT);
5982
5983 Types.push_back(QType);
5984 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.InsertNode(QType, InsertPos);
5985 return QualType(QType, 0);
5986 }
5987
5988 /// getObjCInterfaceType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
5989 /// specified ObjC interface decl. The list of protocols is optional.
getObjCInterfaceType(const ObjCInterfaceDecl * Decl,ObjCInterfaceDecl * PrevDecl) const5990 QualType ASTContext::getObjCInterfaceType(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl,
5991 ObjCInterfaceDecl *PrevDecl) const {
5992 if (Decl->TypeForDecl)
5993 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
5994
5995 if (PrevDecl) {
5996 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous decl has no TypeForDecl");
5997 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
5998 return QualType(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
5999 }
6000
6001 // Prefer the definition, if there is one.
6002 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = Decl->getDefinition())
6003 Decl = Def;
6004
6005 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCInterfaceType), alignof(ObjCInterfaceType));
6006 auto *T = new (Mem) ObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
6007 Decl->TypeForDecl = T;
6008 Types.push_back(T);
6009 return QualType(T, 0);
6010 }
6011
6012 /// getTypeOfExprType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we can't unique
6013 /// TypeOfExprType AST's (since expression's are never shared). For example,
6014 /// multiple declarations that refer to "typeof(x)" all contain different
6015 /// DeclRefExpr's. This doesn't effect the type checker, since it operates
6016 /// on canonical type's (which are always unique).
getTypeOfExprType(Expr * tofExpr,TypeOfKind Kind) const6017 QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfExprType(Expr *tofExpr, TypeOfKind Kind) const {
6018 TypeOfExprType *toe;
6019 if (tofExpr->isTypeDependent()) {
6020 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6021 DependentTypeOfExprType::Profile(ID, *this, tofExpr,
6022 Kind == TypeOfKind::Unqualified);
6023
6024 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
6025 DependentTypeOfExprType *Canon =
6026 DependentTypeOfExprTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6027 if (Canon) {
6028 // We already have a "canonical" version of an identical, dependent
6029 // typeof(expr) type. Use that as our canonical type.
6030 toe = new (*this, alignof(TypeOfExprType)) TypeOfExprType(
6031 *this, tofExpr, Kind, QualType((TypeOfExprType *)Canon, 0));
6032 } else {
6033 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
6034 Canon = new (*this, alignof(DependentTypeOfExprType))
6035 DependentTypeOfExprType(*this, tofExpr, Kind);
6036 DependentTypeOfExprTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
6037 toe = Canon;
6038 }
6039 } else {
6040 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofExpr->getType());
6041 toe = new (*this, alignof(TypeOfExprType))
6042 TypeOfExprType(*this, tofExpr, Kind, Canonical);
6043 }
6044 Types.push_back(toe);
6045 return QualType(toe, 0);
6046 }
6047
6048 /// getTypeOfType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique
6049 /// TypeOfType nodes. The only motivation to unique these nodes would be
6050 /// memory savings. Since typeof(t) is fairly uncommon, space shouldn't be
6051 /// an issue. This doesn't affect the type checker, since it operates
6052 /// on canonical types (which are always unique).
getTypeOfType(QualType tofType,TypeOfKind Kind) const6053 QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfType(QualType tofType, TypeOfKind Kind) const {
6054 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofType);
6055 auto *tot = new (*this, alignof(TypeOfType))
6056 TypeOfType(*this, tofType, Canonical, Kind);
6057 Types.push_back(tot);
6058 return QualType(tot, 0);
6059 }
6060
6061 /// getReferenceQualifiedType - Given an expr, will return the type for
6062 /// that expression, as in [dcl.type.simple]p4 but without taking id-expressions
6063 /// and class member access into account.
getReferenceQualifiedType(const Expr * E) const6064 QualType ASTContext::getReferenceQualifiedType(const Expr *E) const {
6065 // C++11 [dcl.type.simple]p4:
6066 // [...]
6067 QualType T = E->getType();
6068 switch (E->getValueKind()) {
6069 // - otherwise, if e is an xvalue, decltype(e) is T&&, where T is the
6070 // type of e;
6071 case VK_XValue:
6072 return getRValueReferenceType(T);
6073 // - otherwise, if e is an lvalue, decltype(e) is T&, where T is the
6074 // type of e;
6075 case VK_LValue:
6076 return getLValueReferenceType(T);
6077 // - otherwise, decltype(e) is the type of e.
6078 case VK_PRValue:
6079 return T;
6080 }
6081 llvm_unreachable("Unknown value kind");
6082 }
6083
6084 /// Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique DecltypeType
6085 /// nodes. This would never be helpful, since each such type has its own
6086 /// expression, and would not give a significant memory saving, since there
6087 /// is an Expr tree under each such type.
getDecltypeType(Expr * e,QualType UnderlyingType) const6088 QualType ASTContext::getDecltypeType(Expr *e, QualType UnderlyingType) const {
6089 DecltypeType *dt;
6090
6091 // C++11 [temp.type]p2:
6092 // If an expression e involves a template parameter, decltype(e) denotes a
6093 // unique dependent type. Two such decltype-specifiers refer to the same
6094 // type only if their expressions are equivalent (14.5.6.1).
6095 if (e->isInstantiationDependent()) {
6096 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6097 DependentDecltypeType::Profile(ID, *this, e);
6098
6099 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
6100 DependentDecltypeType *Canon
6101 = DependentDecltypeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6102 if (!Canon) {
6103 // Build a new, canonical decltype(expr) type.
6104 Canon = new (*this, alignof(DependentDecltypeType))
6105 DependentDecltypeType(e, DependentTy);
6106 DependentDecltypeTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
6107 }
6108 dt = new (*this, alignof(DecltypeType))
6109 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, QualType((DecltypeType *)Canon, 0));
6110 } else {
6111 dt = new (*this, alignof(DecltypeType))
6112 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
6113 }
6114 Types.push_back(dt);
6115 return QualType(dt, 0);
6116 }
6117
getPackIndexingType(QualType Pattern,Expr * IndexExpr,bool FullySubstituted,ArrayRef<QualType> Expansions,int Index) const6118 QualType ASTContext::getPackIndexingType(QualType Pattern, Expr *IndexExpr,
6119 bool FullySubstituted,
6120 ArrayRef<QualType> Expansions,
6121 int Index) const {
6122 QualType Canonical;
6123 if (FullySubstituted && Index != -1) {
6124 Canonical = getCanonicalType(Expansions[Index]);
6125 } else {
6126 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6127 PackIndexingType::Profile(ID, *this, Pattern, IndexExpr);
6128 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
6129 PackIndexingType *Canon =
6130 DependentPackIndexingTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6131 if (!Canon) {
6132 void *Mem = Allocate(
6133 PackIndexingType::totalSizeToAlloc<QualType>(Expansions.size()),
6134 TypeAlignment);
6135 Canon = new (Mem)
6136 PackIndexingType(*this, QualType(), Pattern, IndexExpr, Expansions);
6137 DependentPackIndexingTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
6138 }
6139 Canonical = QualType(Canon, 0);
6140 }
6141
6142 void *Mem =
6143 Allocate(PackIndexingType::totalSizeToAlloc<QualType>(Expansions.size()),
6144 TypeAlignment);
6145 auto *T = new (Mem)
6146 PackIndexingType(*this, Canonical, Pattern, IndexExpr, Expansions);
6147 Types.push_back(T);
6148 return QualType(T, 0);
6149 }
6150
6151 /// getUnaryTransformationType - We don't unique these, since the memory
6152 /// savings are minimal and these are rare.
getUnaryTransformType(QualType BaseType,QualType UnderlyingType,UnaryTransformType::UTTKind Kind) const6153 QualType ASTContext::getUnaryTransformType(QualType BaseType,
6154 QualType UnderlyingType,
6155 UnaryTransformType::UTTKind Kind)
6156 const {
6157 UnaryTransformType *ut = nullptr;
6158
6159 if (BaseType->isDependentType()) {
6160 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
6161 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6162 DependentUnaryTransformType::Profile(ID, getCanonicalType(BaseType), Kind);
6163
6164 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
6165 DependentUnaryTransformType *Canon
6166 = DependentUnaryTransformTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6167
6168 if (!Canon) {
6169 // Build a new, canonical __underlying_type(type) type.
6170 Canon = new (*this, alignof(DependentUnaryTransformType))
6171 DependentUnaryTransformType(*this, getCanonicalType(BaseType), Kind);
6172 DependentUnaryTransformTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
6173 }
6174 ut = new (*this, alignof(UnaryTransformType))
6175 UnaryTransformType(BaseType, QualType(), Kind, QualType(Canon, 0));
6176 } else {
6177 QualType CanonType = getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType);
6178 ut = new (*this, alignof(UnaryTransformType))
6179 UnaryTransformType(BaseType, UnderlyingType, Kind, CanonType);
6180 }
6181 Types.push_back(ut);
6182 return QualType(ut, 0);
6183 }
6184
getAutoTypeInternal(QualType DeducedType,AutoTypeKeyword Keyword,bool IsDependent,bool IsPack,ConceptDecl * TypeConstraintConcept,ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> TypeConstraintArgs,bool IsCanon) const6185 QualType ASTContext::getAutoTypeInternal(
6186 QualType DeducedType, AutoTypeKeyword Keyword, bool IsDependent,
6187 bool IsPack, ConceptDecl *TypeConstraintConcept,
6188 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> TypeConstraintArgs, bool IsCanon) const {
6189 if (DeducedType.isNull() && Keyword == AutoTypeKeyword::Auto &&
6190 !TypeConstraintConcept && !IsDependent)
6191 return getAutoDeductType();
6192
6193 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
6194 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
6195 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6196 AutoType::Profile(ID, *this, DeducedType, Keyword, IsDependent,
6197 TypeConstraintConcept, TypeConstraintArgs);
6198 if (AutoType *AT = AutoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
6199 return QualType(AT, 0);
6200
6201 QualType Canon;
6202 if (!IsCanon) {
6203 if (!DeducedType.isNull()) {
6204 Canon = DeducedType.getCanonicalType();
6205 } else if (TypeConstraintConcept) {
6206 bool AnyNonCanonArgs = false;
6207 ConceptDecl *CanonicalConcept = TypeConstraintConcept->getCanonicalDecl();
6208 auto CanonicalConceptArgs = ::getCanonicalTemplateArguments(
6209 *this, TypeConstraintArgs, AnyNonCanonArgs);
6210 if (CanonicalConcept != TypeConstraintConcept || AnyNonCanonArgs) {
6211 Canon =
6212 getAutoTypeInternal(QualType(), Keyword, IsDependent, IsPack,
6213 CanonicalConcept, CanonicalConceptArgs, true);
6214 // Find the insert position again.
6215 [[maybe_unused]] auto *Nothing =
6216 AutoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6217 assert(!Nothing && "canonical type broken");
6218 }
6219 }
6220 }
6221
6222 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(AutoType) +
6223 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * TypeConstraintArgs.size(),
6224 alignof(AutoType));
6225 auto *AT = new (Mem) AutoType(
6226 DeducedType, Keyword,
6227 (IsDependent ? TypeDependence::DependentInstantiation
6228 : TypeDependence::None) |
6229 (IsPack ? TypeDependence::UnexpandedPack : TypeDependence::None),
6230 Canon, TypeConstraintConcept, TypeConstraintArgs);
6231 Types.push_back(AT);
6232 AutoTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
6233 return QualType(AT, 0);
6234 }
6235
6236 /// getAutoType - Return the uniqued reference to the 'auto' type which has been
6237 /// deduced to the given type, or to the canonical undeduced 'auto' type, or the
6238 /// canonical deduced-but-dependent 'auto' type.
6239 QualType
getAutoType(QualType DeducedType,AutoTypeKeyword Keyword,bool IsDependent,bool IsPack,ConceptDecl * TypeConstraintConcept,ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> TypeConstraintArgs) const6240 ASTContext::getAutoType(QualType DeducedType, AutoTypeKeyword Keyword,
6241 bool IsDependent, bool IsPack,
6242 ConceptDecl *TypeConstraintConcept,
6243 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> TypeConstraintArgs) const {
6244 assert((!IsPack || IsDependent) && "only use IsPack for a dependent pack");
6245 assert((!IsDependent || DeducedType.isNull()) &&
6246 "A dependent auto should be undeduced");
6247 return getAutoTypeInternal(DeducedType, Keyword, IsDependent, IsPack,
6248 TypeConstraintConcept, TypeConstraintArgs);
6249 }
6250
getUnconstrainedType(QualType T) const6251 QualType ASTContext::getUnconstrainedType(QualType T) const {
6252 QualType CanonT = T.getCanonicalType();
6253
6254 // Remove a type-constraint from a top-level auto or decltype(auto).
6255 if (auto *AT = CanonT->getAs<AutoType>()) {
6256 if (!AT->isConstrained())
6257 return T;
6258 return getQualifiedType(getAutoType(QualType(), AT->getKeyword(),
6259 AT->isDependentType(),
6260 AT->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()),
6261 T.getQualifiers());
6262 }
6263
6264 // FIXME: We only support constrained auto at the top level in the type of a
6265 // non-type template parameter at the moment. Once we lift that restriction,
6266 // we'll need to recursively build types containing auto here.
6267 assert(!CanonT->getContainedAutoType() ||
6268 !CanonT->getContainedAutoType()->isConstrained());
6269 return T;
6270 }
6271
6272 /// Return the uniqued reference to the deduced template specialization type
6273 /// which has been deduced to the given type, or to the canonical undeduced
6274 /// such type, or the canonical deduced-but-dependent such type.
getDeducedTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,QualType DeducedType,bool IsDependent) const6275 QualType ASTContext::getDeducedTemplateSpecializationType(
6276 TemplateName Template, QualType DeducedType, bool IsDependent) const {
6277 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
6278 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
6279 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6280 DeducedTemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, Template, DeducedType,
6281 IsDependent);
6282 if (DeducedTemplateSpecializationType *DTST =
6283 DeducedTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
6284 return QualType(DTST, 0);
6285
6286 auto *DTST = new (*this, alignof(DeducedTemplateSpecializationType))
6287 DeducedTemplateSpecializationType(Template, DeducedType, IsDependent);
6288 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID TempID;
6289 DTST->Profile(TempID);
6290 assert(ID == TempID && "ID does not match");
6291 Types.push_back(DTST);
6292 DeducedTemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(DTST, InsertPos);
6293 return QualType(DTST, 0);
6294 }
6295
6296 /// getAtomicType - Return the uniqued reference to the atomic type for
6297 /// the given value type.
getAtomicType(QualType T) const6298 QualType ASTContext::getAtomicType(QualType T) const {
6299 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
6300 // structure.
6301 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6302 AtomicType::Profile(ID, T);
6303
6304 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
6305 if (AtomicType *AT = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
6306 return QualType(AT, 0);
6307
6308 // If the atomic value type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
6309 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
6310 QualType Canonical;
6311 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
6312 Canonical = getAtomicType(getCanonicalType(T));
6313
6314 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
6315 AtomicType *NewIP = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6316 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
6317 }
6318 auto *New = new (*this, alignof(AtomicType)) AtomicType(T, Canonical);
6319 Types.push_back(New);
6320 AtomicTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
6321 return QualType(New, 0);
6322 }
6323
6324 /// getAutoDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto'.
getAutoDeductType() const6325 QualType ASTContext::getAutoDeductType() const {
6326 if (AutoDeductTy.isNull())
6327 AutoDeductTy = QualType(new (*this, alignof(AutoType))
6328 AutoType(QualType(), AutoTypeKeyword::Auto,
6329 TypeDependence::None, QualType(),
6330 /*concept*/ nullptr, /*args*/ {}),
6331 0);
6332 return AutoDeductTy;
6333 }
6334
6335 /// getAutoRRefDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto &&'.
getAutoRRefDeductType() const6336 QualType ASTContext::getAutoRRefDeductType() const {
6337 if (AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull())
6338 AutoRRefDeductTy = getRValueReferenceType(getAutoDeductType());
6339 assert(!AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull() && "can't build 'auto &&' pattern");
6340 return AutoRRefDeductTy;
6341 }
6342
6343 /// getTagDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
6344 /// specified TagDecl (struct/union/class/enum) decl.
getTagDeclType(const TagDecl * Decl) const6345 QualType ASTContext::getTagDeclType(const TagDecl *Decl) const {
6346 assert(Decl);
6347 // FIXME: What is the design on getTagDeclType when it requires casting
6348 // away const? mutable?
6349 return getTypeDeclType(const_cast<TagDecl*>(Decl));
6350 }
6351
6352 /// getSizeType - Return the unique type for "size_t" (C99 7.17), the result
6353 /// of the sizeof operator (C99 6.5.3.4p4). The value is target dependent and
6354 /// needs to agree with the definition in <stddef.h>.
getSizeType() const6355 CanQualType ASTContext::getSizeType() const {
6356 return getFromTargetType(Target->getSizeType());
6357 }
6358
6359 /// Return the unique signed counterpart of the integer type
6360 /// corresponding to size_t.
getSignedSizeType() const6361 CanQualType ASTContext::getSignedSizeType() const {
6362 return getFromTargetType(Target->getSignedSizeType());
6363 }
6364
6365 /// getIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "intmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
getIntMaxType() const6366 CanQualType ASTContext::getIntMaxType() const {
6367 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntMaxType());
6368 }
6369
6370 /// getUIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "uintmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
getUIntMaxType() const6371 CanQualType ASTContext::getUIntMaxType() const {
6372 return getFromTargetType(Target->getUIntMaxType());
6373 }
6374
6375 /// getSignedWCharType - Return the type of "signed wchar_t".
6376 /// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
getSignedWCharType() const6377 QualType ASTContext::getSignedWCharType() const {
6378 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
6379 return WCharTy;
6380 }
6381
6382 /// getUnsignedWCharType - Return the type of "unsigned wchar_t".
6383 /// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
getUnsignedWCharType() const6384 QualType ASTContext::getUnsignedWCharType() const {
6385 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
6386 return UnsignedIntTy;
6387 }
6388
getIntPtrType() const6389 QualType ASTContext::getIntPtrType() const {
6390 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntPtrType());
6391 }
6392
getUIntPtrType() const6393 QualType ASTContext::getUIntPtrType() const {
6394 return getCorrespondingUnsignedType(getIntPtrType());
6395 }
6396
6397 /// getPointerDiffType - Return the unique type for "ptrdiff_t" (C99 7.17)
6398 /// defined in <stddef.h>. Pointer - pointer requires this (C99 6.5.6p9).
getPointerDiffType() const6399 QualType ASTContext::getPointerDiffType() const {
6400 return getFromTargetType(Target->getPtrDiffType(LangAS::Default));
6401 }
6402
6403 /// Return the unique unsigned counterpart of "ptrdiff_t"
6404 /// integer type. The standard (C11 7.21.6.1p7) refers to this type
6405 /// in the definition of %tu format specifier.
getUnsignedPointerDiffType() const6406 QualType ASTContext::getUnsignedPointerDiffType() const {
6407 return getFromTargetType(Target->getUnsignedPtrDiffType(LangAS::Default));
6408 }
6409
6410 /// Return the unique type for "pid_t" defined in
6411 /// <sys/types.h>. We need this to compute the correct type for vfork().
getProcessIDType() const6412 QualType ASTContext::getProcessIDType() const {
6413 return getFromTargetType(Target->getProcessIDType());
6414 }
6415
6416 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6417 // Type Operators
6418 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6419
getCanonicalParamType(QualType T) const6420 CanQualType ASTContext::getCanonicalParamType(QualType T) const {
6421 // Push qualifiers into arrays, and then discard any remaining
6422 // qualifiers.
6423 T = getCanonicalType(T);
6424 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
6425 const Type *Ty = T.getTypePtr();
6426 QualType Result;
6427 if (getLangOpts().HLSL && isa<ConstantArrayType>(Ty)) {
6428 Result = getArrayParameterType(QualType(Ty, 0));
6429 } else if (isa<ArrayType>(Ty)) {
6430 Result = getArrayDecayedType(QualType(Ty,0));
6431 } else if (isa<FunctionType>(Ty)) {
6432 Result = getPointerType(QualType(Ty, 0));
6433 } else {
6434 Result = QualType(Ty, 0);
6435 }
6436
6437 return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(Result);
6438 }
6439
getUnqualifiedArrayType(QualType type,Qualifiers & quals) const6440 QualType ASTContext::getUnqualifiedArrayType(QualType type,
6441 Qualifiers &quals) const {
6442 SplitQualType splitType = type.getSplitUnqualifiedType();
6443
6444 // FIXME: getSplitUnqualifiedType() actually walks all the way to
6445 // the unqualified desugared type and then drops it on the floor.
6446 // We then have to strip that sugar back off with
6447 // getUnqualifiedDesugaredType(), which is silly.
6448 const auto *AT =
6449 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(splitType.Ty->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
6450
6451 // If we don't have an array, just use the results in splitType.
6452 if (!AT) {
6453 quals = splitType.Quals;
6454 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
6455 }
6456
6457 // Otherwise, recurse on the array's element type.
6458 QualType elementType = AT->getElementType();
6459 QualType unqualElementType = getUnqualifiedArrayType(elementType, quals);
6460
6461 // If that didn't change the element type, AT has no qualifiers, so we
6462 // can just use the results in splitType.
6463 if (elementType == unqualElementType) {
6464 assert(quals.empty()); // from the recursive call
6465 quals = splitType.Quals;
6466 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
6467 }
6468
6469 // Otherwise, add in the qualifiers from the outermost type, then
6470 // build the type back up.
6471 quals.addConsistentQualifiers(splitType.Quals);
6472
6473 if (const auto *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) {
6474 return getConstantArrayType(unqualElementType, CAT->getSize(),
6475 CAT->getSizeExpr(), CAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
6476 }
6477
6478 if (const auto *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) {
6479 return getIncompleteArrayType(unqualElementType, IAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
6480 }
6481
6482 if (const auto *VAT = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(AT)) {
6483 return getVariableArrayType(unqualElementType,
6484 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
6485 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
6486 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
6487 VAT->getBracketsRange());
6488 }
6489
6490 const auto *DSAT = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(AT);
6491 return getDependentSizedArrayType(unqualElementType, DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
6492 DSAT->getSizeModifier(), 0,
6493 SourceRange());
6494 }
6495
6496 /// Attempt to unwrap two types that may both be array types with the same bound
6497 /// (or both be array types of unknown bound) for the purpose of comparing the
6498 /// cv-decomposition of two types per C++ [conv.qual].
6499 ///
6500 /// \param AllowPiMismatch Allow the Pi1 and Pi2 to differ as described in
6501 /// C++20 [conv.qual], if permitted by the current language mode.
UnwrapSimilarArrayTypes(QualType & T1,QualType & T2,bool AllowPiMismatch)6502 void ASTContext::UnwrapSimilarArrayTypes(QualType &T1, QualType &T2,
6503 bool AllowPiMismatch) {
6504 while (true) {
6505 auto *AT1 = getAsArrayType(T1);
6506 if (!AT1)
6507 return;
6508
6509 auto *AT2 = getAsArrayType(T2);
6510 if (!AT2)
6511 return;
6512
6513 // If we don't have two array types with the same constant bound nor two
6514 // incomplete array types, we've unwrapped everything we can.
6515 // C++20 also permits one type to be a constant array type and the other
6516 // to be an incomplete array type.
6517 // FIXME: Consider also unwrapping array of unknown bound and VLA.
6518 if (auto *CAT1 = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT1)) {
6519 auto *CAT2 = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT2);
6520 if (!((CAT2 && CAT1->getSize() == CAT2->getSize()) ||
6521 (AllowPiMismatch && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 &&
6522 isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT2))))
6523 return;
6524 } else if (isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT1)) {
6525 if (!(isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT2) ||
6526 (AllowPiMismatch && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 &&
6527 isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT2))))
6528 return;
6529 } else {
6530 return;
6531 }
6532
6533 T1 = AT1->getElementType();
6534 T2 = AT2->getElementType();
6535 }
6536 }
6537
6538 /// Attempt to unwrap two types that may be similar (C++ [conv.qual]).
6539 ///
6540 /// If T1 and T2 are both pointer types of the same kind, or both array types
6541 /// with the same bound, unwraps layers from T1 and T2 until a pointer type is
6542 /// unwrapped. Top-level qualifiers on T1 and T2 are ignored.
6543 ///
6544 /// This function will typically be called in a loop that successively
6545 /// "unwraps" pointer and pointer-to-member types to compare them at each
6546 /// level.
6547 ///
6548 /// \param AllowPiMismatch Allow the Pi1 and Pi2 to differ as described in
6549 /// C++20 [conv.qual], if permitted by the current language mode.
6550 ///
6551 /// \return \c true if a pointer type was unwrapped, \c false if we reached a
6552 /// pair of types that can't be unwrapped further.
UnwrapSimilarTypes(QualType & T1,QualType & T2,bool AllowPiMismatch)6553 bool ASTContext::UnwrapSimilarTypes(QualType &T1, QualType &T2,
6554 bool AllowPiMismatch) {
6555 UnwrapSimilarArrayTypes(T1, T2, AllowPiMismatch);
6556
6557 const auto *T1PtrType = T1->getAs<PointerType>();
6558 const auto *T2PtrType = T2->getAs<PointerType>();
6559 if (T1PtrType && T2PtrType) {
6560 T1 = T1PtrType->getPointeeType();
6561 T2 = T2PtrType->getPointeeType();
6562 return true;
6563 }
6564
6565 const auto *T1MPType = T1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
6566 const auto *T2MPType = T2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
6567 if (T1MPType && T2MPType &&
6568 hasSameUnqualifiedType(QualType(T1MPType->getClass(), 0),
6569 QualType(T2MPType->getClass(), 0))) {
6570 T1 = T1MPType->getPointeeType();
6571 T2 = T2MPType->getPointeeType();
6572 return true;
6573 }
6574
6575 if (getLangOpts().ObjC) {
6576 const auto *T1OPType = T1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6577 const auto *T2OPType = T2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6578 if (T1OPType && T2OPType) {
6579 T1 = T1OPType->getPointeeType();
6580 T2 = T2OPType->getPointeeType();
6581 return true;
6582 }
6583 }
6584
6585 // FIXME: Block pointers, too?
6586
6587 return false;
6588 }
6589
hasSimilarType(QualType T1,QualType T2)6590 bool ASTContext::hasSimilarType(QualType T1, QualType T2) {
6591 while (true) {
6592 Qualifiers Quals;
6593 T1 = getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals);
6594 T2 = getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals);
6595 if (hasSameType(T1, T2))
6596 return true;
6597 if (!UnwrapSimilarTypes(T1, T2))
6598 return false;
6599 }
6600 }
6601
hasCvrSimilarType(QualType T1,QualType T2)6602 bool ASTContext::hasCvrSimilarType(QualType T1, QualType T2) {
6603 while (true) {
6604 Qualifiers Quals1, Quals2;
6605 T1 = getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals1);
6606 T2 = getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals2);
6607
6608 Quals1.removeCVRQualifiers();
6609 Quals2.removeCVRQualifiers();
6610 if (Quals1 != Quals2)
6611 return false;
6612
6613 if (hasSameType(T1, T2))
6614 return true;
6615
6616 if (!UnwrapSimilarTypes(T1, T2, /*AllowPiMismatch*/ false))
6617 return false;
6618 }
6619 }
6620
6621 DeclarationNameInfo
getNameForTemplate(TemplateName Name,SourceLocation NameLoc) const6622 ASTContext::getNameForTemplate(TemplateName Name,
6623 SourceLocation NameLoc) const {
6624 switch (Name.getKind()) {
6625 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
6626 case TemplateName::Template:
6627 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
6628 return DeclarationNameInfo(Name.getAsTemplateDecl()->getDeclName(),
6629 NameLoc);
6630
6631 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate: {
6632 OverloadedTemplateStorage *Storage = Name.getAsOverloadedTemplate();
6633 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
6634 return DeclarationNameInfo((*Storage->begin())->getDeclName(), NameLoc);
6635 }
6636
6637 case TemplateName::AssumedTemplate: {
6638 AssumedTemplateStorage *Storage = Name.getAsAssumedTemplateName();
6639 return DeclarationNameInfo(Storage->getDeclName(), NameLoc);
6640 }
6641
6642 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
6643 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
6644 DeclarationName DName;
6645 if (DTN->isIdentifier()) {
6646 DName = DeclarationNames.getIdentifier(DTN->getIdentifier());
6647 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc);
6648 } else {
6649 DName = DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(DTN->getOperator());
6650 // DNInfo work in progress: FIXME: source locations?
6651 DeclarationNameLoc DNLoc =
6652 DeclarationNameLoc::makeCXXOperatorNameLoc(SourceRange());
6653 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc, DNLoc);
6654 }
6655 }
6656
6657 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
6658 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
6659 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
6660 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameter()->getDeclName(),
6661 NameLoc);
6662 }
6663
6664 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
6665 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
6666 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
6667 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameterPack()->getDeclName(),
6668 NameLoc);
6669 }
6670 case TemplateName::UsingTemplate:
6671 return DeclarationNameInfo(Name.getAsUsingShadowDecl()->getDeclName(),
6672 NameLoc);
6673 }
6674
6675 llvm_unreachable("bad template name kind!");
6676 }
6677
6678 TemplateName
getCanonicalTemplateName(const TemplateName & Name) const6679 ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateName(const TemplateName &Name) const {
6680 switch (Name.getKind()) {
6681 case TemplateName::UsingTemplate:
6682 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
6683 case TemplateName::Template: {
6684 TemplateDecl *Template = Name.getAsTemplateDecl();
6685 if (auto *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Template))
6686 Template = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(TTP);
6687
6688 // The canonical template name is the canonical template declaration.
6689 return TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(Template->getCanonicalDecl()));
6690 }
6691
6692 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate:
6693 case TemplateName::AssumedTemplate:
6694 llvm_unreachable("cannot canonicalize unresolved template");
6695
6696 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
6697 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
6698 assert(DTN && "Non-dependent template names must refer to template decls.");
6699 return DTN->CanonicalTemplateName;
6700 }
6701
6702 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
6703 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
6704 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
6705 return getCanonicalTemplateName(subst->getReplacement());
6706 }
6707
6708 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
6709 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst =
6710 Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
6711 TemplateArgument canonArgPack =
6712 getCanonicalTemplateArgument(subst->getArgumentPack());
6713 return getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(
6714 canonArgPack, subst->getAssociatedDecl()->getCanonicalDecl(),
6715 subst->getFinal(), subst->getIndex());
6716 }
6717 }
6718
6719 llvm_unreachable("bad template name!");
6720 }
6721
hasSameTemplateName(const TemplateName & X,const TemplateName & Y) const6722 bool ASTContext::hasSameTemplateName(const TemplateName &X,
6723 const TemplateName &Y) const {
6724 return getCanonicalTemplateName(X).getAsVoidPointer() ==
6725 getCanonicalTemplateName(Y).getAsVoidPointer();
6726 }
6727
isSameConstraintExpr(const Expr * XCE,const Expr * YCE) const6728 bool ASTContext::isSameConstraintExpr(const Expr *XCE, const Expr *YCE) const {
6729 if (!XCE != !YCE)
6730 return false;
6731
6732 if (!XCE)
6733 return true;
6734
6735 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID XCEID, YCEID;
6736 XCE->Profile(XCEID, *this, /*Canonical=*/true, /*ProfileLambdaExpr=*/true);
6737 YCE->Profile(YCEID, *this, /*Canonical=*/true, /*ProfileLambdaExpr=*/true);
6738 return XCEID == YCEID;
6739 }
6740
isSameTypeConstraint(const TypeConstraint * XTC,const TypeConstraint * YTC) const6741 bool ASTContext::isSameTypeConstraint(const TypeConstraint *XTC,
6742 const TypeConstraint *YTC) const {
6743 if (!XTC != !YTC)
6744 return false;
6745
6746 if (!XTC)
6747 return true;
6748
6749 auto *NCX = XTC->getNamedConcept();
6750 auto *NCY = YTC->getNamedConcept();
6751 if (!NCX || !NCY || !isSameEntity(NCX, NCY))
6752 return false;
6753 if (XTC->getConceptReference()->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() !=
6754 YTC->getConceptReference()->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
6755 return false;
6756 if (XTC->getConceptReference()->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
6757 if (XTC->getConceptReference()
6758 ->getTemplateArgsAsWritten()
6759 ->NumTemplateArgs !=
6760 YTC->getConceptReference()->getTemplateArgsAsWritten()->NumTemplateArgs)
6761 return false;
6762
6763 // Compare slowly by profiling.
6764 //
6765 // We couldn't compare the profiling result for the template
6766 // args here. Consider the following example in different modules:
6767 //
6768 // template <__integer_like _Tp, C<_Tp> Sentinel>
6769 // constexpr _Tp operator()(_Tp &&__t, Sentinel &&last) const {
6770 // return __t;
6771 // }
6772 //
6773 // When we compare the profiling result for `C<_Tp>` in different
6774 // modules, it will compare the type of `_Tp` in different modules.
6775 // However, the type of `_Tp` in different modules refer to different
6776 // types here naturally. So we couldn't compare the profiling result
6777 // for the template args directly.
6778 return isSameConstraintExpr(XTC->getImmediatelyDeclaredConstraint(),
6779 YTC->getImmediatelyDeclaredConstraint());
6780 }
6781
isSameTemplateParameter(const NamedDecl * X,const NamedDecl * Y) const6782 bool ASTContext::isSameTemplateParameter(const NamedDecl *X,
6783 const NamedDecl *Y) const {
6784 if (X->getKind() != Y->getKind())
6785 return false;
6786
6787 if (auto *TX = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(X)) {
6788 auto *TY = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Y);
6789 if (TX->isParameterPack() != TY->isParameterPack())
6790 return false;
6791 if (TX->hasTypeConstraint() != TY->hasTypeConstraint())
6792 return false;
6793 return isSameTypeConstraint(TX->getTypeConstraint(),
6794 TY->getTypeConstraint());
6795 }
6796
6797 if (auto *TX = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(X)) {
6798 auto *TY = cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(Y);
6799 return TX->isParameterPack() == TY->isParameterPack() &&
6800 TX->getASTContext().hasSameType(TX->getType(), TY->getType()) &&
6801 isSameConstraintExpr(TX->getPlaceholderTypeConstraint(),
6802 TY->getPlaceholderTypeConstraint());
6803 }
6804
6805 auto *TX = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(X);
6806 auto *TY = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Y);
6807 return TX->isParameterPack() == TY->isParameterPack() &&
6808 isSameTemplateParameterList(TX->getTemplateParameters(),
6809 TY->getTemplateParameters());
6810 }
6811
isSameTemplateParameterList(const TemplateParameterList * X,const TemplateParameterList * Y) const6812 bool ASTContext::isSameTemplateParameterList(
6813 const TemplateParameterList *X, const TemplateParameterList *Y) const {
6814 if (X->size() != Y->size())
6815 return false;
6816
6817 for (unsigned I = 0, N = X->size(); I != N; ++I)
6818 if (!isSameTemplateParameter(X->getParam(I), Y->getParam(I)))
6819 return false;
6820
6821 return isSameConstraintExpr(X->getRequiresClause(), Y->getRequiresClause());
6822 }
6823
isSameDefaultTemplateArgument(const NamedDecl * X,const NamedDecl * Y) const6824 bool ASTContext::isSameDefaultTemplateArgument(const NamedDecl *X,
6825 const NamedDecl *Y) const {
6826 // If the type parameter isn't the same already, we don't need to check the
6827 // default argument further.
6828 if (!isSameTemplateParameter(X, Y))
6829 return false;
6830
6831 if (auto *TTPX = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(X)) {
6832 auto *TTPY = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Y);
6833 if (!TTPX->hasDefaultArgument() || !TTPY->hasDefaultArgument())
6834 return false;
6835
6836 return hasSameType(TTPX->getDefaultArgument().getArgument().getAsType(),
6837 TTPY->getDefaultArgument().getArgument().getAsType());
6838 }
6839
6840 if (auto *NTTPX = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(X)) {
6841 auto *NTTPY = cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(Y);
6842 if (!NTTPX->hasDefaultArgument() || !NTTPY->hasDefaultArgument())
6843 return false;
6844
6845 Expr *DefaultArgumentX =
6846 NTTPX->getDefaultArgument().getArgument().getAsExpr()->IgnoreImpCasts();
6847 Expr *DefaultArgumentY =
6848 NTTPY->getDefaultArgument().getArgument().getAsExpr()->IgnoreImpCasts();
6849 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID XID, YID;
6850 DefaultArgumentX->Profile(XID, *this, /*Canonical=*/true);
6851 DefaultArgumentY->Profile(YID, *this, /*Canonical=*/true);
6852 return XID == YID;
6853 }
6854
6855 auto *TTPX = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(X);
6856 auto *TTPY = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Y);
6857
6858 if (!TTPX->hasDefaultArgument() || !TTPY->hasDefaultArgument())
6859 return false;
6860
6861 const TemplateArgument &TAX = TTPX->getDefaultArgument().getArgument();
6862 const TemplateArgument &TAY = TTPY->getDefaultArgument().getArgument();
6863 return hasSameTemplateName(TAX.getAsTemplate(), TAY.getAsTemplate());
6864 }
6865
getNamespace(const NestedNameSpecifier * X)6866 static NamespaceDecl *getNamespace(const NestedNameSpecifier *X) {
6867 if (auto *NS = X->getAsNamespace())
6868 return NS;
6869 if (auto *NAS = X->getAsNamespaceAlias())
6870 return NAS->getNamespace();
6871 return nullptr;
6872 }
6873
isSameQualifier(const NestedNameSpecifier * X,const NestedNameSpecifier * Y)6874 static bool isSameQualifier(const NestedNameSpecifier *X,
6875 const NestedNameSpecifier *Y) {
6876 if (auto *NSX = getNamespace(X)) {
6877 auto *NSY = getNamespace(Y);
6878 if (!NSY || NSX->getCanonicalDecl() != NSY->getCanonicalDecl())
6879 return false;
6880 } else if (X->getKind() != Y->getKind())
6881 return false;
6882
6883 // FIXME: For namespaces and types, we're permitted to check that the entity
6884 // is named via the same tokens. We should probably do so.
6885 switch (X->getKind()) {
6886 case NestedNameSpecifier::Identifier:
6887 if (X->getAsIdentifier() != Y->getAsIdentifier())
6888 return false;
6889 break;
6890 case NestedNameSpecifier::Namespace:
6891 case NestedNameSpecifier::NamespaceAlias:
6892 // We've already checked that we named the same namespace.
6893 break;
6894 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpec:
6895 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpecWithTemplate:
6896 if (X->getAsType()->getCanonicalTypeInternal() !=
6897 Y->getAsType()->getCanonicalTypeInternal())
6898 return false;
6899 break;
6900 case NestedNameSpecifier::Global:
6901 case NestedNameSpecifier::Super:
6902 return true;
6903 }
6904
6905 // Recurse into earlier portion of NNS, if any.
6906 auto *PX = X->getPrefix();
6907 auto *PY = Y->getPrefix();
6908 if (PX && PY)
6909 return isSameQualifier(PX, PY);
6910 return !PX && !PY;
6911 }
6912
6913 /// Determine whether the attributes we can overload on are identical for A and
6914 /// B. Will ignore any overloadable attrs represented in the type of A and B.
hasSameOverloadableAttrs(const FunctionDecl * A,const FunctionDecl * B)6915 static bool hasSameOverloadableAttrs(const FunctionDecl *A,
6916 const FunctionDecl *B) {
6917 // Note that pass_object_size attributes are represented in the function's
6918 // ExtParameterInfo, so we don't need to check them here.
6919
6920 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID Cand1ID, Cand2ID;
6921 auto AEnableIfAttrs = A->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>();
6922 auto BEnableIfAttrs = B->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>();
6923
6924 for (auto Pair : zip_longest(AEnableIfAttrs, BEnableIfAttrs)) {
6925 std::optional<EnableIfAttr *> Cand1A = std::get<0>(Pair);
6926 std::optional<EnableIfAttr *> Cand2A = std::get<1>(Pair);
6927
6928 // Return false if the number of enable_if attributes is different.
6929 if (!Cand1A || !Cand2A)
6930 return false;
6931
6932 Cand1ID.clear();
6933 Cand2ID.clear();
6934
6935 (*Cand1A)->getCond()->Profile(Cand1ID, A->getASTContext(), true);
6936 (*Cand2A)->getCond()->Profile(Cand2ID, B->getASTContext(), true);
6937
6938 // Return false if any of the enable_if expressions of A and B are
6939 // different.
6940 if (Cand1ID != Cand2ID)
6941 return false;
6942 }
6943 return true;
6944 }
6945
isSameEntity(const NamedDecl * X,const NamedDecl * Y) const6946 bool ASTContext::isSameEntity(const NamedDecl *X, const NamedDecl *Y) const {
6947 // Caution: this function is called by the AST reader during deserialization,
6948 // so it cannot rely on AST invariants being met. Non-trivial accessors
6949 // should be avoided, along with any traversal of redeclaration chains.
6950
6951 if (X == Y)
6952 return true;
6953
6954 if (X->getDeclName() != Y->getDeclName())
6955 return false;
6956
6957 // Must be in the same context.
6958 //
6959 // Note that we can't use DeclContext::Equals here, because the DeclContexts
6960 // could be two different declarations of the same function. (We will fix the
6961 // semantic DC to refer to the primary definition after merging.)
6962 if (!declaresSameEntity(cast<Decl>(X->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()),
6963 cast<Decl>(Y->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext())))
6964 return false;
6965
6966 // Two typedefs refer to the same entity if they have the same underlying
6967 // type.
6968 if (const auto *TypedefX = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(X))
6969 if (const auto *TypedefY = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Y))
6970 return hasSameType(TypedefX->getUnderlyingType(),
6971 TypedefY->getUnderlyingType());
6972
6973 // Must have the same kind.
6974 if (X->getKind() != Y->getKind())
6975 return false;
6976
6977 // Objective-C classes and protocols with the same name always match.
6978 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(X) || isa<ObjCProtocolDecl>(X))
6979 return true;
6980
6981 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(X)) {
6982 // No need to handle these here: we merge them when adding them to the
6983 // template.
6984 return false;
6985 }
6986
6987 // Compatible tags match.
6988 if (const auto *TagX = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(X)) {
6989 const auto *TagY = cast<TagDecl>(Y);
6990 return (TagX->getTagKind() == TagY->getTagKind()) ||
6991 ((TagX->getTagKind() == TagTypeKind::Struct ||
6992 TagX->getTagKind() == TagTypeKind::Class ||
6993 TagX->getTagKind() == TagTypeKind::Interface) &&
6994 (TagY->getTagKind() == TagTypeKind::Struct ||
6995 TagY->getTagKind() == TagTypeKind::Class ||
6996 TagY->getTagKind() == TagTypeKind::Interface));
6997 }
6998
6999 // Functions with the same type and linkage match.
7000 // FIXME: This needs to cope with merging of prototyped/non-prototyped
7001 // functions, etc.
7002 if (const auto *FuncX = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(X)) {
7003 const auto *FuncY = cast<FunctionDecl>(Y);
7004 if (const auto *CtorX = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(X)) {
7005 const auto *CtorY = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Y);
7006 if (CtorX->getInheritedConstructor() &&
7007 !isSameEntity(CtorX->getInheritedConstructor().getConstructor(),
7008 CtorY->getInheritedConstructor().getConstructor()))
7009 return false;
7010 }
7011
7012 if (FuncX->isMultiVersion() != FuncY->isMultiVersion())
7013 return false;
7014
7015 // Multiversioned functions with different feature strings are represented
7016 // as separate declarations.
7017 if (FuncX->isMultiVersion()) {
7018 const auto *TAX = FuncX->getAttr<TargetAttr>();
7019 const auto *TAY = FuncY->getAttr<TargetAttr>();
7020 assert(TAX && TAY && "Multiversion Function without target attribute");
7021
7022 if (TAX->getFeaturesStr() != TAY->getFeaturesStr())
7023 return false;
7024 }
7025
7026 // Per C++20 [temp.over.link]/4, friends in different classes are sometimes
7027 // not the same entity if they are constrained.
7028 if ((FuncX->isMemberLikeConstrainedFriend() ||
7029 FuncY->isMemberLikeConstrainedFriend()) &&
7030 !FuncX->getLexicalDeclContext()->Equals(
7031 FuncY->getLexicalDeclContext())) {
7032 return false;
7033 }
7034
7035 if (!isSameConstraintExpr(FuncX->getTrailingRequiresClause(),
7036 FuncY->getTrailingRequiresClause()))
7037 return false;
7038
7039 auto GetTypeAsWritten = [](const FunctionDecl *FD) {
7040 // Map to the first declaration that we've already merged into this one.
7041 // The TSI of redeclarations might not match (due to calling conventions
7042 // being inherited onto the type but not the TSI), but the TSI type of
7043 // the first declaration of the function should match across modules.
7044 FD = FD->getCanonicalDecl();
7045 return FD->getTypeSourceInfo() ? FD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getType()
7046 : FD->getType();
7047 };
7048 QualType XT = GetTypeAsWritten(FuncX), YT = GetTypeAsWritten(FuncY);
7049 if (!hasSameType(XT, YT)) {
7050 // We can get functions with different types on the redecl chain in C++17
7051 // if they have differing exception specifications and at least one of
7052 // the excpetion specs is unresolved.
7053 auto *XFPT = XT->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
7054 auto *YFPT = YT->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
7055 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 && XFPT && YFPT &&
7056 (isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(XFPT->getExceptionSpecType()) ||
7057 isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(YFPT->getExceptionSpecType())) &&
7058 hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringExceptionSpec(XT, YT))
7059 return true;
7060 return false;
7061 }
7062
7063 return FuncX->getLinkageInternal() == FuncY->getLinkageInternal() &&
7064 hasSameOverloadableAttrs(FuncX, FuncY);
7065 }
7066
7067 // Variables with the same type and linkage match.
7068 if (const auto *VarX = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(X)) {
7069 const auto *VarY = cast<VarDecl>(Y);
7070 if (VarX->getLinkageInternal() == VarY->getLinkageInternal()) {
7071 // During deserialization, we might compare variables before we load
7072 // their types. Assume the types will end up being the same.
7073 if (VarX->getType().isNull() || VarY->getType().isNull())
7074 return true;
7075
7076 if (hasSameType(VarX->getType(), VarY->getType()))
7077 return true;
7078
7079 // We can get decls with different types on the redecl chain. Eg.
7080 // template <typename T> struct S { static T Var[]; }; // #1
7081 // template <typename T> T S<T>::Var[sizeof(T)]; // #2
7082 // Only? happens when completing an incomplete array type. In this case
7083 // when comparing #1 and #2 we should go through their element type.
7084 const ArrayType *VarXTy = getAsArrayType(VarX->getType());
7085 const ArrayType *VarYTy = getAsArrayType(VarY->getType());
7086 if (!VarXTy || !VarYTy)
7087 return false;
7088 if (VarXTy->isIncompleteArrayType() || VarYTy->isIncompleteArrayType())
7089 return hasSameType(VarXTy->getElementType(), VarYTy->getElementType());
7090 }
7091 return false;
7092 }
7093
7094 // Namespaces with the same name and inlinedness match.
7095 if (const auto *NamespaceX = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(X)) {
7096 const auto *NamespaceY = cast<NamespaceDecl>(Y);
7097 return NamespaceX->isInline() == NamespaceY->isInline();
7098 }
7099
7100 // Identical template names and kinds match if their template parameter lists
7101 // and patterns match.
7102 if (const auto *TemplateX = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(X)) {
7103 const auto *TemplateY = cast<TemplateDecl>(Y);
7104
7105 // ConceptDecl wouldn't be the same if their constraint expression differs.
7106 if (const auto *ConceptX = dyn_cast<ConceptDecl>(X)) {
7107 const auto *ConceptY = cast<ConceptDecl>(Y);
7108 if (!isSameConstraintExpr(ConceptX->getConstraintExpr(),
7109 ConceptY->getConstraintExpr()))
7110 return false;
7111 }
7112
7113 return isSameEntity(TemplateX->getTemplatedDecl(),
7114 TemplateY->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
7115 isSameTemplateParameterList(TemplateX->getTemplateParameters(),
7116 TemplateY->getTemplateParameters());
7117 }
7118
7119 // Fields with the same name and the same type match.
7120 if (const auto *FDX = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(X)) {
7121 const auto *FDY = cast<FieldDecl>(Y);
7122 // FIXME: Also check the bitwidth is odr-equivalent, if any.
7123 return hasSameType(FDX->getType(), FDY->getType());
7124 }
7125
7126 // Indirect fields with the same target field match.
7127 if (const auto *IFDX = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(X)) {
7128 const auto *IFDY = cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(Y);
7129 return IFDX->getAnonField()->getCanonicalDecl() ==
7130 IFDY->getAnonField()->getCanonicalDecl();
7131 }
7132
7133 // Enumerators with the same name match.
7134 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(X))
7135 // FIXME: Also check the value is odr-equivalent.
7136 return true;
7137
7138 // Using shadow declarations with the same target match.
7139 if (const auto *USX = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(X)) {
7140 const auto *USY = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Y);
7141 return declaresSameEntity(USX->getTargetDecl(), USY->getTargetDecl());
7142 }
7143
7144 // Using declarations with the same qualifier match. (We already know that
7145 // the name matches.)
7146 if (const auto *UX = dyn_cast<UsingDecl>(X)) {
7147 const auto *UY = cast<UsingDecl>(Y);
7148 return isSameQualifier(UX->getQualifier(), UY->getQualifier()) &&
7149 UX->hasTypename() == UY->hasTypename() &&
7150 UX->isAccessDeclaration() == UY->isAccessDeclaration();
7151 }
7152 if (const auto *UX = dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(X)) {
7153 const auto *UY = cast<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(Y);
7154 return isSameQualifier(UX->getQualifier(), UY->getQualifier()) &&
7155 UX->isAccessDeclaration() == UY->isAccessDeclaration();
7156 }
7157 if (const auto *UX = dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(X)) {
7158 return isSameQualifier(
7159 UX->getQualifier(),
7160 cast<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Y)->getQualifier());
7161 }
7162
7163 // Using-pack declarations are only created by instantiation, and match if
7164 // they're instantiated from matching UnresolvedUsing...Decls.
7165 if (const auto *UX = dyn_cast<UsingPackDecl>(X)) {
7166 return declaresSameEntity(
7167 UX->getInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(),
7168 cast<UsingPackDecl>(Y)->getInstantiatedFromUsingDecl());
7169 }
7170
7171 // Namespace alias definitions with the same target match.
7172 if (const auto *NAX = dyn_cast<NamespaceAliasDecl>(X)) {
7173 const auto *NAY = cast<NamespaceAliasDecl>(Y);
7174 return NAX->getNamespace()->Equals(NAY->getNamespace());
7175 }
7176
7177 return false;
7178 }
7179
7180 TemplateArgument
getCanonicalTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument & Arg) const7181 ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg) const {
7182 switch (Arg.getKind()) {
7183 case TemplateArgument::Null:
7184 return Arg;
7185
7186 case TemplateArgument::Expression:
7187 return Arg;
7188
7189 case TemplateArgument::Declaration: {
7190 auto *D = cast<ValueDecl>(Arg.getAsDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
7191 return TemplateArgument(D, getCanonicalType(Arg.getParamTypeForDecl()),
7192 Arg.getIsDefaulted());
7193 }
7194
7195 case TemplateArgument::NullPtr:
7196 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getNullPtrType()),
7197 /*isNullPtr*/ true, Arg.getIsDefaulted());
7198
7199 case TemplateArgument::Template:
7200 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(Arg.getAsTemplate()),
7201 Arg.getIsDefaulted());
7202
7203 case TemplateArgument::TemplateExpansion:
7204 return TemplateArgument(
7205 getCanonicalTemplateName(Arg.getAsTemplateOrTemplatePattern()),
7206 Arg.getNumTemplateExpansions(), Arg.getIsDefaulted());
7207
7208 case TemplateArgument::Integral:
7209 return TemplateArgument(Arg, getCanonicalType(Arg.getIntegralType()));
7210
7211 case TemplateArgument::StructuralValue:
7212 return TemplateArgument(*this,
7213 getCanonicalType(Arg.getStructuralValueType()),
7214 Arg.getAsStructuralValue());
7215
7216 case TemplateArgument::Type:
7217 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getAsType()),
7218 /*isNullPtr*/ false, Arg.getIsDefaulted());
7219
7220 case TemplateArgument::Pack: {
7221 bool AnyNonCanonArgs = false;
7222 auto CanonArgs = ::getCanonicalTemplateArguments(
7223 *this, Arg.pack_elements(), AnyNonCanonArgs);
7224 if (!AnyNonCanonArgs)
7225 return Arg;
7226 return TemplateArgument::CreatePackCopy(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this),
7227 CanonArgs);
7228 }
7229 }
7230
7231 // Silence GCC warning
7232 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled template argument kind");
7233 }
7234
7235 NestedNameSpecifier *
getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NestedNameSpecifier * NNS) const7236 ASTContext::getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS) const {
7237 if (!NNS)
7238 return nullptr;
7239
7240 switch (NNS->getKind()) {
7241 case NestedNameSpecifier::Identifier:
7242 // Canonicalize the prefix but keep the identifier the same.
7243 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this,
7244 getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS->getPrefix()),
7245 NNS->getAsIdentifier());
7246
7247 case NestedNameSpecifier::Namespace:
7248 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
7249 // this namespace and no prefix.
7250 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
7251 NNS->getAsNamespace()->getFirstDecl());
7252
7253 case NestedNameSpecifier::NamespaceAlias:
7254 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
7255 // this namespace and no prefix.
7256 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(
7257 *this, nullptr,
7258 NNS->getAsNamespaceAlias()->getNamespace()->getFirstDecl());
7259
7260 // The difference between TypeSpec and TypeSpecWithTemplate is that the
7261 // latter will have the 'template' keyword when printed.
7262 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpec:
7263 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpecWithTemplate: {
7264 const Type *T = getCanonicalType(NNS->getAsType());
7265
7266 // If we have some kind of dependent-named type (e.g., "typename T::type"),
7267 // break it apart into its prefix and identifier, then reconsititute those
7268 // as the canonical nested-name-specifier. This is required to canonicalize
7269 // a dependent nested-name-specifier involving typedefs of dependent-name
7270 // types, e.g.,
7271 // typedef typename T::type T1;
7272 // typedef typename T1::type T2;
7273 if (const auto *DNT = T->getAs<DependentNameType>())
7274 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, DNT->getQualifier(),
7275 DNT->getIdentifier());
7276 if (const auto *DTST = T->getAs<DependentTemplateSpecializationType>())
7277 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, DTST->getQualifier(), true, T);
7278
7279 // TODO: Set 'Template' parameter to true for other template types.
7280 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr, false, T);
7281 }
7282
7283 case NestedNameSpecifier::Global:
7284 case NestedNameSpecifier::Super:
7285 // The global specifier and __super specifer are canonical and unique.
7286 return NNS;
7287 }
7288
7289 llvm_unreachable("Invalid NestedNameSpecifier::Kind!");
7290 }
7291
getAsArrayType(QualType T) const7292 const ArrayType *ASTContext::getAsArrayType(QualType T) const {
7293 // Handle the non-qualified case efficiently.
7294 if (!T.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
7295 // Handle the common positive case fast.
7296 if (const auto *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(T))
7297 return AT;
7298 }
7299
7300 // Handle the common negative case fast.
7301 if (!isa<ArrayType>(T.getCanonicalType()))
7302 return nullptr;
7303
7304 // Apply any qualifiers from the array type to the element type. This
7305 // implements C99 6.7.3p8: "If the specification of an array type includes
7306 // any type qualifiers, the element type is so qualified, not the array type."
7307
7308 // If we get here, we either have type qualifiers on the type, or we have
7309 // sugar such as a typedef in the way. If we have type qualifiers on the type
7310 // we must propagate them down into the element type.
7311
7312 SplitQualType split = T.getSplitDesugaredType();
7313 Qualifiers qs = split.Quals;
7314
7315 // If we have a simple case, just return now.
7316 const auto *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(split.Ty);
7317 if (!ATy || qs.empty())
7318 return ATy;
7319
7320 // Otherwise, we have an array and we have qualifiers on it. Push the
7321 // qualifiers into the array element type and return a new array type.
7322 QualType NewEltTy = getQualifiedType(ATy->getElementType(), qs);
7323
7324 if (const auto *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(ATy))
7325 return cast<ArrayType>(getConstantArrayType(NewEltTy, CAT->getSize(),
7326 CAT->getSizeExpr(),
7327 CAT->getSizeModifier(),
7328 CAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
7329 if (const auto *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ATy))
7330 return cast<ArrayType>(getIncompleteArrayType(NewEltTy,
7331 IAT->getSizeModifier(),
7332 IAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
7333
7334 if (const auto *DSAT = dyn_cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ATy))
7335 return cast<ArrayType>(
7336 getDependentSizedArrayType(NewEltTy,
7337 DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
7338 DSAT->getSizeModifier(),
7339 DSAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
7340 DSAT->getBracketsRange()));
7341
7342 const auto *VAT = cast<VariableArrayType>(ATy);
7343 return cast<ArrayType>(getVariableArrayType(NewEltTy,
7344 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
7345 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
7346 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
7347 VAT->getBracketsRange()));
7348 }
7349
getAdjustedParameterType(QualType T) const7350 QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedParameterType(QualType T) const {
7351 if (getLangOpts().HLSL && T->isConstantArrayType())
7352 return getArrayParameterType(T);
7353 if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
7354 return getDecayedType(T);
7355 return T;
7356 }
7357
getSignatureParameterType(QualType T) const7358 QualType ASTContext::getSignatureParameterType(QualType T) const {
7359 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
7360 T = getAdjustedParameterType(T);
7361 return T.getUnqualifiedType();
7362 }
7363
getExceptionObjectType(QualType T) const7364 QualType ASTContext::getExceptionObjectType(QualType T) const {
7365 // C++ [except.throw]p3:
7366 // A throw-expression initializes a temporary object, called the exception
7367 // object, the type of which is determined by removing any top-level
7368 // cv-qualifiers from the static type of the operand of throw and adjusting
7369 // the type from "array of T" or "function returning T" to "pointer to T"
7370 // or "pointer to function returning T", [...]
7371 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
7372 if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
7373 T = getDecayedType(T);
7374 return T.getUnqualifiedType();
7375 }
7376
7377 /// getArrayDecayedType - Return the properly qualified result of decaying the
7378 /// specified array type to a pointer. This operation is non-trivial when
7379 /// handling typedefs etc. The canonical type of "T" must be an array type,
7380 /// this returns a pointer to a properly qualified element of the array.
7381 ///
7382 /// See C99 6.7.5.3p7 and C99 6.3.2.1p3.
getArrayDecayedType(QualType Ty) const7383 QualType ASTContext::getArrayDecayedType(QualType Ty) const {
7384 // Get the element type with 'getAsArrayType' so that we don't lose any
7385 // typedefs in the element type of the array. This also handles propagation
7386 // of type qualifiers from the array type into the element type if present
7387 // (C99 6.7.3p8).
7388 const ArrayType *PrettyArrayType = getAsArrayType(Ty);
7389 assert(PrettyArrayType && "Not an array type!");
7390
7391 QualType PtrTy = getPointerType(PrettyArrayType->getElementType());
7392
7393 // int x[restrict 4] -> int *restrict
7394 QualType Result = getQualifiedType(PtrTy,
7395 PrettyArrayType->getIndexTypeQualifiers());
7396
7397 // int x[_Nullable] -> int * _Nullable
7398 if (auto Nullability = Ty->getNullability()) {
7399 Result = const_cast<ASTContext *>(this)->getAttributedType(
7400 AttributedType::getNullabilityAttrKind(*Nullability), Result, Result);
7401 }
7402 return Result;
7403 }
7404
getBaseElementType(const ArrayType * array) const7405 QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(const ArrayType *array) const {
7406 return getBaseElementType(array->getElementType());
7407 }
7408
getBaseElementType(QualType type) const7409 QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(QualType type) const {
7410 Qualifiers qs;
7411 while (true) {
7412 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
7413 const ArrayType *array = split.Ty->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe();
7414 if (!array) break;
7415
7416 type = array->getElementType();
7417 qs.addConsistentQualifiers(split.Quals);
7418 }
7419
7420 return getQualifiedType(type, qs);
7421 }
7422
7423 /// getConstantArrayElementCount - Returns number of constant array elements.
7424 uint64_t
getConstantArrayElementCount(const ConstantArrayType * CA) const7425 ASTContext::getConstantArrayElementCount(const ConstantArrayType *CA) const {
7426 uint64_t ElementCount = 1;
7427 do {
7428 ElementCount *= CA->getZExtSize();
7429 CA = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantArrayType>(
7430 CA->getElementType()->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe());
7431 } while (CA);
7432 return ElementCount;
7433 }
7434
getArrayInitLoopExprElementCount(const ArrayInitLoopExpr * AILE) const7435 uint64_t ASTContext::getArrayInitLoopExprElementCount(
7436 const ArrayInitLoopExpr *AILE) const {
7437 if (!AILE)
7438 return 0;
7439
7440 uint64_t ElementCount = 1;
7441
7442 do {
7443 ElementCount *= AILE->getArraySize().getZExtValue();
7444 AILE = dyn_cast<ArrayInitLoopExpr>(AILE->getSubExpr());
7445 } while (AILE);
7446
7447 return ElementCount;
7448 }
7449
7450 /// getFloatingRank - Return a relative rank for floating point types.
7451 /// This routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't a float.
getFloatingRank(QualType T)7452 static FloatingRank getFloatingRank(QualType T) {
7453 if (const auto *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
7454 return getFloatingRank(CT->getElementType());
7455
7456 switch (T->castAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
7457 default: llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
7458 case BuiltinType::Float16: return Float16Rank;
7459 case BuiltinType::Half: return HalfRank;
7460 case BuiltinType::Float: return FloatRank;
7461 case BuiltinType::Double: return DoubleRank;
7462 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return LongDoubleRank;
7463 case BuiltinType::Float128: return Float128Rank;
7464 case BuiltinType::BFloat16: return BFloat16Rank;
7465 case BuiltinType::Ibm128: return Ibm128Rank;
7466 }
7467 }
7468
7469 /// getFloatingTypeOrder - Compare the rank of the two specified floating
7470 /// point types, ignoring the domain of the type (i.e. 'double' ==
7471 /// '_Complex double'). If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
7472 /// LHS < RHS, return -1.
getFloatingTypeOrder(QualType LHS,QualType RHS) const7473 int ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
7474 FloatingRank LHSR = getFloatingRank(LHS);
7475 FloatingRank RHSR = getFloatingRank(RHS);
7476
7477 if (LHSR == RHSR)
7478 return 0;
7479 if (LHSR > RHSR)
7480 return 1;
7481 return -1;
7482 }
7483
getFloatingTypeSemanticOrder(QualType LHS,QualType RHS) const7484 int ASTContext::getFloatingTypeSemanticOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
7485 if (&getFloatTypeSemantics(LHS) == &getFloatTypeSemantics(RHS))
7486 return 0;
7487 return getFloatingTypeOrder(LHS, RHS);
7488 }
7489
7490 /// getIntegerRank - Return an integer conversion rank (C99 6.3.1.1p1). This
7491 /// routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't an integer or enum,
7492 /// or if it is not canonicalized.
getIntegerRank(const Type * T) const7493 unsigned ASTContext::getIntegerRank(const Type *T) const {
7494 assert(T->isCanonicalUnqualified() && "T should be canonicalized");
7495
7496 // Results in this 'losing' to any type of the same size, but winning if
7497 // larger.
7498 if (const auto *EIT = dyn_cast<BitIntType>(T))
7499 return 0 + (EIT->getNumBits() << 3);
7500
7501 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
7502 default: llvm_unreachable("getIntegerRank(): not a built-in integer");
7503 case BuiltinType::Bool:
7504 return 1 + (getIntWidth(BoolTy) << 3);
7505 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
7506 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
7507 case BuiltinType::SChar:
7508 case BuiltinType::UChar:
7509 return 2 + (getIntWidth(CharTy) << 3);
7510 case BuiltinType::Short:
7511 case BuiltinType::UShort:
7512 return 3 + (getIntWidth(ShortTy) << 3);
7513 case BuiltinType::Int:
7514 case BuiltinType::UInt:
7515 return 4 + (getIntWidth(IntTy) << 3);
7516 case BuiltinType::Long:
7517 case BuiltinType::ULong:
7518 return 5 + (getIntWidth(LongTy) << 3);
7519 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
7520 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
7521 return 6 + (getIntWidth(LongLongTy) << 3);
7522 case BuiltinType::Int128:
7523 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
7524 return 7 + (getIntWidth(Int128Ty) << 3);
7525
7526 // "The ranks of char8_t, char16_t, char32_t, and wchar_t equal the ranks of
7527 // their underlying types" [c++20 conv.rank]
7528 case BuiltinType::Char8:
7529 return getIntegerRank(UnsignedCharTy.getTypePtr());
7530 case BuiltinType::Char16:
7531 return getIntegerRank(
7532 getFromTargetType(Target->getChar16Type()).getTypePtr());
7533 case BuiltinType::Char32:
7534 return getIntegerRank(
7535 getFromTargetType(Target->getChar32Type()).getTypePtr());
7536 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
7537 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
7538 return getIntegerRank(
7539 getFromTargetType(Target->getWCharType()).getTypePtr());
7540 }
7541 }
7542
7543 /// Whether this is a promotable bitfield reference according
7544 /// to C99 6.3.1.1p2, bullet 2 (and GCC extensions).
7545 ///
7546 /// \returns the type this bit-field will promote to, or NULL if no
7547 /// promotion occurs.
isPromotableBitField(Expr * E) const7548 QualType ASTContext::isPromotableBitField(Expr *E) const {
7549 if (E->isTypeDependent() || E->isValueDependent())
7550 return {};
7551
7552 // C++ [conv.prom]p5:
7553 // If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any other
7554 // value of that type for promotion purposes.
7555 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && E->getType()->isEnumeralType())
7556 return {};
7557
7558 // FIXME: We should not do this unless E->refersToBitField() is true. This
7559 // matters in C where getSourceBitField() will find bit-fields for various
7560 // cases where the source expression is not a bit-field designator.
7561
7562 FieldDecl *Field = E->getSourceBitField(); // FIXME: conditional bit-fields?
7563 if (!Field)
7564 return {};
7565
7566 QualType FT = Field->getType();
7567
7568 uint64_t BitWidth = Field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
7569 uint64_t IntSize = getTypeSize(IntTy);
7570 // C++ [conv.prom]p5:
7571 // A prvalue for an integral bit-field can be converted to a prvalue of type
7572 // int if int can represent all the values of the bit-field; otherwise, it
7573 // can be converted to unsigned int if unsigned int can represent all the
7574 // values of the bit-field. If the bit-field is larger yet, no integral
7575 // promotion applies to it.
7576 // C11 6.3.1.1/2:
7577 // [For a bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int:]
7578 // If an int can represent all values of the original type (as restricted by
7579 // the width, for a bit-field), the value is converted to an int; otherwise,
7580 // it is converted to an unsigned int.
7581 //
7582 // FIXME: C does not permit promotion of a 'long : 3' bitfield to int.
7583 // We perform that promotion here to match GCC and C++.
7584 // FIXME: C does not permit promotion of an enum bit-field whose rank is
7585 // greater than that of 'int'. We perform that promotion to match GCC.
7586 //
7587 // C23 6.3.1.1p2:
7588 // The value from a bit-field of a bit-precise integer type is converted to
7589 // the corresponding bit-precise integer type. (The rest is the same as in
7590 // C11.)
7591 if (QualType QT = Field->getType(); QT->isBitIntType())
7592 return QT;
7593
7594 if (BitWidth < IntSize)
7595 return IntTy;
7596
7597 if (BitWidth == IntSize)
7598 return FT->isSignedIntegerType() ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
7599
7600 // Bit-fields wider than int are not subject to promotions, and therefore act
7601 // like the base type. GCC has some weird bugs in this area that we
7602 // deliberately do not follow (GCC follows a pre-standard resolution to
7603 // C's DR315 which treats bit-width as being part of the type, and this leaks
7604 // into their semantics in some cases).
7605 return {};
7606 }
7607
7608 /// getPromotedIntegerType - Returns the type that Promotable will
7609 /// promote to: C99 6.3.1.1p2, assuming that Promotable is a promotable
7610 /// integer type.
getPromotedIntegerType(QualType Promotable) const7611 QualType ASTContext::getPromotedIntegerType(QualType Promotable) const {
7612 assert(!Promotable.isNull());
7613 assert(isPromotableIntegerType(Promotable));
7614 if (const auto *ET = Promotable->getAs<EnumType>())
7615 return ET->getDecl()->getPromotionType();
7616
7617 if (const auto *BT = Promotable->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
7618 // C++ [conv.prom]: A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t
7619 // (3.9.1) can be converted to a prvalue of the first of the following
7620 // types that can represent all the values of its underlying type:
7621 // int, unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or
7622 // unsigned long long int [...]
7623 // FIXME: Is there some better way to compute this?
7624 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S ||
7625 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_U ||
7626 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char8 ||
7627 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char16 ||
7628 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char32) {
7629 bool FromIsSigned = BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S;
7630 uint64_t FromSize = getTypeSize(BT);
7631 QualType PromoteTypes[] = { IntTy, UnsignedIntTy, LongTy, UnsignedLongTy,
7632 LongLongTy, UnsignedLongLongTy };
7633 for (const auto &PT : PromoteTypes) {
7634 uint64_t ToSize = getTypeSize(PT);
7635 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
7636 (FromSize == ToSize && FromIsSigned == PT->isSignedIntegerType()))
7637 return PT;
7638 }
7639 llvm_unreachable("char type should fit into long long");
7640 }
7641 }
7642
7643 // At this point, we should have a signed or unsigned integer type.
7644 if (Promotable->isSignedIntegerType())
7645 return IntTy;
7646 uint64_t PromotableSize = getIntWidth(Promotable);
7647 uint64_t IntSize = getIntWidth(IntTy);
7648 assert(Promotable->isUnsignedIntegerType() && PromotableSize <= IntSize);
7649 return (PromotableSize != IntSize) ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
7650 }
7651
7652 /// Recurses in pointer/array types until it finds an objc retainable
7653 /// type and returns its ownership.
getInnerObjCOwnership(QualType T) const7654 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime ASTContext::getInnerObjCOwnership(QualType T) const {
7655 while (!T.isNull()) {
7656 if (T.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_None)
7657 return T.getObjCLifetime();
7658 if (T->isArrayType())
7659 T = getBaseElementType(T);
7660 else if (const auto *PT = T->getAs<PointerType>())
7661 T = PT->getPointeeType();
7662 else if (const auto *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>())
7663 T = RT->getPointeeType();
7664 else
7665 break;
7666 }
7667
7668 return Qualifiers::OCL_None;
7669 }
7670
getIntegerTypeForEnum(const EnumType * ET)7671 static const Type *getIntegerTypeForEnum(const EnumType *ET) {
7672 // Incomplete enum types are not treated as integer types.
7673 // FIXME: In C++, enum types are never integer types.
7674 if (ET->getDecl()->isComplete() && !ET->getDecl()->isScoped())
7675 return ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr();
7676 return nullptr;
7677 }
7678
7679 /// getIntegerTypeOrder - Returns the highest ranked integer type:
7680 /// C99 6.3.1.8p1. If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
7681 /// LHS < RHS, return -1.
getIntegerTypeOrder(QualType LHS,QualType RHS) const7682 int ASTContext::getIntegerTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
7683 const Type *LHSC = getCanonicalType(LHS).getTypePtr();
7684 const Type *RHSC = getCanonicalType(RHS).getTypePtr();
7685
7686 // Unwrap enums to their underlying type.
7687 if (const auto *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(LHSC))
7688 LHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
7689 if (const auto *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(RHSC))
7690 RHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
7691
7692 if (LHSC == RHSC) return 0;
7693
7694 bool LHSUnsigned = LHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
7695 bool RHSUnsigned = RHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
7696
7697 unsigned LHSRank = getIntegerRank(LHSC);
7698 unsigned RHSRank = getIntegerRank(RHSC);
7699
7700 if (LHSUnsigned == RHSUnsigned) { // Both signed or both unsigned.
7701 if (LHSRank == RHSRank) return 0;
7702 return LHSRank > RHSRank ? 1 : -1;
7703 }
7704
7705 // Otherwise, the LHS is signed and the RHS is unsigned or visa versa.
7706 if (LHSUnsigned) {
7707 // If the unsigned [LHS] type is larger, return it.
7708 if (LHSRank >= RHSRank)
7709 return 1;
7710
7711 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
7712 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
7713 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
7714 return -1;
7715 }
7716
7717 // If the unsigned [RHS] type is larger, return it.
7718 if (RHSRank >= LHSRank)
7719 return -1;
7720
7721 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
7722 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
7723 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
7724 return 1;
7725 }
7726
getCFConstantStringDecl() const7727 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getCFConstantStringDecl() const {
7728 if (CFConstantStringTypeDecl)
7729 return CFConstantStringTypeDecl;
7730
7731 assert(!CFConstantStringTagDecl &&
7732 "tag and typedef should be initialized together");
7733 CFConstantStringTagDecl = buildImplicitRecord("__NSConstantString_tag");
7734 CFConstantStringTagDecl->startDefinition();
7735
7736 struct {
7737 QualType Type;
7738 const char *Name;
7739 } Fields[5];
7740 unsigned Count = 0;
7741
7742 /// Objective-C ABI
7743 ///
7744 /// typedef struct __NSConstantString_tag {
7745 /// const int *isa;
7746 /// int flags;
7747 /// const char *str;
7748 /// long length;
7749 /// } __NSConstantString;
7750 ///
7751 /// Swift ABI (4.1, 4.2)
7752 ///
7753 /// typedef struct __NSConstantString_tag {
7754 /// uintptr_t _cfisa;
7755 /// uintptr_t _swift_rc;
7756 /// _Atomic(uint64_t) _cfinfoa;
7757 /// const char *_ptr;
7758 /// uint32_t _length;
7759 /// } __NSConstantString;
7760 ///
7761 /// Swift ABI (5.0)
7762 ///
7763 /// typedef struct __NSConstantString_tag {
7764 /// uintptr_t _cfisa;
7765 /// uintptr_t _swift_rc;
7766 /// _Atomic(uint64_t) _cfinfoa;
7767 /// const char *_ptr;
7768 /// uintptr_t _length;
7769 /// } __NSConstantString;
7770
7771 const auto CFRuntime = getLangOpts().CFRuntime;
7772 if (static_cast<unsigned>(CFRuntime) <
7773 static_cast<unsigned>(LangOptions::CoreFoundationABI::Swift)) {
7774 Fields[Count++] = { getPointerType(IntTy.withConst()), "isa" };
7775 Fields[Count++] = { IntTy, "flags" };
7776 Fields[Count++] = { getPointerType(CharTy.withConst()), "str" };
7777 Fields[Count++] = { LongTy, "length" };
7778 } else {
7779 Fields[Count++] = { getUIntPtrType(), "_cfisa" };
7780 Fields[Count++] = { getUIntPtrType(), "_swift_rc" };
7781 Fields[Count++] = { getFromTargetType(Target->getUInt64Type()), "_swift_rc" };
7782 Fields[Count++] = { getPointerType(CharTy.withConst()), "_ptr" };
7783 if (CFRuntime == LangOptions::CoreFoundationABI::Swift4_1 ||
7784 CFRuntime == LangOptions::CoreFoundationABI::Swift4_2)
7785 Fields[Count++] = { IntTy, "_ptr" };
7786 else
7787 Fields[Count++] = { getUIntPtrType(), "_ptr" };
7788 }
7789
7790 // Create fields
7791 for (unsigned i = 0; i < Count; ++i) {
7792 FieldDecl *Field =
7793 FieldDecl::Create(*this, CFConstantStringTagDecl, SourceLocation(),
7794 SourceLocation(), &Idents.get(Fields[i].Name),
7795 Fields[i].Type, /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
7796 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
7797 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
7798 CFConstantStringTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
7799 }
7800
7801 CFConstantStringTagDecl->completeDefinition();
7802 // This type is designed to be compatible with NSConstantString, but cannot
7803 // use the same name, since NSConstantString is an interface.
7804 auto tagType = getTagDeclType(CFConstantStringTagDecl);
7805 CFConstantStringTypeDecl =
7806 buildImplicitTypedef(tagType, "__NSConstantString");
7807
7808 return CFConstantStringTypeDecl;
7809 }
7810
getCFConstantStringTagDecl() const7811 RecordDecl *ASTContext::getCFConstantStringTagDecl() const {
7812 if (!CFConstantStringTagDecl)
7813 getCFConstantStringDecl(); // Build the tag and the typedef.
7814 return CFConstantStringTagDecl;
7815 }
7816
7817 // getCFConstantStringType - Return the type used for constant CFStrings.
getCFConstantStringType() const7818 QualType ASTContext::getCFConstantStringType() const {
7819 return getTypedefType(getCFConstantStringDecl());
7820 }
7821
getObjCSuperType() const7822 QualType ASTContext::getObjCSuperType() const {
7823 if (ObjCSuperType.isNull()) {
7824 RecordDecl *ObjCSuperTypeDecl = buildImplicitRecord("objc_super");
7825 getTranslationUnitDecl()->addDecl(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
7826 ObjCSuperType = getTagDeclType(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
7827 }
7828 return ObjCSuperType;
7829 }
7830
setCFConstantStringType(QualType T)7831 void ASTContext::setCFConstantStringType(QualType T) {
7832 const auto *TD = T->castAs<TypedefType>();
7833 CFConstantStringTypeDecl = cast<TypedefDecl>(TD->getDecl());
7834 const auto *TagType =
7835 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->getUnderlyingType()->castAs<RecordType>();
7836 CFConstantStringTagDecl = TagType->getDecl();
7837 }
7838
getBlockDescriptorType() const7839 QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorType() const {
7840 if (BlockDescriptorType)
7841 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
7842
7843 RecordDecl *RD;
7844 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
7845 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor");
7846 RD->startDefinition();
7847
7848 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
7849 UnsignedLongTy,
7850 UnsignedLongTy,
7851 };
7852
7853 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
7854 "reserved",
7855 "Size"
7856 };
7857
7858 for (size_t i = 0; i < 2; ++i) {
7859 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
7860 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
7861 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
7862 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
7863 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
7864 RD->addDecl(Field);
7865 }
7866
7867 RD->completeDefinition();
7868
7869 BlockDescriptorType = RD;
7870
7871 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
7872 }
7873
getBlockDescriptorExtendedType() const7874 QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorExtendedType() const {
7875 if (BlockDescriptorExtendedType)
7876 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
7877
7878 RecordDecl *RD;
7879 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
7880 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor_withcopydispose");
7881 RD->startDefinition();
7882
7883 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
7884 UnsignedLongTy,
7885 UnsignedLongTy,
7886 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy),
7887 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy)
7888 };
7889
7890 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
7891 "reserved",
7892 "Size",
7893 "CopyFuncPtr",
7894 "DestroyFuncPtr"
7895 };
7896
7897 for (size_t i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
7898 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
7899 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
7900 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
7901 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
7902 /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
7903 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
7904 RD->addDecl(Field);
7905 }
7906
7907 RD->completeDefinition();
7908
7909 BlockDescriptorExtendedType = RD;
7910 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
7911 }
7912
getOpenCLTypeKind(const Type * T) const7913 OpenCLTypeKind ASTContext::getOpenCLTypeKind(const Type *T) const {
7914 const auto *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(T);
7915
7916 if (!BT) {
7917 if (isa<PipeType>(T))
7918 return OCLTK_Pipe;
7919
7920 return OCLTK_Default;
7921 }
7922
7923 switch (BT->getKind()) {
7924 #define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
7925 case BuiltinType::Id: \
7926 return OCLTK_Image;
7927 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
7928
7929 case BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent:
7930 return OCLTK_ClkEvent;
7931
7932 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
7933 return OCLTK_Event;
7934
7935 case BuiltinType::OCLQueue:
7936 return OCLTK_Queue;
7937
7938 case BuiltinType::OCLReserveID:
7939 return OCLTK_ReserveID;
7940
7941 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
7942 return OCLTK_Sampler;
7943
7944 default:
7945 return OCLTK_Default;
7946 }
7947 }
7948
getOpenCLTypeAddrSpace(const Type * T) const7949 LangAS ASTContext::getOpenCLTypeAddrSpace(const Type *T) const {
7950 return Target->getOpenCLTypeAddrSpace(getOpenCLTypeKind(T));
7951 }
7952
7953 /// BlockRequiresCopying - Returns true if byref variable "D" of type "Ty"
7954 /// requires copy/dispose. Note that this must match the logic
7955 /// in buildByrefHelpers.
BlockRequiresCopying(QualType Ty,const VarDecl * D)7956 bool ASTContext::BlockRequiresCopying(QualType Ty,
7957 const VarDecl *D) {
7958 if (const CXXRecordDecl *record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
7959 const Expr *copyExpr = getBlockVarCopyInit(D).getCopyExpr();
7960 if (!copyExpr && record->hasTrivialDestructor()) return false;
7961
7962 return true;
7963 }
7964
7965 // The block needs copy/destroy helpers if Ty is non-trivial to destructively
7966 // move or destroy.
7967 if (Ty.isNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructiveMove() || Ty.isDestructedType())
7968 return true;
7969
7970 if (!Ty->isObjCRetainableType()) return false;
7971
7972 Qualifiers qs = Ty.getQualifiers();
7973
7974 // If we have lifetime, that dominates.
7975 if (Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = qs.getObjCLifetime()) {
7976 switch (lifetime) {
7977 case Qualifiers::OCL_None: llvm_unreachable("impossible");
7978
7979 // These are just bits as far as the runtime is concerned.
7980 case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone:
7981 case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing:
7982 return false;
7983
7984 // These cases should have been taken care of when checking the type's
7985 // non-triviality.
7986 case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak:
7987 case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong:
7988 llvm_unreachable("impossible");
7989 }
7990 llvm_unreachable("fell out of lifetime switch!");
7991 }
7992 return (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || isObjCNSObjectType(Ty) ||
7993 Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType());
7994 }
7995
getByrefLifetime(QualType Ty,Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime & LifeTime,bool & HasByrefExtendedLayout) const7996 bool ASTContext::getByrefLifetime(QualType Ty,
7997 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime &LifeTime,
7998 bool &HasByrefExtendedLayout) const {
7999 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC ||
8000 getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC)
8001 return false;
8002
8003 HasByrefExtendedLayout = false;
8004 if (Ty->isRecordType()) {
8005 HasByrefExtendedLayout = true;
8006 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
8007 } else if ((LifeTime = Ty.getObjCLifetime())) {
8008 // Honor the ARC qualifiers.
8009 } else if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType()) {
8010 // The MRR rule.
8011 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone;
8012 } else {
8013 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
8014 }
8015 return true;
8016 }
8017
getNSUIntegerType() const8018 CanQualType ASTContext::getNSUIntegerType() const {
8019 assert(Target && "Expected target to be initialized");
8020 const llvm::Triple &T = Target->getTriple();
8021 // Windows is LLP64 rather than LP64
8022 if (T.isOSWindows() && T.isArch64Bit())
8023 return UnsignedLongLongTy;
8024 return UnsignedLongTy;
8025 }
8026
getNSIntegerType() const8027 CanQualType ASTContext::getNSIntegerType() const {
8028 assert(Target && "Expected target to be initialized");
8029 const llvm::Triple &T = Target->getTriple();
8030 // Windows is LLP64 rather than LP64
8031 if (T.isOSWindows() && T.isArch64Bit())
8032 return LongLongTy;
8033 return LongTy;
8034 }
8035
getObjCInstanceTypeDecl()8036 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCInstanceTypeDecl() {
8037 if (!ObjCInstanceTypeDecl)
8038 ObjCInstanceTypeDecl =
8039 buildImplicitTypedef(getObjCIdType(), "instancetype");
8040 return ObjCInstanceTypeDecl;
8041 }
8042
8043 // This returns true if a type has been typedefed to BOOL:
8044 // typedef <type> BOOL;
isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(QualType T)8045 static bool isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(QualType T) {
8046 if (const auto *TT = dyn_cast<TypedefType>(T))
8047 if (IdentifierInfo *II = TT->getDecl()->getIdentifier())
8048 return II->isStr("BOOL");
8049
8050 return false;
8051 }
8052
8053 /// getObjCEncodingTypeSize returns size of type for objective-c encoding
8054 /// purpose.
getObjCEncodingTypeSize(QualType type) const8055 CharUnits ASTContext::getObjCEncodingTypeSize(QualType type) const {
8056 if (!type->isIncompleteArrayType() && type->isIncompleteType())
8057 return CharUnits::Zero();
8058
8059 CharUnits sz = getTypeSizeInChars(type);
8060
8061 // Make all integer and enum types at least as large as an int
8062 if (sz.isPositive() && type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
8063 sz = std::max(sz, getTypeSizeInChars(IntTy));
8064 // Treat arrays as pointers, since that's how they're passed in.
8065 else if (type->isArrayType())
8066 sz = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
8067 return sz;
8068 }
8069
isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(const VarDecl * VD) const8070 bool ASTContext::isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(const VarDecl *VD) const {
8071 return getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() &&
8072 VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
8073 VD->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() &&
8074 !VD->getFirstDecl()->isOutOfLine() && VD->getFirstDecl()->hasInit();
8075 }
8076
8077 ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind
getInlineVariableDefinitionKind(const VarDecl * VD) const8078 ASTContext::getInlineVariableDefinitionKind(const VarDecl *VD) const {
8079 if (!VD->isInline())
8080 return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::None;
8081
8082 // In almost all cases, it's a weak definition.
8083 auto *First = VD->getFirstDecl();
8084 if (First->isInlineSpecified() || !First->isStaticDataMember())
8085 return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Weak;
8086
8087 // If there's a file-context declaration in this translation unit, it's a
8088 // non-discardable definition.
8089 for (auto *D : VD->redecls())
8090 if (D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFileContext() &&
8091 !D->isInlineSpecified() && (D->isConstexpr() || First->isConstexpr()))
8092 return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Strong;
8093
8094 // If we've not seen one yet, we don't know.
8095 return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::WeakUnknown;
8096 }
8097
charUnitsToString(const CharUnits & CU)8098 static std::string charUnitsToString(const CharUnits &CU) {
8099 return llvm::itostr(CU.getQuantity());
8100 }
8101
8102 /// getObjCEncodingForBlock - Return the encoded type for this block
8103 /// declaration.
getObjCEncodingForBlock(const BlockExpr * Expr) const8104 std::string ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForBlock(const BlockExpr *Expr) const {
8105 std::string S;
8106
8107 const BlockDecl *Decl = Expr->getBlockDecl();
8108 QualType BlockTy =
8109 Expr->getType()->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8110 QualType BlockReturnTy = BlockTy->castAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType();
8111 // Encode result type.
8112 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
8113 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, BlockReturnTy, S,
8114 true /*Extended*/);
8115 else
8116 getObjCEncodingForType(BlockReturnTy, S);
8117 // Compute size of all parameters.
8118 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
8119 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
8120 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
8121 CharUnits ParmOffset = PtrSize;
8122 for (auto *PI : Decl->parameters()) {
8123 QualType PType = PI->getType();
8124 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
8125 if (sz.isZero())
8126 continue;
8127 assert(sz.isPositive() && "BlockExpr - Incomplete param type");
8128 ParmOffset += sz;
8129 }
8130 // Size of the argument frame
8131 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
8132 // Block pointer and offset.
8133 S += "@?0";
8134
8135 // Argument types.
8136 ParmOffset = PtrSize;
8137 for (auto *PVDecl : Decl->parameters()) {
8138 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
8139 if (const auto *AT =
8140 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
8141 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
8142 // elements.
8143 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
8144 PType = PVDecl->getType();
8145 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
8146 PType = PVDecl->getType();
8147 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
8148 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, PType,
8149 S, true /*Extended*/);
8150 else
8151 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
8152 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
8153 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
8154 }
8155
8156 return S;
8157 }
8158
8159 std::string
getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl(const FunctionDecl * Decl) const8160 ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl(const FunctionDecl *Decl) const {
8161 std::string S;
8162 // Encode result type.
8163 getObjCEncodingForType(Decl->getReturnType(), S);
8164 CharUnits ParmOffset;
8165 // Compute size of all parameters.
8166 for (auto *PI : Decl->parameters()) {
8167 QualType PType = PI->getType();
8168 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
8169 if (sz.isZero())
8170 continue;
8171
8172 assert(sz.isPositive() &&
8173 "getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl - Incomplete param type");
8174 ParmOffset += sz;
8175 }
8176 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
8177 ParmOffset = CharUnits::Zero();
8178
8179 // Argument types.
8180 for (auto *PVDecl : Decl->parameters()) {
8181 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
8182 if (const auto *AT =
8183 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
8184 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
8185 // elements.
8186 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
8187 PType = PVDecl->getType();
8188 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
8189 PType = PVDecl->getType();
8190 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
8191 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
8192 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
8193 }
8194
8195 return S;
8196 }
8197
8198 /// getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter - Return the encoded type for a single
8199 /// method parameter or return type. If Extended, include class names and
8200 /// block object types.
getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,QualType T,std::string & S,bool Extended) const8201 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
8202 QualType T, std::string& S,
8203 bool Extended) const {
8204 // Encode type qualifier, 'in', 'inout', etc. for the parameter.
8205 getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(QT, S);
8206 // Encode parameter type.
8207 ObjCEncOptions Options = ObjCEncOptions()
8208 .setExpandPointedToStructures()
8209 .setExpandStructures()
8210 .setIsOutermostType();
8211 if (Extended)
8212 Options.setEncodeBlockParameters().setEncodeClassNames();
8213 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, Options, /*Field=*/nullptr);
8214 }
8215
8216 /// getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Return the encoded type for this method
8217 /// declaration.
getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl(const ObjCMethodDecl * Decl,bool Extended) const8218 std::string ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl(const ObjCMethodDecl *Decl,
8219 bool Extended) const {
8220 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
8221 // Encode return type.
8222 std::string S;
8223 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
8224 Decl->getReturnType(), S, Extended);
8225 // Compute size of all parameters.
8226 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
8227 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
8228 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
8229 // The first two arguments (self and _cmd) are pointers; account for
8230 // their size.
8231 CharUnits ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
8232 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
8233 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
8234 QualType PType = (*PI)->getType();
8235 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
8236 if (sz.isZero())
8237 continue;
8238
8239 assert(sz.isPositive() &&
8240 "getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Incomplete param type");
8241 ParmOffset += sz;
8242 }
8243 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
8244 S += "@0:";
8245 S += charUnitsToString(PtrSize);
8246
8247 // Argument types.
8248 ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
8249 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
8250 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
8251 const ParmVarDecl *PVDecl = *PI;
8252 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
8253 if (const auto *AT =
8254 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
8255 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
8256 // elements.
8257 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
8258 PType = PVDecl->getType();
8259 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
8260 PType = PVDecl->getType();
8261 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(PVDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
8262 PType, S, Extended);
8263 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
8264 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
8265 }
8266
8267 return S;
8268 }
8269
8270 ObjCPropertyImplDecl *
getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(const ObjCPropertyDecl * PD,const Decl * Container) const8271 ASTContext::getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(
8272 const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
8273 const Decl *Container) const {
8274 if (!Container)
8275 return nullptr;
8276 if (const auto *CID = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(Container)) {
8277 for (auto *PID : CID->property_impls())
8278 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
8279 return PID;
8280 } else {
8281 const auto *OID = cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(Container);
8282 for (auto *PID : OID->property_impls())
8283 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
8284 return PID;
8285 }
8286 return nullptr;
8287 }
8288
8289 /// getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl - Return the encoded type for this
8290 /// property declaration. If non-NULL, Container must be either an
8291 /// ObjCCategoryImplDecl or ObjCImplementationDecl; it should only be
8292 /// NULL when getting encodings for protocol properties.
8293 /// Property attributes are stored as a comma-delimited C string. The simple
8294 /// attributes readonly and bycopy are encoded as single characters. The
8295 /// parametrized attributes, getter=name, setter=name, and ivar=name, are
8296 /// encoded as single characters, followed by an identifier. Property types
8297 /// are also encoded as a parametrized attribute. The characters used to encode
8298 /// these attributes are defined by the following enumeration:
8299 /// @code
8300 /// enum PropertyAttributes {
8301 /// kPropertyReadOnly = 'R', // property is read-only.
8302 /// kPropertyBycopy = 'C', // property is a copy of the value last assigned
8303 /// kPropertyByref = '&', // property is a reference to the value last assigned
8304 /// kPropertyDynamic = 'D', // property is dynamic
8305 /// kPropertyGetter = 'G', // followed by getter selector name
8306 /// kPropertySetter = 'S', // followed by setter selector name
8307 /// kPropertyInstanceVariable = 'V' // followed by instance variable name
8308 /// kPropertyType = 'T' // followed by old-style type encoding.
8309 /// kPropertyWeak = 'W' // 'weak' property
8310 /// kPropertyStrong = 'P' // property GC'able
8311 /// kPropertyNonAtomic = 'N' // property non-atomic
8312 /// kPropertyOptional = '?' // property optional
8313 /// };
8314 /// @endcode
8315 std::string
getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl(const ObjCPropertyDecl * PD,const Decl * Container) const8316 ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl(const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
8317 const Decl *Container) const {
8318 // Collect information from the property implementation decl(s).
8319 bool Dynamic = false;
8320 ObjCPropertyImplDecl *SynthesizePID = nullptr;
8321
8322 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PropertyImpDecl =
8323 getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(PD, Container)) {
8324 if (PropertyImpDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
8325 Dynamic = true;
8326 else
8327 SynthesizePID = PropertyImpDecl;
8328 }
8329
8330 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
8331 std::string S = "T";
8332
8333 // Encode result type.
8334 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
8335 // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
8336 getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(PD->getType(), S);
8337
8338 if (PD->isOptional())
8339 S += ",?";
8340
8341 if (PD->isReadOnly()) {
8342 S += ",R";
8343 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyAttribute::kind_copy)
8344 S += ",C";
8345 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyAttribute::kind_retain)
8346 S += ",&";
8347 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyAttribute::kind_weak)
8348 S += ",W";
8349 } else {
8350 switch (PD->getSetterKind()) {
8351 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Assign: break;
8352 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Copy: S += ",C"; break;
8353 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Retain: S += ",&"; break;
8354 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Weak: S += ",W"; break;
8355 }
8356 }
8357
8358 // It really isn't clear at all what this means, since properties
8359 // are "dynamic by default".
8360 if (Dynamic)
8361 S += ",D";
8362
8363 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyAttribute::kind_nonatomic)
8364 S += ",N";
8365
8366 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyAttribute::kind_getter) {
8367 S += ",G";
8368 S += PD->getGetterName().getAsString();
8369 }
8370
8371 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyAttribute::kind_setter) {
8372 S += ",S";
8373 S += PD->getSetterName().getAsString();
8374 }
8375
8376 if (SynthesizePID) {
8377 const ObjCIvarDecl *OID = SynthesizePID->getPropertyIvarDecl();
8378 S += ",V";
8379 S += OID->getNameAsString();
8380 }
8381
8382 // FIXME: OBJCGC: weak & strong
8383 return S;
8384 }
8385
8386 /// getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding -
8387 /// Another legacy compatibility encoding: 32-bit longs are encoded as
8388 /// 'l' or 'L' , but not always. For typedefs, we need to use
8389 /// 'i' or 'I' instead if encoding a struct field, or a pointer!
getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(QualType & PointeeTy) const8390 void ASTContext::getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding (QualType &PointeeTy) const {
8391 if (PointeeTy->getAs<TypedefType>()) {
8392 if (const auto *BT = PointeeTy->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
8393 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::ULong && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
8394 PointeeTy = UnsignedIntTy;
8395 else
8396 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Long && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
8397 PointeeTy = IntTy;
8398 }
8399 }
8400 }
8401
getObjCEncodingForType(QualType T,std::string & S,const FieldDecl * Field,QualType * NotEncodedT) const8402 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForType(QualType T, std::string& S,
8403 const FieldDecl *Field,
8404 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
8405 // We follow the behavior of gcc, expanding structures which are
8406 // directly pointed to, and expanding embedded structures. Note that
8407 // these rules are sufficient to prevent recursive encoding of the
8408 // same type.
8409 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S,
8410 ObjCEncOptions()
8411 .setExpandPointedToStructures()
8412 .setExpandStructures()
8413 .setIsOutermostType(),
8414 Field, NotEncodedT);
8415 }
8416
getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(QualType T,std::string & S) const8417 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(QualType T,
8418 std::string& S) const {
8419 // Encode result type.
8420 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
8421 // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
8422 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S,
8423 ObjCEncOptions()
8424 .setExpandPointedToStructures()
8425 .setExpandStructures()
8426 .setIsOutermostType()
8427 .setEncodingProperty(),
8428 /*Field=*/nullptr);
8429 }
8430
getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveType(const ASTContext * C,const BuiltinType * BT)8431 static char getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveType(const ASTContext *C,
8432 const BuiltinType *BT) {
8433 BuiltinType::Kind kind = BT->getKind();
8434 switch (kind) {
8435 case BuiltinType::Void: return 'v';
8436 case BuiltinType::Bool: return 'B';
8437 case BuiltinType::Char8:
8438 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
8439 case BuiltinType::UChar: return 'C';
8440 case BuiltinType::Char16:
8441 case BuiltinType::UShort: return 'S';
8442 case BuiltinType::Char32:
8443 case BuiltinType::UInt: return 'I';
8444 case BuiltinType::ULong:
8445 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'L' : 'Q';
8446 case BuiltinType::UInt128: return 'T';
8447 case BuiltinType::ULongLong: return 'Q';
8448 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
8449 case BuiltinType::SChar: return 'c';
8450 case BuiltinType::Short: return 's';
8451 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
8452 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
8453 case BuiltinType::Int: return 'i';
8454 case BuiltinType::Long:
8455 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'l' : 'q';
8456 case BuiltinType::LongLong: return 'q';
8457 case BuiltinType::Int128: return 't';
8458 case BuiltinType::Float: return 'f';
8459 case BuiltinType::Double: return 'd';
8460 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return 'D';
8461 case BuiltinType::NullPtr: return '*'; // like char*
8462
8463 case BuiltinType::BFloat16:
8464 case BuiltinType::Float16:
8465 case BuiltinType::Float128:
8466 case BuiltinType::Ibm128:
8467 case BuiltinType::Half:
8468 case BuiltinType::ShortAccum:
8469 case BuiltinType::Accum:
8470 case BuiltinType::LongAccum:
8471 case BuiltinType::UShortAccum:
8472 case BuiltinType::UAccum:
8473 case BuiltinType::ULongAccum:
8474 case BuiltinType::ShortFract:
8475 case BuiltinType::Fract:
8476 case BuiltinType::LongFract:
8477 case BuiltinType::UShortFract:
8478 case BuiltinType::UFract:
8479 case BuiltinType::ULongFract:
8480 case BuiltinType::SatShortAccum:
8481 case BuiltinType::SatAccum:
8482 case BuiltinType::SatLongAccum:
8483 case BuiltinType::SatUShortAccum:
8484 case BuiltinType::SatUAccum:
8485 case BuiltinType::SatULongAccum:
8486 case BuiltinType::SatShortFract:
8487 case BuiltinType::SatFract:
8488 case BuiltinType::SatLongFract:
8489 case BuiltinType::SatUShortFract:
8490 case BuiltinType::SatUFract:
8491 case BuiltinType::SatULongFract:
8492 // FIXME: potentially need @encodes for these!
8493 return ' ';
8494
8495 #define SVE_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) \
8496 case BuiltinType::Id:
8497 #include "clang/Basic/AArch64SVEACLETypes.def"
8498 #define RVV_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) case BuiltinType::Id:
8499 #include "clang/Basic/RISCVVTypes.def"
8500 #define WASM_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) case BuiltinType::Id:
8501 #include "clang/Basic/WebAssemblyReferenceTypes.def"
8502 #define AMDGPU_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) case BuiltinType::Id:
8503 #include "clang/Basic/AMDGPUTypes.def"
8504 {
8505 DiagnosticsEngine &Diags = C->getDiagnostics();
8506 unsigned DiagID = Diags.getCustomDiagID(DiagnosticsEngine::Error,
8507 "cannot yet @encode type %0");
8508 Diags.Report(DiagID) << BT->getName(C->getPrintingPolicy());
8509 return ' ';
8510 }
8511
8512 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
8513 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
8514 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
8515 llvm_unreachable("@encoding ObjC primitive type");
8516
8517 // OpenCL and placeholder types don't need @encodings.
8518 #define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
8519 case BuiltinType::Id:
8520 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
8521 #define EXT_OPAQUE_TYPE(ExtType, Id, Ext) \
8522 case BuiltinType::Id:
8523 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLExtensionTypes.def"
8524 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
8525 case BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent:
8526 case BuiltinType::OCLQueue:
8527 case BuiltinType::OCLReserveID:
8528 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
8529 case BuiltinType::Dependent:
8530 #define PPC_VECTOR_TYPE(Name, Id, Size) \
8531 case BuiltinType::Id:
8532 #include "clang/Basic/PPCTypes.def"
8533 #define BUILTIN_TYPE(KIND, ID)
8534 #define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(KIND, ID) \
8535 case BuiltinType::KIND:
8536 #include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
8537 llvm_unreachable("invalid builtin type for @encode");
8538 }
8539 llvm_unreachable("invalid BuiltinType::Kind value");
8540 }
8541
ObjCEncodingForEnumType(const ASTContext * C,const EnumType * ET)8542 static char ObjCEncodingForEnumType(const ASTContext *C, const EnumType *ET) {
8543 EnumDecl *Enum = ET->getDecl();
8544
8545 // The encoding of an non-fixed enum type is always 'i', regardless of size.
8546 if (!Enum->isFixed())
8547 return 'i';
8548
8549 // The encoding of a fixed enum type matches its fixed underlying type.
8550 const auto *BT = Enum->getIntegerType()->castAs<BuiltinType>();
8551 return getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveType(C, BT);
8552 }
8553
EncodeBitField(const ASTContext * Ctx,std::string & S,QualType T,const FieldDecl * FD)8554 static void EncodeBitField(const ASTContext *Ctx, std::string& S,
8555 QualType T, const FieldDecl *FD) {
8556 assert(FD->isBitField() && "not a bitfield - getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl");
8557 S += 'b';
8558 // The NeXT runtime encodes bit fields as b followed by the number of bits.
8559 // The GNU runtime requires more information; bitfields are encoded as b,
8560 // then the offset (in bits) of the first element, then the type of the
8561 // bitfield, then the size in bits. For example, in this structure:
8562 //
8563 // struct
8564 // {
8565 // int integer;
8566 // int flags:2;
8567 // };
8568 // On a 32-bit system, the encoding for flags would be b2 for the NeXT
8569 // runtime, but b32i2 for the GNU runtime. The reason for this extra
8570 // information is not especially sensible, but we're stuck with it for
8571 // compatibility with GCC, although providing it breaks anything that
8572 // actually uses runtime introspection and wants to work on both runtimes...
8573 if (Ctx->getLangOpts().ObjCRuntime.isGNUFamily()) {
8574 uint64_t Offset;
8575
8576 if (const auto *IVD = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(FD)) {
8577 Offset = Ctx->lookupFieldBitOffset(IVD->getContainingInterface(), nullptr,
8578 IVD);
8579 } else {
8580 const RecordDecl *RD = FD->getParent();
8581 const ASTRecordLayout &RL = Ctx->getASTRecordLayout(RD);
8582 Offset = RL.getFieldOffset(FD->getFieldIndex());
8583 }
8584
8585 S += llvm::utostr(Offset);
8586
8587 if (const auto *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
8588 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(Ctx, ET);
8589 else {
8590 const auto *BT = T->castAs<BuiltinType>();
8591 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveType(Ctx, BT);
8592 }
8593 }
8594 S += llvm::utostr(FD->getBitWidthValue(*Ctx));
8595 }
8596
8597 // Helper function for determining whether the encoded type string would include
8598 // a template specialization type.
hasTemplateSpecializationInEncodedString(const Type * T,bool VisitBasesAndFields)8599 static bool hasTemplateSpecializationInEncodedString(const Type *T,
8600 bool VisitBasesAndFields) {
8601 T = T->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe();
8602
8603 if (auto *PT = T->getAs<PointerType>())
8604 return hasTemplateSpecializationInEncodedString(
8605 PT->getPointeeType().getTypePtr(), false);
8606
8607 auto *CXXRD = T->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
8608
8609 if (!CXXRD)
8610 return false;
8611
8612 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(CXXRD))
8613 return true;
8614
8615 if (!CXXRD->hasDefinition() || !VisitBasesAndFields)
8616 return false;
8617
8618 for (const auto &B : CXXRD->bases())
8619 if (hasTemplateSpecializationInEncodedString(B.getType().getTypePtr(),
8620 true))
8621 return true;
8622
8623 for (auto *FD : CXXRD->fields())
8624 if (hasTemplateSpecializationInEncodedString(FD->getType().getTypePtr(),
8625 true))
8626 return true;
8627
8628 return false;
8629 }
8630
8631 // FIXME: Use SmallString for accumulating string.
getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(QualType T,std::string & S,const ObjCEncOptions Options,const FieldDecl * FD,QualType * NotEncodedT) const8632 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(QualType T, std::string &S,
8633 const ObjCEncOptions Options,
8634 const FieldDecl *FD,
8635 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
8636 CanQualType CT = getCanonicalType(T);
8637 switch (CT->getTypeClass()) {
8638 case Type::Builtin:
8639 case Type::Enum:
8640 if (FD && FD->isBitField())
8641 return EncodeBitField(this, S, T, FD);
8642 if (const auto *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CT))
8643 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveType(this, BT);
8644 else
8645 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(this, cast<EnumType>(CT));
8646 return;
8647
8648 case Type::Complex:
8649 S += 'j';
8650 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), S,
8651 ObjCEncOptions(),
8652 /*Field=*/nullptr);
8653 return;
8654
8655 case Type::Atomic:
8656 S += 'A';
8657 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T->castAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType(), S,
8658 ObjCEncOptions(),
8659 /*Field=*/nullptr);
8660 return;
8661
8662 // encoding for pointer or reference types.
8663 case Type::Pointer:
8664 case Type::LValueReference:
8665 case Type::RValueReference: {
8666 QualType PointeeTy;
8667 if (isa<PointerType>(CT)) {
8668 const auto *PT = T->castAs<PointerType>();
8669 if (PT->isObjCSelType()) {
8670 S += ':';
8671 return;
8672 }
8673 PointeeTy = PT->getPointeeType();
8674 } else {
8675 PointeeTy = T->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
8676 }
8677
8678 bool isReadOnly = false;
8679 // For historical/compatibility reasons, the read-only qualifier of the
8680 // pointee gets emitted _before_ the '^'. The read-only qualifier of
8681 // the pointer itself gets ignored, _unless_ we are looking at a typedef!
8682 // Also, do not emit the 'r' for anything but the outermost type!
8683 if (T->getAs<TypedefType>()) {
8684 if (Options.IsOutermostType() && T.isConstQualified()) {
8685 isReadOnly = true;
8686 S += 'r';
8687 }
8688 } else if (Options.IsOutermostType()) {
8689 QualType P = PointeeTy;
8690 while (auto PT = P->getAs<PointerType>())
8691 P = PT->getPointeeType();
8692 if (P.isConstQualified()) {
8693 isReadOnly = true;
8694 S += 'r';
8695 }
8696 }
8697 if (isReadOnly) {
8698 // Another legacy compatibility encoding. Some ObjC qualifier and type
8699 // combinations need to be rearranged.
8700 // Rewrite "in const" from "nr" to "rn"
8701 if (StringRef(S).ends_with("nr"))
8702 S.replace(S.end()-2, S.end(), "rn");
8703 }
8704
8705 if (PointeeTy->isCharType()) {
8706 // char pointer types should be encoded as '*' unless it is a
8707 // type that has been typedef'd to 'BOOL'.
8708 if (!isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(PointeeTy)) {
8709 S += '*';
8710 return;
8711 }
8712 } else if (const auto *RTy = PointeeTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
8713 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_class *" to "#".
8714 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_class")) {
8715 S += '#';
8716 return;
8717 }
8718 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_object *" to "@".
8719 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_object")) {
8720 S += '@';
8721 return;
8722 }
8723 // If the encoded string for the class includes template names, just emit
8724 // "^v" for pointers to the class.
8725 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
8726 (!getLangOpts().EncodeCXXClassTemplateSpec &&
8727 hasTemplateSpecializationInEncodedString(
8728 RTy, Options.ExpandPointedToStructures()))) {
8729 S += "^v";
8730 return;
8731 }
8732 // fall through...
8733 }
8734 S += '^';
8735 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(PointeeTy);
8736
8737 ObjCEncOptions NewOptions;
8738 if (Options.ExpandPointedToStructures())
8739 NewOptions.setExpandStructures();
8740 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S, NewOptions,
8741 /*Field=*/nullptr, NotEncodedT);
8742 return;
8743 }
8744
8745 case Type::ConstantArray:
8746 case Type::IncompleteArray:
8747 case Type::VariableArray: {
8748 const auto *AT = cast<ArrayType>(CT);
8749
8750 if (isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT) && !Options.IsStructField()) {
8751 // Incomplete arrays are encoded as a pointer to the array element.
8752 S += '^';
8753
8754 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
8755 AT->getElementType(), S,
8756 Options.keepingOnly(ObjCEncOptions().setExpandStructures()), FD);
8757 } else {
8758 S += '[';
8759
8760 if (const auto *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
8761 S += llvm::utostr(CAT->getZExtSize());
8762 else {
8763 //Variable length arrays are encoded as a regular array with 0 elements.
8764 assert((isa<VariableArrayType>(AT) || isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) &&
8765 "Unknown array type!");
8766 S += '0';
8767 }
8768
8769 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
8770 AT->getElementType(), S,
8771 Options.keepingOnly(ObjCEncOptions().setExpandStructures()), FD,
8772 NotEncodedT);
8773 S += ']';
8774 }
8775 return;
8776 }
8777
8778 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
8779 case Type::FunctionProto:
8780 S += '?';
8781 return;
8782
8783 case Type::Record: {
8784 RecordDecl *RDecl = cast<RecordType>(CT)->getDecl();
8785 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? '(' : '{';
8786 // Anonymous structures print as '?'
8787 if (const IdentifierInfo *II = RDecl->getIdentifier()) {
8788 S += II->getName();
8789 if (const auto *Spec = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RDecl)) {
8790 const TemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
8791 llvm::raw_string_ostream OS(S);
8792 printTemplateArgumentList(OS, TemplateArgs.asArray(),
8793 getPrintingPolicy());
8794 }
8795 } else {
8796 S += '?';
8797 }
8798 if (Options.ExpandStructures()) {
8799 S += '=';
8800 if (!RDecl->isUnion()) {
8801 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RDecl, S, FD, true, NotEncodedT);
8802 } else {
8803 for (const auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) {
8804 if (FD) {
8805 S += '"';
8806 S += Field->getNameAsString();
8807 S += '"';
8808 }
8809
8810 // Special case bit-fields.
8811 if (Field->isBitField()) {
8812 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S,
8813 ObjCEncOptions().setExpandStructures(),
8814 Field);
8815 } else {
8816 QualType qt = Field->getType();
8817 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
8818 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
8819 qt, S,
8820 ObjCEncOptions().setExpandStructures().setIsStructField(), FD,
8821 NotEncodedT);
8822 }
8823 }
8824 }
8825 }
8826 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? ')' : '}';
8827 return;
8828 }
8829
8830 case Type::BlockPointer: {
8831 const auto *BT = T->castAs<BlockPointerType>();
8832 S += "@?"; // Unlike a pointer-to-function, which is "^?".
8833 if (Options.EncodeBlockParameters()) {
8834 const auto *FT = BT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
8835
8836 S += '<';
8837 // Block return type
8838 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(FT->getReturnType(), S,
8839 Options.forComponentType(), FD, NotEncodedT);
8840 // Block self
8841 S += "@?";
8842 // Block parameters
8843 if (const auto *FPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
8844 for (const auto &I : FPT->param_types())
8845 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(I, S, Options.forComponentType(), FD,
8846 NotEncodedT);
8847 }
8848 S += '>';
8849 }
8850 return;
8851 }
8852
8853 case Type::ObjCObject: {
8854 // hack to match legacy encoding of *id and *Class
8855 QualType Ty = getObjCObjectPointerType(CT);
8856 if (Ty->isObjCIdType()) {
8857 S += "{objc_object=}";
8858 return;
8859 }
8860 else if (Ty->isObjCClassType()) {
8861 S += "{objc_class=}";
8862 return;
8863 }
8864 // TODO: Double check to make sure this intentionally falls through.
8865 [[fallthrough]];
8866 }
8867
8868 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
8869 // Ignore protocol qualifiers when mangling at this level.
8870 // @encode(class_name)
8871 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = T->castAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
8872 S += '{';
8873 S += OI->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
8874 if (Options.ExpandStructures()) {
8875 S += '=';
8876 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
8877 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
8878 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
8879 const FieldDecl *Field = Ivars[i];
8880 if (Field->isBitField())
8881 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S,
8882 ObjCEncOptions().setExpandStructures(),
8883 Field);
8884 else
8885 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S,
8886 ObjCEncOptions().setExpandStructures(), FD,
8887 NotEncodedT);
8888 }
8889 }
8890 S += '}';
8891 return;
8892 }
8893
8894 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
8895 const auto *OPT = T->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
8896 if (OPT->isObjCIdType()) {
8897 S += '@';
8898 return;
8899 }
8900
8901 if (OPT->isObjCClassType() || OPT->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) {
8902 // FIXME: Consider if we need to output qualifiers for 'Class<p>'.
8903 // Since this is a binary compatibility issue, need to consult with
8904 // runtime folks. Fortunately, this is a *very* obscure construct.
8905 S += '#';
8906 return;
8907 }
8908
8909 if (OPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
8910 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
8911 getObjCIdType(), S,
8912 Options.keepingOnly(ObjCEncOptions()
8913 .setExpandPointedToStructures()
8914 .setExpandStructures()),
8915 FD);
8916 if (FD || Options.EncodingProperty() || Options.EncodeClassNames()) {
8917 // Note that we do extended encoding of protocol qualifier list
8918 // Only when doing ivar or property encoding.
8919 S += '"';
8920 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
8921 S += '<';
8922 S += I->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
8923 S += '>';
8924 }
8925 S += '"';
8926 }
8927 return;
8928 }
8929
8930 S += '@';
8931 if (OPT->getInterfaceDecl() &&
8932 (FD || Options.EncodingProperty() || Options.EncodeClassNames())) {
8933 S += '"';
8934 S += OPT->getInterfaceDecl()->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
8935 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
8936 S += '<';
8937 S += I->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
8938 S += '>';
8939 }
8940 S += '"';
8941 }
8942 return;
8943 }
8944
8945 // gcc just blithely ignores member pointers.
8946 // FIXME: we should do better than that. 'M' is available.
8947 case Type::MemberPointer:
8948 // This matches gcc's encoding, even though technically it is insufficient.
8949 //FIXME. We should do a better job than gcc.
8950 case Type::Vector:
8951 case Type::ExtVector:
8952 // Until we have a coherent encoding of these three types, issue warning.
8953 if (NotEncodedT)
8954 *NotEncodedT = T;
8955 return;
8956
8957 case Type::ConstantMatrix:
8958 if (NotEncodedT)
8959 *NotEncodedT = T;
8960 return;
8961
8962 case Type::BitInt:
8963 if (NotEncodedT)
8964 *NotEncodedT = T;
8965 return;
8966
8967 // We could see an undeduced auto type here during error recovery.
8968 // Just ignore it.
8969 case Type::Auto:
8970 case Type::DeducedTemplateSpecialization:
8971 return;
8972
8973 case Type::ArrayParameter:
8974 case Type::Pipe:
8975 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(KIND, BASE)
8976 #define TYPE(KIND, BASE)
8977 #define DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
8978 case Type::KIND:
8979 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
8980 case Type::KIND:
8981 #define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
8982 case Type::KIND:
8983 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.inc"
8984 llvm_unreachable("@encode for dependent type!");
8985 }
8986 llvm_unreachable("bad type kind!");
8987 }
8988
getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RecordDecl * RDecl,std::string & S,const FieldDecl * FD,bool includeVBases,QualType * NotEncodedT) const8989 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RecordDecl *RDecl,
8990 std::string &S,
8991 const FieldDecl *FD,
8992 bool includeVBases,
8993 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
8994 assert(RDecl && "Expected non-null RecordDecl");
8995 assert(!RDecl->isUnion() && "Should not be called for unions");
8996 if (!RDecl->getDefinition() || RDecl->getDefinition()->isInvalidDecl())
8997 return;
8998
8999 const auto *CXXRec = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RDecl);
9000 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *> FieldOrBaseOffsets;
9001 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RDecl);
9002
9003 if (CXXRec) {
9004 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->bases()) {
9005 if (!BI.isVirtual()) {
9006 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
9007 if (base->isEmpty())
9008 continue;
9009 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getBaseClassOffset(base));
9010 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
9011 std::make_pair(offs, base));
9012 }
9013 }
9014 }
9015
9016 for (FieldDecl *Field : RDecl->fields()) {
9017 if (!Field->isZeroLengthBitField(*this) && Field->isZeroSize(*this))
9018 continue;
9019 uint64_t offs = layout.getFieldOffset(Field->getFieldIndex());
9020 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
9021 std::make_pair(offs, Field));
9022 }
9023
9024 if (CXXRec && includeVBases) {
9025 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->vbases()) {
9026 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
9027 if (base->isEmpty())
9028 continue;
9029 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getVBaseClassOffset(base));
9030 if (offs >= uint64_t(toBits(layout.getNonVirtualSize())) &&
9031 FieldOrBaseOffsets.find(offs) == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end())
9032 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(),
9033 std::make_pair(offs, base));
9034 }
9035 }
9036
9037 CharUnits size;
9038 if (CXXRec) {
9039 size = includeVBases ? layout.getSize() : layout.getNonVirtualSize();
9040 } else {
9041 size = layout.getSize();
9042 }
9043
9044 #ifndef NDEBUG
9045 uint64_t CurOffs = 0;
9046 #endif
9047 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *>::iterator
9048 CurLayObj = FieldOrBaseOffsets.begin();
9049
9050 if (CXXRec && CXXRec->isDynamicClass() &&
9051 (CurLayObj == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end() || CurLayObj->first != 0)) {
9052 if (FD) {
9053 S += "\"_vptr$";
9054 std::string recname = CXXRec->getNameAsString();
9055 if (recname.empty()) recname = "?";
9056 S += recname;
9057 S += '"';
9058 }
9059 S += "^^?";
9060 #ifndef NDEBUG
9061 CurOffs += getTypeSize(VoidPtrTy);
9062 #endif
9063 }
9064
9065 if (!RDecl->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) {
9066 // Mark the end of the structure.
9067 uint64_t offs = toBits(size);
9068 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
9069 std::make_pair(offs, nullptr));
9070 }
9071
9072 for (; CurLayObj != FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(); ++CurLayObj) {
9073 #ifndef NDEBUG
9074 assert(CurOffs <= CurLayObj->first);
9075 if (CurOffs < CurLayObj->first) {
9076 uint64_t padding = CurLayObj->first - CurOffs;
9077 // FIXME: There doesn't seem to be a way to indicate in the encoding that
9078 // packing/alignment of members is different that normal, in which case
9079 // the encoding will be out-of-sync with the real layout.
9080 // If the runtime switches to just consider the size of types without
9081 // taking into account alignment, we could make padding explicit in the
9082 // encoding (e.g. using arrays of chars). The encoding strings would be
9083 // longer then though.
9084 CurOffs += padding;
9085 }
9086 #endif
9087
9088 NamedDecl *dcl = CurLayObj->second;
9089 if (!dcl)
9090 break; // reached end of structure.
9091
9092 if (auto *base = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(dcl)) {
9093 // We expand the bases without their virtual bases since those are going
9094 // in the initial structure. Note that this differs from gcc which
9095 // expands virtual bases each time one is encountered in the hierarchy,
9096 // making the encoding type bigger than it really is.
9097 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(base, S, FD, /*includeVBases*/false,
9098 NotEncodedT);
9099 assert(!base->isEmpty());
9100 #ifndef NDEBUG
9101 CurOffs += toBits(getASTRecordLayout(base).getNonVirtualSize());
9102 #endif
9103 } else {
9104 const auto *field = cast<FieldDecl>(dcl);
9105 if (FD) {
9106 S += '"';
9107 S += field->getNameAsString();
9108 S += '"';
9109 }
9110
9111 if (field->isBitField()) {
9112 EncodeBitField(this, S, field->getType(), field);
9113 #ifndef NDEBUG
9114 CurOffs += field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
9115 #endif
9116 } else {
9117 QualType qt = field->getType();
9118 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
9119 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
9120 qt, S, ObjCEncOptions().setExpandStructures().setIsStructField(),
9121 FD, NotEncodedT);
9122 #ifndef NDEBUG
9123 CurOffs += getTypeSize(field->getType());
9124 #endif
9125 }
9126 }
9127 }
9128 }
9129
getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,std::string & S) const9130 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
9131 std::string& S) const {
9132 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_In)
9133 S += 'n';
9134 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Inout)
9135 S += 'N';
9136 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Out)
9137 S += 'o';
9138 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Bycopy)
9139 S += 'O';
9140 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Byref)
9141 S += 'R';
9142 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Oneway)
9143 S += 'V';
9144 }
9145
getObjCIdDecl() const9146 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCIdDecl() const {
9147 if (!ObjCIdDecl) {
9148 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, {}, {});
9149 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
9150 ObjCIdDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "id");
9151 }
9152 return ObjCIdDecl;
9153 }
9154
getObjCSelDecl() const9155 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCSelDecl() const {
9156 if (!ObjCSelDecl) {
9157 QualType T = getPointerType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy);
9158 ObjCSelDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "SEL");
9159 }
9160 return ObjCSelDecl;
9161 }
9162
getObjCClassDecl() const9163 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCClassDecl() const {
9164 if (!ObjCClassDecl) {
9165 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, {}, {});
9166 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
9167 ObjCClassDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "Class");
9168 }
9169 return ObjCClassDecl;
9170 }
9171
getObjCProtocolDecl() const9172 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjCProtocolDecl() const {
9173 if (!ObjCProtocolClassDecl) {
9174 ObjCProtocolClassDecl
9175 = ObjCInterfaceDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
9176 SourceLocation(),
9177 &Idents.get("Protocol"),
9178 /*typeParamList=*/nullptr,
9179 /*PrevDecl=*/nullptr,
9180 SourceLocation(), true);
9181 }
9182
9183 return ObjCProtocolClassDecl;
9184 }
9185
9186 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9187 // __builtin_va_list Construction Functions
9188 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9189
CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(const ASTContext * Context,StringRef Name)9190 static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context,
9191 StringRef Name) {
9192 // typedef char* __builtin[_ms]_va_list;
9193 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->CharTy);
9194 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, Name);
9195 }
9196
CreateMSVaListDecl(const ASTContext * Context)9197 static TypedefDecl *CreateMSVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
9198 return CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(Context, "__builtin_ms_va_list");
9199 }
9200
CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext * Context)9201 static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
9202 return CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(Context, "__builtin_va_list");
9203 }
9204
CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext * Context)9205 static TypedefDecl *CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
9206 // typedef void* __builtin_va_list;
9207 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
9208 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
9209 }
9210
9211 static TypedefDecl *
CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext * Context)9212 CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
9213 // struct __va_list
9214 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
9215 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
9216 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
9217 auto *NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(
9218 const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context), Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
9219 /*Inline=*/false, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
9220 &Context->Idents.get("std"),
9221 /*PrevDecl=*/nullptr, /*Nested=*/false);
9222 NS->setImplicit();
9223 VaListTagDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
9224 }
9225
9226 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
9227
9228 const size_t NumFields = 5;
9229 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
9230 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
9231
9232 // void *__stack;
9233 FieldTypes[0] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
9234 FieldNames[0] = "__stack";
9235
9236 // void *__gr_top;
9237 FieldTypes[1] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
9238 FieldNames[1] = "__gr_top";
9239
9240 // void *__vr_top;
9241 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
9242 FieldNames[2] = "__vr_top";
9243
9244 // int __gr_offs;
9245 FieldTypes[3] = Context->IntTy;
9246 FieldNames[3] = "__gr_offs";
9247
9248 // int __vr_offs;
9249 FieldTypes[4] = Context->IntTy;
9250 FieldNames[4] = "__vr_offs";
9251
9252 // Create fields
9253 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
9254 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
9255 VaListTagDecl,
9256 SourceLocation(),
9257 SourceLocation(),
9258 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
9259 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
9260 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
9261 /*Mutable=*/false,
9262 ICIS_NoInit);
9263 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
9264 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
9265 }
9266 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
9267 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
9268 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
9269
9270 // } __builtin_va_list;
9271 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__builtin_va_list");
9272 }
9273
CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext * Context)9274 static TypedefDecl *CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
9275 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
9276 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
9277
9278 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
9279 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
9280
9281 const size_t NumFields = 5;
9282 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
9283 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
9284
9285 // unsigned char gpr;
9286 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
9287 FieldNames[0] = "gpr";
9288
9289 // unsigned char fpr;
9290 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
9291 FieldNames[1] = "fpr";
9292
9293 // unsigned short reserved;
9294 FieldTypes[2] = Context->UnsignedShortTy;
9295 FieldNames[2] = "reserved";
9296
9297 // void* overflow_arg_area;
9298 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
9299 FieldNames[3] = "overflow_arg_area";
9300
9301 // void* reg_save_area;
9302 FieldTypes[4] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
9303 FieldNames[4] = "reg_save_area";
9304
9305 // Create fields
9306 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
9307 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*Context, VaListTagDecl,
9308 SourceLocation(),
9309 SourceLocation(),
9310 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
9311 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
9312 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
9313 /*Mutable=*/false,
9314 ICIS_NoInit);
9315 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
9316 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
9317 }
9318 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
9319 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
9320 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
9321
9322 // } __va_list_tag;
9323 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
9324 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
9325
9326 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
9327 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
9328
9329 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
9330 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
9331 QualType VaListTagArrayType = Context->getConstantArrayType(
9332 VaListTagTypedefType, Size, nullptr, ArraySizeModifier::Normal, 0);
9333 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
9334 }
9335
9336 static TypedefDecl *
CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext * Context)9337 CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
9338 // struct __va_list_tag {
9339 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
9340 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
9341 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
9342
9343 const size_t NumFields = 4;
9344 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
9345 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
9346
9347 // unsigned gp_offset;
9348 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
9349 FieldNames[0] = "gp_offset";
9350
9351 // unsigned fp_offset;
9352 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
9353 FieldNames[1] = "fp_offset";
9354
9355 // void* overflow_arg_area;
9356 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
9357 FieldNames[2] = "overflow_arg_area";
9358
9359 // void* reg_save_area;
9360 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
9361 FieldNames[3] = "reg_save_area";
9362
9363 // Create fields
9364 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
9365 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
9366 VaListTagDecl,
9367 SourceLocation(),
9368 SourceLocation(),
9369 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
9370 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
9371 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
9372 /*Mutable=*/false,
9373 ICIS_NoInit);
9374 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
9375 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
9376 }
9377 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
9378 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
9379 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
9380
9381 // };
9382
9383 // typedef struct __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
9384 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
9385 QualType VaListTagArrayType = Context->getConstantArrayType(
9386 VaListTagType, Size, nullptr, ArraySizeModifier::Normal, 0);
9387 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
9388 }
9389
CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext * Context)9390 static TypedefDecl *CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
9391 // typedef int __builtin_va_list[4];
9392 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 4);
9393 QualType IntArrayType = Context->getConstantArrayType(
9394 Context->IntTy, Size, nullptr, ArraySizeModifier::Normal, 0);
9395 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(IntArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
9396 }
9397
9398 static TypedefDecl *
CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext * Context)9399 CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
9400 // struct __va_list
9401 RecordDecl *VaListDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
9402 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
9403 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
9404 NamespaceDecl *NS;
9405 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
9406 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
9407 /*Inline=*/false, SourceLocation(),
9408 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
9409 /*PrevDecl=*/nullptr, /*Nested=*/false);
9410 NS->setImplicit();
9411 VaListDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
9412 }
9413
9414 VaListDecl->startDefinition();
9415
9416 // void * __ap;
9417 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
9418 VaListDecl,
9419 SourceLocation(),
9420 SourceLocation(),
9421 &Context->Idents.get("__ap"),
9422 Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy),
9423 /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
9424 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
9425 /*Mutable=*/false,
9426 ICIS_NoInit);
9427 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
9428 VaListDecl->addDecl(Field);
9429
9430 // };
9431 VaListDecl->completeDefinition();
9432 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListDecl;
9433
9434 // typedef struct __va_list __builtin_va_list;
9435 QualType T = Context->getRecordType(VaListDecl);
9436 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
9437 }
9438
9439 static TypedefDecl *
CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext * Context)9440 CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
9441 // struct __va_list_tag {
9442 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
9443 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
9444 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
9445
9446 const size_t NumFields = 4;
9447 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
9448 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
9449
9450 // long __gpr;
9451 FieldTypes[0] = Context->LongTy;
9452 FieldNames[0] = "__gpr";
9453
9454 // long __fpr;
9455 FieldTypes[1] = Context->LongTy;
9456 FieldNames[1] = "__fpr";
9457
9458 // void *__overflow_arg_area;
9459 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
9460 FieldNames[2] = "__overflow_arg_area";
9461
9462 // void *__reg_save_area;
9463 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
9464 FieldNames[3] = "__reg_save_area";
9465
9466 // Create fields
9467 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
9468 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
9469 VaListTagDecl,
9470 SourceLocation(),
9471 SourceLocation(),
9472 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
9473 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
9474 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
9475 /*Mutable=*/false,
9476 ICIS_NoInit);
9477 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
9478 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
9479 }
9480 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
9481 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
9482 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
9483
9484 // };
9485
9486 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
9487 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
9488 QualType VaListTagArrayType = Context->getConstantArrayType(
9489 VaListTagType, Size, nullptr, ArraySizeModifier::Normal, 0);
9490
9491 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
9492 }
9493
CreateHexagonBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext * Context)9494 static TypedefDecl *CreateHexagonBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
9495 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
9496 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
9497 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
9498 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
9499
9500 const size_t NumFields = 3;
9501 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
9502 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
9503
9504 // void *CurrentSavedRegisterArea;
9505 FieldTypes[0] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
9506 FieldNames[0] = "__current_saved_reg_area_pointer";
9507
9508 // void *SavedRegAreaEnd;
9509 FieldTypes[1] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
9510 FieldNames[1] = "__saved_reg_area_end_pointer";
9511
9512 // void *OverflowArea;
9513 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
9514 FieldNames[2] = "__overflow_area_pointer";
9515
9516 // Create fields
9517 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
9518 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
9519 const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context), VaListTagDecl, SourceLocation(),
9520 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i],
9521 /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
9522 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
9523 /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
9524 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
9525 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
9526 }
9527 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
9528 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
9529 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
9530
9531 // } __va_list_tag;
9532 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
9533 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
9534
9535 QualType VaListTagTypedefType = Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
9536
9537 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
9538 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
9539 QualType VaListTagArrayType = Context->getConstantArrayType(
9540 VaListTagTypedefType, Size, nullptr, ArraySizeModifier::Normal, 0);
9541
9542 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
9543 }
9544
CreateVaListDecl(const ASTContext * Context,TargetInfo::BuiltinVaListKind Kind)9545 static TypedefDecl *CreateVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context,
9546 TargetInfo::BuiltinVaListKind Kind) {
9547 switch (Kind) {
9548 case TargetInfo::CharPtrBuiltinVaList:
9549 return CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
9550 case TargetInfo::VoidPtrBuiltinVaList:
9551 return CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
9552 case TargetInfo::AArch64ABIBuiltinVaList:
9553 return CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
9554 case TargetInfo::PowerABIBuiltinVaList:
9555 return CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
9556 case TargetInfo::X86_64ABIBuiltinVaList:
9557 return CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
9558 case TargetInfo::PNaClABIBuiltinVaList:
9559 return CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
9560 case TargetInfo::AAPCSABIBuiltinVaList:
9561 return CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
9562 case TargetInfo::SystemZBuiltinVaList:
9563 return CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
9564 case TargetInfo::HexagonBuiltinVaList:
9565 return CreateHexagonBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
9566 }
9567
9568 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled __builtin_va_list type kind");
9569 }
9570
getBuiltinVaListDecl() const9571 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinVaListDecl() const {
9572 if (!BuiltinVaListDecl) {
9573 BuiltinVaListDecl = CreateVaListDecl(this, Target->getBuiltinVaListKind());
9574 assert(BuiltinVaListDecl->isImplicit());
9575 }
9576
9577 return BuiltinVaListDecl;
9578 }
9579
getVaListTagDecl() const9580 Decl *ASTContext::getVaListTagDecl() const {
9581 // Force the creation of VaListTagDecl by building the __builtin_va_list
9582 // declaration.
9583 if (!VaListTagDecl)
9584 (void)getBuiltinVaListDecl();
9585
9586 return VaListTagDecl;
9587 }
9588
getBuiltinMSVaListDecl() const9589 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinMSVaListDecl() const {
9590 if (!BuiltinMSVaListDecl)
9591 BuiltinMSVaListDecl = CreateMSVaListDecl(this);
9592
9593 return BuiltinMSVaListDecl;
9594 }
9595
canBuiltinBeRedeclared(const FunctionDecl * FD) const9596 bool ASTContext::canBuiltinBeRedeclared(const FunctionDecl *FD) const {
9597 // Allow redecl custom type checking builtin for HLSL.
9598 if (LangOpts.HLSL && FD->getBuiltinID() != Builtin::NotBuiltin &&
9599 BuiltinInfo.hasCustomTypechecking(FD->getBuiltinID()))
9600 return true;
9601 return BuiltinInfo.canBeRedeclared(FD->getBuiltinID());
9602 }
9603
setObjCConstantStringInterface(ObjCInterfaceDecl * Decl)9604 void ASTContext::setObjCConstantStringInterface(ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl) {
9605 assert(ObjCConstantStringType.isNull() &&
9606 "'NSConstantString' type already set!");
9607
9608 ObjCConstantStringType = getObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
9609 }
9610
9611 /// Retrieve the template name that corresponds to a non-empty
9612 /// lookup.
9613 TemplateName
getOverloadedTemplateName(UnresolvedSetIterator Begin,UnresolvedSetIterator End) const9614 ASTContext::getOverloadedTemplateName(UnresolvedSetIterator Begin,
9615 UnresolvedSetIterator End) const {
9616 unsigned size = End - Begin;
9617 assert(size > 1 && "set is not overloaded!");
9618
9619 void *memory = Allocate(sizeof(OverloadedTemplateStorage) +
9620 size * sizeof(FunctionTemplateDecl*));
9621 auto *OT = new (memory) OverloadedTemplateStorage(size);
9622
9623 NamedDecl **Storage = OT->getStorage();
9624 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = Begin; I != End; ++I) {
9625 NamedDecl *D = *I;
9626 assert(isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) ||
9627 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(D) ||
9628 (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D) &&
9629 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D->getUnderlyingDecl())));
9630 *Storage++ = D;
9631 }
9632
9633 return TemplateName(OT);
9634 }
9635
9636 /// Retrieve a template name representing an unqualified-id that has been
9637 /// assumed to name a template for ADL purposes.
getAssumedTemplateName(DeclarationName Name) const9638 TemplateName ASTContext::getAssumedTemplateName(DeclarationName Name) const {
9639 auto *OT = new (*this) AssumedTemplateStorage(Name);
9640 return TemplateName(OT);
9641 }
9642
9643 /// Retrieve the template name that represents a qualified
9644 /// template name such as \c std::vector.
getQualifiedTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier * NNS,bool TemplateKeyword,TemplateName Template) const9645 TemplateName ASTContext::getQualifiedTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
9646 bool TemplateKeyword,
9647 TemplateName Template) const {
9648 assert(Template.getKind() == TemplateName::Template ||
9649 Template.getKind() == TemplateName::UsingTemplate);
9650
9651 // FIXME: Canonicalization?
9652 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
9653 QualifiedTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
9654
9655 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
9656 QualifiedTemplateName *QTN =
9657 QualifiedTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
9658 if (!QTN) {
9659 QTN = new (*this, alignof(QualifiedTemplateName))
9660 QualifiedTemplateName(NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
9661 QualifiedTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
9662 }
9663
9664 return TemplateName(QTN);
9665 }
9666
9667 /// Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
9668 /// template name such as \c MetaFun::template apply.
9669 TemplateName
getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier * NNS,const IdentifierInfo * Name) const9670 ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
9671 const IdentifierInfo *Name) const {
9672 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
9673 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
9674
9675 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
9676 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Name);
9677
9678 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
9679 DependentTemplateName *QTN =
9680 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
9681
9682 if (QTN)
9683 return TemplateName(QTN);
9684
9685 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
9686 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
9687 QTN = new (*this, alignof(DependentTemplateName))
9688 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name);
9689 } else {
9690 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Name);
9691 QTN = new (*this, alignof(DependentTemplateName))
9692 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name, Canon);
9693 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN =
9694 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
9695 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent type name canonicalization broken");
9696 (void)CheckQTN;
9697 }
9698
9699 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
9700 return TemplateName(QTN);
9701 }
9702
9703 /// Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
9704 /// template name such as \c MetaFun::template operator+.
9705 TemplateName
getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier * NNS,OverloadedOperatorKind Operator) const9706 ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
9707 OverloadedOperatorKind Operator) const {
9708 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
9709 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
9710
9711 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
9712 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Operator);
9713
9714 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
9715 DependentTemplateName *QTN
9716 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
9717
9718 if (QTN)
9719 return TemplateName(QTN);
9720
9721 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
9722 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
9723 QTN = new (*this, alignof(DependentTemplateName))
9724 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator);
9725 } else {
9726 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Operator);
9727 QTN = new (*this, alignof(DependentTemplateName))
9728 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator, Canon);
9729
9730 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN
9731 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
9732 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent template name canonicalization broken");
9733 (void)CheckQTN;
9734 }
9735
9736 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
9737 return TemplateName(QTN);
9738 }
9739
getSubstTemplateTemplateParm(TemplateName Replacement,Decl * AssociatedDecl,unsigned Index,std::optional<unsigned> PackIndex) const9740 TemplateName ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParm(
9741 TemplateName Replacement, Decl *AssociatedDecl, unsigned Index,
9742 std::optional<unsigned> PackIndex) const {
9743 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
9744 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage::Profile(ID, Replacement, AssociatedDecl,
9745 Index, PackIndex);
9746
9747 void *insertPos = nullptr;
9748 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
9749 = SubstTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
9750
9751 if (!subst) {
9752 subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage(
9753 Replacement, AssociatedDecl, Index, PackIndex);
9754 SubstTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(subst, insertPos);
9755 }
9756
9757 return TemplateName(subst);
9758 }
9759
9760 TemplateName
getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(const TemplateArgument & ArgPack,Decl * AssociatedDecl,unsigned Index,bool Final) const9761 ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(const TemplateArgument &ArgPack,
9762 Decl *AssociatedDecl,
9763 unsigned Index, bool Final) const {
9764 auto &Self = const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this);
9765 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
9766 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage::Profile(ID, Self, ArgPack,
9767 AssociatedDecl, Index, Final);
9768
9769 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
9770 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *Subst
9771 = SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
9772
9773 if (!Subst) {
9774 Subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage(
9775 ArgPack.pack_elements(), AssociatedDecl, Index, Final);
9776 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.InsertNode(Subst, InsertPos);
9777 }
9778
9779 return TemplateName(Subst);
9780 }
9781
9782 /// getFromTargetType - Given one of the integer types provided by
9783 /// TargetInfo, produce the corresponding type. The unsigned @p Type
9784 /// is actually a value of type @c TargetInfo::IntType.
getFromTargetType(unsigned Type) const9785 CanQualType ASTContext::getFromTargetType(unsigned Type) const {
9786 switch (Type) {
9787 case TargetInfo::NoInt: return {};
9788 case TargetInfo::SignedChar: return SignedCharTy;
9789 case TargetInfo::UnsignedChar: return UnsignedCharTy;
9790 case TargetInfo::SignedShort: return ShortTy;
9791 case TargetInfo::UnsignedShort: return UnsignedShortTy;
9792 case TargetInfo::SignedInt: return IntTy;
9793 case TargetInfo::UnsignedInt: return UnsignedIntTy;
9794 case TargetInfo::SignedLong: return LongTy;
9795 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLong: return UnsignedLongTy;
9796 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong: return LongLongTy;
9797 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLongLong: return UnsignedLongLongTy;
9798 }
9799
9800 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::IntType value");
9801 }
9802
9803 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9804 // Type Predicates.
9805 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9806
9807 /// getObjCGCAttr - Returns one of GCNone, Weak or Strong objc's
9808 /// garbage collection attribute.
9809 ///
getObjCGCAttrKind(QualType Ty) const9810 Qualifiers::GC ASTContext::getObjCGCAttrKind(QualType Ty) const {
9811 if (getLangOpts().getGC() == LangOptions::NonGC)
9812 return Qualifiers::GCNone;
9813
9814 assert(getLangOpts().ObjC);
9815 Qualifiers::GC GCAttrs = Ty.getObjCGCAttr();
9816
9817 // Default behaviour under objective-C's gc is for ObjC pointers
9818 // (or pointers to them) be treated as though they were declared
9819 // as __strong.
9820 if (GCAttrs == Qualifiers::GCNone) {
9821 if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
9822 return Qualifiers::Strong;
9823 else if (Ty->isPointerType())
9824 return getObjCGCAttrKind(Ty->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
9825 } else {
9826 // It's not valid to set GC attributes on anything that isn't a
9827 // pointer.
9828 #ifndef NDEBUG
9829 QualType CT = Ty->getCanonicalTypeInternal();
9830 while (const auto *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CT))
9831 CT = AT->getElementType();
9832 assert(CT->isAnyPointerType() || CT->isBlockPointerType());
9833 #endif
9834 }
9835 return GCAttrs;
9836 }
9837
9838 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9839 // Type Compatibility Testing
9840 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9841
9842 /// areCompatVectorTypes - Return true if the two specified vector types are
9843 /// compatible.
areCompatVectorTypes(const VectorType * LHS,const VectorType * RHS)9844 static bool areCompatVectorTypes(const VectorType *LHS,
9845 const VectorType *RHS) {
9846 assert(LHS->isCanonicalUnqualified() && RHS->isCanonicalUnqualified());
9847 return LHS->getElementType() == RHS->getElementType() &&
9848 LHS->getNumElements() == RHS->getNumElements();
9849 }
9850
9851 /// areCompatMatrixTypes - Return true if the two specified matrix types are
9852 /// compatible.
areCompatMatrixTypes(const ConstantMatrixType * LHS,const ConstantMatrixType * RHS)9853 static bool areCompatMatrixTypes(const ConstantMatrixType *LHS,
9854 const ConstantMatrixType *RHS) {
9855 assert(LHS->isCanonicalUnqualified() && RHS->isCanonicalUnqualified());
9856 return LHS->getElementType() == RHS->getElementType() &&
9857 LHS->getNumRows() == RHS->getNumRows() &&
9858 LHS->getNumColumns() == RHS->getNumColumns();
9859 }
9860
areCompatibleVectorTypes(QualType FirstVec,QualType SecondVec)9861 bool ASTContext::areCompatibleVectorTypes(QualType FirstVec,
9862 QualType SecondVec) {
9863 assert(FirstVec->isVectorType() && "FirstVec should be a vector type");
9864 assert(SecondVec->isVectorType() && "SecondVec should be a vector type");
9865
9866 if (hasSameUnqualifiedType(FirstVec, SecondVec))
9867 return true;
9868
9869 // Treat Neon vector types and most AltiVec vector types as if they are the
9870 // equivalent GCC vector types.
9871 const auto *First = FirstVec->castAs<VectorType>();
9872 const auto *Second = SecondVec->castAs<VectorType>();
9873 if (First->getNumElements() == Second->getNumElements() &&
9874 hasSameType(First->getElementType(), Second->getElementType()) &&
9875 First->getVectorKind() != VectorKind::AltiVecPixel &&
9876 First->getVectorKind() != VectorKind::AltiVecBool &&
9877 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorKind::AltiVecPixel &&
9878 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorKind::AltiVecBool &&
9879 First->getVectorKind() != VectorKind::SveFixedLengthData &&
9880 First->getVectorKind() != VectorKind::SveFixedLengthPredicate &&
9881 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorKind::SveFixedLengthData &&
9882 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorKind::SveFixedLengthPredicate &&
9883 First->getVectorKind() != VectorKind::RVVFixedLengthData &&
9884 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorKind::RVVFixedLengthData &&
9885 First->getVectorKind() != VectorKind::RVVFixedLengthMask &&
9886 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorKind::RVVFixedLengthMask)
9887 return true;
9888
9889 return false;
9890 }
9891
9892 /// getSVETypeSize - Return SVE vector or predicate register size.
getSVETypeSize(ASTContext & Context,const BuiltinType * Ty)9893 static uint64_t getSVETypeSize(ASTContext &Context, const BuiltinType *Ty) {
9894 assert(Ty->isSveVLSBuiltinType() && "Invalid SVE Type");
9895 if (Ty->getKind() == BuiltinType::SveBool ||
9896 Ty->getKind() == BuiltinType::SveCount)
9897 return (Context.getLangOpts().VScaleMin * 128) / Context.getCharWidth();
9898 return Context.getLangOpts().VScaleMin * 128;
9899 }
9900
areCompatibleSveTypes(QualType FirstType,QualType SecondType)9901 bool ASTContext::areCompatibleSveTypes(QualType FirstType,
9902 QualType SecondType) {
9903 auto IsValidCast = [this](QualType FirstType, QualType SecondType) {
9904 if (const auto *BT = FirstType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
9905 if (const auto *VT = SecondType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
9906 // Predicates have the same representation as uint8 so we also have to
9907 // check the kind to make these types incompatible.
9908 if (VT->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::SveFixedLengthPredicate)
9909 return BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::SveBool;
9910 else if (VT->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::SveFixedLengthData)
9911 return VT->getElementType().getCanonicalType() ==
9912 FirstType->getSveEltType(*this);
9913 else if (VT->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::Generic)
9914 return getTypeSize(SecondType) == getSVETypeSize(*this, BT) &&
9915 hasSameType(VT->getElementType(),
9916 getBuiltinVectorTypeInfo(BT).ElementType);
9917 }
9918 }
9919 return false;
9920 };
9921
9922 return IsValidCast(FirstType, SecondType) ||
9923 IsValidCast(SecondType, FirstType);
9924 }
9925
areLaxCompatibleSveTypes(QualType FirstType,QualType SecondType)9926 bool ASTContext::areLaxCompatibleSveTypes(QualType FirstType,
9927 QualType SecondType) {
9928 auto IsLaxCompatible = [this](QualType FirstType, QualType SecondType) {
9929 const auto *BT = FirstType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
9930 if (!BT)
9931 return false;
9932
9933 const auto *VecTy = SecondType->getAs<VectorType>();
9934 if (VecTy && (VecTy->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::SveFixedLengthData ||
9935 VecTy->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::Generic)) {
9936 const LangOptions::LaxVectorConversionKind LVCKind =
9937 getLangOpts().getLaxVectorConversions();
9938
9939 // Can not convert between sve predicates and sve vectors because of
9940 // different size.
9941 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::SveBool &&
9942 VecTy->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::SveFixedLengthData)
9943 return false;
9944
9945 // If __ARM_FEATURE_SVE_BITS != N do not allow GNU vector lax conversion.
9946 // "Whenever __ARM_FEATURE_SVE_BITS==N, GNUT implicitly
9947 // converts to VLAT and VLAT implicitly converts to GNUT."
9948 // ACLE Spec Version 00bet6, 3.7.3.2. Behavior common to vectors and
9949 // predicates.
9950 if (VecTy->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::Generic &&
9951 getTypeSize(SecondType) != getSVETypeSize(*this, BT))
9952 return false;
9953
9954 // If -flax-vector-conversions=all is specified, the types are
9955 // certainly compatible.
9956 if (LVCKind == LangOptions::LaxVectorConversionKind::All)
9957 return true;
9958
9959 // If -flax-vector-conversions=integer is specified, the types are
9960 // compatible if the elements are integer types.
9961 if (LVCKind == LangOptions::LaxVectorConversionKind::Integer)
9962 return VecTy->getElementType().getCanonicalType()->isIntegerType() &&
9963 FirstType->getSveEltType(*this)->isIntegerType();
9964 }
9965
9966 return false;
9967 };
9968
9969 return IsLaxCompatible(FirstType, SecondType) ||
9970 IsLaxCompatible(SecondType, FirstType);
9971 }
9972
9973 /// getRVVTypeSize - Return RVV vector register size.
getRVVTypeSize(ASTContext & Context,const BuiltinType * Ty)9974 static uint64_t getRVVTypeSize(ASTContext &Context, const BuiltinType *Ty) {
9975 assert(Ty->isRVVVLSBuiltinType() && "Invalid RVV Type");
9976 auto VScale = Context.getTargetInfo().getVScaleRange(Context.getLangOpts());
9977 if (!VScale)
9978 return 0;
9979
9980 ASTContext::BuiltinVectorTypeInfo Info = Context.getBuiltinVectorTypeInfo(Ty);
9981
9982 uint64_t EltSize = Context.getTypeSize(Info.ElementType);
9983 if (Info.ElementType == Context.BoolTy)
9984 EltSize = 1;
9985
9986 uint64_t MinElts = Info.EC.getKnownMinValue();
9987 return VScale->first * MinElts * EltSize;
9988 }
9989
areCompatibleRVVTypes(QualType FirstType,QualType SecondType)9990 bool ASTContext::areCompatibleRVVTypes(QualType FirstType,
9991 QualType SecondType) {
9992 assert(
9993 ((FirstType->isRVVSizelessBuiltinType() && SecondType->isVectorType()) ||
9994 (FirstType->isVectorType() && SecondType->isRVVSizelessBuiltinType())) &&
9995 "Expected RVV builtin type and vector type!");
9996
9997 auto IsValidCast = [this](QualType FirstType, QualType SecondType) {
9998 if (const auto *BT = FirstType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
9999 if (const auto *VT = SecondType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
10000 if (VT->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::RVVFixedLengthMask) {
10001 BuiltinVectorTypeInfo Info = getBuiltinVectorTypeInfo(BT);
10002 return FirstType->isRVVVLSBuiltinType() &&
10003 Info.ElementType == BoolTy &&
10004 getTypeSize(SecondType) == getRVVTypeSize(*this, BT);
10005 }
10006 if (VT->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::RVVFixedLengthData ||
10007 VT->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::Generic)
10008 return FirstType->isRVVVLSBuiltinType() &&
10009 getTypeSize(SecondType) == getRVVTypeSize(*this, BT) &&
10010 hasSameType(VT->getElementType(),
10011 getBuiltinVectorTypeInfo(BT).ElementType);
10012 }
10013 }
10014 return false;
10015 };
10016
10017 return IsValidCast(FirstType, SecondType) ||
10018 IsValidCast(SecondType, FirstType);
10019 }
10020
areLaxCompatibleRVVTypes(QualType FirstType,QualType SecondType)10021 bool ASTContext::areLaxCompatibleRVVTypes(QualType FirstType,
10022 QualType SecondType) {
10023 assert(
10024 ((FirstType->isRVVSizelessBuiltinType() && SecondType->isVectorType()) ||
10025 (FirstType->isVectorType() && SecondType->isRVVSizelessBuiltinType())) &&
10026 "Expected RVV builtin type and vector type!");
10027
10028 auto IsLaxCompatible = [this](QualType FirstType, QualType SecondType) {
10029 const auto *BT = FirstType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
10030 if (!BT)
10031 return false;
10032
10033 if (!BT->isRVVVLSBuiltinType())
10034 return false;
10035
10036 const auto *VecTy = SecondType->getAs<VectorType>();
10037 if (VecTy && VecTy->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::Generic) {
10038 const LangOptions::LaxVectorConversionKind LVCKind =
10039 getLangOpts().getLaxVectorConversions();
10040
10041 // If __riscv_v_fixed_vlen != N do not allow vector lax conversion.
10042 if (getTypeSize(SecondType) != getRVVTypeSize(*this, BT))
10043 return false;
10044
10045 // If -flax-vector-conversions=all is specified, the types are
10046 // certainly compatible.
10047 if (LVCKind == LangOptions::LaxVectorConversionKind::All)
10048 return true;
10049
10050 // If -flax-vector-conversions=integer is specified, the types are
10051 // compatible if the elements are integer types.
10052 if (LVCKind == LangOptions::LaxVectorConversionKind::Integer)
10053 return VecTy->getElementType().getCanonicalType()->isIntegerType() &&
10054 FirstType->getRVVEltType(*this)->isIntegerType();
10055 }
10056
10057 return false;
10058 };
10059
10060 return IsLaxCompatible(FirstType, SecondType) ||
10061 IsLaxCompatible(SecondType, FirstType);
10062 }
10063
hasDirectOwnershipQualifier(QualType Ty) const10064 bool ASTContext::hasDirectOwnershipQualifier(QualType Ty) const {
10065 while (true) {
10066 // __strong id
10067 if (const AttributedType *Attr = dyn_cast<AttributedType>(Ty)) {
10068 if (Attr->getAttrKind() == attr::ObjCOwnership)
10069 return true;
10070
10071 Ty = Attr->getModifiedType();
10072
10073 // X *__strong (...)
10074 } else if (const ParenType *Paren = dyn_cast<ParenType>(Ty)) {
10075 Ty = Paren->getInnerType();
10076
10077 // We do not want to look through typedefs, typeof(expr),
10078 // typeof(type), or any other way that the type is somehow
10079 // abstracted.
10080 } else {
10081 return false;
10082 }
10083 }
10084 }
10085
10086 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
10087 // ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - Compatibility testing for qualified id's.
10088 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
10089
10090 /// ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol - return 'true' if 'lProto' is in the
10091 /// inheritance hierarchy of 'rProto'.
10092 bool
ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(ObjCProtocolDecl * lProto,ObjCProtocolDecl * rProto) const10093 ASTContext::ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(ObjCProtocolDecl *lProto,
10094 ObjCProtocolDecl *rProto) const {
10095 if (declaresSameEntity(lProto, rProto))
10096 return true;
10097 for (auto *PI : rProto->protocols())
10098 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lProto, PI))
10099 return true;
10100 return false;
10101 }
10102
10103 /// ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible - compare Class<pr,...> and
10104 /// Class<pr1, ...>.
ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(const ObjCObjectPointerType * lhs,const ObjCObjectPointerType * rhs)10105 bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(
10106 const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhs, const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhs) {
10107 for (auto *lhsProto : lhs->quals()) {
10108 bool match = false;
10109 for (auto *rhsProto : rhs->quals()) {
10110 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto)) {
10111 match = true;
10112 break;
10113 }
10114 }
10115 if (!match)
10116 return false;
10117 }
10118 return true;
10119 }
10120
10121 /// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - We know that one of lhs/rhs is an
10122 /// ObjCQualifiedIDType.
ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(const ObjCObjectPointerType * lhs,const ObjCObjectPointerType * rhs,bool compare)10123 bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(
10124 const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhs, const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhs,
10125 bool compare) {
10126 // Allow id<P..> and an 'id' in all cases.
10127 if (lhs->isObjCIdType() || rhs->isObjCIdType())
10128 return true;
10129
10130 // Don't allow id<P..> to convert to Class or Class<P..> in either direction.
10131 if (lhs->isObjCClassType() || lhs->isObjCQualifiedClassType() ||
10132 rhs->isObjCClassType() || rhs->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
10133 return false;
10134
10135 if (lhs->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
10136 if (rhs->qual_empty()) {
10137 // If the RHS is a unqualified interface pointer "NSString*",
10138 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
10139 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhs->getInterfaceDecl()) {
10140 for (auto *I : lhs->quals()) {
10141 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
10142 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
10143 // through its super class and categories.
10144 if (!rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true))
10145 return false;
10146 }
10147 }
10148 // If there are no qualifiers and no interface, we have an 'id'.
10149 return true;
10150 }
10151 // Both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
10152 for (auto *lhsProto : lhs->quals()) {
10153 bool match = false;
10154
10155 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
10156 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
10157 // through its super class and categories.
10158 for (auto *rhsProto : rhs->quals()) {
10159 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
10160 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
10161 match = true;
10162 break;
10163 }
10164 }
10165 // If the RHS is a qualified interface pointer "NSString<P>*",
10166 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
10167 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhs->getInterfaceDecl()) {
10168 for (auto *I : lhs->quals()) {
10169 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
10170 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
10171 // through its super class and categories.
10172 if (rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true)) {
10173 match = true;
10174 break;
10175 }
10176 }
10177 }
10178 if (!match)
10179 return false;
10180 }
10181
10182 return true;
10183 }
10184
10185 assert(rhs->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && "One of the LHS/RHS should be id<x>");
10186
10187 if (lhs->getInterfaceType()) {
10188 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
10189 for (auto *lhsProto : lhs->quals()) {
10190 bool match = false;
10191
10192 // when comparing an id<P> on rhs with a static type on lhs,
10193 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
10194 // through its super class and categories.
10195 // First, lhs protocols in the qualifier list must be found, direct
10196 // or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
10197 for (auto *rhsProto : rhs->quals()) {
10198 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
10199 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
10200 match = true;
10201 break;
10202 }
10203 }
10204 if (!match)
10205 return false;
10206 }
10207
10208 // Static class's protocols, or its super class or category protocols
10209 // must be found, direct or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
10210 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *lhsID = lhs->getInterfaceDecl()) {
10211 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols;
10212 CollectInheritedProtocols(lhsID, LHSInheritedProtocols);
10213 // This is rather dubious but matches gcc's behavior. If lhs has
10214 // no type qualifier and its class has no static protocol(s)
10215 // assume that it is mismatch.
10216 if (LHSInheritedProtocols.empty() && lhs->qual_empty())
10217 return false;
10218 for (auto *lhsProto : LHSInheritedProtocols) {
10219 bool match = false;
10220 for (auto *rhsProto : rhs->quals()) {
10221 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
10222 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
10223 match = true;
10224 break;
10225 }
10226 }
10227 if (!match)
10228 return false;
10229 }
10230 }
10231 return true;
10232 }
10233 return false;
10234 }
10235
10236 /// canAssignObjCInterfaces - Return true if the two interface types are
10237 /// compatible for assignment from RHS to LHS. This handles validation of any
10238 /// protocol qualifiers on the LHS or RHS.
canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectPointerType * LHSOPT,const ObjCObjectPointerType * RHSOPT)10239 bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
10240 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT) {
10241 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
10242 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
10243
10244 // If either type represents the built-in 'id' type, return true.
10245 if (LHS->isObjCUnqualifiedId() || RHS->isObjCUnqualifiedId())
10246 return true;
10247
10248 // Function object that propagates a successful result or handles
10249 // __kindof types.
10250 auto finish = [&](bool succeeded) -> bool {
10251 if (succeeded)
10252 return true;
10253
10254 if (!RHS->isKindOfType())
10255 return false;
10256
10257 // Strip off __kindof and protocol qualifiers, then check whether
10258 // we can assign the other way.
10259 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
10260 LHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this));
10261 };
10262
10263 // Casts from or to id<P> are allowed when the other side has compatible
10264 // protocols.
10265 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedId() || RHS->isObjCQualifiedId()) {
10266 return finish(ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT, false));
10267 }
10268
10269 // Verify protocol compatibility for casts from Class<P1> to Class<P2>.
10270 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedClass() && RHS->isObjCQualifiedClass()) {
10271 return finish(ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT));
10272 }
10273
10274 // Casts from Class to Class<Foo>, or vice-versa, are allowed.
10275 if (LHS->isObjCClass() && RHS->isObjCClass()) {
10276 return true;
10277 }
10278
10279 // If we have 2 user-defined types, fall into that path.
10280 if (LHS->getInterface() && RHS->getInterface()) {
10281 return finish(canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS));
10282 }
10283
10284 return false;
10285 }
10286
10287 /// canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer - This routine is specifically written
10288 /// for providing type-safety for objective-c pointers used to pass/return
10289 /// arguments in block literals. When passed as arguments, passing 'A*' where
10290 /// 'id' is expected is not OK. Passing 'Sub *" where 'Super *" is expected is
10291 /// not OK. For the return type, the opposite is not OK.
canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(const ObjCObjectPointerType * LHSOPT,const ObjCObjectPointerType * RHSOPT,bool BlockReturnType)10292 bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
10293 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
10294 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
10295 bool BlockReturnType) {
10296
10297 // Function object that propagates a successful result or handles
10298 // __kindof types.
10299 auto finish = [&](bool succeeded) -> bool {
10300 if (succeeded)
10301 return true;
10302
10303 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Expected = BlockReturnType ? RHSOPT : LHSOPT;
10304 if (!Expected->isKindOfType())
10305 return false;
10306
10307 // Strip off __kindof and protocol qualifiers, then check whether
10308 // we can assign the other way.
10309 return canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
10310 RHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
10311 LHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
10312 BlockReturnType);
10313 };
10314
10315 if (RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || LHSOPT->isObjCIdType())
10316 return true;
10317
10318 if (LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
10319 return finish(RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ||
10320 RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType());
10321 }
10322
10323 if (LHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
10324 if (getLangOpts().CompatibilityQualifiedIdBlockParamTypeChecking)
10325 // Use for block parameters previous type checking for compatibility.
10326 return finish(ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT, false) ||
10327 // Or corrected type checking as in non-compat mode.
10328 (!BlockReturnType &&
10329 ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(RHSOPT, LHSOPT, false)));
10330 else
10331 return finish(ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(
10332 (BlockReturnType ? LHSOPT : RHSOPT),
10333 (BlockReturnType ? RHSOPT : LHSOPT), false));
10334 }
10335
10336 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = LHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
10337 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = RHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
10338 if (LHS && RHS) { // We have 2 user-defined types.
10339 if (LHS != RHS) {
10340 if (LHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getDecl()))
10341 return finish(BlockReturnType);
10342 if (RHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(LHS->getDecl()))
10343 return finish(!BlockReturnType);
10344 }
10345 else
10346 return true;
10347 }
10348 return false;
10349 }
10350
10351 /// Comparison routine for Objective-C protocols to be used with
10352 /// llvm::array_pod_sort.
compareObjCProtocolsByName(ObjCProtocolDecl * const * lhs,ObjCProtocolDecl * const * rhs)10353 static int compareObjCProtocolsByName(ObjCProtocolDecl * const *lhs,
10354 ObjCProtocolDecl * const *rhs) {
10355 return (*lhs)->getName().compare((*rhs)->getName());
10356 }
10357
10358 /// getIntersectionOfProtocols - This routine finds the intersection of set
10359 /// of protocols inherited from two distinct objective-c pointer objects with
10360 /// the given common base.
10361 /// It is used to build composite qualifier list of the composite type of
10362 /// the conditional expression involving two objective-c pointer objects.
10363 static
getIntersectionOfProtocols(ASTContext & Context,const ObjCInterfaceDecl * CommonBase,const ObjCObjectPointerType * LHSOPT,const ObjCObjectPointerType * RHSOPT,SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl * > & IntersectionSet)10364 void getIntersectionOfProtocols(ASTContext &Context,
10365 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *CommonBase,
10366 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
10367 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
10368 SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &IntersectionSet) {
10369
10370 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
10371 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
10372 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS must have an interface base");
10373 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS must have an interface base");
10374
10375 // Add all of the protocols for the LHS.
10376 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSProtocolSet;
10377
10378 // Start with the protocol qualifiers.
10379 for (auto *proto : LHS->quals()) {
10380 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(proto, LHSProtocolSet);
10381 }
10382
10383 // Also add the protocols associated with the LHS interface.
10384 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(LHS->getInterface(), LHSProtocolSet);
10385
10386 // Add all of the protocols for the RHS.
10387 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> RHSProtocolSet;
10388
10389 // Start with the protocol qualifiers.
10390 for (auto *proto : RHS->quals()) {
10391 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(proto, RHSProtocolSet);
10392 }
10393
10394 // Also add the protocols associated with the RHS interface.
10395 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), RHSProtocolSet);
10396
10397 // Compute the intersection of the collected protocol sets.
10398 for (auto *proto : LHSProtocolSet) {
10399 if (RHSProtocolSet.count(proto))
10400 IntersectionSet.push_back(proto);
10401 }
10402
10403 // Compute the set of protocols that is implied by either the common type or
10404 // the protocols within the intersection.
10405 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> ImpliedProtocols;
10406 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(CommonBase, ImpliedProtocols);
10407
10408 // Remove any implied protocols from the list of inherited protocols.
10409 if (!ImpliedProtocols.empty()) {
10410 llvm::erase_if(IntersectionSet, [&](ObjCProtocolDecl *proto) -> bool {
10411 return ImpliedProtocols.contains(proto);
10412 });
10413 }
10414
10415 // Sort the remaining protocols by name.
10416 llvm::array_pod_sort(IntersectionSet.begin(), IntersectionSet.end(),
10417 compareObjCProtocolsByName);
10418 }
10419
10420 /// Determine whether the first type is a subtype of the second.
canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ASTContext & ctx,QualType lhs,QualType rhs)10421 static bool canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ASTContext &ctx, QualType lhs,
10422 QualType rhs) {
10423 // Common case: two object pointers.
10424 const auto *lhsOPT = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
10425 const auto *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
10426 if (lhsOPT && rhsOPT)
10427 return ctx.canAssignObjCInterfaces(lhsOPT, rhsOPT);
10428
10429 // Two block pointers.
10430 const auto *lhsBlock = lhs->getAs<BlockPointerType>();
10431 const auto *rhsBlock = rhs->getAs<BlockPointerType>();
10432 if (lhsBlock && rhsBlock)
10433 return ctx.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhs, rhs);
10434
10435 // If either is an unqualified 'id' and the other is a block, it's
10436 // acceptable.
10437 if ((lhsOPT && lhsOPT->isObjCIdType() && rhsBlock) ||
10438 (rhsOPT && rhsOPT->isObjCIdType() && lhsBlock))
10439 return true;
10440
10441 return false;
10442 }
10443
10444 // Check that the given Objective-C type argument lists are equivalent.
sameObjCTypeArgs(ASTContext & ctx,const ObjCInterfaceDecl * iface,ArrayRef<QualType> lhsArgs,ArrayRef<QualType> rhsArgs,bool stripKindOf)10445 static bool sameObjCTypeArgs(ASTContext &ctx,
10446 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *iface,
10447 ArrayRef<QualType> lhsArgs,
10448 ArrayRef<QualType> rhsArgs,
10449 bool stripKindOf) {
10450 if (lhsArgs.size() != rhsArgs.size())
10451 return false;
10452
10453 ObjCTypeParamList *typeParams = iface->getTypeParamList();
10454 if (!typeParams)
10455 return false;
10456
10457 for (unsigned i = 0, n = lhsArgs.size(); i != n; ++i) {
10458 if (ctx.hasSameType(lhsArgs[i], rhsArgs[i]))
10459 continue;
10460
10461 switch (typeParams->begin()[i]->getVariance()) {
10462 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Invariant:
10463 if (!stripKindOf ||
10464 !ctx.hasSameType(lhsArgs[i].stripObjCKindOfType(ctx),
10465 rhsArgs[i].stripObjCKindOfType(ctx))) {
10466 return false;
10467 }
10468 break;
10469
10470 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Covariant:
10471 if (!canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ctx, lhsArgs[i], rhsArgs[i]))
10472 return false;
10473 break;
10474
10475 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Contravariant:
10476 if (!canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ctx, rhsArgs[i], lhsArgs[i]))
10477 return false;
10478 break;
10479 }
10480 }
10481
10482 return true;
10483 }
10484
areCommonBaseCompatible(const ObjCObjectPointerType * Lptr,const ObjCObjectPointerType * Rptr)10485 QualType ASTContext::areCommonBaseCompatible(
10486 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Lptr,
10487 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Rptr) {
10488 const ObjCObjectType *LHS = Lptr->getObjectType();
10489 const ObjCObjectType *RHS = Rptr->getObjectType();
10490 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* LDecl = LHS->getInterface();
10491 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* RDecl = RHS->getInterface();
10492
10493 if (!LDecl || !RDecl)
10494 return {};
10495
10496 // When either LHS or RHS is a kindof type, we should return a kindof type.
10497 // For example, for common base of kindof(ASub1) and kindof(ASub2), we return
10498 // kindof(A).
10499 bool anyKindOf = LHS->isKindOfType() || RHS->isKindOfType();
10500
10501 // Follow the left-hand side up the class hierarchy until we either hit a
10502 // root or find the RHS. Record the ancestors in case we don't find it.
10503 llvm::SmallDenseMap<const ObjCInterfaceDecl *, const ObjCObjectType *, 4>
10504 LHSAncestors;
10505 while (true) {
10506 // Record this ancestor. We'll need this if the common type isn't in the
10507 // path from the LHS to the root.
10508 LHSAncestors[LHS->getInterface()->getCanonicalDecl()] = LHS;
10509
10510 if (declaresSameEntity(LHS->getInterface(), RDecl)) {
10511 // Get the type arguments.
10512 ArrayRef<QualType> LHSTypeArgs = LHS->getTypeArgsAsWritten();
10513 bool anyChanges = false;
10514 if (LHS->isSpecialized() && RHS->isSpecialized()) {
10515 // Both have type arguments, compare them.
10516 if (!sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
10517 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHS->getTypeArgs(),
10518 /*stripKindOf=*/true))
10519 return {};
10520 } else if (LHS->isSpecialized() != RHS->isSpecialized()) {
10521 // If only one has type arguments, the result will not have type
10522 // arguments.
10523 LHSTypeArgs = {};
10524 anyChanges = true;
10525 }
10526
10527 // Compute the intersection of protocols.
10528 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols;
10529 getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, LHS->getInterface(), Lptr, Rptr,
10530 Protocols);
10531 if (!Protocols.empty())
10532 anyChanges = true;
10533
10534 // If anything in the LHS will have changed, build a new result type.
10535 // If we need to return a kindof type but LHS is not a kindof type, we
10536 // build a new result type.
10537 if (anyChanges || LHS->isKindOfType() != anyKindOf) {
10538 QualType Result = getObjCInterfaceType(LHS->getInterface());
10539 Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, LHSTypeArgs, Protocols,
10540 anyKindOf || LHS->isKindOfType());
10541 return getObjCObjectPointerType(Result);
10542 }
10543
10544 return getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType(LHS, 0));
10545 }
10546
10547 // Find the superclass.
10548 QualType LHSSuperType = LHS->getSuperClassType();
10549 if (LHSSuperType.isNull())
10550 break;
10551
10552 LHS = LHSSuperType->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
10553 }
10554
10555 // We didn't find anything by following the LHS to its root; now check
10556 // the RHS against the cached set of ancestors.
10557 while (true) {
10558 auto KnownLHS = LHSAncestors.find(RHS->getInterface()->getCanonicalDecl());
10559 if (KnownLHS != LHSAncestors.end()) {
10560 LHS = KnownLHS->second;
10561
10562 // Get the type arguments.
10563 ArrayRef<QualType> RHSTypeArgs = RHS->getTypeArgsAsWritten();
10564 bool anyChanges = false;
10565 if (LHS->isSpecialized() && RHS->isSpecialized()) {
10566 // Both have type arguments, compare them.
10567 if (!sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
10568 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHS->getTypeArgs(),
10569 /*stripKindOf=*/true))
10570 return {};
10571 } else if (LHS->isSpecialized() != RHS->isSpecialized()) {
10572 // If only one has type arguments, the result will not have type
10573 // arguments.
10574 RHSTypeArgs = {};
10575 anyChanges = true;
10576 }
10577
10578 // Compute the intersection of protocols.
10579 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols;
10580 getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, RHS->getInterface(), Lptr, Rptr,
10581 Protocols);
10582 if (!Protocols.empty())
10583 anyChanges = true;
10584
10585 // If we need to return a kindof type but RHS is not a kindof type, we
10586 // build a new result type.
10587 if (anyChanges || RHS->isKindOfType() != anyKindOf) {
10588 QualType Result = getObjCInterfaceType(RHS->getInterface());
10589 Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, RHSTypeArgs, Protocols,
10590 anyKindOf || RHS->isKindOfType());
10591 return getObjCObjectPointerType(Result);
10592 }
10593
10594 return getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType(RHS, 0));
10595 }
10596
10597 // Find the superclass of the RHS.
10598 QualType RHSSuperType = RHS->getSuperClassType();
10599 if (RHSSuperType.isNull())
10600 break;
10601
10602 RHS = RHSSuperType->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
10603 }
10604
10605 return {};
10606 }
10607
canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectType * LHS,const ObjCObjectType * RHS)10608 bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectType *LHS,
10609 const ObjCObjectType *RHS) {
10610 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS is not an interface type");
10611 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS is not an interface type");
10612
10613 // Verify that the base decls are compatible: the RHS must be a subclass of
10614 // the LHS.
10615 ObjCInterfaceDecl *LHSInterface = LHS->getInterface();
10616 bool IsSuperClass = LHSInterface->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface());
10617 if (!IsSuperClass)
10618 return false;
10619
10620 // If the LHS has protocol qualifiers, determine whether all of them are
10621 // satisfied by the RHS (i.e., the RHS has a superset of the protocols in the
10622 // LHS).
10623 if (LHS->getNumProtocols() > 0) {
10624 // OK if conversion of LHS to SuperClass results in narrowing of types
10625 // ; i.e., SuperClass may implement at least one of the protocols
10626 // in LHS's protocol list. Example, SuperObj<P1> = lhs<P1,P2> is ok.
10627 // But not SuperObj<P1,P2,P3> = lhs<P1,P2>.
10628 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> SuperClassInheritedProtocols;
10629 CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), SuperClassInheritedProtocols);
10630 // Also, if RHS has explicit quelifiers, include them for comparing with LHS's
10631 // qualifiers.
10632 for (auto *RHSPI : RHS->quals())
10633 CollectInheritedProtocols(RHSPI, SuperClassInheritedProtocols);
10634 // If there is no protocols associated with RHS, it is not a match.
10635 if (SuperClassInheritedProtocols.empty())
10636 return false;
10637
10638 for (const auto *LHSProto : LHS->quals()) {
10639 bool SuperImplementsProtocol = false;
10640 for (auto *SuperClassProto : SuperClassInheritedProtocols)
10641 if (SuperClassProto->lookupProtocolNamed(LHSProto->getIdentifier())) {
10642 SuperImplementsProtocol = true;
10643 break;
10644 }
10645 if (!SuperImplementsProtocol)
10646 return false;
10647 }
10648 }
10649
10650 // If the LHS is specialized, we may need to check type arguments.
10651 if (LHS->isSpecialized()) {
10652 // Follow the superclass chain until we've matched the LHS class in the
10653 // hierarchy. This substitutes type arguments through.
10654 const ObjCObjectType *RHSSuper = RHS;
10655 while (!declaresSameEntity(RHSSuper->getInterface(), LHSInterface))
10656 RHSSuper = RHSSuper->getSuperClassType()->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
10657
10658 // If the RHS is specializd, compare type arguments.
10659 if (RHSSuper->isSpecialized() &&
10660 !sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
10661 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHSSuper->getTypeArgs(),
10662 /*stripKindOf=*/true)) {
10663 return false;
10664 }
10665 }
10666
10667 return true;
10668 }
10669
areComparableObjCPointerTypes(QualType LHS,QualType RHS)10670 bool ASTContext::areComparableObjCPointerTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
10671 // get the "pointed to" types
10672 const auto *LHSOPT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
10673 const auto *RHSOPT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
10674
10675 if (!LHSOPT || !RHSOPT)
10676 return false;
10677
10678 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT) ||
10679 canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT);
10680 }
10681
canBindObjCObjectType(QualType To,QualType From)10682 bool ASTContext::canBindObjCObjectType(QualType To, QualType From) {
10683 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(
10684 getObjCObjectPointerType(To)->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
10685 getObjCObjectPointerType(From)->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>());
10686 }
10687
10688 /// typesAreCompatible - C99 6.7.3p9: For two qualified types to be compatible,
10689 /// both shall have the identically qualified version of a compatible type.
10690 /// C99 6.2.7p1: Two types have compatible types if their types are the
10691 /// same. See 6.7.[2,3,5] for additional rules.
typesAreCompatible(QualType LHS,QualType RHS,bool CompareUnqualified)10692 bool ASTContext::typesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
10693 bool CompareUnqualified) {
10694 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
10695 return hasSameType(LHS, RHS);
10696
10697 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, false, CompareUnqualified).isNull();
10698 }
10699
propertyTypesAreCompatible(QualType LHS,QualType RHS)10700 bool ASTContext::propertyTypesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
10701 return typesAreCompatible(LHS, RHS);
10702 }
10703
typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(QualType LHS,QualType RHS)10704 bool ASTContext::typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
10705 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true).isNull();
10706 }
10707
10708 /// mergeTransparentUnionType - if T is a transparent union type and a member
10709 /// of T is compatible with SubType, return the merged type, else return
10710 /// QualType()
mergeTransparentUnionType(QualType T,QualType SubType,bool OfBlockPointer,bool Unqualified)10711 QualType ASTContext::mergeTransparentUnionType(QualType T, QualType SubType,
10712 bool OfBlockPointer,
10713 bool Unqualified) {
10714 if (const RecordType *UT = T->getAsUnionType()) {
10715 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
10716 if (UD->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) {
10717 for (const auto *I : UD->fields()) {
10718 QualType ET = I->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
10719 QualType MT = mergeTypes(ET, SubType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
10720 if (!MT.isNull())
10721 return MT;
10722 }
10723 }
10724 }
10725
10726 return {};
10727 }
10728
10729 /// mergeFunctionParameterTypes - merge two types which appear as function
10730 /// parameter types
mergeFunctionParameterTypes(QualType lhs,QualType rhs,bool OfBlockPointer,bool Unqualified)10731 QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionParameterTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
10732 bool OfBlockPointer,
10733 bool Unqualified) {
10734 // GNU extension: two types are compatible if they appear as a function
10735 // argument, one of the types is a transparent union type and the other
10736 // type is compatible with a union member
10737 QualType lmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer,
10738 Unqualified);
10739 if (!lmerge.isNull())
10740 return lmerge;
10741
10742 QualType rmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(rhs, lhs, OfBlockPointer,
10743 Unqualified);
10744 if (!rmerge.isNull())
10745 return rmerge;
10746
10747 return mergeTypes(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
10748 }
10749
mergeFunctionTypes(QualType lhs,QualType rhs,bool OfBlockPointer,bool Unqualified,bool AllowCXX,bool IsConditionalOperator)10750 QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
10751 bool OfBlockPointer, bool Unqualified,
10752 bool AllowCXX,
10753 bool IsConditionalOperator) {
10754 const auto *lbase = lhs->castAs<FunctionType>();
10755 const auto *rbase = rhs->castAs<FunctionType>();
10756 const auto *lproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(lbase);
10757 const auto *rproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(rbase);
10758 bool allLTypes = true;
10759 bool allRTypes = true;
10760
10761 // Check return type
10762 QualType retType;
10763 if (OfBlockPointer) {
10764 QualType RHS = rbase->getReturnType();
10765 QualType LHS = lbase->getReturnType();
10766 bool UnqualifiedResult = Unqualified;
10767 if (!UnqualifiedResult)
10768 UnqualifiedResult = (!RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers());
10769 retType = mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true, UnqualifiedResult, true);
10770 }
10771 else
10772 retType = mergeTypes(lbase->getReturnType(), rbase->getReturnType(), false,
10773 Unqualified);
10774 if (retType.isNull())
10775 return {};
10776
10777 if (Unqualified)
10778 retType = retType.getUnqualifiedType();
10779
10780 CanQualType LRetType = getCanonicalType(lbase->getReturnType());
10781 CanQualType RRetType = getCanonicalType(rbase->getReturnType());
10782 if (Unqualified) {
10783 LRetType = LRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
10784 RRetType = RRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
10785 }
10786
10787 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != LRetType)
10788 allLTypes = false;
10789 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != RRetType)
10790 allRTypes = false;
10791
10792 // FIXME: double check this
10793 // FIXME: should we error if lbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
10794 // rbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
10795 // lbase->getRegParmAttr() != rbase->getRegParmAttr()?
10796 FunctionType::ExtInfo lbaseInfo = lbase->getExtInfo();
10797 FunctionType::ExtInfo rbaseInfo = rbase->getExtInfo();
10798
10799 // Compatible functions must have compatible calling conventions
10800 if (lbaseInfo.getCC() != rbaseInfo.getCC())
10801 return {};
10802
10803 // Regparm is part of the calling convention.
10804 if (lbaseInfo.getHasRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getHasRegParm())
10805 return {};
10806 if (lbaseInfo.getRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getRegParm())
10807 return {};
10808
10809 if (lbaseInfo.getProducesResult() != rbaseInfo.getProducesResult())
10810 return {};
10811 if (lbaseInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs() != rbaseInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs())
10812 return {};
10813 if (lbaseInfo.getNoCfCheck() != rbaseInfo.getNoCfCheck())
10814 return {};
10815
10816 // When merging declarations, it's common for supplemental information like
10817 // attributes to only be present in one of the declarations, and we generally
10818 // want type merging to preserve the union of information. So a merged
10819 // function type should be noreturn if it was noreturn in *either* operand
10820 // type.
10821 //
10822 // But for the conditional operator, this is backwards. The result of the
10823 // operator could be either operand, and its type should conservatively
10824 // reflect that. So a function type in a composite type is noreturn only
10825 // if it's noreturn in *both* operand types.
10826 //
10827 // Arguably, noreturn is a kind of subtype, and the conditional operator
10828 // ought to produce the most specific common supertype of its operand types.
10829 // That would differ from this rule in contravariant positions. However,
10830 // neither C nor C++ generally uses this kind of subtype reasoning. Also,
10831 // as a practical matter, it would only affect C code that does abstraction of
10832 // higher-order functions (taking noreturn callbacks!), which is uncommon to
10833 // say the least. So we use the simpler rule.
10834 bool NoReturn = IsConditionalOperator
10835 ? lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() && rbaseInfo.getNoReturn()
10836 : lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() || rbaseInfo.getNoReturn();
10837 if (lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
10838 allLTypes = false;
10839 if (rbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
10840 allRTypes = false;
10841
10842 FunctionType::ExtInfo einfo = lbaseInfo.withNoReturn(NoReturn);
10843
10844 std::optional<FunctionEffectSet> MergedFX;
10845
10846 if (lproto && rproto) { // two C99 style function prototypes
10847 assert((AllowCXX ||
10848 (!lproto->hasExceptionSpec() && !rproto->hasExceptionSpec())) &&
10849 "C++ shouldn't be here");
10850 // Compatible functions must have the same number of parameters
10851 if (lproto->getNumParams() != rproto->getNumParams())
10852 return {};
10853
10854 // Variadic and non-variadic functions aren't compatible
10855 if (lproto->isVariadic() != rproto->isVariadic())
10856 return {};
10857
10858 if (lproto->getMethodQuals() != rproto->getMethodQuals())
10859 return {};
10860
10861 // Function effects are handled similarly to noreturn, see above.
10862 FunctionEffectsRef LHSFX = lproto->getFunctionEffects();
10863 FunctionEffectsRef RHSFX = rproto->getFunctionEffects();
10864 if (LHSFX != RHSFX) {
10865 if (IsConditionalOperator)
10866 MergedFX = FunctionEffectSet::getIntersection(LHSFX, RHSFX);
10867 else {
10868 FunctionEffectSet::Conflicts Errs;
10869 MergedFX = FunctionEffectSet::getUnion(LHSFX, RHSFX, Errs);
10870 // Here we're discarding a possible error due to conflicts in the effect
10871 // sets. But we're not in a context where we can report it. The
10872 // operation does however guarantee maintenance of invariants.
10873 }
10874 if (*MergedFX != LHSFX)
10875 allLTypes = false;
10876 if (*MergedFX != RHSFX)
10877 allRTypes = false;
10878 }
10879
10880 SmallVector<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo, 4> newParamInfos;
10881 bool canUseLeft, canUseRight;
10882 if (!mergeExtParameterInfo(lproto, rproto, canUseLeft, canUseRight,
10883 newParamInfos))
10884 return {};
10885
10886 if (!canUseLeft)
10887 allLTypes = false;
10888 if (!canUseRight)
10889 allRTypes = false;
10890
10891 // Check parameter type compatibility
10892 SmallVector<QualType, 10> types;
10893 for (unsigned i = 0, n = lproto->getNumParams(); i < n; i++) {
10894 QualType lParamType = lproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
10895 QualType rParamType = rproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
10896 QualType paramType = mergeFunctionParameterTypes(
10897 lParamType, rParamType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
10898 if (paramType.isNull())
10899 return {};
10900
10901 if (Unqualified)
10902 paramType = paramType.getUnqualifiedType();
10903
10904 types.push_back(paramType);
10905 if (Unqualified) {
10906 lParamType = lParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
10907 rParamType = rParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
10908 }
10909
10910 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(lParamType))
10911 allLTypes = false;
10912 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(rParamType))
10913 allRTypes = false;
10914 }
10915
10916 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
10917 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
10918
10919 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = lproto->getExtProtoInfo();
10920 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
10921 EPI.ExtParameterInfos =
10922 newParamInfos.empty() ? nullptr : newParamInfos.data();
10923 if (MergedFX)
10924 EPI.FunctionEffects = *MergedFX;
10925 return getFunctionType(retType, types, EPI);
10926 }
10927
10928 if (lproto) allRTypes = false;
10929 if (rproto) allLTypes = false;
10930
10931 const FunctionProtoType *proto = lproto ? lproto : rproto;
10932 if (proto) {
10933 assert((AllowCXX || !proto->hasExceptionSpec()) && "C++ shouldn't be here");
10934 if (proto->isVariadic())
10935 return {};
10936 // Check that the types are compatible with the types that
10937 // would result from default argument promotions (C99 6.7.5.3p15).
10938 // The only types actually affected are promotable integer
10939 // types and floats, which would be passed as a different
10940 // type depending on whether the prototype is visible.
10941 for (unsigned i = 0, n = proto->getNumParams(); i < n; ++i) {
10942 QualType paramTy = proto->getParamType(i);
10943
10944 // Look at the converted type of enum types, since that is the type used
10945 // to pass enum values.
10946 if (const auto *Enum = paramTy->getAs<EnumType>()) {
10947 paramTy = Enum->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
10948 if (paramTy.isNull())
10949 return {};
10950 }
10951
10952 if (isPromotableIntegerType(paramTy) ||
10953 getCanonicalType(paramTy).getUnqualifiedType() == FloatTy)
10954 return {};
10955 }
10956
10957 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
10958 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
10959
10960 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = proto->getExtProtoInfo();
10961 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
10962 if (MergedFX)
10963 EPI.FunctionEffects = *MergedFX;
10964 return getFunctionType(retType, proto->getParamTypes(), EPI);
10965 }
10966
10967 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
10968 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
10969 return getFunctionNoProtoType(retType, einfo);
10970 }
10971
10972 /// Given that we have an enum type and a non-enum type, try to merge them.
mergeEnumWithInteger(ASTContext & Context,const EnumType * ET,QualType other,bool isBlockReturnType)10973 static QualType mergeEnumWithInteger(ASTContext &Context, const EnumType *ET,
10974 QualType other, bool isBlockReturnType) {
10975 // C99 6.7.2.2p4: Each enumerated type shall be compatible with char,
10976 // a signed integer type, or an unsigned integer type.
10977 // Compatibility is based on the underlying type, not the promotion
10978 // type.
10979 QualType underlyingType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
10980 if (underlyingType.isNull())
10981 return {};
10982 if (Context.hasSameType(underlyingType, other))
10983 return other;
10984
10985 // In block return types, we're more permissive and accept any
10986 // integral type of the same size.
10987 if (isBlockReturnType && other->isIntegerType() &&
10988 Context.getTypeSize(underlyingType) == Context.getTypeSize(other))
10989 return other;
10990
10991 return {};
10992 }
10993
mergeTypes(QualType LHS,QualType RHS,bool OfBlockPointer,bool Unqualified,bool BlockReturnType,bool IsConditionalOperator)10994 QualType ASTContext::mergeTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS, bool OfBlockPointer,
10995 bool Unqualified, bool BlockReturnType,
10996 bool IsConditionalOperator) {
10997 // For C++ we will not reach this code with reference types (see below),
10998 // for OpenMP variant call overloading we might.
10999 //
11000 // C++ [expr]: If an expression initially has the type "reference to T", the
11001 // type is adjusted to "T" prior to any further analysis, the expression
11002 // designates the object or function denoted by the reference, and the
11003 // expression is an lvalue unless the reference is an rvalue reference and
11004 // the expression is a function call (possibly inside parentheses).
11005 auto *LHSRefTy = LHS->getAs<ReferenceType>();
11006 auto *RHSRefTy = RHS->getAs<ReferenceType>();
11007 if (LangOpts.OpenMP && LHSRefTy && RHSRefTy &&
11008 LHS->getTypeClass() == RHS->getTypeClass())
11009 return mergeTypes(LHSRefTy->getPointeeType(), RHSRefTy->getPointeeType(),
11010 OfBlockPointer, Unqualified, BlockReturnType);
11011 if (LHSRefTy || RHSRefTy)
11012 return {};
11013
11014 if (Unqualified) {
11015 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
11016 RHS = RHS.getUnqualifiedType();
11017 }
11018
11019 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
11020 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
11021
11022 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
11023 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
11024 return LHS;
11025
11026 // If the qualifiers are different, the types aren't compatible... mostly.
11027 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
11028 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
11029 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
11030 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type
11031 // mismatch.
11032 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
11033 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace() ||
11034 LQuals.getObjCLifetime() != RQuals.getObjCLifetime() ||
11035 LQuals.hasUnaligned() != RQuals.hasUnaligned())
11036 return {};
11037
11038 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
11039 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
11040 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
11041 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
11042 // qualified __strong.
11043 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
11044 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
11045 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
11046
11047 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
11048 return {};
11049
11050 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
11051 return mergeTypes(LHS, getObjCGCQualType(RHS, Qualifiers::Strong));
11052 }
11053 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong && LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
11054 return mergeTypes(getObjCGCQualType(LHS, Qualifiers::Strong), RHS);
11055 }
11056 return {};
11057 }
11058
11059 // Okay, qualifiers are equal.
11060
11061 Type::TypeClass LHSClass = LHSCan->getTypeClass();
11062 Type::TypeClass RHSClass = RHSCan->getTypeClass();
11063
11064 // We want to consider the two function types to be the same for these
11065 // comparisons, just force one to the other.
11066 if (LHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) LHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
11067 if (RHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) RHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
11068
11069 // Same as above for arrays
11070 if (LHSClass == Type::VariableArray || LHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
11071 LHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
11072 if (RHSClass == Type::VariableArray || RHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
11073 RHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
11074
11075 // ObjCInterfaces are just specialized ObjCObjects.
11076 if (LHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) LHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
11077 if (RHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) RHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
11078
11079 // Canonicalize ExtVector -> Vector.
11080 if (LHSClass == Type::ExtVector) LHSClass = Type::Vector;
11081 if (RHSClass == Type::ExtVector) RHSClass = Type::Vector;
11082
11083 // If the canonical type classes don't match.
11084 if (LHSClass != RHSClass) {
11085 // Note that we only have special rules for turning block enum
11086 // returns into block int returns, not vice-versa.
11087 if (const auto *ETy = LHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
11088 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, RHS, false);
11089 }
11090 if (const EnumType* ETy = RHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
11091 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, LHS, BlockReturnType);
11092 }
11093 // allow block pointer type to match an 'id' type.
11094 if (OfBlockPointer && !BlockReturnType) {
11095 if (LHS->isObjCIdType() && RHS->isBlockPointerType())
11096 return LHS;
11097 if (RHS->isObjCIdType() && LHS->isBlockPointerType())
11098 return RHS;
11099 }
11100 // Allow __auto_type to match anything; it merges to the type with more
11101 // information.
11102 if (const auto *AT = LHS->getAs<AutoType>()) {
11103 if (!AT->isDeduced() && AT->isGNUAutoType())
11104 return RHS;
11105 }
11106 if (const auto *AT = RHS->getAs<AutoType>()) {
11107 if (!AT->isDeduced() && AT->isGNUAutoType())
11108 return LHS;
11109 }
11110 return {};
11111 }
11112
11113 // The canonical type classes match.
11114 switch (LHSClass) {
11115 #define TYPE(Class, Base)
11116 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
11117 #define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
11118 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
11119 #define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
11120 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.inc"
11121 llvm_unreachable("Non-canonical and dependent types shouldn't get here");
11122
11123 case Type::Auto:
11124 case Type::DeducedTemplateSpecialization:
11125 case Type::LValueReference:
11126 case Type::RValueReference:
11127 case Type::MemberPointer:
11128 llvm_unreachable("C++ should never be in mergeTypes");
11129
11130 case Type::ObjCInterface:
11131 case Type::IncompleteArray:
11132 case Type::VariableArray:
11133 case Type::FunctionProto:
11134 case Type::ExtVector:
11135 llvm_unreachable("Types are eliminated above");
11136
11137 case Type::Pointer:
11138 {
11139 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
11140 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
11141 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
11142 if (Unqualified) {
11143 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
11144 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
11145 }
11146 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, false,
11147 Unqualified);
11148 if (ResultType.isNull())
11149 return {};
11150 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
11151 return LHS;
11152 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
11153 return RHS;
11154 return getPointerType(ResultType);
11155 }
11156 case Type::BlockPointer:
11157 {
11158 // Merge two block pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
11159 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
11160 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
11161 if (Unqualified) {
11162 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
11163 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
11164 }
11165 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
11166 Qualifiers LHSPteeQual = LHSPointee.getQualifiers();
11167 Qualifiers RHSPteeQual = RHSPointee.getQualifiers();
11168 // Blocks can't be an expression in a ternary operator (OpenCL v2.0
11169 // 6.12.5) thus the following check is asymmetric.
11170 if (!LHSPteeQual.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(RHSPteeQual))
11171 return {};
11172 LHSPteeQual.removeAddressSpace();
11173 RHSPteeQual.removeAddressSpace();
11174 LHSPointee =
11175 QualType(LHSPointee.getTypePtr(), LHSPteeQual.getAsOpaqueValue());
11176 RHSPointee =
11177 QualType(RHSPointee.getTypePtr(), RHSPteeQual.getAsOpaqueValue());
11178 }
11179 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, OfBlockPointer,
11180 Unqualified);
11181 if (ResultType.isNull())
11182 return {};
11183 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
11184 return LHS;
11185 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
11186 return RHS;
11187 return getBlockPointerType(ResultType);
11188 }
11189 case Type::Atomic:
11190 {
11191 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
11192 QualType LHSValue = LHS->castAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
11193 QualType RHSValue = RHS->castAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
11194 if (Unqualified) {
11195 LHSValue = LHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
11196 RHSValue = RHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
11197 }
11198 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSValue, RHSValue, false,
11199 Unqualified);
11200 if (ResultType.isNull())
11201 return {};
11202 if (getCanonicalType(LHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
11203 return LHS;
11204 if (getCanonicalType(RHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
11205 return RHS;
11206 return getAtomicType(ResultType);
11207 }
11208 case Type::ConstantArray:
11209 {
11210 const ConstantArrayType* LCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(LHS);
11211 const ConstantArrayType* RCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(RHS);
11212 if (LCAT && RCAT && RCAT->getZExtSize() != LCAT->getZExtSize())
11213 return {};
11214
11215 QualType LHSElem = getAsArrayType(LHS)->getElementType();
11216 QualType RHSElem = getAsArrayType(RHS)->getElementType();
11217 if (Unqualified) {
11218 LHSElem = LHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
11219 RHSElem = RHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
11220 }
11221
11222 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSElem, RHSElem, false, Unqualified);
11223 if (ResultType.isNull())
11224 return {};
11225
11226 const VariableArrayType* LVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(LHS);
11227 const VariableArrayType* RVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(RHS);
11228
11229 // If either side is a variable array, and both are complete, check whether
11230 // the current dimension is definite.
11231 if (LVAT || RVAT) {
11232 auto SizeFetch = [this](const VariableArrayType* VAT,
11233 const ConstantArrayType* CAT)
11234 -> std::pair<bool,llvm::APInt> {
11235 if (VAT) {
11236 std::optional<llvm::APSInt> TheInt;
11237 Expr *E = VAT->getSizeExpr();
11238 if (E && (TheInt = E->getIntegerConstantExpr(*this)))
11239 return std::make_pair(true, *TheInt);
11240 return std::make_pair(false, llvm::APSInt());
11241 }
11242 if (CAT)
11243 return std::make_pair(true, CAT->getSize());
11244 return std::make_pair(false, llvm::APInt());
11245 };
11246
11247 bool HaveLSize, HaveRSize;
11248 llvm::APInt LSize, RSize;
11249 std::tie(HaveLSize, LSize) = SizeFetch(LVAT, LCAT);
11250 std::tie(HaveRSize, RSize) = SizeFetch(RVAT, RCAT);
11251 if (HaveLSize && HaveRSize && !llvm::APInt::isSameValue(LSize, RSize))
11252 return {}; // Definite, but unequal, array dimension
11253 }
11254
11255 if (LCAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
11256 return LHS;
11257 if (RCAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
11258 return RHS;
11259 if (LCAT)
11260 return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, LCAT->getSize(),
11261 LCAT->getSizeExpr(), ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
11262 if (RCAT)
11263 return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, RCAT->getSize(),
11264 RCAT->getSizeExpr(), ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
11265 if (LVAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
11266 return LHS;
11267 if (RVAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
11268 return RHS;
11269 if (LVAT) {
11270 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
11271 // the array's size has to be the size of LHS, but the type
11272 // has to be different.
11273 return LHS;
11274 }
11275 if (RVAT) {
11276 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
11277 // the array's size has to be the size of RHS, but the type
11278 // has to be different.
11279 return RHS;
11280 }
11281 if (getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return LHS;
11282 if (getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return RHS;
11283 return getIncompleteArrayType(ResultType, ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
11284 }
11285 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
11286 return mergeFunctionTypes(LHS, RHS, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified,
11287 /*AllowCXX=*/false, IsConditionalOperator);
11288 case Type::Record:
11289 case Type::Enum:
11290 return {};
11291 case Type::Builtin:
11292 // Only exactly equal builtin types are compatible, which is tested above.
11293 return {};
11294 case Type::Complex:
11295 // Distinct complex types are incompatible.
11296 return {};
11297 case Type::Vector:
11298 // FIXME: The merged type should be an ExtVector!
11299 if (areCompatVectorTypes(LHSCan->castAs<VectorType>(),
11300 RHSCan->castAs<VectorType>()))
11301 return LHS;
11302 return {};
11303 case Type::ConstantMatrix:
11304 if (areCompatMatrixTypes(LHSCan->castAs<ConstantMatrixType>(),
11305 RHSCan->castAs<ConstantMatrixType>()))
11306 return LHS;
11307 return {};
11308 case Type::ObjCObject: {
11309 // Check if the types are assignment compatible.
11310 // FIXME: This should be type compatibility, e.g. whether
11311 // "LHS x; RHS x;" at global scope is legal.
11312 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS->castAs<ObjCObjectType>(),
11313 RHS->castAs<ObjCObjectType>()))
11314 return LHS;
11315 return {};
11316 }
11317 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
11318 if (OfBlockPointer) {
11319 if (canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
11320 LHS->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
11321 RHS->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(), BlockReturnType))
11322 return LHS;
11323 return {};
11324 }
11325 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
11326 RHS->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()))
11327 return LHS;
11328 return {};
11329 case Type::Pipe:
11330 assert(LHS != RHS &&
11331 "Equivalent pipe types should have already been handled!");
11332 return {};
11333 case Type::ArrayParameter:
11334 assert(LHS != RHS &&
11335 "Equivalent ArrayParameter types should have already been handled!");
11336 return {};
11337 case Type::BitInt: {
11338 // Merge two bit-precise int types, while trying to preserve typedef info.
11339 bool LHSUnsigned = LHS->castAs<BitIntType>()->isUnsigned();
11340 bool RHSUnsigned = RHS->castAs<BitIntType>()->isUnsigned();
11341 unsigned LHSBits = LHS->castAs<BitIntType>()->getNumBits();
11342 unsigned RHSBits = RHS->castAs<BitIntType>()->getNumBits();
11343
11344 // Like unsigned/int, shouldn't have a type if they don't match.
11345 if (LHSUnsigned != RHSUnsigned)
11346 return {};
11347
11348 if (LHSBits != RHSBits)
11349 return {};
11350 return LHS;
11351 }
11352 }
11353
11354 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Type::Class!");
11355 }
11356
mergeExtParameterInfo(const FunctionProtoType * FirstFnType,const FunctionProtoType * SecondFnType,bool & CanUseFirst,bool & CanUseSecond,SmallVectorImpl<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo> & NewParamInfos)11357 bool ASTContext::mergeExtParameterInfo(
11358 const FunctionProtoType *FirstFnType, const FunctionProtoType *SecondFnType,
11359 bool &CanUseFirst, bool &CanUseSecond,
11360 SmallVectorImpl<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo> &NewParamInfos) {
11361 assert(NewParamInfos.empty() && "param info list not empty");
11362 CanUseFirst = CanUseSecond = true;
11363 bool FirstHasInfo = FirstFnType->hasExtParameterInfos();
11364 bool SecondHasInfo = SecondFnType->hasExtParameterInfos();
11365
11366 // Fast path: if the first type doesn't have ext parameter infos,
11367 // we match if and only if the second type also doesn't have them.
11368 if (!FirstHasInfo && !SecondHasInfo)
11369 return true;
11370
11371 bool NeedParamInfo = false;
11372 size_t E = FirstHasInfo ? FirstFnType->getExtParameterInfos().size()
11373 : SecondFnType->getExtParameterInfos().size();
11374
11375 for (size_t I = 0; I < E; ++I) {
11376 FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo FirstParam, SecondParam;
11377 if (FirstHasInfo)
11378 FirstParam = FirstFnType->getExtParameterInfo(I);
11379 if (SecondHasInfo)
11380 SecondParam = SecondFnType->getExtParameterInfo(I);
11381
11382 // Cannot merge unless everything except the noescape flag matches.
11383 if (FirstParam.withIsNoEscape(false) != SecondParam.withIsNoEscape(false))
11384 return false;
11385
11386 bool FirstNoEscape = FirstParam.isNoEscape();
11387 bool SecondNoEscape = SecondParam.isNoEscape();
11388 bool IsNoEscape = FirstNoEscape && SecondNoEscape;
11389 NewParamInfos.push_back(FirstParam.withIsNoEscape(IsNoEscape));
11390 if (NewParamInfos.back().getOpaqueValue())
11391 NeedParamInfo = true;
11392 if (FirstNoEscape != IsNoEscape)
11393 CanUseFirst = false;
11394 if (SecondNoEscape != IsNoEscape)
11395 CanUseSecond = false;
11396 }
11397
11398 if (!NeedParamInfo)
11399 NewParamInfos.clear();
11400
11401 return true;
11402 }
11403
ResetObjCLayout(const ObjCContainerDecl * CD)11404 void ASTContext::ResetObjCLayout(const ObjCContainerDecl *CD) {
11405 ObjCLayouts[CD] = nullptr;
11406 }
11407
11408 /// mergeObjCGCQualifiers - This routine merges ObjC's GC attribute of 'LHS' and
11409 /// 'RHS' attributes and returns the merged version; including for function
11410 /// return types.
mergeObjCGCQualifiers(QualType LHS,QualType RHS)11411 QualType ASTContext::mergeObjCGCQualifiers(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
11412 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
11413 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
11414 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
11415 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
11416 return LHS;
11417 if (RHSCan->isFunctionType()) {
11418 if (!LHSCan->isFunctionType())
11419 return {};
11420 QualType OldReturnType =
11421 cast<FunctionType>(RHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
11422 QualType NewReturnType =
11423 cast<FunctionType>(LHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
11424 QualType ResReturnType =
11425 mergeObjCGCQualifiers(NewReturnType, OldReturnType);
11426 if (ResReturnType.isNull())
11427 return {};
11428 if (ResReturnType == NewReturnType || ResReturnType == OldReturnType) {
11429 // id foo(); ... __strong id foo(); or: __strong id foo(); ... id foo();
11430 // In either case, use OldReturnType to build the new function type.
11431 const auto *F = LHS->castAs<FunctionType>();
11432 if (const auto *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(F)) {
11433 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
11434 EPI.ExtInfo = getFunctionExtInfo(LHS);
11435 QualType ResultType =
11436 getFunctionType(OldReturnType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
11437 return ResultType;
11438 }
11439 }
11440 return {};
11441 }
11442
11443 // If the qualifiers are different, the types can still be merged.
11444 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
11445 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
11446 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
11447 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type mismatch.
11448 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
11449 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace())
11450 return {};
11451
11452 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
11453 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
11454 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
11455 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
11456 // qualified __strong.
11457 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
11458 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
11459 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
11460
11461 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
11462 return {};
11463
11464 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong)
11465 return LHS;
11466 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong)
11467 return RHS;
11468 return {};
11469 }
11470
11471 if (LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
11472 QualType LHSBaseQT = LHS->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
11473 QualType RHSBaseQT = RHS->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
11474 QualType ResQT = mergeObjCGCQualifiers(LHSBaseQT, RHSBaseQT);
11475 if (ResQT == LHSBaseQT)
11476 return LHS;
11477 if (ResQT == RHSBaseQT)
11478 return RHS;
11479 }
11480 return {};
11481 }
11482
11483 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
11484 // Integer Predicates
11485 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
11486
getIntWidth(QualType T) const11487 unsigned ASTContext::getIntWidth(QualType T) const {
11488 if (const auto *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
11489 T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
11490 if (T->isBooleanType())
11491 return 1;
11492 if (const auto *EIT = T->getAs<BitIntType>())
11493 return EIT->getNumBits();
11494 // For builtin types, just use the standard type sizing method
11495 return (unsigned)getTypeSize(T);
11496 }
11497
getCorrespondingUnsignedType(QualType T) const11498 QualType ASTContext::getCorrespondingUnsignedType(QualType T) const {
11499 assert((T->hasIntegerRepresentation() || T->isEnumeralType() ||
11500 T->isFixedPointType()) &&
11501 "Unexpected type");
11502
11503 // Turn <4 x signed int> -> <4 x unsigned int>
11504 if (const auto *VTy = T->getAs<VectorType>())
11505 return getVectorType(getCorrespondingUnsignedType(VTy->getElementType()),
11506 VTy->getNumElements(), VTy->getVectorKind());
11507
11508 // For _BitInt, return an unsigned _BitInt with same width.
11509 if (const auto *EITy = T->getAs<BitIntType>())
11510 return getBitIntType(/*Unsigned=*/true, EITy->getNumBits());
11511
11512 // For enums, get the underlying integer type of the enum, and let the general
11513 // integer type signchanging code handle it.
11514 if (const auto *ETy = T->getAs<EnumType>())
11515 T = ETy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
11516
11517 switch (T->castAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
11518 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
11519 // Plain `char` is mapped to `unsigned char` even if it's already unsigned
11520 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
11521 case BuiltinType::SChar:
11522 case BuiltinType::Char8:
11523 return UnsignedCharTy;
11524 case BuiltinType::Short:
11525 return UnsignedShortTy;
11526 case BuiltinType::Int:
11527 return UnsignedIntTy;
11528 case BuiltinType::Long:
11529 return UnsignedLongTy;
11530 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
11531 return UnsignedLongLongTy;
11532 case BuiltinType::Int128:
11533 return UnsignedInt128Ty;
11534 // wchar_t is special. It is either signed or not, but when it's signed,
11535 // there's no matching "unsigned wchar_t". Therefore we return the unsigned
11536 // version of its underlying type instead.
11537 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
11538 return getUnsignedWCharType();
11539
11540 case BuiltinType::ShortAccum:
11541 return UnsignedShortAccumTy;
11542 case BuiltinType::Accum:
11543 return UnsignedAccumTy;
11544 case BuiltinType::LongAccum:
11545 return UnsignedLongAccumTy;
11546 case BuiltinType::SatShortAccum:
11547 return SatUnsignedShortAccumTy;
11548 case BuiltinType::SatAccum:
11549 return SatUnsignedAccumTy;
11550 case BuiltinType::SatLongAccum:
11551 return SatUnsignedLongAccumTy;
11552 case BuiltinType::ShortFract:
11553 return UnsignedShortFractTy;
11554 case BuiltinType::Fract:
11555 return UnsignedFractTy;
11556 case BuiltinType::LongFract:
11557 return UnsignedLongFractTy;
11558 case BuiltinType::SatShortFract:
11559 return SatUnsignedShortFractTy;
11560 case BuiltinType::SatFract:
11561 return SatUnsignedFractTy;
11562 case BuiltinType::SatLongFract:
11563 return SatUnsignedLongFractTy;
11564 default:
11565 assert((T->hasUnsignedIntegerRepresentation() ||
11566 T->isUnsignedFixedPointType()) &&
11567 "Unexpected signed integer or fixed point type");
11568 return T;
11569 }
11570 }
11571
getCorrespondingSignedType(QualType T) const11572 QualType ASTContext::getCorrespondingSignedType(QualType T) const {
11573 assert((T->hasIntegerRepresentation() || T->isEnumeralType() ||
11574 T->isFixedPointType()) &&
11575 "Unexpected type");
11576
11577 // Turn <4 x unsigned int> -> <4 x signed int>
11578 if (const auto *VTy = T->getAs<VectorType>())
11579 return getVectorType(getCorrespondingSignedType(VTy->getElementType()),
11580 VTy->getNumElements(), VTy->getVectorKind());
11581
11582 // For _BitInt, return a signed _BitInt with same width.
11583 if (const auto *EITy = T->getAs<BitIntType>())
11584 return getBitIntType(/*Unsigned=*/false, EITy->getNumBits());
11585
11586 // For enums, get the underlying integer type of the enum, and let the general
11587 // integer type signchanging code handle it.
11588 if (const auto *ETy = T->getAs<EnumType>())
11589 T = ETy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
11590
11591 switch (T->castAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
11592 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
11593 // Plain `char` is mapped to `signed char` even if it's already signed
11594 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
11595 case BuiltinType::UChar:
11596 case BuiltinType::Char8:
11597 return SignedCharTy;
11598 case BuiltinType::UShort:
11599 return ShortTy;
11600 case BuiltinType::UInt:
11601 return IntTy;
11602 case BuiltinType::ULong:
11603 return LongTy;
11604 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
11605 return LongLongTy;
11606 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
11607 return Int128Ty;
11608 // wchar_t is special. It is either unsigned or not, but when it's unsigned,
11609 // there's no matching "signed wchar_t". Therefore we return the signed
11610 // version of its underlying type instead.
11611 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
11612 return getSignedWCharType();
11613
11614 case BuiltinType::UShortAccum:
11615 return ShortAccumTy;
11616 case BuiltinType::UAccum:
11617 return AccumTy;
11618 case BuiltinType::ULongAccum:
11619 return LongAccumTy;
11620 case BuiltinType::SatUShortAccum:
11621 return SatShortAccumTy;
11622 case BuiltinType::SatUAccum:
11623 return SatAccumTy;
11624 case BuiltinType::SatULongAccum:
11625 return SatLongAccumTy;
11626 case BuiltinType::UShortFract:
11627 return ShortFractTy;
11628 case BuiltinType::UFract:
11629 return FractTy;
11630 case BuiltinType::ULongFract:
11631 return LongFractTy;
11632 case BuiltinType::SatUShortFract:
11633 return SatShortFractTy;
11634 case BuiltinType::SatUFract:
11635 return SatFractTy;
11636 case BuiltinType::SatULongFract:
11637 return SatLongFractTy;
11638 default:
11639 assert(
11640 (T->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation() || T->isSignedFixedPointType()) &&
11641 "Unexpected signed integer or fixed point type");
11642 return T;
11643 }
11644 }
11645
11646 ASTMutationListener::~ASTMutationListener() = default;
11647
DeducedReturnType(const FunctionDecl * FD,QualType ReturnType)11648 void ASTMutationListener::DeducedReturnType(const FunctionDecl *FD,
11649 QualType ReturnType) {}
11650
11651 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
11652 // Builtin Type Computation
11653 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
11654
11655 /// DecodeTypeFromStr - This decodes one type descriptor from Str, advancing the
11656 /// pointer over the consumed characters. This returns the resultant type. If
11657 /// AllowTypeModifiers is false then modifier like * are not parsed, just basic
11658 /// types. This allows "v2i*" to be parsed as a pointer to a v2i instead of
11659 /// a vector of "i*".
11660 ///
11661 /// RequiresICE is filled in on return to indicate whether the value is required
11662 /// to be an Integer Constant Expression.
DecodeTypeFromStr(const char * & Str,const ASTContext & Context,ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError & Error,bool & RequiresICE,bool AllowTypeModifiers)11663 static QualType DecodeTypeFromStr(const char *&Str, const ASTContext &Context,
11664 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
11665 bool &RequiresICE,
11666 bool AllowTypeModifiers) {
11667 // Modifiers.
11668 int HowLong = 0;
11669 bool Signed = false, Unsigned = false;
11670 RequiresICE = false;
11671
11672 // Read the prefixed modifiers first.
11673 bool Done = false;
11674 #ifndef NDEBUG
11675 bool IsSpecial = false;
11676 #endif
11677 while (!Done) {
11678 switch (*Str++) {
11679 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
11680 case 'I':
11681 RequiresICE = true;
11682 break;
11683 case 'S':
11684 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
11685 assert(!Signed && "Can't use 'S' modifier multiple times!");
11686 Signed = true;
11687 break;
11688 case 'U':
11689 assert(!Signed && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
11690 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use 'U' modifier multiple times!");
11691 Unsigned = true;
11692 break;
11693 case 'L':
11694 assert(!IsSpecial && "Can't use 'L' with 'W', 'N', 'Z' or 'O' modifiers");
11695 assert(HowLong <= 2 && "Can't have LLLL modifier");
11696 ++HowLong;
11697 break;
11698 case 'N':
11699 // 'N' behaves like 'L' for all non LP64 targets and 'int' otherwise.
11700 assert(!IsSpecial && "Can't use two 'N', 'W', 'Z' or 'O' modifiers!");
11701 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Can't use both 'L' and 'N' modifiers!");
11702 #ifndef NDEBUG
11703 IsSpecial = true;
11704 #endif
11705 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32)
11706 ++HowLong;
11707 break;
11708 case 'W':
11709 // This modifier represents int64 type.
11710 assert(!IsSpecial && "Can't use two 'N', 'W', 'Z' or 'O' modifiers!");
11711 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Can't use both 'L' and 'W' modifiers!");
11712 #ifndef NDEBUG
11713 IsSpecial = true;
11714 #endif
11715 switch (Context.getTargetInfo().getInt64Type()) {
11716 default:
11717 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected integer type");
11718 case TargetInfo::SignedLong:
11719 HowLong = 1;
11720 break;
11721 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong:
11722 HowLong = 2;
11723 break;
11724 }
11725 break;
11726 case 'Z':
11727 // This modifier represents int32 type.
11728 assert(!IsSpecial && "Can't use two 'N', 'W', 'Z' or 'O' modifiers!");
11729 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Can't use both 'L' and 'Z' modifiers!");
11730 #ifndef NDEBUG
11731 IsSpecial = true;
11732 #endif
11733 switch (Context.getTargetInfo().getIntTypeByWidth(32, true)) {
11734 default:
11735 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected integer type");
11736 case TargetInfo::SignedInt:
11737 HowLong = 0;
11738 break;
11739 case TargetInfo::SignedLong:
11740 HowLong = 1;
11741 break;
11742 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong:
11743 HowLong = 2;
11744 break;
11745 }
11746 break;
11747 case 'O':
11748 assert(!IsSpecial && "Can't use two 'N', 'W', 'Z' or 'O' modifiers!");
11749 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Can't use both 'L' and 'O' modifiers!");
11750 #ifndef NDEBUG
11751 IsSpecial = true;
11752 #endif
11753 if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL)
11754 HowLong = 1;
11755 else
11756 HowLong = 2;
11757 break;
11758 }
11759 }
11760
11761 QualType Type;
11762
11763 // Read the base type.
11764 switch (*Str++) {
11765 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type letter!");
11766 case 'x':
11767 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
11768 "Bad modifiers used with 'x'!");
11769 Type = Context.Float16Ty;
11770 break;
11771 case 'y':
11772 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
11773 "Bad modifiers used with 'y'!");
11774 Type = Context.BFloat16Ty;
11775 break;
11776 case 'v':
11777 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
11778 "Bad modifiers used with 'v'!");
11779 Type = Context.VoidTy;
11780 break;
11781 case 'h':
11782 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
11783 "Bad modifiers used with 'h'!");
11784 Type = Context.HalfTy;
11785 break;
11786 case 'f':
11787 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
11788 "Bad modifiers used with 'f'!");
11789 Type = Context.FloatTy;
11790 break;
11791 case 'd':
11792 assert(HowLong < 3 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
11793 "Bad modifiers used with 'd'!");
11794 if (HowLong == 1)
11795 Type = Context.LongDoubleTy;
11796 else if (HowLong == 2)
11797 Type = Context.Float128Ty;
11798 else
11799 Type = Context.DoubleTy;
11800 break;
11801 case 's':
11802 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 's'!");
11803 if (Unsigned)
11804 Type = Context.UnsignedShortTy;
11805 else
11806 Type = Context.ShortTy;
11807 break;
11808 case 'i':
11809 if (HowLong == 3)
11810 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedInt128Ty : Context.Int128Ty;
11811 else if (HowLong == 2)
11812 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongLongTy : Context.LongLongTy;
11813 else if (HowLong == 1)
11814 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongTy : Context.LongTy;
11815 else
11816 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedIntTy : Context.IntTy;
11817 break;
11818 case 'c':
11819 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 'c'!");
11820 if (Signed)
11821 Type = Context.SignedCharTy;
11822 else if (Unsigned)
11823 Type = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
11824 else
11825 Type = Context.CharTy;
11826 break;
11827 case 'b': // boolean
11828 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'b'!");
11829 Type = Context.BoolTy;
11830 break;
11831 case 'z': // size_t.
11832 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'z'!");
11833 Type = Context.getSizeType();
11834 break;
11835 case 'w': // wchar_t.
11836 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'w'!");
11837 Type = Context.getWideCharType();
11838 break;
11839 case 'F':
11840 Type = Context.getCFConstantStringType();
11841 break;
11842 case 'G':
11843 Type = Context.getObjCIdType();
11844 break;
11845 case 'H':
11846 Type = Context.getObjCSelType();
11847 break;
11848 case 'M':
11849 Type = Context.getObjCSuperType();
11850 break;
11851 case 'a':
11852 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
11853 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
11854 break;
11855 case 'A':
11856 // This is a "reference" to a va_list; however, what exactly
11857 // this means depends on how va_list is defined. There are two
11858 // different kinds of va_list: ones passed by value, and ones
11859 // passed by reference. An example of a by-value va_list is
11860 // x86, where va_list is a char*. An example of by-ref va_list
11861 // is x86-64, where va_list is a __va_list_tag[1]. For x86,
11862 // we want this argument to be a char*&; for x86-64, we want
11863 // it to be a __va_list_tag*.
11864 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
11865 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
11866 if (Type->isArrayType())
11867 Type = Context.getArrayDecayedType(Type);
11868 else
11869 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
11870 break;
11871 case 'q': {
11872 char *End;
11873 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
11874 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
11875 Str = End;
11876
11877 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error,
11878 RequiresICE, false);
11879 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require vector ICE");
11880
11881 Type = Context.getScalableVectorType(ElementType, NumElements);
11882 break;
11883 }
11884 case 'Q': {
11885 switch (*Str++) {
11886 case 'a': {
11887 Type = Context.SveCountTy;
11888 break;
11889 }
11890 case 'b': {
11891 Type = Context.AMDGPUBufferRsrcTy;
11892 break;
11893 }
11894 default:
11895 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected target builtin type");
11896 }
11897 break;
11898 }
11899 case 'V': {
11900 char *End;
11901 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
11902 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
11903 Str = End;
11904
11905 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error,
11906 RequiresICE, false);
11907 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require vector ICE");
11908
11909 // TODO: No way to make AltiVec vectors in builtins yet.
11910 Type = Context.getVectorType(ElementType, NumElements, VectorKind::Generic);
11911 break;
11912 }
11913 case 'E': {
11914 char *End;
11915
11916 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
11917 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
11918
11919 Str = End;
11920
11921 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
11922 false);
11923 Type = Context.getExtVectorType(ElementType, NumElements);
11924 break;
11925 }
11926 case 'X': {
11927 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
11928 false);
11929 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require complex ICE");
11930 Type = Context.getComplexType(ElementType);
11931 break;
11932 }
11933 case 'Y':
11934 Type = Context.getPointerDiffType();
11935 break;
11936 case 'P':
11937 Type = Context.getFILEType();
11938 if (Type.isNull()) {
11939 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_stdio;
11940 return {};
11941 }
11942 break;
11943 case 'J':
11944 if (Signed)
11945 Type = Context.getsigjmp_bufType();
11946 else
11947 Type = Context.getjmp_bufType();
11948
11949 if (Type.isNull()) {
11950 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp;
11951 return {};
11952 }
11953 break;
11954 case 'K':
11955 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'K'!");
11956 Type = Context.getucontext_tType();
11957
11958 if (Type.isNull()) {
11959 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_ucontext;
11960 return {};
11961 }
11962 break;
11963 case 'p':
11964 Type = Context.getProcessIDType();
11965 break;
11966 }
11967
11968 // If there are modifiers and if we're allowed to parse them, go for it.
11969 Done = !AllowTypeModifiers;
11970 while (!Done) {
11971 switch (char c = *Str++) {
11972 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
11973 case '*':
11974 case '&': {
11975 // Both pointers and references can have their pointee types
11976 // qualified with an address space.
11977 char *End;
11978 unsigned AddrSpace = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
11979 if (End != Str) {
11980 // Note AddrSpace == 0 is not the same as an unspecified address space.
11981 Type = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(
11982 Type,
11983 Context.getLangASForBuiltinAddressSpace(AddrSpace));
11984 Str = End;
11985 }
11986 if (c == '*')
11987 Type = Context.getPointerType(Type);
11988 else
11989 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
11990 break;
11991 }
11992 // FIXME: There's no way to have a built-in with an rvalue ref arg.
11993 case 'C':
11994 Type = Type.withConst();
11995 break;
11996 case 'D':
11997 Type = Context.getVolatileType(Type);
11998 break;
11999 case 'R':
12000 Type = Type.withRestrict();
12001 break;
12002 }
12003 }
12004
12005 assert((!RequiresICE || Type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) &&
12006 "Integer constant 'I' type must be an integer");
12007
12008 return Type;
12009 }
12010
12011 // On some targets such as PowerPC, some of the builtins are defined with custom
12012 // type descriptors for target-dependent types. These descriptors are decoded in
12013 // other functions, but it may be useful to be able to fall back to default
12014 // descriptor decoding to define builtins mixing target-dependent and target-
12015 // independent types. This function allows decoding one type descriptor with
12016 // default decoding.
DecodeTypeStr(const char * & Str,const ASTContext & Context,GetBuiltinTypeError & Error,bool & RequireICE,bool AllowTypeModifiers) const12017 QualType ASTContext::DecodeTypeStr(const char *&Str, const ASTContext &Context,
12018 GetBuiltinTypeError &Error, bool &RequireICE,
12019 bool AllowTypeModifiers) const {
12020 return DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequireICE, AllowTypeModifiers);
12021 }
12022
12023 /// GetBuiltinType - Return the type for the specified builtin.
GetBuiltinType(unsigned Id,GetBuiltinTypeError & Error,unsigned * IntegerConstantArgs) const12024 QualType ASTContext::GetBuiltinType(unsigned Id,
12025 GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
12026 unsigned *IntegerConstantArgs) const {
12027 const char *TypeStr = BuiltinInfo.getTypeString(Id);
12028 if (TypeStr[0] == '\0') {
12029 Error = GE_Missing_type;
12030 return {};
12031 }
12032
12033 SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
12034
12035 bool RequiresICE = false;
12036 Error = GE_None;
12037 QualType ResType = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error,
12038 RequiresICE, true);
12039 if (Error != GE_None)
12040 return {};
12041
12042 assert(!RequiresICE && "Result of intrinsic cannot be required to be an ICE");
12043
12044 while (TypeStr[0] && TypeStr[0] != '.') {
12045 QualType Ty = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error, RequiresICE, true);
12046 if (Error != GE_None)
12047 return {};
12048
12049 // If this argument is required to be an IntegerConstantExpression and the
12050 // caller cares, fill in the bitmask we return.
12051 if (RequiresICE && IntegerConstantArgs)
12052 *IntegerConstantArgs |= 1 << ArgTypes.size();
12053
12054 // Do array -> pointer decay. The builtin should use the decayed type.
12055 if (Ty->isArrayType())
12056 Ty = getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
12057
12058 ArgTypes.push_back(Ty);
12059 }
12060
12061 if (Id == Builtin::BI__GetExceptionInfo)
12062 return {};
12063
12064 assert((TypeStr[0] != '.' || TypeStr[1] == 0) &&
12065 "'.' should only occur at end of builtin type list!");
12066
12067 bool Variadic = (TypeStr[0] == '.');
12068
12069 FunctionType::ExtInfo EI(getDefaultCallingConvention(
12070 Variadic, /*IsCXXMethod=*/false, /*IsBuiltin=*/true));
12071 if (BuiltinInfo.isNoReturn(Id)) EI = EI.withNoReturn(true);
12072
12073
12074 // We really shouldn't be making a no-proto type here.
12075 if (ArgTypes.empty() && Variadic && !getLangOpts().requiresStrictPrototypes())
12076 return getFunctionNoProtoType(ResType, EI);
12077
12078 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
12079 EPI.ExtInfo = EI;
12080 EPI.Variadic = Variadic;
12081 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && BuiltinInfo.isNoThrow(Id))
12082 EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type =
12083 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ? EST_BasicNoexcept : EST_DynamicNone;
12084
12085 return getFunctionType(ResType, ArgTypes, EPI);
12086 }
12087
basicGVALinkageForFunction(const ASTContext & Context,const FunctionDecl * FD)12088 static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForFunction(const ASTContext &Context,
12089 const FunctionDecl *FD) {
12090 if (!FD->isExternallyVisible())
12091 return GVA_Internal;
12092
12093 // Non-user-provided functions get emitted as weak definitions with every
12094 // use, no matter whether they've been explicitly instantiated etc.
12095 if (!FD->isUserProvided())
12096 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
12097
12098 GVALinkage External;
12099 switch (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
12100 case TSK_Undeclared:
12101 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
12102 External = GVA_StrongExternal;
12103 break;
12104
12105 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
12106 return GVA_StrongODR;
12107
12108 // C++11 [temp.explicit]p10:
12109 // [ Note: The intent is that an inline function that is the subject of
12110 // an explicit instantiation declaration will still be implicitly
12111 // instantiated when used so that the body can be considered for
12112 // inlining, but that no out-of-line copy of the inline function would be
12113 // generated in the translation unit. -- end note ]
12114 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
12115 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
12116
12117 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
12118 External = GVA_DiscardableODR;
12119 break;
12120 }
12121
12122 if (!FD->isInlined())
12123 return External;
12124
12125 if ((!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
12126 !Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() &&
12127 !FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) ||
12128 FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) {
12129 // FIXME: This doesn't match gcc's behavior for dllexport inline functions.
12130
12131 // GNU or C99 inline semantics. Determine whether this symbol should be
12132 // externally visible.
12133 if (FD->isInlineDefinitionExternallyVisible())
12134 return External;
12135
12136 // C99 inline semantics, where the symbol is not externally visible.
12137 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
12138 }
12139
12140 // Functions specified with extern and inline in -fms-compatibility mode
12141 // forcibly get emitted. While the body of the function cannot be later
12142 // replaced, the function definition cannot be discarded.
12143 if (FD->isMSExternInline())
12144 return GVA_StrongODR;
12145
12146 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() &&
12147 isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD) &&
12148 cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD)->isInheritingConstructor())
12149 // Our approach to inheriting constructors is fundamentally different from
12150 // that used by the MS ABI, so keep our inheriting constructor thunks
12151 // internal rather than trying to pick an unambiguous mangling for them.
12152 return GVA_Internal;
12153
12154 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
12155 }
12156
adjustGVALinkageForAttributes(const ASTContext & Context,const Decl * D,GVALinkage L)12157 static GVALinkage adjustGVALinkageForAttributes(const ASTContext &Context,
12158 const Decl *D, GVALinkage L) {
12159 // See http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/xa0d9ste.aspx
12160 // dllexport/dllimport on inline functions.
12161 if (D->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>()) {
12162 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR || L == GVA_StrongODR)
12163 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
12164 } else if (D->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) {
12165 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR)
12166 return GVA_StrongODR;
12167 } else if (Context.getLangOpts().CUDA && Context.getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice) {
12168 // Device-side functions with __global__ attribute must always be
12169 // visible externally so they can be launched from host.
12170 if (D->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>() &&
12171 (L == GVA_DiscardableODR || L == GVA_Internal))
12172 return GVA_StrongODR;
12173 // Single source offloading languages like CUDA/HIP need to be able to
12174 // access static device variables from host code of the same compilation
12175 // unit. This is done by externalizing the static variable with a shared
12176 // name between the host and device compilation which is the same for the
12177 // same compilation unit whereas different among different compilation
12178 // units.
12179 if (Context.shouldExternalize(D))
12180 return GVA_StrongExternal;
12181 }
12182 return L;
12183 }
12184
12185 /// Adjust the GVALinkage for a declaration based on what an external AST source
12186 /// knows about whether there can be other definitions of this declaration.
12187 static GVALinkage
adjustGVALinkageForExternalDefinitionKind(const ASTContext & Ctx,const Decl * D,GVALinkage L)12188 adjustGVALinkageForExternalDefinitionKind(const ASTContext &Ctx, const Decl *D,
12189 GVALinkage L) {
12190 ExternalASTSource *Source = Ctx.getExternalSource();
12191 if (!Source)
12192 return L;
12193
12194 switch (Source->hasExternalDefinitions(D)) {
12195 case ExternalASTSource::EK_Never:
12196 // Other translation units rely on us to provide the definition.
12197 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR)
12198 return GVA_StrongODR;
12199 break;
12200
12201 case ExternalASTSource::EK_Always:
12202 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
12203
12204 case ExternalASTSource::EK_ReplyHazy:
12205 break;
12206 }
12207 return L;
12208 }
12209
GetGVALinkageForFunction(const FunctionDecl * FD) const12210 GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD) const {
12211 return adjustGVALinkageForExternalDefinitionKind(*this, FD,
12212 adjustGVALinkageForAttributes(*this, FD,
12213 basicGVALinkageForFunction(*this, FD)));
12214 }
12215
basicGVALinkageForVariable(const ASTContext & Context,const VarDecl * VD)12216 static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForVariable(const ASTContext &Context,
12217 const VarDecl *VD) {
12218 // As an extension for interactive REPLs, make sure constant variables are
12219 // only emitted once instead of LinkageComputer::getLVForNamespaceScopeDecl
12220 // marking them as internal.
12221 if (Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
12222 Context.getLangOpts().IncrementalExtensions &&
12223 VD->getType().isConstQualified() &&
12224 !VD->getType().isVolatileQualified() && !VD->isInline() &&
12225 !isa<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(VD) && !VD->getDescribedVarTemplate())
12226 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
12227
12228 if (!VD->isExternallyVisible())
12229 return GVA_Internal;
12230
12231 if (VD->isStaticLocal()) {
12232 const DeclContext *LexicalContext = VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod();
12233 while (LexicalContext && !isa<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext))
12234 LexicalContext = LexicalContext->getLexicalParent();
12235
12236 // ObjC Blocks can create local variables that don't have a FunctionDecl
12237 // LexicalContext.
12238 if (!LexicalContext)
12239 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
12240
12241 // Otherwise, let the static local variable inherit its linkage from the
12242 // nearest enclosing function.
12243 auto StaticLocalLinkage =
12244 Context.GetGVALinkageForFunction(cast<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext));
12245
12246 // Itanium ABI 5.2.2: "Each COMDAT group [for a static local variable] must
12247 // be emitted in any object with references to the symbol for the object it
12248 // contains, whether inline or out-of-line."
12249 // Similar behavior is observed with MSVC. An alternative ABI could use
12250 // StrongODR/AvailableExternally to match the function, but none are
12251 // known/supported currently.
12252 if (StaticLocalLinkage == GVA_StrongODR ||
12253 StaticLocalLinkage == GVA_AvailableExternally)
12254 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
12255 return StaticLocalLinkage;
12256 }
12257
12258 // MSVC treats in-class initialized static data members as definitions.
12259 // By giving them non-strong linkage, out-of-line definitions won't
12260 // cause link errors.
12261 if (Context.isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD))
12262 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
12263
12264 // Most non-template variables have strong linkage; inline variables are
12265 // linkonce_odr or (occasionally, for compatibility) weak_odr.
12266 GVALinkage StrongLinkage;
12267 switch (Context.getInlineVariableDefinitionKind(VD)) {
12268 case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::None:
12269 StrongLinkage = GVA_StrongExternal;
12270 break;
12271 case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Weak:
12272 case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::WeakUnknown:
12273 StrongLinkage = GVA_DiscardableODR;
12274 break;
12275 case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Strong:
12276 StrongLinkage = GVA_StrongODR;
12277 break;
12278 }
12279
12280 switch (VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
12281 case TSK_Undeclared:
12282 return StrongLinkage;
12283
12284 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
12285 return Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() &&
12286 VD->isStaticDataMember()
12287 ? GVA_StrongODR
12288 : StrongLinkage;
12289
12290 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
12291 return GVA_StrongODR;
12292
12293 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
12294 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
12295
12296 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
12297 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
12298 }
12299
12300 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Linkage!");
12301 }
12302
GetGVALinkageForVariable(const VarDecl * VD) const12303 GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForVariable(const VarDecl *VD) const {
12304 return adjustGVALinkageForExternalDefinitionKind(*this, VD,
12305 adjustGVALinkageForAttributes(*this, VD,
12306 basicGVALinkageForVariable(*this, VD)));
12307 }
12308
DeclMustBeEmitted(const Decl * D)12309 bool ASTContext::DeclMustBeEmitted(const Decl *D) {
12310 if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
12311 if (!VD->isFileVarDecl())
12312 return false;
12313 // Global named register variables (GNU extension) are never emitted.
12314 if (VD->getStorageClass() == SC_Register)
12315 return false;
12316 if (VD->getDescribedVarTemplate() ||
12317 isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(VD))
12318 return false;
12319 } else if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
12320 // We never need to emit an uninstantiated function template.
12321 if (FD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplate)
12322 return false;
12323 } else if (isa<PragmaCommentDecl>(D))
12324 return true;
12325 else if (isa<PragmaDetectMismatchDecl>(D))
12326 return true;
12327 else if (isa<OMPRequiresDecl>(D))
12328 return true;
12329 else if (isa<OMPThreadPrivateDecl>(D))
12330 return !D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext();
12331 else if (isa<OMPAllocateDecl>(D))
12332 return !D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext();
12333 else if (isa<OMPDeclareReductionDecl>(D) || isa<OMPDeclareMapperDecl>(D))
12334 return !D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext();
12335 else if (isa<ImportDecl>(D))
12336 return true;
12337 else
12338 return false;
12339
12340 // If this is a member of a class template, we do not need to emit it.
12341 if (D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext())
12342 return false;
12343
12344 // Weak references don't produce any output by themselves.
12345 if (D->hasAttr<WeakRefAttr>())
12346 return false;
12347
12348 // Aliases and used decls are required.
12349 if (D->hasAttr<AliasAttr>() || D->hasAttr<UsedAttr>())
12350 return true;
12351
12352 if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
12353 // Forward declarations aren't required.
12354 if (!FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody())
12355 return FD->doesDeclarationForceExternallyVisibleDefinition();
12356
12357 // Constructors and destructors are required.
12358 if (FD->hasAttr<ConstructorAttr>() || FD->hasAttr<DestructorAttr>())
12359 return true;
12360
12361 // The key function for a class is required. This rule only comes
12362 // into play when inline functions can be key functions, though.
12363 if (getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().canKeyFunctionBeInline()) {
12364 if (const auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) {
12365 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = MD->getParent();
12366 if (MD->isOutOfLine() && RD->isDynamicClass()) {
12367 const CXXMethodDecl *KeyFunc = getCurrentKeyFunction(RD);
12368 if (KeyFunc && KeyFunc->getCanonicalDecl() == MD->getCanonicalDecl())
12369 return true;
12370 }
12371 }
12372 }
12373
12374 GVALinkage Linkage = GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD);
12375
12376 // static, static inline, always_inline, and extern inline functions can
12377 // always be deferred. Normal inline functions can be deferred in C99/C++.
12378 // Implicit template instantiations can also be deferred in C++.
12379 return !isDiscardableGVALinkage(Linkage);
12380 }
12381
12382 const auto *VD = cast<VarDecl>(D);
12383 assert(VD->isFileVarDecl() && "Expected file scoped var");
12384
12385 // If the decl is marked as `declare target to`, it should be emitted for the
12386 // host and for the device.
12387 if (LangOpts.OpenMP &&
12388 OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::isDeclareTargetDeclaration(VD))
12389 return true;
12390
12391 if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly &&
12392 !isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD))
12393 return false;
12394
12395 if (VD->shouldEmitInExternalSource())
12396 return false;
12397
12398 // Variables that can be needed in other TUs are required.
12399 auto Linkage = GetGVALinkageForVariable(VD);
12400 if (!isDiscardableGVALinkage(Linkage))
12401 return true;
12402
12403 // We never need to emit a variable that is available in another TU.
12404 if (Linkage == GVA_AvailableExternally)
12405 return false;
12406
12407 // Variables that have destruction with side-effects are required.
12408 if (VD->needsDestruction(*this))
12409 return true;
12410
12411 // Variables that have initialization with side-effects are required.
12412 if (VD->getInit() && VD->getInit()->HasSideEffects(*this) &&
12413 // We can get a value-dependent initializer during error recovery.
12414 (VD->getInit()->isValueDependent() || !VD->evaluateValue()))
12415 return true;
12416
12417 // Likewise, variables with tuple-like bindings are required if their
12418 // bindings have side-effects.
12419 if (const auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(VD))
12420 for (const auto *BD : DD->bindings())
12421 if (const auto *BindingVD = BD->getHoldingVar())
12422 if (DeclMustBeEmitted(BindingVD))
12423 return true;
12424
12425 return false;
12426 }
12427
forEachMultiversionedFunctionVersion(const FunctionDecl * FD,llvm::function_ref<void (FunctionDecl *)> Pred) const12428 void ASTContext::forEachMultiversionedFunctionVersion(
12429 const FunctionDecl *FD,
12430 llvm::function_ref<void(FunctionDecl *)> Pred) const {
12431 assert(FD->isMultiVersion() && "Only valid for multiversioned functions");
12432 llvm::SmallDenseSet<const FunctionDecl*, 4> SeenDecls;
12433 FD = FD->getMostRecentDecl();
12434 // FIXME: The order of traversal here matters and depends on the order of
12435 // lookup results, which happens to be (mostly) oldest-to-newest, but we
12436 // shouldn't rely on that.
12437 for (auto *CurDecl :
12438 FD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->lookup(FD->getDeclName())) {
12439 FunctionDecl *CurFD = CurDecl->getAsFunction()->getMostRecentDecl();
12440 if (CurFD && hasSameType(CurFD->getType(), FD->getType()) &&
12441 !SeenDecls.contains(CurFD)) {
12442 SeenDecls.insert(CurFD);
12443 Pred(CurFD);
12444 }
12445 }
12446 }
12447
getDefaultCallingConvention(bool IsVariadic,bool IsCXXMethod,bool IsBuiltin) const12448 CallingConv ASTContext::getDefaultCallingConvention(bool IsVariadic,
12449 bool IsCXXMethod,
12450 bool IsBuiltin) const {
12451 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
12452 if (IsCXXMethod)
12453 return ABI->getDefaultMethodCallConv(IsVariadic);
12454
12455 // Builtins ignore user-specified default calling convention and remain the
12456 // Target's default calling convention.
12457 if (!IsBuiltin) {
12458 switch (LangOpts.getDefaultCallingConv()) {
12459 case LangOptions::DCC_None:
12460 break;
12461 case LangOptions::DCC_CDecl:
12462 return CC_C;
12463 case LangOptions::DCC_FastCall:
12464 if (getTargetInfo().hasFeature("sse2") && !IsVariadic)
12465 return CC_X86FastCall;
12466 break;
12467 case LangOptions::DCC_StdCall:
12468 if (!IsVariadic)
12469 return CC_X86StdCall;
12470 break;
12471 case LangOptions::DCC_VectorCall:
12472 // __vectorcall cannot be applied to variadic functions.
12473 if (!IsVariadic)
12474 return CC_X86VectorCall;
12475 break;
12476 case LangOptions::DCC_RegCall:
12477 // __regcall cannot be applied to variadic functions.
12478 if (!IsVariadic)
12479 return CC_X86RegCall;
12480 break;
12481 case LangOptions::DCC_RtdCall:
12482 if (!IsVariadic)
12483 return CC_M68kRTD;
12484 break;
12485 }
12486 }
12487 return Target->getDefaultCallingConv();
12488 }
12489
isNearlyEmpty(const CXXRecordDecl * RD) const12490 bool ASTContext::isNearlyEmpty(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
12491 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
12492 return ABI->isNearlyEmpty(RD);
12493 }
12494
getVTableContext()12495 VTableContextBase *ASTContext::getVTableContext() {
12496 if (!VTContext.get()) {
12497 auto ABI = Target->getCXXABI();
12498 if (ABI.isMicrosoft())
12499 VTContext.reset(new MicrosoftVTableContext(*this));
12500 else {
12501 auto ComponentLayout = getLangOpts().RelativeCXXABIVTables
12502 ? ItaniumVTableContext::Relative
12503 : ItaniumVTableContext::Pointer;
12504 VTContext.reset(new ItaniumVTableContext(*this, ComponentLayout));
12505 }
12506 }
12507 return VTContext.get();
12508 }
12509
createMangleContext(const TargetInfo * T)12510 MangleContext *ASTContext::createMangleContext(const TargetInfo *T) {
12511 if (!T)
12512 T = Target;
12513 switch (T->getCXXABI().getKind()) {
12514 case TargetCXXABI::AppleARM64:
12515 case TargetCXXABI::Fuchsia:
12516 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
12517 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
12518 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM:
12519 case TargetCXXABI::GenericMIPS:
12520 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
12521 case TargetCXXABI::WebAssembly:
12522 case TargetCXXABI::WatchOS:
12523 case TargetCXXABI::XL:
12524 return ItaniumMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
12525 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
12526 return MicrosoftMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
12527 }
12528 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI");
12529 }
12530
createDeviceMangleContext(const TargetInfo & T)12531 MangleContext *ASTContext::createDeviceMangleContext(const TargetInfo &T) {
12532 assert(T.getCXXABI().getKind() != TargetCXXABI::Microsoft &&
12533 "Device mangle context does not support Microsoft mangling.");
12534 switch (T.getCXXABI().getKind()) {
12535 case TargetCXXABI::AppleARM64:
12536 case TargetCXXABI::Fuchsia:
12537 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
12538 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
12539 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM:
12540 case TargetCXXABI::GenericMIPS:
12541 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
12542 case TargetCXXABI::WebAssembly:
12543 case TargetCXXABI::WatchOS:
12544 case TargetCXXABI::XL:
12545 return ItaniumMangleContext::create(
12546 *this, getDiagnostics(),
12547 [](ASTContext &, const NamedDecl *ND) -> std::optional<unsigned> {
12548 if (const auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ND))
12549 return RD->getDeviceLambdaManglingNumber();
12550 return std::nullopt;
12551 },
12552 /*IsAux=*/true);
12553 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
12554 return MicrosoftMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics(),
12555 /*IsAux=*/true);
12556 }
12557 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI");
12558 }
12559
12560 CXXABI::~CXXABI() = default;
12561
getSideTableAllocatedMemory() const12562 size_t ASTContext::getSideTableAllocatedMemory() const {
12563 return ASTRecordLayouts.getMemorySize() +
12564 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCLayouts) +
12565 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(KeyFunctions) +
12566 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCImpls) +
12567 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(BlockVarCopyInits) +
12568 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(DeclAttrs) +
12569 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(TemplateOrInstantiation) +
12570 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingDecl) +
12571 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl) +
12572 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl) +
12573 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(OverriddenMethods) +
12574 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(Types) +
12575 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(VariableArrayTypes);
12576 }
12577
12578 /// getIntTypeForBitwidth -
12579 /// sets integer QualTy according to specified details:
12580 /// bitwidth, signed/unsigned.
12581 /// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
getIntTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth,unsigned Signed) const12582 QualType ASTContext::getIntTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth,
12583 unsigned Signed) const {
12584 TargetInfo::IntType Ty = getTargetInfo().getIntTypeByWidth(DestWidth, Signed);
12585 CanQualType QualTy = getFromTargetType(Ty);
12586 if (!QualTy && DestWidth == 128)
12587 return Signed ? Int128Ty : UnsignedInt128Ty;
12588 return QualTy;
12589 }
12590
12591 /// getRealTypeForBitwidth -
12592 /// sets floating point QualTy according to specified bitwidth.
12593 /// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
getRealTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth,FloatModeKind ExplicitType) const12594 QualType ASTContext::getRealTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth,
12595 FloatModeKind ExplicitType) const {
12596 FloatModeKind Ty =
12597 getTargetInfo().getRealTypeByWidth(DestWidth, ExplicitType);
12598 switch (Ty) {
12599 case FloatModeKind::Half:
12600 return HalfTy;
12601 case FloatModeKind::Float:
12602 return FloatTy;
12603 case FloatModeKind::Double:
12604 return DoubleTy;
12605 case FloatModeKind::LongDouble:
12606 return LongDoubleTy;
12607 case FloatModeKind::Float128:
12608 return Float128Ty;
12609 case FloatModeKind::Ibm128:
12610 return Ibm128Ty;
12611 case FloatModeKind::NoFloat:
12612 return {};
12613 }
12614
12615 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::RealType value");
12616 }
12617
setManglingNumber(const NamedDecl * ND,unsigned Number)12618 void ASTContext::setManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND, unsigned Number) {
12619 if (Number <= 1)
12620 return;
12621
12622 MangleNumbers[ND] = Number;
12623
12624 if (Listener)
12625 Listener->AddedManglingNumber(ND, Number);
12626 }
12627
getManglingNumber(const NamedDecl * ND,bool ForAuxTarget) const12628 unsigned ASTContext::getManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND,
12629 bool ForAuxTarget) const {
12630 auto I = MangleNumbers.find(ND);
12631 unsigned Res = I != MangleNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
12632 // CUDA/HIP host compilation encodes host and device mangling numbers
12633 // as lower and upper half of 32 bit integer.
12634 if (LangOpts.CUDA && !LangOpts.CUDAIsDevice) {
12635 Res = ForAuxTarget ? Res >> 16 : Res & 0xFFFF;
12636 } else {
12637 assert(!ForAuxTarget && "Only CUDA/HIP host compilation supports mangling "
12638 "number for aux target");
12639 }
12640 return Res > 1 ? Res : 1;
12641 }
12642
setStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl * VD,unsigned Number)12643 void ASTContext::setStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD, unsigned Number) {
12644 if (Number <= 1)
12645 return;
12646
12647 StaticLocalNumbers[VD] = Number;
12648
12649 if (Listener)
12650 Listener->AddedStaticLocalNumbers(VD, Number);
12651 }
12652
getStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl * VD) const12653 unsigned ASTContext::getStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD) const {
12654 auto I = StaticLocalNumbers.find(VD);
12655 return I != StaticLocalNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
12656 }
12657
12658 MangleNumberingContext &
getManglingNumberContext(const DeclContext * DC)12659 ASTContext::getManglingNumberContext(const DeclContext *DC) {
12660 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus); // We don't need mangling numbers for plain C.
12661 std::unique_ptr<MangleNumberingContext> &MCtx = MangleNumberingContexts[DC];
12662 if (!MCtx)
12663 MCtx = createMangleNumberingContext();
12664 return *MCtx;
12665 }
12666
12667 MangleNumberingContext &
getManglingNumberContext(NeedExtraManglingDecl_t,const Decl * D)12668 ASTContext::getManglingNumberContext(NeedExtraManglingDecl_t, const Decl *D) {
12669 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus); // We don't need mangling numbers for plain C.
12670 std::unique_ptr<MangleNumberingContext> &MCtx =
12671 ExtraMangleNumberingContexts[D];
12672 if (!MCtx)
12673 MCtx = createMangleNumberingContext();
12674 return *MCtx;
12675 }
12676
12677 std::unique_ptr<MangleNumberingContext>
createMangleNumberingContext() const12678 ASTContext::createMangleNumberingContext() const {
12679 return ABI->createMangleNumberingContext();
12680 }
12681
12682 const CXXConstructorDecl *
getCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl * RD)12683 ASTContext::getCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl *RD) {
12684 return ABI->getCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(
12685 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getFirstDecl()));
12686 }
12687
addCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl * RD,CXXConstructorDecl * CD)12688 void ASTContext::addCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl *RD,
12689 CXXConstructorDecl *CD) {
12690 return ABI->addCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(
12691 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getFirstDecl()),
12692 cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(CD->getFirstDecl()));
12693 }
12694
addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TagDecl * TD,TypedefNameDecl * DD)12695 void ASTContext::addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TagDecl *TD,
12696 TypedefNameDecl *DD) {
12697 return ABI->addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TD, DD);
12698 }
12699
12700 TypedefNameDecl *
getTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(const TagDecl * TD)12701 ASTContext::getTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(const TagDecl *TD) {
12702 return ABI->getTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TD);
12703 }
12704
addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TagDecl * TD,DeclaratorDecl * DD)12705 void ASTContext::addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TagDecl *TD,
12706 DeclaratorDecl *DD) {
12707 return ABI->addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TD, DD);
12708 }
12709
getDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(const TagDecl * TD)12710 DeclaratorDecl *ASTContext::getDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(const TagDecl *TD) {
12711 return ABI->getDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TD);
12712 }
12713
setParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl * D,unsigned int index)12714 void ASTContext::setParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D, unsigned int index) {
12715 ParamIndices[D] = index;
12716 }
12717
getParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl * D) const12718 unsigned ASTContext::getParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D) const {
12719 ParameterIndexTable::const_iterator I = ParamIndices.find(D);
12720 assert(I != ParamIndices.end() &&
12721 "ParmIndices lacks entry set by ParmVarDecl");
12722 return I->second;
12723 }
12724
getStringLiteralArrayType(QualType EltTy,unsigned Length) const12725 QualType ASTContext::getStringLiteralArrayType(QualType EltTy,
12726 unsigned Length) const {
12727 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
12728 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || getLangOpts().ConstStrings)
12729 EltTy = EltTy.withConst();
12730
12731 EltTy = adjustStringLiteralBaseType(EltTy);
12732
12733 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
12734 // the null terminator character.
12735 return getConstantArrayType(EltTy, llvm::APInt(32, Length + 1), nullptr,
12736 ArraySizeModifier::Normal, /*IndexTypeQuals*/ 0);
12737 }
12738
12739 StringLiteral *
getPredefinedStringLiteralFromCache(StringRef Key) const12740 ASTContext::getPredefinedStringLiteralFromCache(StringRef Key) const {
12741 StringLiteral *&Result = StringLiteralCache[Key];
12742 if (!Result)
12743 Result = StringLiteral::Create(
12744 *this, Key, StringLiteralKind::Ordinary,
12745 /*Pascal*/ false, getStringLiteralArrayType(CharTy, Key.size()),
12746 SourceLocation());
12747 return Result;
12748 }
12749
12750 MSGuidDecl *
getMSGuidDecl(MSGuidDecl::Parts Parts) const12751 ASTContext::getMSGuidDecl(MSGuidDecl::Parts Parts) const {
12752 assert(MSGuidTagDecl && "building MS GUID without MS extensions?");
12753
12754 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
12755 MSGuidDecl::Profile(ID, Parts);
12756
12757 void *InsertPos;
12758 if (MSGuidDecl *Existing = MSGuidDecls.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
12759 return Existing;
12760
12761 QualType GUIDType = getMSGuidType().withConst();
12762 MSGuidDecl *New = MSGuidDecl::Create(*this, GUIDType, Parts);
12763 MSGuidDecls.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
12764 return New;
12765 }
12766
12767 UnnamedGlobalConstantDecl *
getUnnamedGlobalConstantDecl(QualType Ty,const APValue & APVal) const12768 ASTContext::getUnnamedGlobalConstantDecl(QualType Ty,
12769 const APValue &APVal) const {
12770 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
12771 UnnamedGlobalConstantDecl::Profile(ID, Ty, APVal);
12772
12773 void *InsertPos;
12774 if (UnnamedGlobalConstantDecl *Existing =
12775 UnnamedGlobalConstantDecls.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
12776 return Existing;
12777
12778 UnnamedGlobalConstantDecl *New =
12779 UnnamedGlobalConstantDecl::Create(*this, Ty, APVal);
12780 UnnamedGlobalConstantDecls.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
12781 return New;
12782 }
12783
12784 TemplateParamObjectDecl *
getTemplateParamObjectDecl(QualType T,const APValue & V) const12785 ASTContext::getTemplateParamObjectDecl(QualType T, const APValue &V) const {
12786 assert(T->isRecordType() && "template param object of unexpected type");
12787
12788 // C++ [temp.param]p8:
12789 // [...] a static storage duration object of type 'const T' [...]
12790 T.addConst();
12791
12792 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
12793 TemplateParamObjectDecl::Profile(ID, T, V);
12794
12795 void *InsertPos;
12796 if (TemplateParamObjectDecl *Existing =
12797 TemplateParamObjectDecls.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
12798 return Existing;
12799
12800 TemplateParamObjectDecl *New = TemplateParamObjectDecl::Create(*this, T, V);
12801 TemplateParamObjectDecls.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
12802 return New;
12803 }
12804
AtomicUsesUnsupportedLibcall(const AtomicExpr * E) const12805 bool ASTContext::AtomicUsesUnsupportedLibcall(const AtomicExpr *E) const {
12806 const llvm::Triple &T = getTargetInfo().getTriple();
12807 if (!T.isOSDarwin())
12808 return false;
12809
12810 if (!(T.isiOS() && T.isOSVersionLT(7)) &&
12811 !(T.isMacOSX() && T.isOSVersionLT(10, 9)))
12812 return false;
12813
12814 QualType AtomicTy = E->getPtr()->getType()->getPointeeType();
12815 CharUnits sizeChars = getTypeSizeInChars(AtomicTy);
12816 uint64_t Size = sizeChars.getQuantity();
12817 CharUnits alignChars = getTypeAlignInChars(AtomicTy);
12818 unsigned Align = alignChars.getQuantity();
12819 unsigned MaxInlineWidthInBits = getTargetInfo().getMaxAtomicInlineWidth();
12820 return (Size != Align || toBits(sizeChars) > MaxInlineWidthInBits);
12821 }
12822
12823 bool
ObjCMethodsAreEqual(const ObjCMethodDecl * MethodDecl,const ObjCMethodDecl * MethodImpl)12824 ASTContext::ObjCMethodsAreEqual(const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodDecl,
12825 const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodImpl) {
12826 // No point trying to match an unavailable/deprecated mothod.
12827 if (MethodDecl->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>()
12828 || MethodDecl->hasAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
12829 return false;
12830 if (MethodDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier() !=
12831 MethodImpl->getObjCDeclQualifier())
12832 return false;
12833 if (!hasSameType(MethodDecl->getReturnType(), MethodImpl->getReturnType()))
12834 return false;
12835
12836 if (MethodDecl->param_size() != MethodImpl->param_size())
12837 return false;
12838
12839 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator IM = MethodImpl->param_begin(),
12840 IF = MethodDecl->param_begin(), EM = MethodImpl->param_end(),
12841 EF = MethodDecl->param_end();
12842 IM != EM && IF != EF; ++IM, ++IF) {
12843 const ParmVarDecl *DeclVar = (*IF);
12844 const ParmVarDecl *ImplVar = (*IM);
12845 if (ImplVar->getObjCDeclQualifier() != DeclVar->getObjCDeclQualifier())
12846 return false;
12847 if (!hasSameType(DeclVar->getType(), ImplVar->getType()))
12848 return false;
12849 }
12850
12851 return (MethodDecl->isVariadic() == MethodImpl->isVariadic());
12852 }
12853
getTargetNullPointerValue(QualType QT) const12854 uint64_t ASTContext::getTargetNullPointerValue(QualType QT) const {
12855 LangAS AS;
12856 if (QT->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType()->isNullPtrType())
12857 AS = LangAS::Default;
12858 else
12859 AS = QT->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
12860
12861 return getTargetInfo().getNullPointerValue(AS);
12862 }
12863
getTargetAddressSpace(LangAS AS) const12864 unsigned ASTContext::getTargetAddressSpace(LangAS AS) const {
12865 return getTargetInfo().getTargetAddressSpace(AS);
12866 }
12867
hasSameExpr(const Expr * X,const Expr * Y) const12868 bool ASTContext::hasSameExpr(const Expr *X, const Expr *Y) const {
12869 if (X == Y)
12870 return true;
12871 if (!X || !Y)
12872 return false;
12873 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID IDX, IDY;
12874 X->Profile(IDX, *this, /*Canonical=*/true);
12875 Y->Profile(IDY, *this, /*Canonical=*/true);
12876 return IDX == IDY;
12877 }
12878
12879 // The getCommon* helpers return, for given 'same' X and Y entities given as
12880 // inputs, another entity which is also the 'same' as the inputs, but which
12881 // is closer to the canonical form of the inputs, each according to a given
12882 // criteria.
12883 // The getCommon*Checked variants are 'null inputs not-allowed' equivalents of
12884 // the regular ones.
12885
getCommonDecl(Decl * X,Decl * Y)12886 static Decl *getCommonDecl(Decl *X, Decl *Y) {
12887 if (!declaresSameEntity(X, Y))
12888 return nullptr;
12889 for (const Decl *DX : X->redecls()) {
12890 // If we reach Y before reaching the first decl, that means X is older.
12891 if (DX == Y)
12892 return X;
12893 // If we reach the first decl, then Y is older.
12894 if (DX->isFirstDecl())
12895 return Y;
12896 }
12897 llvm_unreachable("Corrupt redecls chain");
12898 }
12899
12900 template <class T, std::enable_if_t<std::is_base_of_v<Decl, T>, bool> = true>
getCommonDecl(T * X,T * Y)12901 static T *getCommonDecl(T *X, T *Y) {
12902 return cast_or_null<T>(
12903 getCommonDecl(const_cast<Decl *>(cast_or_null<Decl>(X)),
12904 const_cast<Decl *>(cast_or_null<Decl>(Y))));
12905 }
12906
12907 template <class T, std::enable_if_t<std::is_base_of_v<Decl, T>, bool> = true>
getCommonDeclChecked(T * X,T * Y)12908 static T *getCommonDeclChecked(T *X, T *Y) {
12909 return cast<T>(getCommonDecl(const_cast<Decl *>(cast<Decl>(X)),
12910 const_cast<Decl *>(cast<Decl>(Y))));
12911 }
12912
getCommonTemplateName(ASTContext & Ctx,TemplateName X,TemplateName Y)12913 static TemplateName getCommonTemplateName(ASTContext &Ctx, TemplateName X,
12914 TemplateName Y) {
12915 if (X.getAsVoidPointer() == Y.getAsVoidPointer())
12916 return X;
12917 // FIXME: There are cases here where we could find a common template name
12918 // with more sugar. For example one could be a SubstTemplateTemplate*
12919 // replacing the other.
12920 TemplateName CX = Ctx.getCanonicalTemplateName(X);
12921 if (CX.getAsVoidPointer() !=
12922 Ctx.getCanonicalTemplateName(Y).getAsVoidPointer())
12923 return TemplateName();
12924 return CX;
12925 }
12926
12927 static TemplateName
getCommonTemplateNameChecked(ASTContext & Ctx,TemplateName X,TemplateName Y)12928 getCommonTemplateNameChecked(ASTContext &Ctx, TemplateName X, TemplateName Y) {
12929 TemplateName R = getCommonTemplateName(Ctx, X, Y);
12930 assert(R.getAsVoidPointer() != nullptr);
12931 return R;
12932 }
12933
getCommonTypes(ASTContext & Ctx,ArrayRef<QualType> Xs,ArrayRef<QualType> Ys,bool Unqualified=false)12934 static auto getCommonTypes(ASTContext &Ctx, ArrayRef<QualType> Xs,
12935 ArrayRef<QualType> Ys, bool Unqualified = false) {
12936 assert(Xs.size() == Ys.size());
12937 SmallVector<QualType, 8> Rs(Xs.size());
12938 for (size_t I = 0; I < Rs.size(); ++I)
12939 Rs[I] = Ctx.getCommonSugaredType(Xs[I], Ys[I], Unqualified);
12940 return Rs;
12941 }
12942
12943 template <class T>
getCommonAttrLoc(const T * X,const T * Y)12944 static SourceLocation getCommonAttrLoc(const T *X, const T *Y) {
12945 return X->getAttributeLoc() == Y->getAttributeLoc() ? X->getAttributeLoc()
12946 : SourceLocation();
12947 }
12948
getCommonTemplateArgument(ASTContext & Ctx,const TemplateArgument & X,const TemplateArgument & Y)12949 static TemplateArgument getCommonTemplateArgument(ASTContext &Ctx,
12950 const TemplateArgument &X,
12951 const TemplateArgument &Y) {
12952 if (X.getKind() != Y.getKind())
12953 return TemplateArgument();
12954
12955 switch (X.getKind()) {
12956 case TemplateArgument::ArgKind::Type:
12957 if (!Ctx.hasSameType(X.getAsType(), Y.getAsType()))
12958 return TemplateArgument();
12959 return TemplateArgument(
12960 Ctx.getCommonSugaredType(X.getAsType(), Y.getAsType()));
12961 case TemplateArgument::ArgKind::NullPtr:
12962 if (!Ctx.hasSameType(X.getNullPtrType(), Y.getNullPtrType()))
12963 return TemplateArgument();
12964 return TemplateArgument(
12965 Ctx.getCommonSugaredType(X.getNullPtrType(), Y.getNullPtrType()),
12966 /*Unqualified=*/true);
12967 case TemplateArgument::ArgKind::Expression:
12968 if (!Ctx.hasSameType(X.getAsExpr()->getType(), Y.getAsExpr()->getType()))
12969 return TemplateArgument();
12970 // FIXME: Try to keep the common sugar.
12971 return X;
12972 case TemplateArgument::ArgKind::Template: {
12973 TemplateName TX = X.getAsTemplate(), TY = Y.getAsTemplate();
12974 TemplateName CTN = ::getCommonTemplateName(Ctx, TX, TY);
12975 if (!CTN.getAsVoidPointer())
12976 return TemplateArgument();
12977 return TemplateArgument(CTN);
12978 }
12979 case TemplateArgument::ArgKind::TemplateExpansion: {
12980 TemplateName TX = X.getAsTemplateOrTemplatePattern(),
12981 TY = Y.getAsTemplateOrTemplatePattern();
12982 TemplateName CTN = ::getCommonTemplateName(Ctx, TX, TY);
12983 if (!CTN.getAsVoidPointer())
12984 return TemplateName();
12985 auto NExpX = X.getNumTemplateExpansions();
12986 assert(NExpX == Y.getNumTemplateExpansions());
12987 return TemplateArgument(CTN, NExpX);
12988 }
12989 default:
12990 // FIXME: Handle the other argument kinds.
12991 return X;
12992 }
12993 }
12994
getCommonTemplateArguments(ASTContext & Ctx,SmallVectorImpl<TemplateArgument> & R,ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Xs,ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Ys)12995 static bool getCommonTemplateArguments(ASTContext &Ctx,
12996 SmallVectorImpl<TemplateArgument> &R,
12997 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Xs,
12998 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Ys) {
12999 if (Xs.size() != Ys.size())
13000 return true;
13001 R.resize(Xs.size());
13002 for (size_t I = 0; I < R.size(); ++I) {
13003 R[I] = getCommonTemplateArgument(Ctx, Xs[I], Ys[I]);
13004 if (R[I].isNull())
13005 return true;
13006 }
13007 return false;
13008 }
13009
getCommonTemplateArguments(ASTContext & Ctx,ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Xs,ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Ys)13010 static auto getCommonTemplateArguments(ASTContext &Ctx,
13011 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Xs,
13012 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Ys) {
13013 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 8> R;
13014 bool Different = getCommonTemplateArguments(Ctx, R, Xs, Ys);
13015 assert(!Different);
13016 (void)Different;
13017 return R;
13018 }
13019
13020 template <class T>
getCommonTypeKeyword(const T * X,const T * Y)13021 static ElaboratedTypeKeyword getCommonTypeKeyword(const T *X, const T *Y) {
13022 return X->getKeyword() == Y->getKeyword() ? X->getKeyword()
13023 : ElaboratedTypeKeyword::None;
13024 }
13025
13026 template <class T>
getCommonNNS(ASTContext & Ctx,const T * X,const T * Y)13027 static NestedNameSpecifier *getCommonNNS(ASTContext &Ctx, const T *X,
13028 const T *Y) {
13029 // FIXME: Try to keep the common NNS sugar.
13030 return X->getQualifier() == Y->getQualifier()
13031 ? X->getQualifier()
13032 : Ctx.getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(X->getQualifier());
13033 }
13034
13035 template <class T>
getCommonElementType(ASTContext & Ctx,const T * X,const T * Y)13036 static QualType getCommonElementType(ASTContext &Ctx, const T *X, const T *Y) {
13037 return Ctx.getCommonSugaredType(X->getElementType(), Y->getElementType());
13038 }
13039
13040 template <class T>
getCommonArrayElementType(ASTContext & Ctx,const T * X,Qualifiers & QX,const T * Y,Qualifiers & QY)13041 static QualType getCommonArrayElementType(ASTContext &Ctx, const T *X,
13042 Qualifiers &QX, const T *Y,
13043 Qualifiers &QY) {
13044 QualType EX = X->getElementType(), EY = Y->getElementType();
13045 QualType R = Ctx.getCommonSugaredType(EX, EY,
13046 /*Unqualified=*/true);
13047 Qualifiers RQ = R.getQualifiers();
13048 QX += EX.getQualifiers() - RQ;
13049 QY += EY.getQualifiers() - RQ;
13050 return R;
13051 }
13052
13053 template <class T>
getCommonPointeeType(ASTContext & Ctx,const T * X,const T * Y)13054 static QualType getCommonPointeeType(ASTContext &Ctx, const T *X, const T *Y) {
13055 return Ctx.getCommonSugaredType(X->getPointeeType(), Y->getPointeeType());
13056 }
13057
getCommonSizeExpr(ASTContext & Ctx,T * X,T * Y)13058 template <class T> static auto *getCommonSizeExpr(ASTContext &Ctx, T *X, T *Y) {
13059 assert(Ctx.hasSameExpr(X->getSizeExpr(), Y->getSizeExpr()));
13060 return X->getSizeExpr();
13061 }
13062
getCommonSizeModifier(const ArrayType * X,const ArrayType * Y)13063 static auto getCommonSizeModifier(const ArrayType *X, const ArrayType *Y) {
13064 assert(X->getSizeModifier() == Y->getSizeModifier());
13065 return X->getSizeModifier();
13066 }
13067
getCommonIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(const ArrayType * X,const ArrayType * Y)13068 static auto getCommonIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(const ArrayType *X,
13069 const ArrayType *Y) {
13070 assert(X->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers() == Y->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers());
13071 return X->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers();
13072 }
13073
13074 // Merges two type lists such that the resulting vector will contain
13075 // each type (in a canonical sense) only once, in the order they appear
13076 // from X to Y. If they occur in both X and Y, the result will contain
13077 // the common sugared type between them.
mergeTypeLists(ASTContext & Ctx,SmallVectorImpl<QualType> & Out,ArrayRef<QualType> X,ArrayRef<QualType> Y)13078 static void mergeTypeLists(ASTContext &Ctx, SmallVectorImpl<QualType> &Out,
13079 ArrayRef<QualType> X, ArrayRef<QualType> Y) {
13080 llvm::DenseMap<QualType, unsigned> Found;
13081 for (auto Ts : {X, Y}) {
13082 for (QualType T : Ts) {
13083 auto Res = Found.try_emplace(Ctx.getCanonicalType(T), Out.size());
13084 if (!Res.second) {
13085 QualType &U = Out[Res.first->second];
13086 U = Ctx.getCommonSugaredType(U, T);
13087 } else {
13088 Out.emplace_back(T);
13089 }
13090 }
13091 }
13092 }
13093
13094 FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo
mergeExceptionSpecs(FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo ESI1,FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo ESI2,SmallVectorImpl<QualType> & ExceptionTypeStorage,bool AcceptDependent)13095 ASTContext::mergeExceptionSpecs(FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo ESI1,
13096 FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo ESI2,
13097 SmallVectorImpl<QualType> &ExceptionTypeStorage,
13098 bool AcceptDependent) {
13099 ExceptionSpecificationType EST1 = ESI1.Type, EST2 = ESI2.Type;
13100
13101 // If either of them can throw anything, that is the result.
13102 for (auto I : {EST_None, EST_MSAny, EST_NoexceptFalse}) {
13103 if (EST1 == I)
13104 return ESI1;
13105 if (EST2 == I)
13106 return ESI2;
13107 }
13108
13109 // If either of them is non-throwing, the result is the other.
13110 for (auto I :
13111 {EST_NoThrow, EST_DynamicNone, EST_BasicNoexcept, EST_NoexceptTrue}) {
13112 if (EST1 == I)
13113 return ESI2;
13114 if (EST2 == I)
13115 return ESI1;
13116 }
13117
13118 // If we're left with value-dependent computed noexcept expressions, we're
13119 // stuck. Before C++17, we can just drop the exception specification entirely,
13120 // since it's not actually part of the canonical type. And this should never
13121 // happen in C++17, because it would mean we were computing the composite
13122 // pointer type of dependent types, which should never happen.
13123 if (EST1 == EST_DependentNoexcept || EST2 == EST_DependentNoexcept) {
13124 assert(AcceptDependent &&
13125 "computing composite pointer type of dependent types");
13126 return FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo();
13127 }
13128
13129 // Switch over the possibilities so that people adding new values know to
13130 // update this function.
13131 switch (EST1) {
13132 case EST_None:
13133 case EST_DynamicNone:
13134 case EST_MSAny:
13135 case EST_BasicNoexcept:
13136 case EST_DependentNoexcept:
13137 case EST_NoexceptFalse:
13138 case EST_NoexceptTrue:
13139 case EST_NoThrow:
13140 llvm_unreachable("These ESTs should be handled above");
13141
13142 case EST_Dynamic: {
13143 // This is the fun case: both exception specifications are dynamic. Form
13144 // the union of the two lists.
13145 assert(EST2 == EST_Dynamic && "other cases should already be handled");
13146 mergeTypeLists(*this, ExceptionTypeStorage, ESI1.Exceptions,
13147 ESI2.Exceptions);
13148 FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo Result(EST_Dynamic);
13149 Result.Exceptions = ExceptionTypeStorage;
13150 return Result;
13151 }
13152
13153 case EST_Unevaluated:
13154 case EST_Uninstantiated:
13155 case EST_Unparsed:
13156 llvm_unreachable("shouldn't see unresolved exception specifications here");
13157 }
13158
13159 llvm_unreachable("invalid ExceptionSpecificationType");
13160 }
13161
getCommonNonSugarTypeNode(ASTContext & Ctx,const Type * X,Qualifiers & QX,const Type * Y,Qualifiers & QY)13162 static QualType getCommonNonSugarTypeNode(ASTContext &Ctx, const Type *X,
13163 Qualifiers &QX, const Type *Y,
13164 Qualifiers &QY) {
13165 Type::TypeClass TC = X->getTypeClass();
13166 assert(TC == Y->getTypeClass());
13167 switch (TC) {
13168 #define UNEXPECTED_TYPE(Class, Kind) \
13169 case Type::Class: \
13170 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected " Kind ": " #Class);
13171
13172 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) UNEXPECTED_TYPE(Class, "non-canonical")
13173 #define TYPE(Class, Base)
13174 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.inc"
13175
13176 #define SUGAR_FREE_TYPE(Class) UNEXPECTED_TYPE(Class, "sugar-free")
13177 SUGAR_FREE_TYPE(Builtin)
13178 SUGAR_FREE_TYPE(DeducedTemplateSpecialization)
13179 SUGAR_FREE_TYPE(DependentBitInt)
13180 SUGAR_FREE_TYPE(Enum)
13181 SUGAR_FREE_TYPE(BitInt)
13182 SUGAR_FREE_TYPE(ObjCInterface)
13183 SUGAR_FREE_TYPE(Record)
13184 SUGAR_FREE_TYPE(SubstTemplateTypeParmPack)
13185 SUGAR_FREE_TYPE(UnresolvedUsing)
13186 #undef SUGAR_FREE_TYPE
13187 #define NON_UNIQUE_TYPE(Class) UNEXPECTED_TYPE(Class, "non-unique")
13188 NON_UNIQUE_TYPE(TypeOfExpr)
13189 NON_UNIQUE_TYPE(VariableArray)
13190 #undef NON_UNIQUE_TYPE
13191
13192 UNEXPECTED_TYPE(TypeOf, "sugar")
13193
13194 #undef UNEXPECTED_TYPE
13195
13196 case Type::Auto: {
13197 const auto *AX = cast<AutoType>(X), *AY = cast<AutoType>(Y);
13198 assert(AX->getDeducedType().isNull());
13199 assert(AY->getDeducedType().isNull());
13200 assert(AX->getKeyword() == AY->getKeyword());
13201 assert(AX->isInstantiationDependentType() ==
13202 AY->isInstantiationDependentType());
13203 auto As = getCommonTemplateArguments(Ctx, AX->getTypeConstraintArguments(),
13204 AY->getTypeConstraintArguments());
13205 return Ctx.getAutoType(QualType(), AX->getKeyword(),
13206 AX->isInstantiationDependentType(),
13207 AX->containsUnexpandedParameterPack(),
13208 getCommonDeclChecked(AX->getTypeConstraintConcept(),
13209 AY->getTypeConstraintConcept()),
13210 As);
13211 }
13212 case Type::IncompleteArray: {
13213 const auto *AX = cast<IncompleteArrayType>(X),
13214 *AY = cast<IncompleteArrayType>(Y);
13215 return Ctx.getIncompleteArrayType(
13216 getCommonArrayElementType(Ctx, AX, QX, AY, QY),
13217 getCommonSizeModifier(AX, AY), getCommonIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(AX, AY));
13218 }
13219 case Type::DependentSizedArray: {
13220 const auto *AX = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(X),
13221 *AY = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(Y);
13222 return Ctx.getDependentSizedArrayType(
13223 getCommonArrayElementType(Ctx, AX, QX, AY, QY),
13224 getCommonSizeExpr(Ctx, AX, AY), getCommonSizeModifier(AX, AY),
13225 getCommonIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(AX, AY),
13226 AX->getBracketsRange() == AY->getBracketsRange()
13227 ? AX->getBracketsRange()
13228 : SourceRange());
13229 }
13230 case Type::ConstantArray: {
13231 const auto *AX = cast<ConstantArrayType>(X),
13232 *AY = cast<ConstantArrayType>(Y);
13233 assert(AX->getSize() == AY->getSize());
13234 const Expr *SizeExpr = Ctx.hasSameExpr(AX->getSizeExpr(), AY->getSizeExpr())
13235 ? AX->getSizeExpr()
13236 : nullptr;
13237 return Ctx.getConstantArrayType(
13238 getCommonArrayElementType(Ctx, AX, QX, AY, QY), AX->getSize(), SizeExpr,
13239 getCommonSizeModifier(AX, AY), getCommonIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(AX, AY));
13240 }
13241 case Type::ArrayParameter: {
13242 const auto *AX = cast<ArrayParameterType>(X),
13243 *AY = cast<ArrayParameterType>(Y);
13244 assert(AX->getSize() == AY->getSize());
13245 const Expr *SizeExpr = Ctx.hasSameExpr(AX->getSizeExpr(), AY->getSizeExpr())
13246 ? AX->getSizeExpr()
13247 : nullptr;
13248 auto ArrayTy = Ctx.getConstantArrayType(
13249 getCommonArrayElementType(Ctx, AX, QX, AY, QY), AX->getSize(), SizeExpr,
13250 getCommonSizeModifier(AX, AY), getCommonIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(AX, AY));
13251 return Ctx.getArrayParameterType(ArrayTy);
13252 }
13253 case Type::Atomic: {
13254 const auto *AX = cast<AtomicType>(X), *AY = cast<AtomicType>(Y);
13255 return Ctx.getAtomicType(
13256 Ctx.getCommonSugaredType(AX->getValueType(), AY->getValueType()));
13257 }
13258 case Type::Complex: {
13259 const auto *CX = cast<ComplexType>(X), *CY = cast<ComplexType>(Y);
13260 return Ctx.getComplexType(getCommonArrayElementType(Ctx, CX, QX, CY, QY));
13261 }
13262 case Type::Pointer: {
13263 const auto *PX = cast<PointerType>(X), *PY = cast<PointerType>(Y);
13264 return Ctx.getPointerType(getCommonPointeeType(Ctx, PX, PY));
13265 }
13266 case Type::BlockPointer: {
13267 const auto *PX = cast<BlockPointerType>(X), *PY = cast<BlockPointerType>(Y);
13268 return Ctx.getBlockPointerType(getCommonPointeeType(Ctx, PX, PY));
13269 }
13270 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
13271 const auto *PX = cast<ObjCObjectPointerType>(X),
13272 *PY = cast<ObjCObjectPointerType>(Y);
13273 return Ctx.getObjCObjectPointerType(getCommonPointeeType(Ctx, PX, PY));
13274 }
13275 case Type::MemberPointer: {
13276 const auto *PX = cast<MemberPointerType>(X),
13277 *PY = cast<MemberPointerType>(Y);
13278 return Ctx.getMemberPointerType(
13279 getCommonPointeeType(Ctx, PX, PY),
13280 Ctx.getCommonSugaredType(QualType(PX->getClass(), 0),
13281 QualType(PY->getClass(), 0))
13282 .getTypePtr());
13283 }
13284 case Type::LValueReference: {
13285 const auto *PX = cast<LValueReferenceType>(X),
13286 *PY = cast<LValueReferenceType>(Y);
13287 // FIXME: Preserve PointeeTypeAsWritten.
13288 return Ctx.getLValueReferenceType(getCommonPointeeType(Ctx, PX, PY),
13289 PX->isSpelledAsLValue() ||
13290 PY->isSpelledAsLValue());
13291 }
13292 case Type::RValueReference: {
13293 const auto *PX = cast<RValueReferenceType>(X),
13294 *PY = cast<RValueReferenceType>(Y);
13295 // FIXME: Preserve PointeeTypeAsWritten.
13296 return Ctx.getRValueReferenceType(getCommonPointeeType(Ctx, PX, PY));
13297 }
13298 case Type::DependentAddressSpace: {
13299 const auto *PX = cast<DependentAddressSpaceType>(X),
13300 *PY = cast<DependentAddressSpaceType>(Y);
13301 assert(Ctx.hasSameExpr(PX->getAddrSpaceExpr(), PY->getAddrSpaceExpr()));
13302 return Ctx.getDependentAddressSpaceType(getCommonPointeeType(Ctx, PX, PY),
13303 PX->getAddrSpaceExpr(),
13304 getCommonAttrLoc(PX, PY));
13305 }
13306 case Type::FunctionNoProto: {
13307 const auto *FX = cast<FunctionNoProtoType>(X),
13308 *FY = cast<FunctionNoProtoType>(Y);
13309 assert(FX->getExtInfo() == FY->getExtInfo());
13310 return Ctx.getFunctionNoProtoType(
13311 Ctx.getCommonSugaredType(FX->getReturnType(), FY->getReturnType()),
13312 FX->getExtInfo());
13313 }
13314 case Type::FunctionProto: {
13315 const auto *FX = cast<FunctionProtoType>(X),
13316 *FY = cast<FunctionProtoType>(Y);
13317 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPIX = FX->getExtProtoInfo(),
13318 EPIY = FY->getExtProtoInfo();
13319 assert(EPIX.ExtInfo == EPIY.ExtInfo);
13320 assert(EPIX.ExtParameterInfos == EPIY.ExtParameterInfos);
13321 assert(EPIX.RefQualifier == EPIY.RefQualifier);
13322 assert(EPIX.TypeQuals == EPIY.TypeQuals);
13323 assert(EPIX.Variadic == EPIY.Variadic);
13324
13325 // FIXME: Can we handle an empty EllipsisLoc?
13326 // Use emtpy EllipsisLoc if X and Y differ.
13327
13328 EPIX.HasTrailingReturn = EPIX.HasTrailingReturn && EPIY.HasTrailingReturn;
13329
13330 QualType R =
13331 Ctx.getCommonSugaredType(FX->getReturnType(), FY->getReturnType());
13332 auto P = getCommonTypes(Ctx, FX->param_types(), FY->param_types(),
13333 /*Unqualified=*/true);
13334
13335 SmallVector<QualType, 8> Exceptions;
13336 EPIX.ExceptionSpec = Ctx.mergeExceptionSpecs(
13337 EPIX.ExceptionSpec, EPIY.ExceptionSpec, Exceptions, true);
13338 return Ctx.getFunctionType(R, P, EPIX);
13339 }
13340 case Type::ObjCObject: {
13341 const auto *OX = cast<ObjCObjectType>(X), *OY = cast<ObjCObjectType>(Y);
13342 assert(
13343 std::equal(OX->getProtocols().begin(), OX->getProtocols().end(),
13344 OY->getProtocols().begin(), OY->getProtocols().end(),
13345 [](const ObjCProtocolDecl *P0, const ObjCProtocolDecl *P1) {
13346 return P0->getCanonicalDecl() == P1->getCanonicalDecl();
13347 }) &&
13348 "protocol lists must be the same");
13349 auto TAs = getCommonTypes(Ctx, OX->getTypeArgsAsWritten(),
13350 OY->getTypeArgsAsWritten());
13351 return Ctx.getObjCObjectType(
13352 Ctx.getCommonSugaredType(OX->getBaseType(), OY->getBaseType()), TAs,
13353 OX->getProtocols(),
13354 OX->isKindOfTypeAsWritten() && OY->isKindOfTypeAsWritten());
13355 }
13356 case Type::ConstantMatrix: {
13357 const auto *MX = cast<ConstantMatrixType>(X),
13358 *MY = cast<ConstantMatrixType>(Y);
13359 assert(MX->getNumRows() == MY->getNumRows());
13360 assert(MX->getNumColumns() == MY->getNumColumns());
13361 return Ctx.getConstantMatrixType(getCommonElementType(Ctx, MX, MY),
13362 MX->getNumRows(), MX->getNumColumns());
13363 }
13364 case Type::DependentSizedMatrix: {
13365 const auto *MX = cast<DependentSizedMatrixType>(X),
13366 *MY = cast<DependentSizedMatrixType>(Y);
13367 assert(Ctx.hasSameExpr(MX->getRowExpr(), MY->getRowExpr()));
13368 assert(Ctx.hasSameExpr(MX->getColumnExpr(), MY->getColumnExpr()));
13369 return Ctx.getDependentSizedMatrixType(
13370 getCommonElementType(Ctx, MX, MY), MX->getRowExpr(),
13371 MX->getColumnExpr(), getCommonAttrLoc(MX, MY));
13372 }
13373 case Type::Vector: {
13374 const auto *VX = cast<VectorType>(X), *VY = cast<VectorType>(Y);
13375 assert(VX->getNumElements() == VY->getNumElements());
13376 assert(VX->getVectorKind() == VY->getVectorKind());
13377 return Ctx.getVectorType(getCommonElementType(Ctx, VX, VY),
13378 VX->getNumElements(), VX->getVectorKind());
13379 }
13380 case Type::ExtVector: {
13381 const auto *VX = cast<ExtVectorType>(X), *VY = cast<ExtVectorType>(Y);
13382 assert(VX->getNumElements() == VY->getNumElements());
13383 return Ctx.getExtVectorType(getCommonElementType(Ctx, VX, VY),
13384 VX->getNumElements());
13385 }
13386 case Type::DependentSizedExtVector: {
13387 const auto *VX = cast<DependentSizedExtVectorType>(X),
13388 *VY = cast<DependentSizedExtVectorType>(Y);
13389 return Ctx.getDependentSizedExtVectorType(getCommonElementType(Ctx, VX, VY),
13390 getCommonSizeExpr(Ctx, VX, VY),
13391 getCommonAttrLoc(VX, VY));
13392 }
13393 case Type::DependentVector: {
13394 const auto *VX = cast<DependentVectorType>(X),
13395 *VY = cast<DependentVectorType>(Y);
13396 assert(VX->getVectorKind() == VY->getVectorKind());
13397 return Ctx.getDependentVectorType(
13398 getCommonElementType(Ctx, VX, VY), getCommonSizeExpr(Ctx, VX, VY),
13399 getCommonAttrLoc(VX, VY), VX->getVectorKind());
13400 }
13401 case Type::InjectedClassName: {
13402 const auto *IX = cast<InjectedClassNameType>(X),
13403 *IY = cast<InjectedClassNameType>(Y);
13404 return Ctx.getInjectedClassNameType(
13405 getCommonDeclChecked(IX->getDecl(), IY->getDecl()),
13406 Ctx.getCommonSugaredType(IX->getInjectedSpecializationType(),
13407 IY->getInjectedSpecializationType()));
13408 }
13409 case Type::TemplateSpecialization: {
13410 const auto *TX = cast<TemplateSpecializationType>(X),
13411 *TY = cast<TemplateSpecializationType>(Y);
13412 auto As = getCommonTemplateArguments(Ctx, TX->template_arguments(),
13413 TY->template_arguments());
13414 return Ctx.getTemplateSpecializationType(
13415 ::getCommonTemplateNameChecked(Ctx, TX->getTemplateName(),
13416 TY->getTemplateName()),
13417 As, X->getCanonicalTypeInternal());
13418 }
13419 case Type::Decltype: {
13420 const auto *DX = cast<DecltypeType>(X);
13421 [[maybe_unused]] const auto *DY = cast<DecltypeType>(Y);
13422 assert(DX->isDependentType());
13423 assert(DY->isDependentType());
13424 assert(Ctx.hasSameExpr(DX->getUnderlyingExpr(), DY->getUnderlyingExpr()));
13425 // As Decltype is not uniqued, building a common type would be wasteful.
13426 return QualType(DX, 0);
13427 }
13428 case Type::PackIndexing: {
13429 const auto *DX = cast<PackIndexingType>(X);
13430 [[maybe_unused]] const auto *DY = cast<PackIndexingType>(Y);
13431 assert(DX->isDependentType());
13432 assert(DY->isDependentType());
13433 assert(Ctx.hasSameExpr(DX->getIndexExpr(), DY->getIndexExpr()));
13434 return QualType(DX, 0);
13435 }
13436 case Type::DependentName: {
13437 const auto *NX = cast<DependentNameType>(X),
13438 *NY = cast<DependentNameType>(Y);
13439 assert(NX->getIdentifier() == NY->getIdentifier());
13440 return Ctx.getDependentNameType(
13441 getCommonTypeKeyword(NX, NY), getCommonNNS(Ctx, NX, NY),
13442 NX->getIdentifier(), NX->getCanonicalTypeInternal());
13443 }
13444 case Type::DependentTemplateSpecialization: {
13445 const auto *TX = cast<DependentTemplateSpecializationType>(X),
13446 *TY = cast<DependentTemplateSpecializationType>(Y);
13447 assert(TX->getIdentifier() == TY->getIdentifier());
13448 auto As = getCommonTemplateArguments(Ctx, TX->template_arguments(),
13449 TY->template_arguments());
13450 return Ctx.getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
13451 getCommonTypeKeyword(TX, TY), getCommonNNS(Ctx, TX, TY),
13452 TX->getIdentifier(), As);
13453 }
13454 case Type::UnaryTransform: {
13455 const auto *TX = cast<UnaryTransformType>(X),
13456 *TY = cast<UnaryTransformType>(Y);
13457 assert(TX->getUTTKind() == TY->getUTTKind());
13458 return Ctx.getUnaryTransformType(
13459 Ctx.getCommonSugaredType(TX->getBaseType(), TY->getBaseType()),
13460 Ctx.getCommonSugaredType(TX->getUnderlyingType(),
13461 TY->getUnderlyingType()),
13462 TX->getUTTKind());
13463 }
13464 case Type::PackExpansion: {
13465 const auto *PX = cast<PackExpansionType>(X),
13466 *PY = cast<PackExpansionType>(Y);
13467 assert(PX->getNumExpansions() == PY->getNumExpansions());
13468 return Ctx.getPackExpansionType(
13469 Ctx.getCommonSugaredType(PX->getPattern(), PY->getPattern()),
13470 PX->getNumExpansions(), false);
13471 }
13472 case Type::Pipe: {
13473 const auto *PX = cast<PipeType>(X), *PY = cast<PipeType>(Y);
13474 assert(PX->isReadOnly() == PY->isReadOnly());
13475 auto MP = PX->isReadOnly() ? &ASTContext::getReadPipeType
13476 : &ASTContext::getWritePipeType;
13477 return (Ctx.*MP)(getCommonElementType(Ctx, PX, PY));
13478 }
13479 case Type::TemplateTypeParm: {
13480 const auto *TX = cast<TemplateTypeParmType>(X),
13481 *TY = cast<TemplateTypeParmType>(Y);
13482 assert(TX->getDepth() == TY->getDepth());
13483 assert(TX->getIndex() == TY->getIndex());
13484 assert(TX->isParameterPack() == TY->isParameterPack());
13485 return Ctx.getTemplateTypeParmType(
13486 TX->getDepth(), TX->getIndex(), TX->isParameterPack(),
13487 getCommonDecl(TX->getDecl(), TY->getDecl()));
13488 }
13489 }
13490 llvm_unreachable("Unknown Type Class");
13491 }
13492
getCommonSugarTypeNode(ASTContext & Ctx,const Type * X,const Type * Y,SplitQualType Underlying)13493 static QualType getCommonSugarTypeNode(ASTContext &Ctx, const Type *X,
13494 const Type *Y,
13495 SplitQualType Underlying) {
13496 Type::TypeClass TC = X->getTypeClass();
13497 if (TC != Y->getTypeClass())
13498 return QualType();
13499 switch (TC) {
13500 #define UNEXPECTED_TYPE(Class, Kind) \
13501 case Type::Class: \
13502 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected " Kind ": " #Class);
13503 #define TYPE(Class, Base)
13504 #define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) UNEXPECTED_TYPE(Class, "dependent")
13505 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.inc"
13506
13507 #define CANONICAL_TYPE(Class) UNEXPECTED_TYPE(Class, "canonical")
13508 CANONICAL_TYPE(Atomic)
13509 CANONICAL_TYPE(BitInt)
13510 CANONICAL_TYPE(BlockPointer)
13511 CANONICAL_TYPE(Builtin)
13512 CANONICAL_TYPE(Complex)
13513 CANONICAL_TYPE(ConstantArray)
13514 CANONICAL_TYPE(ArrayParameter)
13515 CANONICAL_TYPE(ConstantMatrix)
13516 CANONICAL_TYPE(Enum)
13517 CANONICAL_TYPE(ExtVector)
13518 CANONICAL_TYPE(FunctionNoProto)
13519 CANONICAL_TYPE(FunctionProto)
13520 CANONICAL_TYPE(IncompleteArray)
13521 CANONICAL_TYPE(LValueReference)
13522 CANONICAL_TYPE(MemberPointer)
13523 CANONICAL_TYPE(ObjCInterface)
13524 CANONICAL_TYPE(ObjCObject)
13525 CANONICAL_TYPE(ObjCObjectPointer)
13526 CANONICAL_TYPE(Pipe)
13527 CANONICAL_TYPE(Pointer)
13528 CANONICAL_TYPE(Record)
13529 CANONICAL_TYPE(RValueReference)
13530 CANONICAL_TYPE(VariableArray)
13531 CANONICAL_TYPE(Vector)
13532 #undef CANONICAL_TYPE
13533
13534 #undef UNEXPECTED_TYPE
13535
13536 case Type::Adjusted: {
13537 const auto *AX = cast<AdjustedType>(X), *AY = cast<AdjustedType>(Y);
13538 QualType OX = AX->getOriginalType(), OY = AY->getOriginalType();
13539 if (!Ctx.hasSameType(OX, OY))
13540 return QualType();
13541 // FIXME: It's inefficient to have to unify the original types.
13542 return Ctx.getAdjustedType(Ctx.getCommonSugaredType(OX, OY),
13543 Ctx.getQualifiedType(Underlying));
13544 }
13545 case Type::Decayed: {
13546 const auto *DX = cast<DecayedType>(X), *DY = cast<DecayedType>(Y);
13547 QualType OX = DX->getOriginalType(), OY = DY->getOriginalType();
13548 if (!Ctx.hasSameType(OX, OY))
13549 return QualType();
13550 // FIXME: It's inefficient to have to unify the original types.
13551 return Ctx.getDecayedType(Ctx.getCommonSugaredType(OX, OY),
13552 Ctx.getQualifiedType(Underlying));
13553 }
13554 case Type::Attributed: {
13555 const auto *AX = cast<AttributedType>(X), *AY = cast<AttributedType>(Y);
13556 AttributedType::Kind Kind = AX->getAttrKind();
13557 if (Kind != AY->getAttrKind())
13558 return QualType();
13559 QualType MX = AX->getModifiedType(), MY = AY->getModifiedType();
13560 if (!Ctx.hasSameType(MX, MY))
13561 return QualType();
13562 // FIXME: It's inefficient to have to unify the modified types.
13563 return Ctx.getAttributedType(Kind, Ctx.getCommonSugaredType(MX, MY),
13564 Ctx.getQualifiedType(Underlying));
13565 }
13566 case Type::BTFTagAttributed: {
13567 const auto *BX = cast<BTFTagAttributedType>(X);
13568 const BTFTypeTagAttr *AX = BX->getAttr();
13569 // The attribute is not uniqued, so just compare the tag.
13570 if (AX->getBTFTypeTag() !=
13571 cast<BTFTagAttributedType>(Y)->getAttr()->getBTFTypeTag())
13572 return QualType();
13573 return Ctx.getBTFTagAttributedType(AX, Ctx.getQualifiedType(Underlying));
13574 }
13575 case Type::Auto: {
13576 const auto *AX = cast<AutoType>(X), *AY = cast<AutoType>(Y);
13577
13578 AutoTypeKeyword KW = AX->getKeyword();
13579 if (KW != AY->getKeyword())
13580 return QualType();
13581
13582 ConceptDecl *CD = ::getCommonDecl(AX->getTypeConstraintConcept(),
13583 AY->getTypeConstraintConcept());
13584 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 8> As;
13585 if (CD &&
13586 getCommonTemplateArguments(Ctx, As, AX->getTypeConstraintArguments(),
13587 AY->getTypeConstraintArguments())) {
13588 CD = nullptr; // The arguments differ, so make it unconstrained.
13589 As.clear();
13590 }
13591
13592 // Both auto types can't be dependent, otherwise they wouldn't have been
13593 // sugar. This implies they can't contain unexpanded packs either.
13594 return Ctx.getAutoType(Ctx.getQualifiedType(Underlying), AX->getKeyword(),
13595 /*IsDependent=*/false, /*IsPack=*/false, CD, As);
13596 }
13597 case Type::PackIndexing:
13598 case Type::Decltype:
13599 return QualType();
13600 case Type::DeducedTemplateSpecialization:
13601 // FIXME: Try to merge these.
13602 return QualType();
13603
13604 case Type::Elaborated: {
13605 const auto *EX = cast<ElaboratedType>(X), *EY = cast<ElaboratedType>(Y);
13606 return Ctx.getElaboratedType(
13607 ::getCommonTypeKeyword(EX, EY), ::getCommonNNS(Ctx, EX, EY),
13608 Ctx.getQualifiedType(Underlying),
13609 ::getCommonDecl(EX->getOwnedTagDecl(), EY->getOwnedTagDecl()));
13610 }
13611 case Type::MacroQualified: {
13612 const auto *MX = cast<MacroQualifiedType>(X),
13613 *MY = cast<MacroQualifiedType>(Y);
13614 const IdentifierInfo *IX = MX->getMacroIdentifier();
13615 if (IX != MY->getMacroIdentifier())
13616 return QualType();
13617 return Ctx.getMacroQualifiedType(Ctx.getQualifiedType(Underlying), IX);
13618 }
13619 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm: {
13620 const auto *SX = cast<SubstTemplateTypeParmType>(X),
13621 *SY = cast<SubstTemplateTypeParmType>(Y);
13622 Decl *CD =
13623 ::getCommonDecl(SX->getAssociatedDecl(), SY->getAssociatedDecl());
13624 if (!CD)
13625 return QualType();
13626 unsigned Index = SX->getIndex();
13627 if (Index != SY->getIndex())
13628 return QualType();
13629 auto PackIndex = SX->getPackIndex();
13630 if (PackIndex != SY->getPackIndex())
13631 return QualType();
13632 return Ctx.getSubstTemplateTypeParmType(Ctx.getQualifiedType(Underlying),
13633 CD, Index, PackIndex);
13634 }
13635 case Type::ObjCTypeParam:
13636 // FIXME: Try to merge these.
13637 return QualType();
13638 case Type::Paren:
13639 return Ctx.getParenType(Ctx.getQualifiedType(Underlying));
13640
13641 case Type::TemplateSpecialization: {
13642 const auto *TX = cast<TemplateSpecializationType>(X),
13643 *TY = cast<TemplateSpecializationType>(Y);
13644 TemplateName CTN = ::getCommonTemplateName(Ctx, TX->getTemplateName(),
13645 TY->getTemplateName());
13646 if (!CTN.getAsVoidPointer())
13647 return QualType();
13648 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 8> Args;
13649 if (getCommonTemplateArguments(Ctx, Args, TX->template_arguments(),
13650 TY->template_arguments()))
13651 return QualType();
13652 return Ctx.getTemplateSpecializationType(CTN, Args,
13653 Ctx.getQualifiedType(Underlying));
13654 }
13655 case Type::Typedef: {
13656 const auto *TX = cast<TypedefType>(X), *TY = cast<TypedefType>(Y);
13657 const TypedefNameDecl *CD = ::getCommonDecl(TX->getDecl(), TY->getDecl());
13658 if (!CD)
13659 return QualType();
13660 return Ctx.getTypedefType(CD, Ctx.getQualifiedType(Underlying));
13661 }
13662 case Type::TypeOf: {
13663 // The common sugar between two typeof expressions, where one is
13664 // potentially a typeof_unqual and the other is not, we unify to the
13665 // qualified type as that retains the most information along with the type.
13666 // We only return a typeof_unqual type when both types are unqual types.
13667 TypeOfKind Kind = TypeOfKind::Qualified;
13668 if (cast<TypeOfType>(X)->getKind() == cast<TypeOfType>(Y)->getKind() &&
13669 cast<TypeOfType>(X)->getKind() == TypeOfKind::Unqualified)
13670 Kind = TypeOfKind::Unqualified;
13671 return Ctx.getTypeOfType(Ctx.getQualifiedType(Underlying), Kind);
13672 }
13673 case Type::TypeOfExpr:
13674 return QualType();
13675
13676 case Type::UnaryTransform: {
13677 const auto *UX = cast<UnaryTransformType>(X),
13678 *UY = cast<UnaryTransformType>(Y);
13679 UnaryTransformType::UTTKind KX = UX->getUTTKind();
13680 if (KX != UY->getUTTKind())
13681 return QualType();
13682 QualType BX = UX->getBaseType(), BY = UY->getBaseType();
13683 if (!Ctx.hasSameType(BX, BY))
13684 return QualType();
13685 // FIXME: It's inefficient to have to unify the base types.
13686 return Ctx.getUnaryTransformType(Ctx.getCommonSugaredType(BX, BY),
13687 Ctx.getQualifiedType(Underlying), KX);
13688 }
13689 case Type::Using: {
13690 const auto *UX = cast<UsingType>(X), *UY = cast<UsingType>(Y);
13691 const UsingShadowDecl *CD =
13692 ::getCommonDecl(UX->getFoundDecl(), UY->getFoundDecl());
13693 if (!CD)
13694 return QualType();
13695 return Ctx.getUsingType(CD, Ctx.getQualifiedType(Underlying));
13696 }
13697 case Type::CountAttributed: {
13698 const auto *DX = cast<CountAttributedType>(X),
13699 *DY = cast<CountAttributedType>(Y);
13700 if (DX->isCountInBytes() != DY->isCountInBytes())
13701 return QualType();
13702 if (DX->isOrNull() != DY->isOrNull())
13703 return QualType();
13704 Expr *CEX = DX->getCountExpr();
13705 Expr *CEY = DY->getCountExpr();
13706 llvm::ArrayRef<clang::TypeCoupledDeclRefInfo> CDX = DX->getCoupledDecls();
13707 if (Ctx.hasSameExpr(CEX, CEY))
13708 return Ctx.getCountAttributedType(Ctx.getQualifiedType(Underlying), CEX,
13709 DX->isCountInBytes(), DX->isOrNull(),
13710 CDX);
13711 if (!CEX->isIntegerConstantExpr(Ctx) || !CEY->isIntegerConstantExpr(Ctx))
13712 return QualType();
13713 // Two declarations with the same integer constant may still differ in their
13714 // expression pointers, so we need to evaluate them.
13715 llvm::APSInt VX = *CEX->getIntegerConstantExpr(Ctx);
13716 llvm::APSInt VY = *CEY->getIntegerConstantExpr(Ctx);
13717 if (VX != VY)
13718 return QualType();
13719 return Ctx.getCountAttributedType(Ctx.getQualifiedType(Underlying), CEX,
13720 DX->isCountInBytes(), DX->isOrNull(),
13721 CDX);
13722 }
13723 }
13724 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled Type Class");
13725 }
13726
unwrapSugar(SplitQualType & T,Qualifiers & QTotal)13727 static auto unwrapSugar(SplitQualType &T, Qualifiers &QTotal) {
13728 SmallVector<SplitQualType, 8> R;
13729 while (true) {
13730 QTotal.addConsistentQualifiers(T.Quals);
13731 QualType NT = T.Ty->getLocallyUnqualifiedSingleStepDesugaredType();
13732 if (NT == QualType(T.Ty, 0))
13733 break;
13734 R.push_back(T);
13735 T = NT.split();
13736 }
13737 return R;
13738 }
13739
getCommonSugaredType(QualType X,QualType Y,bool Unqualified)13740 QualType ASTContext::getCommonSugaredType(QualType X, QualType Y,
13741 bool Unqualified) {
13742 assert(Unqualified ? hasSameUnqualifiedType(X, Y) : hasSameType(X, Y));
13743 if (X == Y)
13744 return X;
13745 if (!Unqualified) {
13746 if (X.isCanonical())
13747 return X;
13748 if (Y.isCanonical())
13749 return Y;
13750 }
13751
13752 SplitQualType SX = X.split(), SY = Y.split();
13753 Qualifiers QX, QY;
13754 // Desugar SX and SY, setting the sugar and qualifiers aside into Xs and Ys,
13755 // until we reach their underlying "canonical nodes". Note these are not
13756 // necessarily canonical types, as they may still have sugared properties.
13757 // QX and QY will store the sum of all qualifiers in Xs and Ys respectively.
13758 auto Xs = ::unwrapSugar(SX, QX), Ys = ::unwrapSugar(SY, QY);
13759 if (SX.Ty != SY.Ty) {
13760 // The canonical nodes differ. Build a common canonical node out of the two,
13761 // unifying their sugar. This may recurse back here.
13762 SX.Ty =
13763 ::getCommonNonSugarTypeNode(*this, SX.Ty, QX, SY.Ty, QY).getTypePtr();
13764 } else {
13765 // The canonical nodes were identical: We may have desugared too much.
13766 // Add any common sugar back in.
13767 while (!Xs.empty() && !Ys.empty() && Xs.back().Ty == Ys.back().Ty) {
13768 QX -= SX.Quals;
13769 QY -= SY.Quals;
13770 SX = Xs.pop_back_val();
13771 SY = Ys.pop_back_val();
13772 }
13773 }
13774 if (Unqualified)
13775 QX = Qualifiers::removeCommonQualifiers(QX, QY);
13776 else
13777 assert(QX == QY);
13778
13779 // Even though the remaining sugar nodes in Xs and Ys differ, some may be
13780 // related. Walk up these nodes, unifying them and adding the result.
13781 while (!Xs.empty() && !Ys.empty()) {
13782 auto Underlying = SplitQualType(
13783 SX.Ty, Qualifiers::removeCommonQualifiers(SX.Quals, SY.Quals));
13784 SX = Xs.pop_back_val();
13785 SY = Ys.pop_back_val();
13786 SX.Ty = ::getCommonSugarTypeNode(*this, SX.Ty, SY.Ty, Underlying)
13787 .getTypePtrOrNull();
13788 // Stop at the first pair which is unrelated.
13789 if (!SX.Ty) {
13790 SX.Ty = Underlying.Ty;
13791 break;
13792 }
13793 QX -= Underlying.Quals;
13794 };
13795
13796 // Add back the missing accumulated qualifiers, which were stripped off
13797 // with the sugar nodes we could not unify.
13798 QualType R = getQualifiedType(SX.Ty, QX);
13799 assert(Unqualified ? hasSameUnqualifiedType(R, X) : hasSameType(R, X));
13800 return R;
13801 }
13802
getCorrespondingUnsaturatedType(QualType Ty) const13803 QualType ASTContext::getCorrespondingUnsaturatedType(QualType Ty) const {
13804 assert(Ty->isFixedPointType());
13805
13806 if (Ty->isUnsaturatedFixedPointType())
13807 return Ty;
13808
13809 switch (Ty->castAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
13810 default:
13811 llvm_unreachable("Not a saturated fixed point type!");
13812 case BuiltinType::SatShortAccum:
13813 return ShortAccumTy;
13814 case BuiltinType::SatAccum:
13815 return AccumTy;
13816 case BuiltinType::SatLongAccum:
13817 return LongAccumTy;
13818 case BuiltinType::SatUShortAccum:
13819 return UnsignedShortAccumTy;
13820 case BuiltinType::SatUAccum:
13821 return UnsignedAccumTy;
13822 case BuiltinType::SatULongAccum:
13823 return UnsignedLongAccumTy;
13824 case BuiltinType::SatShortFract:
13825 return ShortFractTy;
13826 case BuiltinType::SatFract:
13827 return FractTy;
13828 case BuiltinType::SatLongFract:
13829 return LongFractTy;
13830 case BuiltinType::SatUShortFract:
13831 return UnsignedShortFractTy;
13832 case BuiltinType::SatUFract:
13833 return UnsignedFractTy;
13834 case BuiltinType::SatULongFract:
13835 return UnsignedLongFractTy;
13836 }
13837 }
13838
getCorrespondingSaturatedType(QualType Ty) const13839 QualType ASTContext::getCorrespondingSaturatedType(QualType Ty) const {
13840 assert(Ty->isFixedPointType());
13841
13842 if (Ty->isSaturatedFixedPointType()) return Ty;
13843
13844 switch (Ty->castAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
13845 default:
13846 llvm_unreachable("Not a fixed point type!");
13847 case BuiltinType::ShortAccum:
13848 return SatShortAccumTy;
13849 case BuiltinType::Accum:
13850 return SatAccumTy;
13851 case BuiltinType::LongAccum:
13852 return SatLongAccumTy;
13853 case BuiltinType::UShortAccum:
13854 return SatUnsignedShortAccumTy;
13855 case BuiltinType::UAccum:
13856 return SatUnsignedAccumTy;
13857 case BuiltinType::ULongAccum:
13858 return SatUnsignedLongAccumTy;
13859 case BuiltinType::ShortFract:
13860 return SatShortFractTy;
13861 case BuiltinType::Fract:
13862 return SatFractTy;
13863 case BuiltinType::LongFract:
13864 return SatLongFractTy;
13865 case BuiltinType::UShortFract:
13866 return SatUnsignedShortFractTy;
13867 case BuiltinType::UFract:
13868 return SatUnsignedFractTy;
13869 case BuiltinType::ULongFract:
13870 return SatUnsignedLongFractTy;
13871 }
13872 }
13873
getLangASForBuiltinAddressSpace(unsigned AS) const13874 LangAS ASTContext::getLangASForBuiltinAddressSpace(unsigned AS) const {
13875 if (LangOpts.OpenCL)
13876 return getTargetInfo().getOpenCLBuiltinAddressSpace(AS);
13877
13878 if (LangOpts.CUDA)
13879 return getTargetInfo().getCUDABuiltinAddressSpace(AS);
13880
13881 return getLangASFromTargetAS(AS);
13882 }
13883
13884 // Explicitly instantiate this in case a Redeclarable<T> is used from a TU that
13885 // doesn't include ASTContext.h
13886 template
13887 clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
13888 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::ValueType
13889 clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
13890 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::makeValue(
13891 const clang::ASTContext &Ctx, Decl *Value);
13892
getFixedPointScale(QualType Ty) const13893 unsigned char ASTContext::getFixedPointScale(QualType Ty) const {
13894 assert(Ty->isFixedPointType());
13895
13896 const TargetInfo &Target = getTargetInfo();
13897 switch (Ty->castAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
13898 default:
13899 llvm_unreachable("Not a fixed point type!");
13900 case BuiltinType::ShortAccum:
13901 case BuiltinType::SatShortAccum:
13902 return Target.getShortAccumScale();
13903 case BuiltinType::Accum:
13904 case BuiltinType::SatAccum:
13905 return Target.getAccumScale();
13906 case BuiltinType::LongAccum:
13907 case BuiltinType::SatLongAccum:
13908 return Target.getLongAccumScale();
13909 case BuiltinType::UShortAccum:
13910 case BuiltinType::SatUShortAccum:
13911 return Target.getUnsignedShortAccumScale();
13912 case BuiltinType::UAccum:
13913 case BuiltinType::SatUAccum:
13914 return Target.getUnsignedAccumScale();
13915 case BuiltinType::ULongAccum:
13916 case BuiltinType::SatULongAccum:
13917 return Target.getUnsignedLongAccumScale();
13918 case BuiltinType::ShortFract:
13919 case BuiltinType::SatShortFract:
13920 return Target.getShortFractScale();
13921 case BuiltinType::Fract:
13922 case BuiltinType::SatFract:
13923 return Target.getFractScale();
13924 case BuiltinType::LongFract:
13925 case BuiltinType::SatLongFract:
13926 return Target.getLongFractScale();
13927 case BuiltinType::UShortFract:
13928 case BuiltinType::SatUShortFract:
13929 return Target.getUnsignedShortFractScale();
13930 case BuiltinType::UFract:
13931 case BuiltinType::SatUFract:
13932 return Target.getUnsignedFractScale();
13933 case BuiltinType::ULongFract:
13934 case BuiltinType::SatULongFract:
13935 return Target.getUnsignedLongFractScale();
13936 }
13937 }
13938
getFixedPointIBits(QualType Ty) const13939 unsigned char ASTContext::getFixedPointIBits(QualType Ty) const {
13940 assert(Ty->isFixedPointType());
13941
13942 const TargetInfo &Target = getTargetInfo();
13943 switch (Ty->castAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
13944 default:
13945 llvm_unreachable("Not a fixed point type!");
13946 case BuiltinType::ShortAccum:
13947 case BuiltinType::SatShortAccum:
13948 return Target.getShortAccumIBits();
13949 case BuiltinType::Accum:
13950 case BuiltinType::SatAccum:
13951 return Target.getAccumIBits();
13952 case BuiltinType::LongAccum:
13953 case BuiltinType::SatLongAccum:
13954 return Target.getLongAccumIBits();
13955 case BuiltinType::UShortAccum:
13956 case BuiltinType::SatUShortAccum:
13957 return Target.getUnsignedShortAccumIBits();
13958 case BuiltinType::UAccum:
13959 case BuiltinType::SatUAccum:
13960 return Target.getUnsignedAccumIBits();
13961 case BuiltinType::ULongAccum:
13962 case BuiltinType::SatULongAccum:
13963 return Target.getUnsignedLongAccumIBits();
13964 case BuiltinType::ShortFract:
13965 case BuiltinType::SatShortFract:
13966 case BuiltinType::Fract:
13967 case BuiltinType::SatFract:
13968 case BuiltinType::LongFract:
13969 case BuiltinType::SatLongFract:
13970 case BuiltinType::UShortFract:
13971 case BuiltinType::SatUShortFract:
13972 case BuiltinType::UFract:
13973 case BuiltinType::SatUFract:
13974 case BuiltinType::ULongFract:
13975 case BuiltinType::SatULongFract:
13976 return 0;
13977 }
13978 }
13979
13980 llvm::FixedPointSemantics
getFixedPointSemantics(QualType Ty) const13981 ASTContext::getFixedPointSemantics(QualType Ty) const {
13982 assert((Ty->isFixedPointType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) &&
13983 "Can only get the fixed point semantics for a "
13984 "fixed point or integer type.");
13985 if (Ty->isIntegerType())
13986 return llvm::FixedPointSemantics::GetIntegerSemantics(
13987 getIntWidth(Ty), Ty->isSignedIntegerType());
13988
13989 bool isSigned = Ty->isSignedFixedPointType();
13990 return llvm::FixedPointSemantics(
13991 static_cast<unsigned>(getTypeSize(Ty)), getFixedPointScale(Ty), isSigned,
13992 Ty->isSaturatedFixedPointType(),
13993 !isSigned && getTargetInfo().doUnsignedFixedPointTypesHavePadding());
13994 }
13995
getFixedPointMax(QualType Ty) const13996 llvm::APFixedPoint ASTContext::getFixedPointMax(QualType Ty) const {
13997 assert(Ty->isFixedPointType());
13998 return llvm::APFixedPoint::getMax(getFixedPointSemantics(Ty));
13999 }
14000
getFixedPointMin(QualType Ty) const14001 llvm::APFixedPoint ASTContext::getFixedPointMin(QualType Ty) const {
14002 assert(Ty->isFixedPointType());
14003 return llvm::APFixedPoint::getMin(getFixedPointSemantics(Ty));
14004 }
14005
getCorrespondingSignedFixedPointType(QualType Ty) const14006 QualType ASTContext::getCorrespondingSignedFixedPointType(QualType Ty) const {
14007 assert(Ty->isUnsignedFixedPointType() &&
14008 "Expected unsigned fixed point type");
14009
14010 switch (Ty->castAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
14011 case BuiltinType::UShortAccum:
14012 return ShortAccumTy;
14013 case BuiltinType::UAccum:
14014 return AccumTy;
14015 case BuiltinType::ULongAccum:
14016 return LongAccumTy;
14017 case BuiltinType::SatUShortAccum:
14018 return SatShortAccumTy;
14019 case BuiltinType::SatUAccum:
14020 return SatAccumTy;
14021 case BuiltinType::SatULongAccum:
14022 return SatLongAccumTy;
14023 case BuiltinType::UShortFract:
14024 return ShortFractTy;
14025 case BuiltinType::UFract:
14026 return FractTy;
14027 case BuiltinType::ULongFract:
14028 return LongFractTy;
14029 case BuiltinType::SatUShortFract:
14030 return SatShortFractTy;
14031 case BuiltinType::SatUFract:
14032 return SatFractTy;
14033 case BuiltinType::SatULongFract:
14034 return SatLongFractTy;
14035 default:
14036 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected unsigned fixed point type");
14037 }
14038 }
14039
14040 // Given a list of FMV features, return a concatenated list of the
14041 // corresponding backend features (which may contain duplicates).
getFMVBackendFeaturesFor(const llvm::SmallVectorImpl<StringRef> & FMVFeatStrings)14042 static std::vector<std::string> getFMVBackendFeaturesFor(
14043 const llvm::SmallVectorImpl<StringRef> &FMVFeatStrings) {
14044 std::vector<std::string> BackendFeats;
14045 for (StringRef F : FMVFeatStrings)
14046 if (auto FMVExt = llvm::AArch64::parseFMVExtension(F))
14047 for (StringRef F : FMVExt->getImpliedFeatures())
14048 BackendFeats.push_back(F.str());
14049 return BackendFeats;
14050 }
14051
14052 ParsedTargetAttr
filterFunctionTargetAttrs(const TargetAttr * TD) const14053 ASTContext::filterFunctionTargetAttrs(const TargetAttr *TD) const {
14054 assert(TD != nullptr);
14055 ParsedTargetAttr ParsedAttr = Target->parseTargetAttr(TD->getFeaturesStr());
14056
14057 llvm::erase_if(ParsedAttr.Features, [&](const std::string &Feat) {
14058 return !Target->isValidFeatureName(StringRef{Feat}.substr(1));
14059 });
14060 return ParsedAttr;
14061 }
14062
getFunctionFeatureMap(llvm::StringMap<bool> & FeatureMap,const FunctionDecl * FD) const14063 void ASTContext::getFunctionFeatureMap(llvm::StringMap<bool> &FeatureMap,
14064 const FunctionDecl *FD) const {
14065 if (FD)
14066 getFunctionFeatureMap(FeatureMap, GlobalDecl().getWithDecl(FD));
14067 else
14068 Target->initFeatureMap(FeatureMap, getDiagnostics(),
14069 Target->getTargetOpts().CPU,
14070 Target->getTargetOpts().Features);
14071 }
14072
14073 // Fills in the supplied string map with the set of target features for the
14074 // passed in function.
getFunctionFeatureMap(llvm::StringMap<bool> & FeatureMap,GlobalDecl GD) const14075 void ASTContext::getFunctionFeatureMap(llvm::StringMap<bool> &FeatureMap,
14076 GlobalDecl GD) const {
14077 StringRef TargetCPU = Target->getTargetOpts().CPU;
14078 const FunctionDecl *FD = GD.getDecl()->getAsFunction();
14079 if (const auto *TD = FD->getAttr<TargetAttr>()) {
14080 ParsedTargetAttr ParsedAttr = filterFunctionTargetAttrs(TD);
14081
14082 // Make a copy of the features as passed on the command line into the
14083 // beginning of the additional features from the function to override.
14084 // AArch64 handles command line option features in parseTargetAttr().
14085 if (!Target->getTriple().isAArch64())
14086 ParsedAttr.Features.insert(
14087 ParsedAttr.Features.begin(),
14088 Target->getTargetOpts().FeaturesAsWritten.begin(),
14089 Target->getTargetOpts().FeaturesAsWritten.end());
14090
14091 if (ParsedAttr.CPU != "" && Target->isValidCPUName(ParsedAttr.CPU))
14092 TargetCPU = ParsedAttr.CPU;
14093
14094 // Now populate the feature map, first with the TargetCPU which is either
14095 // the default or a new one from the target attribute string. Then we'll use
14096 // the passed in features (FeaturesAsWritten) along with the new ones from
14097 // the attribute.
14098 Target->initFeatureMap(FeatureMap, getDiagnostics(), TargetCPU,
14099 ParsedAttr.Features);
14100 } else if (const auto *SD = FD->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>()) {
14101 llvm::SmallVector<StringRef, 32> FeaturesTmp;
14102 Target->getCPUSpecificCPUDispatchFeatures(
14103 SD->getCPUName(GD.getMultiVersionIndex())->getName(), FeaturesTmp);
14104 std::vector<std::string> Features(FeaturesTmp.begin(), FeaturesTmp.end());
14105 Features.insert(Features.begin(),
14106 Target->getTargetOpts().FeaturesAsWritten.begin(),
14107 Target->getTargetOpts().FeaturesAsWritten.end());
14108 Target->initFeatureMap(FeatureMap, getDiagnostics(), TargetCPU, Features);
14109 } else if (const auto *TC = FD->getAttr<TargetClonesAttr>()) {
14110 if (Target->getTriple().isAArch64()) {
14111 llvm::SmallVector<StringRef, 8> Feats;
14112 TC->getFeatures(Feats, GD.getMultiVersionIndex());
14113 std::vector<std::string> Features = getFMVBackendFeaturesFor(Feats);
14114 Features.insert(Features.begin(),
14115 Target->getTargetOpts().FeaturesAsWritten.begin(),
14116 Target->getTargetOpts().FeaturesAsWritten.end());
14117 Target->initFeatureMap(FeatureMap, getDiagnostics(), TargetCPU, Features);
14118 } else {
14119 std::vector<std::string> Features;
14120 StringRef VersionStr = TC->getFeatureStr(GD.getMultiVersionIndex());
14121 if (VersionStr.starts_with("arch="))
14122 TargetCPU = VersionStr.drop_front(sizeof("arch=") - 1);
14123 else if (VersionStr != "default")
14124 Features.push_back((StringRef{"+"} + VersionStr).str());
14125 Target->initFeatureMap(FeatureMap, getDiagnostics(), TargetCPU, Features);
14126 }
14127 } else if (const auto *TV = FD->getAttr<TargetVersionAttr>()) {
14128 llvm::SmallVector<StringRef, 8> Feats;
14129 TV->getFeatures(Feats);
14130 std::vector<std::string> Features = getFMVBackendFeaturesFor(Feats);
14131 Features.insert(Features.begin(),
14132 Target->getTargetOpts().FeaturesAsWritten.begin(),
14133 Target->getTargetOpts().FeaturesAsWritten.end());
14134 Target->initFeatureMap(FeatureMap, getDiagnostics(), TargetCPU, Features);
14135 } else {
14136 FeatureMap = Target->getTargetOpts().FeatureMap;
14137 }
14138 }
14139
getNewOMPTraitInfo()14140 OMPTraitInfo &ASTContext::getNewOMPTraitInfo() {
14141 OMPTraitInfoVector.emplace_back(new OMPTraitInfo());
14142 return *OMPTraitInfoVector.back();
14143 }
14144
14145 const StreamingDiagnostic &clang::
operator <<(const StreamingDiagnostic & DB,const ASTContext::SectionInfo & Section)14146 operator<<(const StreamingDiagnostic &DB,
14147 const ASTContext::SectionInfo &Section) {
14148 if (Section.Decl)
14149 return DB << Section.Decl;
14150 return DB << "a prior #pragma section";
14151 }
14152
mayExternalize(const Decl * D) const14153 bool ASTContext::mayExternalize(const Decl *D) const {
14154 bool IsInternalVar =
14155 isa<VarDecl>(D) &&
14156 basicGVALinkageForVariable(*this, cast<VarDecl>(D)) == GVA_Internal;
14157 bool IsExplicitDeviceVar = (D->hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>() &&
14158 !D->getAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>()->isImplicit()) ||
14159 (D->hasAttr<CUDAConstantAttr>() &&
14160 !D->getAttr<CUDAConstantAttr>()->isImplicit());
14161 // CUDA/HIP: managed variables need to be externalized since it is
14162 // a declaration in IR, therefore cannot have internal linkage. Kernels in
14163 // anonymous name space needs to be externalized to avoid duplicate symbols.
14164 return (IsInternalVar &&
14165 (D->hasAttr<HIPManagedAttr>() || IsExplicitDeviceVar)) ||
14166 (D->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>() &&
14167 basicGVALinkageForFunction(*this, cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) ==
14168 GVA_Internal);
14169 }
14170
shouldExternalize(const Decl * D) const14171 bool ASTContext::shouldExternalize(const Decl *D) const {
14172 return mayExternalize(D) &&
14173 (D->hasAttr<HIPManagedAttr>() || D->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>() ||
14174 CUDADeviceVarODRUsedByHost.count(cast<VarDecl>(D)));
14175 }
14176
getCUIDHash() const14177 StringRef ASTContext::getCUIDHash() const {
14178 if (!CUIDHash.empty())
14179 return CUIDHash;
14180 if (LangOpts.CUID.empty())
14181 return StringRef();
14182 CUIDHash = llvm::utohexstr(llvm::MD5Hash(LangOpts.CUID), /*LowerCase=*/true);
14183 return CUIDHash;
14184 }
14185
14186 const CXXRecordDecl *
baseForVTableAuthentication(const CXXRecordDecl * ThisClass)14187 ASTContext::baseForVTableAuthentication(const CXXRecordDecl *ThisClass) {
14188 assert(ThisClass);
14189 assert(ThisClass->isPolymorphic());
14190 const CXXRecordDecl *PrimaryBase = ThisClass;
14191 while (1) {
14192 assert(PrimaryBase);
14193 assert(PrimaryBase->isPolymorphic());
14194 auto &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(PrimaryBase);
14195 auto Base = Layout.getPrimaryBase();
14196 if (!Base || Base == PrimaryBase || !Base->isPolymorphic())
14197 break;
14198 PrimaryBase = Base;
14199 }
14200 return PrimaryBase;
14201 }
14202
useAbbreviatedThunkName(GlobalDecl VirtualMethodDecl,StringRef MangledName)14203 bool ASTContext::useAbbreviatedThunkName(GlobalDecl VirtualMethodDecl,
14204 StringRef MangledName) {
14205 auto *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VirtualMethodDecl.getDecl());
14206 assert(Method->isVirtual());
14207 bool DefaultIncludesPointerAuth =
14208 LangOpts.PointerAuthCalls || LangOpts.PointerAuthIntrinsics;
14209
14210 if (!DefaultIncludesPointerAuth)
14211 return true;
14212
14213 auto Existing = ThunksToBeAbbreviated.find(VirtualMethodDecl);
14214 if (Existing != ThunksToBeAbbreviated.end())
14215 return Existing->second.contains(MangledName.str());
14216
14217 std::unique_ptr<MangleContext> Mangler(createMangleContext());
14218 llvm::StringMap<llvm::SmallVector<std::string, 2>> Thunks;
14219 auto VtableContext = getVTableContext();
14220 if (const auto *ThunkInfos = VtableContext->getThunkInfo(VirtualMethodDecl)) {
14221 auto *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method);
14222 for (const auto &Thunk : *ThunkInfos) {
14223 SmallString<256> ElidedName;
14224 llvm::raw_svector_ostream ElidedNameStream(ElidedName);
14225 if (Destructor)
14226 Mangler->mangleCXXDtorThunk(Destructor, VirtualMethodDecl.getDtorType(),
14227 Thunk, /* elideOverrideInfo */ true,
14228 ElidedNameStream);
14229 else
14230 Mangler->mangleThunk(Method, Thunk, /* elideOverrideInfo */ true,
14231 ElidedNameStream);
14232 SmallString<256> MangledName;
14233 llvm::raw_svector_ostream mangledNameStream(MangledName);
14234 if (Destructor)
14235 Mangler->mangleCXXDtorThunk(Destructor, VirtualMethodDecl.getDtorType(),
14236 Thunk, /* elideOverrideInfo */ false,
14237 mangledNameStream);
14238 else
14239 Mangler->mangleThunk(Method, Thunk, /* elideOverrideInfo */ false,
14240 mangledNameStream);
14241
14242 if (Thunks.find(ElidedName) == Thunks.end())
14243 Thunks[ElidedName] = {};
14244 Thunks[ElidedName].push_back(std::string(MangledName));
14245 }
14246 }
14247 llvm::StringSet<> SimplifiedThunkNames;
14248 for (auto &ThunkList : Thunks) {
14249 llvm::sort(ThunkList.second);
14250 SimplifiedThunkNames.insert(ThunkList.second[0]);
14251 }
14252 bool Result = SimplifiedThunkNames.contains(MangledName);
14253 ThunksToBeAbbreviated[VirtualMethodDecl] = std::move(SimplifiedThunkNames);
14254 return Result;
14255 }
14256